Wireless World 1938 06

Download as pdf or txt
Download as pdf or txt
You are on page 1of 110

The

rel

THE
PRACTICAL RADIO

JOURNAL

28th Year of Publication

No. 979.

Proprietors

THURSDAY, JUNE 2ND, 1938.

ILIFFE

Editor

8r SONS LTD.

EDITORIAL

HUGH S. POCOCK.

Editorial,
Advertising and Publishing Offices :
DORSET HOUSE, STAMFORD STREET,
LONDON, S.E.I.
Telephone: Waterloo 33335o lines).
Telegrams: "L thaworld, Sedist, London."
Cove.Nrav
Telegrams:

Hertford Street.
Telephone:
Coventry.

52 to

"Autocar, Coventry."
BIRMINGHAM:

Guildhall Buildings, Navigation Street, 2.


Telephone:
Telegrams
2971 Midland (4 lines).
"Autopress, Birmingham."
:

MANCHESTER

260, Deansgate, 3.

Telegrams:
Manchester."

'" Mitte,

Telephone:
Blackfriars 4412 (4 lines).

GI.Ascow 26e, Renfield Street, C.2.


Telegrams: " (WU., Glasgow." Telephone. Central 4857.
:

PUBLISHED WEEKLY.

ENTERED AS SECOND
CLASS MATTER AT NEW YORK,-N.Y.

Subscription Rates :
Home, ;fis is. 8d. ; Canada, Li is. 8d. ; other
countries, Lt 3s. zed. per annum.
As many of the eirc,ats and apparatus described in these
pages-ore ',coveredby -patents; readers-are advised; before
me.43ting use of them, lo satisfy lhemsetves Oral they would
riot be infringing patents.

CONTENTS
Page
Editorial Comment
Stage Amplification
The Acoustic Labyrinth
The Home Laboratory, VI

481

482
485
487

Peto -Scott DP Communication


Receiver . .
. .

490

Sell -Ranging Milliammeter

492

News of the Week

494

Unbiased

..

496

Letters to the Editor

497

New Range of Valves (Concluded)

498

Random Radiations
Broadcast Programmes

500

Recent Inventions..

500
502

High -Fidelity Broadcasting


New Control Technique Needed?
TO criticise the quality of the
B.B.C. ultra -short-wave broadcasts, for which we have so long
pleaded in this journal, may
seem ungracious, especially at this early
stage. But we feel bound to express
mild disappointment at the opening
transmissions of the present experimental service if, as we hope, this
feature is to become permanent, its
potentialities will be largely wasted
unless it is conducted on the soundest
possible basis.
It was not a little disconcerting during the first concert to find faults in the
balance of the transmission of so serious
a nature as almost to obscure the improved transient and high-frequency
response of which ultra -short-wave
broadcasting is capable. The balance
may have been suitable enough for the
long-distance land -line relays to those
countries who were taking the Toscanini concert on that particular
occasion, but the local listener had the
impression that the overpowering bass
was more than the violins could support-let alone penetrate.
At the second concert balance was
very much better but there were one or
two irritating lapses on the part of the
control room which were quite unmistakable on account of the sensitivity
of
" high-fidelity " equipment
to
changes in microphone noise level.
;

Unworthy of USW
The point that emerges is that the
routine balance and control methods,
while good enough for medium- and
long -wave broadcasting as received on

VOL.

XLII.

No. 22.

COMMENT
ordinary standard sets, hardly suffice
for transmissions of the quality obtainable in the television sound channel.
A revision of control technique and
perhaps a little more care generally will
be needed if the new service becomes
permanent.
But, if the potentialities of the ultrashort-wave service are to be realised to
the full, is a mere revision of the
normal broadcasting technique enough?
We consider that it is not, and suggest
that the service should be planned
from the start to do the fullest justice
to the most highly developed reproducing equipment. In particular, the
volume range might be extended considerably, as there would be no need to
bear in mind the users of standard
Io -guinea sets with strictly limited
outputs ; in fact, the activities of the
control section might be heavily curtailed on most kinds. of transmission.
Volume expansion (of which the complete success is at least problematical
unless a complementary automatic
compression system is in operation at
the transmitter) would then becorze
unnecessary even in receivers designed
for the highest quality.

Independent Balance and Control


If this suggestion were adopted, it
would, of course, no longer be possible
to " tap off " modulation for the ultra short -wave channel from the National
switchboard. An entirely independent
balance and control system would be
necessary, but, in our view, the relatively slight extra cost would be well
justified.
Be this as it may, it is unfortunate
that some satisfactory solution was not
found for the major problems of balance
and control before the start of the
experimental service, over which many
critical musicians were sitting in

judgment.

The Wireless World, une

482

2nd 1938

Stage Amplification
TO

preserve the illusion Of


naturalness is perhaps the
greatest difficulty in the use of
amplifying equipment in the
theatre ; this and other problems
peculiar to this specialised branch
of sound reinforcement are discussed in the present article by -a
contributor who has had wide
experience of the subject.

By ALEXANDER BLACK (Alexander Black Ltd.)

N a recent Editorial in The Wireless


World, the question of sound rein-

would tend to destroy the illusion of


naturalness and put the stage on a level
with the cinema as regards artificiality.
It is sometimes maintained that presentday actors and actresses are not training
their voices to carry over the footlights,
but Mr. Cochran thinks the need for amplification is largely due to the public becoming accustomed to the high level of sound

forcement in the theatre was discussed, and- the prejudice of some


theatre managements against the use of
microphones in the footlights to help
artists voices was criticised.
There is no doubt that the.. early t. p(
of installation in theatres was .unsatisfactory, due. 'to the poor frequency respons(
of the microphones then used, and the
unsuitable! and in many cases unsightly.
positions of the loud speakers. The -result
was that the dialogue was distorted and
the audience was in many cases disconcerted by hearing the sound apparently
coming from various parts of the, auditorium instead of only from the direction
of ..the stage.; The unfortunate result is
that some managers still cannot believe
that there has been a great improvement
in stage amplification in the last year or
two. Further, many theatrical people are

very conservative and staunchly maintain


an attitude summed up in the words " We
were able to do without microphones in
the old days ; why should we want them
now? "
Since the coming of Talkies the public
have found out that it is possible to hear
easily in the cinema, even in the back
seats, which certainly cannot be said of a
number of theatres, and to make matters
worse some actors and actresses, after a
spell of film work, find that on returning
to the theatre stage they are apt to forget
to speak up, and so cannot be heard with
any ease by the audience unless assisted
by microphones in the footlights.
C. B. Cochran's Views
The writer was fortunate in being able
to have a talk on the subject with Mr.
C. B. Cochran during the rehearsals of his
new show " Happy Returns " at the
Adelphi Theatre, where extensive use is
Mr.
being made of microphones.
Cochran considers that stage amplification
should only be used where the lights and
shades of the unassisted human voice
cannot be heard distinctly in every part
of the building.
He regards it .as essential that the
audience should be unaware that amplification is being used ; such knowledge

auditorium, though sometimes this trouble


only affects a few isolated seats.
It is usually difficult to hear in back
rows of the stalls under the circle ; in sonie
theatres the cut-off by the circle is very
pronounced ; similarly, the back rows of
the dress circle are affected, especially if
the headroom to the upper circle is low.
The gallery in most cases hears quite well,
the sound being reflected from the auditorium ceiling.
In eliminating these " dead spots " each
theatre has its own problems. First, it is
essential that the reinforced sound should
only appear to come from the direction of
the stage ; secondly,' the audience should
not be conscious of the existence of loud
speakers in the auditorium ; thirdly, there
must be no distortion of artists' voices.

Illusion of Naturalness
In order to satisfy the first condition, it

is usually necessary to have a loud speaker


on either side of the proscenium, and it is

desirable to have further loud speakers


working at a lower volume to cover the
sides of the back stalls and circle.. The
volume has to be carefully adjusted to
avoid them becoming obvious by being
too loud.
To satisfy the second condition, the loud
speakers must be concealed as much as
possible, and this, of course, depends on
the scheme of decoration in the auditorium ; where there is ornate carving, etc.,
round the proscenium arch it is often possible to fix the speakers on baffles covered
with gauze material the same colour as the
paintwork, and it is quite surprising how
the speakers seem to disappear into their
surroundings. In others it is sometimes
possible to let the loud speakers into the
wood panelling surrounding the proscenium, This method as applied at the
Adelphi Theatre in London is illustrated
in an accompanying photograph.
To satisfy the third condition, it is
essential that the- microphones should be
very sensitive, as they must be able to pick
up artists' voices up to 25ft. away. The
microphones should be small, so that they
are unnoticed by both audience and
artists.
The writer is in complete agreement
with " Cathode Ray " in his interesting
article on distortion_, especially with -regard
to his remarks on straight-line frequency
response. An amplifier for microphone
work in the theatre having a frequency
characteristic level from 20-10,000 cycles
is often unsatisfactory ; it must be remembered that in an. average theatre full of
people the upper frequencies are absorbed
-

One of the loud speakers at the Adelphi


Theatre. A little retouching has been done
on the photograph to make clearer the position of the instrument.

intensity in cinemas. He holds that we in


this country have something to learn from
America, and cites the large Radio City
Theatre, where " a whisper from the stage
carries to any part of the house without
any suggestion that amplification has been

used."
There are, of course, a. number of
smaller theatres with reasonably good
acoustics in which stage amplification is
quite unnecessary and one or two of
medium size have excellent acoustics and
really do not want any help from microphones to get a play across the footlights
In many of the larger
satisfactorily.
theatres there seems to be a definite need
for microphone assistance ; some " dead
spots " are almost certain to exist in the

The Wireless World,

June 2nd, 1933

493

-SOUND REINFORCEMENT
IN

tunately, this- has two objections ; first, the


difficulty of finding a suitable position
where he is unnoticed by the audience,
and, secondly, if there are off-stage effects
to be worked as well during the show, the

THE THEATRE

;ar more than the lower and middle ones,


and it is therefore up to the amplifier to
level things out by emphasising the higher
frequencies. Each theatre must have its
overall characteristic curve of its amplify-

ing and reproducing equipment adjusted


to suit the auditonum acoustics.
The
type and positioning of loud speakers has
also to be taken into consideration when
planning an installation.
Usually it is necessary to arrange for a
rising curve at the higher frequencies,
starting at about 5 to 7,000 cycles ; at times
it is even advisable to attenuate the bass.
Peaks in the characteristic curve must be
avoided at all costs, as their presence
causes stage amplifying equipment to howl
back before any useful amplification can
take place. In the opinion of the writer
small ribbon velocity microphones are by
far the best type for this purpose.
Although their response is not absolutely
linear, this can easily be corrected in the
amplifier. If properly designed, they are
devoid of peaks and can be made very

In the Brasserie at the Coventry Street


Corner House. One of the ceiling speakers
with a deflector to facilitate the downward
diffusion of sound is seen.

The Prompt Corner


at the Adelphi. One

of the stage microphones can be seen.

near the footlights.


The volume level of
any of the loud
speakers used in the
theatre can be regulated from this point.

sensitive. The
amplifier should
also be absolutely
free from h u m,.
which in the case
of most London

theatres

is

problem as the electric supply is D.C.,


and thus the use of
a rotary converter
is involved.
As can be seen
from the picture of
the Prompt Corner at the Adelphi Theatre
there are a great many cables for the lighting system and wires galore for cue lights
and buzzers; the majority of these are not
metal-sheathed and, in consequence, great
care has to be taken in running microphone lines. Insulated shielded cable has
to be installed, especially if ribbon velocity
microphones are being used, in order to
avoid DC ripple being picked up by induction from the mains. The DC -AC converter for the amplifier has to be put out
of the way, usually under the stage, as
there is often a considerable external field
from these machines. When the theatre
supply is AC, conditions are much easier,
thanks to the absence of a converter and
other DC motors, although insulated
shielded microphone cable is still advisable
for ribbon microphones. Footlight microphones have to be mounted on a very flexible, shock -absorbing suspension in order
to avoid picking up the vibrations on the
stage caused by walking and dancing. The
picture shows a special type of horizontal
ribbon microphone and its suspension used
at the Adelphi Theatre.
T.) get the best results from stage amplification, it must be controlled intelligently ;
the correct volume for each turn or scene
must be found during rehearsal. It is probably not realised that quite wide variations
of volume setting are.required for the same
artist but with different stage sets ; as an
instance, in the new Adelphi show there
are approximately 6o cues for change of
volume on the footlight microphones. The
best position for the operator is obviously
in the auditorium, either at the back of
the stalls or dress circle, so that he can
have a direct indication of results. Unfor-

operator is out of touch with the stage


manager, and so difficulties in working
may arise. In a few theatres the operator
is stationed with the orchestra ; this, in the
opinion of the writer, is definitely wrong,
as he is too near the stage to hear if his
speakers are working. In any case, he is
deafened by the orchestra, and is still out
of touch with the stage manager for offstage effects. The best place on the whole
is in the Prompt Corner, as then he can
check stage amplification with headphones, and he is in immediate touch with
the stage manager for off-stage effects.
(The writer hopes to deal with amplifying
equipment for stage effects in a further
article.)

Downward Diffusion
An interesting installation of stage amplification has recently been carried out
at a theatre in Blackpool, where, in addition to the usual two proscenium speakers,
thirteen smaller speakers have been distributed throughout the auditorium. Some
of these speakers are mounted vertically
in mushroom -shaped baffles, which are
fitted below the speakers and above the
audience ; it was found that this plan gave
very good diffusion of sound, which
apparently came from the stage. This
type of installation may also be seen at
Lyons' Coventry Street Brasserie.
The advantages of downward diffusion
of sound, as shown in the photo of the
Brasserie, is that, providing there is some
form of deflector between a speaker in the
ceiling and someone standing beneath it,
it is not possible for him to detect the
origin of the sound, as it appears to come

Wpg20

48'F

JUNE znd, 1938.

Woplid

Stage Amplification-

from all directions. In the above cases


the illusion of direction is given by the
original sound waves coming from the
stage, and in the c.se of the theatre this
is helped by the proscenium speakers.

Another problem was that the orchestra


was rather trapped in the pit, and the
string instruments were hardly heard, so
the expedient was tried of giving; two
violins and the 'cellist small lapel microphones for picking up their instruments,
and a microphone in the
piano for helping the
rhythm. This made a
The layout of the Trocadero- Grill Room can be
gatnered from the sketch,
the position of the stage,
seen below,isalsoindicated.

Emergency Broadcast
Calls
IN

national emergency the broadcast


service offers a direct and convenient
channel for the distribution of authoritative news and for issuing official instructions to the nation at large. In addition,
it might prove useful, on occasions, for
sending out special warnings to any particular locality.
This presents no difficulty, provided listeners were " on the alert," so to speak,
for special announcements of the sort,
.

The Trocadero Grill Room, in which


Mr. Cochran presents an elaborate supper-

li

time cabaret every night, is a place which


presented many unusual problems. The
sketch plan indicates its awkward shape ;
the section A is quite lofty, but the rest
of the room has a fairly' low ceiling.
Without amplification, only the audience
in the centre of section A could hear comfortably ; the rest could only see the
show. It was necessary that all the loud
speakers should be concealed, but unforthe most suitable positions
artistically were not necessarily the best
positions acoustically. However, of the

The microphones on the stage in the


Grill Room are concealed as far as
possible, one suspended microphone can
be seen just in
front of Mr. C. B.
Cochran, who is
standing on the
runaway in front
of the orchestra
pit. Two footlight

microphones are
also just visible.
The violinists and
'cellist are seen
to the left wearing
lapel microphones.

big improvement in
getting the melody
over satisfactorily.

Each group of

microphones is controlled separately,


so

thirteen

loud speakers installed, only


one is in any way noticeable. A further
difficulty was the orchestra pit, which in
a sense is in the middle of the stage to
pick up songs and dialogues five microphones are used, only. one of which is
really noticeable, being suspended over
the centre of the runway.
;

that a good

balance is obtainable.
This idea
was first used in
America, and certainly offers scope for further experiments
in large halls or even in small ones which
happen to have bad acoustics.
In conclusion, the writer wishes to
express his thanks to Mr. C. B. Cochran
and Messrs. J. Lyons and' Company for
help given to him in the preparation and
illustration of this article.

though it would not be so easy to ensure


that an emergency call would be heard by
all those concerned if it came suddenly and
unexpectedly. Some sets would be out of
use at the time, whilst others might be tuned
to different stations, and so would miss any
broadcast appeal.
The situation could, of course, be met if
each house was fitted with a separate
" stand-by " receiver-which might be a
simple crystal set-coupled to its own aerial
and arranged to sound an automatic buzzer
alarm in response to a special " call " signal
sent out on a fixed frequency. Something
of the sort is, in fact, used to allow Headquarters to attract the attention of police
patrol cars wherever they may be.
Apart altogether from emergency requirements, the idea of fitting up a separate and
inexpensive " calling device " has recently
been put forward in America as a means of
attracting listeners' attention to the fact
that some specially " red-hot " news is a'but

to be transmitted.
The " news call " is given by a single valve unit which is fed by a separate aerial
and tuned to a fixed frequency outside the
normal broadcast range. On receipt of a
special call signal it sounds a buzzer alarm
to attract the listener's attention. It can
be left- on " stand-by " duty alone, for
coupled in parallel with the receiver proper
so that it can make its "call" and interrupt any programme that is being received,
or it can be switched right out of action if
the programme is too good to be interrupted,
even for red-hot news.

The !Fireless World, June 2nd, 1938

The Acoustic Labyrinth


HOW IT IMPROVES

By LAWRENCE G. SNELL
ONE of the most formidable pro- simple or inexpensive to design a diablems to be overcome in the phragm suspension which presents a subquest of high -quality reproduc- stantially constant restoring force at large
.tion has always been that of pro- amplitudes. The same may usually be
viding the loud speaker with a satisfactory said of the field system, which is likewise
baffle. The prinonly uniform over
c i p a l shortcom,a limited displaceings of the averment. Therefore,
THE author shows the advantages
age.
large, undamped
cabinet as a baffle
vibrations of the
of the acoustic labyrinth over the
may be classified
system will give
conventional baffle or cabinet as a
under three headrise to amplitude
mounting for a loud speaker. He also
ings
First, exdistortion, again
cessive "box
describes the construction of a labyrinth
particularly
noresonance '' ; seticeable at low frethat is well within the capabilities of
condly, poor baffle
quencies.
the amateur handyman.
effect; and thirdly,
From the foreinsufficient load going observations
ing of the speaker
it should be clear
diaphragm.
that adequate loading of the diaphragm
All these shortcomings particularly is of primary importance. Another result
affect the low -frequency response. The of insufficient damping is that at the
natural resonance of the diaphragm itself
. first is due to the major resonance of the

receiver

:-

.air column contained within the cabinet,


and gives rise to the only too familiar
` booming "
effect, especially noticeable
in the large deep cabinets in which most
radiograms are housed. This resonance
is usually of the order of 50-100 cycles,
and is often supplemented by the natural
resonance of the speaker diaphragm. The
%econd fault particularly applies to small
cabinets, and results in a pronounced falling-off of the bass response due to interference effects from the rear surface of the
diaphragm. Thirdly, the question of
loading and damping. It is quite obvious
that the effective load on a diaphragm
vibrating in free air must be small, and

1330

Fig. 2.-Diagram showing phase displacement of transverse wave in a tube when the length L equals
half a wavelength. Vertical arrows show relative direction of motion of air particles. Wave1,too (velocity of sound)
length (in feet) =
frequency in cis
the coil impedance is subject to wide vari- reinforces that from the' front surfaces of

ations-another source
especially

with

>

ACOUSTIC RESISTANCE AT OPEN END


1

-4LENGTH

it is therefore necessary for it to vibrate


with considerable amplitude to radiate the
requisite amount of acoustic energy. This
introduces difficulties. It is by no means

One.
END

TUBE

tube, open at its other end and having non-absorbent walls. This is really
analogous to a transmission. line terminated in a fixed resistance, the latter being
equivalent to the free end of the tube.
The theoretical variation of resistance presented to the diaphragm with wavelength
is shown plotted in Fig. i, from which it
will be seen that a pronounced peak occurs
whenever the length of the tube equals
an odd quarter -wavelength of the applied
sound, i.e., at IA, 4A, etc. At the minimum points, which occur every half -wavelength, the resistance presented to the diaphragm is merely that of the open end of
the tube. Furthermore, at every odd
half -wavelength the phase at the open end
is opposite to that of the diaphragm, and

DRIVEN

PERFORMANCE

soo

"

P2

LOUD -SPEAKER

of distortion,
pentode -type output
valves. The ideal
" infinite " baffle
would, of course,
answer objections
one and two, but
would do nothing
to improve the
third. I need
hardly enlarge on
the effect of damping on transients.
- In considering
how the " acoustic
labyrinth " helps to
solve the foregoing
problems ..it will be
helpful to examine
the effect of coupling a loud speaker
to the end of a long

Fig. i.-Variation of acoustic resistance of


a tube, open at one end and with a loud
speaker coupled to the other end. The
full curve relates to an unlined tube and
the dotted curve to a lined tube. A=
wavelength of applied sound.

Reference to Fig. 2 should make this


clear.
If matters could be arranged so that the
resistance peak at IA (Pi), would fall at
the natural resonance of the speaker,
thereby damping it ; and so that the phase reversal point P2 builds up the bass response at that point, we should have
partly overcome the defects of the orthodox baffle. This arrangement would,
however, be subject to one serious defect
in that these effects repeat and at higher
frequencies pronounced irregularities in
the response would result. It is well
known that the effect of most sound -absorbent materials increases rapidly with
frequency, so that by lining our tube with
such material we can suppress the unwanted higher frequency resonances, and
also reduce the sharpness of the peak at
Pi, a very desirable feature. Thus at
higher frequencies the reproducer behaves
as a single sound source-in effect, an infinite baffle. To sum up, the lined tube
gives adequate loading at low frequencies,
especially in. -the region of the diaphragm
resonance ; bass boost by phase reversal ;
and " infinite baffle" effect in the upper
registers.
A practical labyrinth construtel by the
it.

WegIlgAg

486

JUNE end, 1938.

WOrfIld
Labyrinthauthor employed a B.T.-H. loin. speaker
of early pattern, and measured approximately zft. 6in. by 2ft. 6in. by eft. overall.
The natural resonance of this speaker was
found to be in the neighbourhood of 40
cycles, and a simple calculation gave the
wavelength equivalent to this frequency
The Iength of
as approximately 28ft.
tube required was therefore 7ft. The tube

The Acoustic

was formed within the cabinet .by inserting three " baffle "

When considering the inclusion of a labyrinth in a complete receiver it should be


remembered that the shape of the cabinet
is not of first importance from the acoustic
point of view, provided that it will contain the labyrinth, and also that 'the
arrangement is unaffected by the proximity of a wall as are most Cabinet speakers.
In the case of. the writer's labyrinth, a
high -quality amplifier was available for
driving it. This amplifier had an undis-

the orchestral basses being very realistic


and The smooth, even reproduction of
organ pedal registers was quite exceptional.
The upper frequency response,
that is, over 4,000 cycles, was, as might be
expected, limited by the characteristics of
the speaker, but the expected improvement in transient response was amply
borne out in practice. The outfit handled
up to 6 watts without showing signs of distress, somewhere about double its output
with an ordinary baffle.

plates horizontally
across it as shown
in Fig. 3. These
were held in position by fillets of
inch. square-section
wood. Both cabinet
and divisions were
constructed of *in.
plywood, a material
which possesses a
remarkable degree
of mechanical rigidity ,and can, moreover, be obtained

PYE ALL -WAVE AERIAL


Pye " Double -3 " All -Wave AntiStatic Aerial kit comprises 6oft. of
screened transmission cable, aerial and receiver transformers, and aerial wire in addition to insulators and fixing brackets.
The transformers are of the iron-core type
and the receiver transformer has a centre tapped primary and an electrostatic screen

THE
SPEAKER
MOUNTED
HERE ON

SMALL

SUB -BAFFLE
DETACHABLE

LID REMOVED

TERMINATING
APERTURE

Fig. 3.-Constructional details of the


labyrinth described
in the text, with
one side removed to show interior.
interior surfaces are lined.

All

torted output of well over 8 watts, and


had-an -excellent transient response, being
resistance -coupled throughout. Field excitation for the speaker was provided from
with several sorts of surface veneers. The the amplifier power unit. One of the first
speaker was mounted in the upper left- things to be noticed on test was a dehand corner of the cabinet on a sub -baffle cidedly unpleasant 5o -cycle hum, which
slightly spaced from the end face, , in was obviously due to the very considerable
This was cerwhich is a loin. square aperture concealed response in that region.
by an ornamental fret. The sound -ab- tainly an anticipation of what to expect in
sorbent material, consisting of hair felt -the way of bass response, and was only
about tin. thick, was loosely tacked to removed by the addition of another stage
the inside surfaces with short wire nails,
three thicknesses being employed in each
section except the lowermost. The hair
felt is in the form of large rectangular
sheets, and it was found most economical
to cut strips exactly the width of the inside of the cabinet and to fold these
around divisions hand the top, sides and
bottom, tacking it down as loosely 'as posAfter this operation all that resible.
main are the detachable back and three
small rectangles. The back of the box,
fitted last, was similarly covered with three of smoothing to the early stages of the amlayers of the felt ; and, when screwed on, plifier, a measure not previously necessproduced a completely lined conduit, with ary.
the loud speaker at its upper end,' and
Listening tests soon showed a very
terminating in a small aperture in the bot- marked improvement. The absence of
tom left-hand corner.
the usual " boom " from cavity resonance
gave rise to a vastly more natural reproduction, especially on speech, and it was
Permissible Modifications
obvious that the degree of coloration due
Many variations of this construction to spurious peaks and harmonics was of a
will, no doubt, suggest themselves, it be- very low order. It was also noticed that
ing of small consequence what form the even with very considerable power the
tube takes, provided that the correct amplitude of the speaker diaphragm was
length be employed and the loud speaker quite small, demonstrating the adequacy
With smaller of the loading, and, no doubt, account
closely coupled to it.
speakers, the natural diaphragm resonance ing for the entire absence of any "crosswill in all probability be higher, thus ne- modulation" between the treble and -bass
cessitating a shorter labyrinth, though registers. The extent of the bass response
naturally with a diminished bass range. was highly satisfactory, the string tone of

between primary and secondary. This not


only prevents the transference of interference to the receiver, by capacity in the transformer, but makes it possible to operate the
cable in a properly balanced condition so
that its effective pick-up of interference is at
a minimum.
The transformers cover the
wide range of 7-2,000 metres without switch-

ing.
The aerial wire is insulated and has seven'
copper and two steel strands, the latter
being included to give greater strength and
reduce stretching. The wire may be erected
in various ways according to individual

circumstances.'
If a suitable tree or pole is available an
inverted -L aerial should be used with the
down -lead at the end remote from the house.
The total length of the horizontal span and
the down -lead should be 6o feet; and the
aerial transformer fitted just above ground
level. The cable connection to the receiver
can be buried if desired.
Where such an arrangement is inconveni-

The Pye All -Wave


Anti -Static Aerial
Kit.

ent, a T -Dipole can be used. This consists


of two horizontal stretches of zo-3oft. each;
with the aerial transformer mounted between them.
The down -lead from the
transformer then consists of the screened
transmission cable.
A similar arrangement known as the "AllDipole " can be adopted when interference
is very bad.
The difference, however, is
that the aerial must no longer be horizontal,
but inclined at an angle. The connections
to the aerial, transformer are also different.
With the inverted-L and the All -Dipole
arrangements, these systems are operative
on all wavebands, but with the T -Dipole the
system functions as a T-aerial on medium
and long wavebands and as a dipole on
short.
The aerial is available from Pye, Ltd.,
Radio Works, Cambridge, and is priced at
Lz 2s. 6d.

The Wireless World, June 2nd, /938

487

The Home Laboratory


APRACTICAL ,design is given
in this.instalment fora dynatron test oscillator with AOC and
provision for modulation at various
frequencie.; ranging from 5o to
io,000 cis. Some of the uses
of the oscillator in conjunction
with cathode-ray gear are discussed.

Part VI.-DESIGN OF SIGNAI. SOURCES


The circuit is arranged so that a voltage
of loo is applied to the screen of the
AC/ S2 (dynatron) valve, and 5o to the
anode. Without AOC the tendency would
be for oscillation, once started, to reach
a 'peak amplitude of at least 40. The
initial grid bias supplied to the AC/ S2 is
about -2 volts ; little enough to allow
oscillation with the LC circuit of lowest
dynamic resistance, and too little to avoid
over-oscillation and consequent distortion
at most of the frequency-switch positions.
A greater bias, totalling 17 volts., is
applied to the V914 diode, delaying

of condensers of the same nominal capacities, or to supplement them with padding

condensers.
The approximate frequencies given in
the different switch positions with the
components specified are

:-

Switch

By M. G. SCROGGIE,

Position

Frequency
C/S

B.Sc., A.11I.I.E.E.

3
4

N the last article it was explained why


a valve oscillator in its simplest form
is unsuitable as the basis of a labora-

tory signal source-the waveform,


amplitude, and frequency calibration are
at the mercy of circuit conditions that are
liable to vary, particularly if the apparatus is to provide more than one frequency. On the other hand, the dynatron
oscillator with automatic oscillation control offers a number of important advantages, including constant amplitude and
good waveform without any special
adjustment during use.
Four years, ago * the present writer
gave information for making a dynatron
oscillator, giving a selection of separate
frequencies between 5o and io,000 c/ s.
Since then he has had occasion to construct another similar oscillator, improving on the old design by incorporating
-AOC. Fig. i shows the complete circuit.
Details are given of the components in
case it is desired to follow this design
exactly ; but there is no special significance
in the specified values of smoothing condensers-they happened to be available
in a standard block.
It may be as well to repeat the warning
that a high -resistance potential -divider for
supplying the anode is useless, owing to
the negative resistance characteristics of
the dynatron.

50
70

115

8
9
10

C/S
1,000
3,000
4,500
7,000
10,000

250
450

Frequency

Switch
Position

As the switches are ganged it i^, possible


to mark the frequencies on the scale

traversed by the control knob. In order


to avoid an. excessive number of coils,
several frequencies are obtained from a
single tapping, and the L / C ratio changes
very considerably from one position of the
switch to another.
Without AOC it would be necessary to
adjust by hand in order to avoid excessive
harmonics and variations in output.

rectification until the peak oscillation


voltage exceeds that amount. Any extra
is rectified and applied as additional bias
to the AC/S2, until equilibrium is established, which is generally when the oscillation is about 19 volts peak. There is;
therefore, no probability of it reaching
anywhere near the bends of the dynatron
characteristic slope, and distortion is very

sl

1.2 H

oN 000voQQ ra
0.6H0 00.25

BOH--

03
---02
020

x-01

90--0

100-'

100

5,000 0

2w

0.01 mfd
4M

5,0009
1W

/1

OUTPUT

9vwwv

AC S2

mid

0.1

4.000 9
1

1.500

Safety Precautions
As there is no transformer winding for
supplying anode volts the circuit is in
direct connection with the mains, and the
precautions that usually apply to DC mains
apparatus should be adopted to prevent
contact with any part of the circuit other
than the secondary of the output transformer. The design can easily be modified by using a mains transformer with
HT winding, and perhaps a larger output
stage. The output of the oscillator as
specified is about 15o milliwatt:i ; and the
output transformer should be selected to
suit the work in view-a multi -ratio type
is very useful. If particular frequencies
are required with any exactitude it may
be necessary to play about with a number
>a

The Wireless World,

July zoth, 1934.

0.25 W

10 mfd

170
0.25 W

14
44

mid.

1,250 9

50 m id.

1W

rh/M1/10

1,000 9

mid.

rV
20 H
30

01

T 15

111130E

MAIN S

Fig. 1.-Complete circuit diagram of one form of controlled dynatron audio -frequency oscillator.
The rectifier is a Westinghouse Type HT15.

With AOC and no manual adjustment the


waveform is very good, and the maximum variations in amplitude are within
0.5 db.

slight, what there is being due almost


entirely to the V914 control valve (and,
at the lowest frequencies, to the iron cored coil). The coils, incidentally, are

Wp@Il@OS1

JUNE 2nd, 1938.

%Ad

The Home Laboratory-

radio -frequency oscillators, of course ;


and, as explained last -time, another
valuable advantage is the ability to
modulate it up to roo per cent. with
negligible distortion and negligible power
from the modulating source, which may
itself conveniently be another AOC
dynatron.

the same,as those used in the earlier oscillator, and are made by Wright and
Weaire, from whom the smoothing choke
also can be obtained. To minimise rectifier distortion, the leak and filter resistances are as high as 4 megohms.
As it is undesirable to draw power

shown) is needed, as in Fig. i ; unless, of


course, the oscillation is picked up by
radiation or very loose coupling.
A system along the above lines can be
made the nucleus of a signal source for
testing receivers, RF stages, and detector
stages, particularly where substantially
distrtionless modulation of variable
depth is required. In' conjunction with a
cathode-ray tube some very searching
tests can be carried out. With regard to
that, it may be of interest at this point
to refer to the most generally useful of
several cathode-ray tube methods of testing modulation depth and distortion. It
is very simple. The modulating signal
is connected across one pair of plates, and
the modulated signal across the other.
'

MODULATED
OUTPUT

1.514p

gg"11-11111

G01

n,a

RE
CONTROL

IRF

IVI

1e00riqME

OSC.

\j.
M..Y

i,ilJ

0.05 t
.---,,-y-,ww-^
/ \
74..

CONTROL

RECT.

11.--4>AE

RECT.

l/p+
1Dy

OSC.

jj

.JU

..W.8

,..s

a, s0G

$Z

,M^.

LT,

2500!

,,1,1

U.-IMO

000,
A

e,000n

--11
1

1
G

T'

... GG,...,
2

Fig.

.I

41

I''

O
-H T

z.-Circuit of two controlled dynatron oscillators, one modulating the other. Amplitude and
modulation depth can be conveniently adjusted.

direct from the oscillatory circuit, a buffer


or output valve is used. An AC/ P valve
with 175 volts on the anode would be
overloaded by the full signal of 19 volts
or so, and is tapped down as shown.
It is useful if the potentiometer controlling
the output is calibrated in decibels, as this
enables measurements of amplificationto
be carried out very quickly and easily,
using merely some sort of indicator to
keep at constant level the output from
the amplifier being tested.
An oscillator of this sort can be used
for taking frequency characteristic curves
of transformers, amplifiers, tone control
circuits, etc. ; for cathode-ray tests ; for
bridge measurements ; and other purposes. It is a straghtforward and stable
piece of equipment, and the only serious
disadvantage is that-it cannot easily be
made to cover the whole band of frequencies continuously, To do this conveniently it is necessary to adopt the
heterodyne (or beat -frequency) principle.

Shortcomings
Now although the beat-frequency oscillator is very simple in principle (being
employed unwittingly by owners of the
cheapest sorts of receiving sets when they
make them oscillate on a station), it is a
very difficult job of design when required
as a signal source. The Sullivan beat frequency oscillator, for example, costs
250. The defects of the cheap sorts are
chiefly a drifting frequency calibration ;
poor waveform, especially at low frequencies ; output varying with frequency ;
radio -frequency leakage ; and spurious
whistles. It is too big a subject to be
dealt with in part of one article.
The AOC dynatron can be used for

There are all sorts of possible arrangements, according to what is required.


Fig. 2 is a suggestion. It shows two
dynatron oscillators, one for radio frequency and the other for the modulation frequency ; both are amplitudecontrolled. The slider Sr adjusts RF and
AF amplitudes simultaneously by biasing
the cathodes of both control rectifiers.
The percentage modulation is, therefore,
unaffected by this adjustment, and either
its knob, or the DC voltmeter V, may be
calibrated to read amplitude.
With the slider S2 in its lowest position
the bias applied to the RF control valve
is steady, and so the RF amplitude is also
steady. But if the slider is moved up,
an audio -frequency alternating voltage is
superimposed on the steady bias, and the
RF amplitude similarly alternates, or in
Other words is modulated.
When S2
reaches the top position the alternating
bias equals the steady bias, and the modulation is ioo per cent. The control S2 can,
therefore, be calibrated in modulation
depth.
Actually the voltages do not work out
quite so simply as this, and some allowance, found by trial, is necessary for the
initial biases required by the dynatrons
before control becomes effective, and for
the imperfection of the rectifier ; but the
principle holds good. By making the
normal amplitude fairly large, the initial
bias variations are relatively small, and
the system conforms approximately to the
simplified description just given.
Component values are marked, to give
some idea of suitable magnitudes ; but
they depend to some extent on the frequencies to be covered. And to prevent
the external circuit from affecting the
radio frequency, an output valve (not
'

Testing Power Handling Capacity


For example, suppose one wants to
test a final IF amplifier stage for its
ability to handle a large output without
distorting the modulation. The stage is
represented in Fig. 3 by the valve V and
IF transformer T. The resistance shown
connected across the secondary is the detector load. With the usual arrangement, in which the transformer coil _and
diode detector are in series, the circuit
shown is obtained by earthing the anode
of the detector. The deflector plate R is
shown connected across part of the resistance, as it may be necessary to do so to
prevent the deflection from running
beyond the screen.
But -first the oscillator should be tested,
if that has not already been done. The
horizontal deflector plates, being connected to the modulating signal (e.g.,
across S2 in Fig. 2), draw a horizontal
line across the screen when no signal is

3.-Use of cathode-ray tube in


modulation depth and freedom from
tion of the modulated signal. It is
connected for testing a stage of IF
amplification.
Fig.

testing
distorshown
or RF

applied to the vertical plates. But if the


plate R is connected to the modulated
output, a parallel -sided figure appears,
such as those shown in Fig. 4. When the
sloping sides are straight lines, as in
Fig. 4 (a), modulation is undistorted.

Wp@Ilggs,

JUNE znd, 1938.


The Home Laboratory

(A+B).

megohms. The amplitude of output at


which distortion sets in, and any change
in the depth of modulation, can be
detected by means of the methods under
discussion.
Further tests can be made with the
signal- and/or AVC-diodes in operation,
the cathode-ray plates being connected
across the corresponding load resistances.
The effects of delay voltage, distortion
due to AC -load being materially lower
than DC load, and leakage of IF into
AF circuits, can all be traced. When the
deflector plates are across the AF volume
control, the figure disappears except for
2

It is important to understand that


" undistorted modulation " is not intended to imply that the modulating
signal is a pure sine wave, but only that
the modulation process
the modulating signal,
form it may have.
The percentage depth
loo (A - B).
given by

489 -

Wr.lcl

does not distort


whatever wave_

of modulation is

Fig. 4 (b) is an

example of distorted modulation ; and an


appearance such as (c) indicates over modulation. With perfect roo per cent.
modulation the figure is an isosceles
triangle. A phase
shift is shown by
-the sloping sides
opening out into
double lines.
Fig. 4.-Typical ex-

mrle of modulation
figuresonthe cathoderay screen. (a) is
modulation without
distortion ; (b) with
distortion ; and (c)
shows Over-modulation.

Having made sure that the modulation

of the oscillator is satisfactory over the


full range of adjustment, one -can transfer
the plate R to the output of the amplifier
under test, the output of the oscillator

being suitably reduced. If the signal


across the primary of the IF transformer
were required to be examined, the plate R
would be connected to the anode of the
valve V through a condenser of about
o.000r mfd., and also to the anode of the
cathode-ray tube through a leak of about

one of the sloping sides, if IF has been all


filtered away. If not, a figure of appreciable area remains. -Absence of distortion at this or any subsequent point is,
of course, indicated by straightness of the
line. But the most favourable condition
for showing up distortion is when, by
adjustment of signal amplitudes at the
deflector plates, the line is at an angle of
A great disparity between vertical
and horizontal amplitudes is useless for
distortion testing.
45

Television Images
SPECIAL screens have been used to reproduce a televised picture by incandescent
instead of fluorescent light. In the so-called
projection tube, for instance, an intensely
brilliant picture is formed by bombarding a
small metal screen only a few microns thick,
the incandescent image then being projected
through a magnifying lens on to a large
viewing screen. By contrast any fluorescent
material has a definite limit of brightness
beyond which it is impossible to go without
risk of burning out the screen.
In practice the incandescent screen is
usually made of very thin tantalum, tungsten or molybdenum, and is initially heated to
a temperature just below the glow point by
current from a local battery. The bombardment of the screen by the electron stream
from the gun of a cathode-ray tube is then
sufficient to create the details of the picture
in varying degrees of incandescence, ranging
from red to white heat. The thinness of the
metal ensures rapid cooling and prevents
undue persistence of the glowing points.
Trial has also been made of a screen of very
thin wire, o.00rin. in diameter, woven into
This is
a mesh of, say, zoo to the inch.
found to improve the cooling effect without
sacrificing any detail of the picture formed
on the mesh as a whole.
As a further advance (Patent No. 479318)
a screen capable of reproducing an incandes-

For

Projection

cent picture of high light -intensity is built


up of number of coils r, 2, 3 of thin tungsten wire, each separately spot-welded at W
to a supporting frame (see accompanying
diagram). The wires are less than a. thousandth of an inch in diameter and are wound

Coiled wire elements are employed to reduce


thermal lag in the incandescent screen described in Patent No. 479318.

1,200 turns to the inch. They are supported and kept in one plane by a series of
cross-wires A, B, C, also spot-welded to the
frame.
This screen construction permits of a certain amount of expansion and contraction
under the heat of bombardment, without
creating a-ny noticeable distortion of the pic-

ture. In order to reduce the scanning voltages required, the screen is initially raised to
a temperature just below the glow -point,
either by feeding current to it from a local
battery, or by heating its surface with infrared rays. Or th screen may be sprayed
uniformly, for the sanie purpose, by electrons coming from a separate gun to that
which supplies the .modulated scanning
stream.

Photoelectric Cell Applications.


Third
edition.
By R! C. Walker, B.Sc.
(Lond.), and T. M. C. Lance, Assoc.
I.R.E. Pp. 336+x., and 200 illustrations. Sir Isaac Pitman and Sons,
Ltd., 39, Parker Street, London,
W.C.2. Price 12S. 6d.
7N this third edition of a very acceptable
1 book the rapid expansion of the subject
is reflected in an increase by about 4o per
cent. in the number of pages and illustrations (and price) compared with the previous
edition reviewed in 1935.
Although the applications and even the
existence of photoelectric cells are still
almost unknown to the general public, it is
not too much to say that nobody with a
practical interest in any branch of industry
or science can any longer afford such ignorance. The variety and ingenuity of photocell applications is quite astonishing, and
so is the simplicity of some of the arrangements by which such a refined product of
research is made to serve under unskilled
supervision.
The volume under review gives only such
theory as is necessary fof understanding the
use of cells. The applications described are
interesting not only for their own sake but
for suggesting how readers' own problems
may possibly be solved. _Enough information on circuit values and on practical
limitations and difficulties is given to enable
the reader to devise many sorts of apparatus
for himself or to get the best results from
any in his charge.
After-an extensive chapter on general
methods of use, the authors deal separately
with counting, timing and mechanical handling devices alarms, indicators and safety
devices ; advertising sound reproduction ;
phototelegraphy ; television ; scientific instruments ; and miscellaneous applications.
Photo -cells are made to serve even such purposes as ensuring that cigarettes are all
packed in boxes with their trade -marks
facing upwards.
.
The briefest chapter but one is on television, and most of that is devoted to Baird
systelnss Marconi-E.M.I. not being specifically mentioned. The iconoscope is dismissed
in a page and a half, and the super -iconoscope omitted entirely. The latter should
certainly be brought into the next edition,
but it is no doubt wise to devote most attention to those applications on which little
information is available rather than television, which is comparatively well known.
The treatment is on the whole very clear,
but the term " sparking voltage " at the
foot of page 14 does not appear to be defined, and the authors should note that
"preventative" is not recognised by any
dictionary. The practice of dividing decibel
scales in steps of 3, described as general, is
one that the reviewer has not met hitherto,
nor does he see why plotting response curves
on a logarithmic base of frequency should
necessarily make the performance of the
apparatus appear very mich worse than an
aural test (page 187).
M. G. S.
;

The TVireless World, June 2nd, 1938

490

Peto Scott
DP COMMUNICATION RECEIVER
A Dual -Purpose

FEATURES. Waveranges.-(1)
metres.
metres.

Superheterodyne for
Broadcast and Morse
Reception

(2) 22-65 metres.


(4) 800-2,000 metres.

(31)

10-2

200-50

Circuit.the current on the heaters.


This feature
will be appreciated by those who propose
to use the instrument in close proximity
to a transmitter.
Provision is made in- the aerial couplings for the use of either a dipole or a
conventional single -wire aerial. The RF
amplifier functions on all four wavebands
and feeds a triode hexode frequency
changer which is controlled with the RF
valve and IF amplifier from the AVC line.
A double -diode _.pentode combines the
functions of secord detector, AVC rectifier and output valve. The latter section
is rated for an output of 3 watts, and is
provided with a variable tone control
across the anode circuit. Telephones are
resistance capacity' fed,- and the jack
switch automatically substitutes a suitable
load resistance for the loud speaker output transformer.
As a broadcast receiver the set performs
well on the medium and long waves.
The overall magnification._ is excellent,
and the sensivity is well maintained at the
ends of scale. About it channels are lost
on either side of the. London Regional
transmitter at a distance of fifteen miles,
and on long waves.the Deutschlandsender
can be received with average sideband
interference from Droitwich and Radio

Var.-mu pentode RF amplifier-triode-hexode


frequency changer-var.-mu pentode IF amplifier-triode beat oscillator-double diode
pentode 2nd del., AVC and output valve.

Full-wave valve rectifier. Controls.-(1)


Tuning. (2) Waverange. (3) AF volume
control and on -off switch. (4) RF gain and
HT switch. (5) Tone. (6) AVC and beat

THERE are many technical features in this receiver which will


appeal to the short-wave receiving and transmitting amateur,
but scope of the set is not confined strictly
to his rather special requirements. 'Long
waves up to 2,000 metres can be received
as well as the usual medium -wave broadcast band, and the quality of reproduction is much better than is necessary for
amateur experiments in communication.
The coloured tuning scale is indirectly
illuminated and is of the conventional
" all-wave " type with a few wavelength
calibrations, but .plenty of station names.
There is no auxiliary band spread dial,
and the amateur bands are indicated by
short dashes similar to those shwing the
limits of the broadcast bands on the two
short-wave ranges.
When used as a normal broadcast receiver tuning will therefore present no
difficulty to the non -technical members of
the household, and in exchange for the:
few concessions made in their interest the
short-wave enthusiast is presented with
a number. of refinements found usually in
communication type receivers of much
,

oscillator

switch.

Price. -111

guineas.

Makers.-Peto

Scott Co., Ltd., 77, City


Road, London, E.C.1.
J

higher price. AVC is optional, and may


be cut out by-means of a rotary switch
when Morse signals .are to be received.
A further turn of the switch brings into
action a beat frequency oscillator coupled
to the IF stage and giving a heterodyne
note near the middle of the audio frequency scale for pure CW reception.
The beat frequency may be adjusted by
means of a trimmer in the coil can immediately behind the HL4 valve on the
chassis.
In addition to the usual AF volume
control and mains. on -off switch there is
an RF gain control incorporating a switch
at the minimum position which breaks the
main HT supply to the valves but leaves
.

Complete circuit diagram. Most of the amplification is provided by the RF and IF stages.
The beat oscillator and AVC are controlled by a three-position ganged switch.

e--

__,

II

I
1
f

I
Ai

Az

o
JJJJ

HFO

AVC

SWITCH
N

.RF GRIN

.NTRGL

Wee@go

JUNE 2nd, r93S.

49r

WopIlc1
Paris.. The few self -generated whistles
developed in the circuit are all to be found
on the longrwave 'range, the other wavebands being entirely clear. .
Making allowance for the restriction of
bass in the interests of low background
noise and microphony on short waves the
quality of reproduction is well balanced
and clear-cut. In this direction a happier
compromise between -the requirements of
the experimenter and the broadcast listener could hardly have been fcund.

FREQUENCY

CHANGER

TH 4A

VALVE

range is switched .on and the stronger


carriers are able to provoke microphony
with both RF 'and AF volume controls at
maximum. The RF control is the more
effective in dealing with this trouble, but
when stability is reached the loud speaker
volume available with the AF control at
maximum is hardly adequate. On short
waves the set will undoubtedly give of its
best with headphones which are well
suited to a receiver with more RF than AF
amplification.

IF AMPLIFIER

VP4B

VALVE

RECTIFIER

VALVE

APV4

OUTPUT
F

VALVE

DDPP4B

AMPLIFIER
VALVE
V P 4 B

TELr: HONE
JACK

BEAT

FREQUENCY
OSCILLATOR
VALVE

HL4

After this there is a chapter on high-definition mechanical systems, which is followed


by one dealing with the television receiver.
In this RF and IF tuned circuits are treated
in addition to the choice of intermediate frequency and VF couplings. The first part of
the book concludes with the subject of
aerials.
The second part represents about one quarter of the book and deals with transmitting technique. It begins with photocells, goes on to discuss the optics of
mechanical scanning systems and then deals
with electronic methods. Film transmission
and vel_ci.ty modulation have chapters to
themselves, and are followed by one on
colour television. The book concludes with
a short appendix on the decibel and an
index.
The book covers a wide field and can be
confidently recommended to those seeking
something more than a superficial knowledge
of television. It is not, however, of a highly
technical nature and is substantially nonmathematical.
The book is well printed and bound and
unusually free from errors. One questionable statement appears on page 79, however.
It is said that in a time -base amplifier grid
bias is obtained by grid current action.
Actually, however, this distorts the sawtooth waveform in a way which is probably
most noticeable as an increase of fly -back
time. Consequently, it is the general practice to use cathode bias and to arrange the
operating conditions so that grid current
does not flow.
W. T. C.
.

2nd DETECTOR
AVC AND
R

'Wireless World
COPYRIGHT

Club News

The cabinet is constructed of steel with a crystalline black finish. All RF components
including the first two valves in the circuit are contained in a separate rubber -suspended unit.

Of the two short-wave ranges the lower,


covering wavelengths from io to 25
metres, is the quieter. It does not seem
to matter, even on strong signals, whether
the AVC is in or out on this range, which
rather suggests that the quiet background
is related to the general sensitivity rather
than to an exceptionally good signal-tonoise .ratio. There is a considerable jump
in noise level when the second short-wave

Thus the receiver fits well into the


arrangements of a family with wide and.
varied wireless interests.
During the
earlier part of the evening weight of
opinion will be in favour of medium and
long waves and the loud speaker, but
later the younger members of the family
will be able to try their hand at really
long-distance reception on short -waves
without causing annoyance to anyone else
however late the sitting. The pleasure
they derive will be enhanced by the knowledge that they have at their command
all the auxiliary services of a professional
" communication " receiver, and a field
for experiment and skill in handling
denied by the conventional all-wave
receiver.

,----IF--

Stafford and District Short-wave Club

Headquarters: 21a, Sandon Road, Stafford.


Han. Sec.: Mr. G. I.. Wale, " Branksome," Acton Gate
Stafford.
-

This club has been recently formed.


On May 23rd a cine lecture was given by
Mr. W. G. J. Nixon of the Osram Valve Technical Department.
At the conclusion of the
lecture Mr. Nixon carried, out some, experiments with photo -electric cells.

Exeter and District Wireless Society


Headquarters: 3, I)ix's Field. Exeter.
Meetings: Mondays at 8 p.m.

Hon. See.: Mr. W. J. Ching, 9, Sivell Place, Reavitree,

Exeter.

On May 22nd' members of the Society were


conducted over the Exeter Odeon Theatre. A
very interesting time was spent in the operating room.
Several records were played in
order to demonstrate the quality of the amplifying system.
There are no ful-ther meetings until the
autumn session commences in September.

Robert Blair Radio Society


Television.
By J. H. Reyner, B.Sc.
Pp. 224+xi. Second edition. Published by Chapman and Hall, Ltd., rr,
Henrietta Street, London, W.C.2.

OET

OUTPUT

the early

PHONES

f-

CO

W,TCN
WITH

rN,N

CONTROL)

chapters of this

book the

INauthor describes a number of the many


mechanical systems of television which have
been used at one time or another. He then
deals with the characteristics of the eye in
relation to television, and in this chapter
flicker, interlacing and illumination are discussed.
The cathode-ray tube is treated in the
following chapter, which also includes some
notes on high -voltage supply circuits. Time bases have a chapter to themselves, which
is followed by a discussion of synchronising,
including the allied subjects of sync separation, DC restoration and the transmitted
waveform.

Headquarters: Islington Men's Institute, Blundell


Street. London, N.7.
Meetings: Wednesdays at 8 p.m.; Thursdays at 8 p.m.
Han. Seo.; Mr. A. R. Richardson, 24, Mercers Road,
London. N.L'I.

\Vhen the weather improves, the Society


hopes to arrange some field days.
Wednesdays are usually given up to
theoretical talks of interest to beginners while
the advanced group is improving its morse.
On Thursdays practical work is undertaken.

Belling-Lee Transmission Line


describing this non-hygrosccpic twin
feeder cable on page 43o of the May
12th issue, figures were given fer an earlier
type of cable. The specification of the twin
feeder now being supplied is as follows
characteristic impedance is 8o ohms and loss
per loo ft. 3 db, both at 45 Mc/s. The price
per standard reel of 65 ft. is los. 6d.

The Wireless World,

June 2nd,

193S

Self-Ranging Milliammeter
M1ULTI-RANGE milliammeters of

the ordinary sort are very useful


for general testing, but they all
have a number of disadvantages. Although the work in hand may
demand all one's thought, a certain
amount of mental energy must be sidetracked for deciding on the appropriate
range and switching the meter accordingly. A moment's
inattention or
thoughtlessness, or
a pure accident,
and flick
the
pointer is wrapped
round the.stop,.and
a moror less costly
meter repair becomes necessary. Qr, if
a fuse is thoughtfully provided, " bang
goes saxpence " on a new one, and even
then the instrument may not be any better
for the nasty jolt it has had. Lastly; a
multi -range meter is usually a good deal
more expensive than " corresponding
single -range type.
The ideal thing is a. meter that automatically adjusts itself to the current it
- gets, -go that one does not have to.give any
thought to range switching ; and even if an
accidental short does occur the pointer is
still somewhere on the scale.
As I explained several years ago,' such a miracle
exists, and is actually cheaper and simpler
than the common range-switching system.
It is nothing else than the well4 nown
metal rectifier. The resistance of a rectifier diminishes as the current through it
increases, which is jtist What we ,want for
an automatic or safety shunt for a.meter.
!

Using a Selenium

Rectifier Shunt

'

'

Choosing the Shunt


In. selecting. a .rectifier shunt these are
the requirements
(r) Near the zero end of the meter
scale the -resist -of the rectifier to be so high in relation' to the
resistance of -the meter'that practically the
full sensitivity of the latter for small currents is preserved.
(2) The resistance of the rectifier to be
so much -lower than that of the meter When
the latter is passing its full -deflection current as to bring the total current to a suitably high value.
(3) With the rectifier shunt -in place, no
part of the meter scale to be unduly
crowded.
(4) The shunt current when the meter
is fully deflected to be within the safe
rating for the rectifier.
To make these stipulations clearer, let
us consider a particular example, making
use of a meter reading up to 5 milliamps.
And suppose that in order to provide a
good margin of safety, and to include all
readings likely to be wanted we aim at
a full-scale reading, when shunted, of i
1 Jan. iith, 1935.

:-

7.

amp. (i,000 milliamps.). Therefore, making sure of requirement (4) first, the rectifier should be rated to carry i amp. (to be
very exact, of course, the rectifier current
is 0.995 amp. at full-scale deflection).
The voltage drop across a single rectifier
disc at its maximum current rating is in
the region of volt, so the meter resistance
to pass 5 milliamps. must be about 15o
ohms. The resistance of most o-5
moving - coil milli ammeters is less
than this and must
therefore be increased. This can
be done experimentally by connecting the rectifier, supplying and keeping adjusted a total current of i amp., and adjusting the extra
resistance of the milliammeter until full
deflection is just obtained (Fig. I).
Now see how much the shunt affects the
deflection near the minimum, say, at i
milliamp. If there is no perceptible effect
at all, it would seem to follow that the
upper parts of the scale will be very
crowded in order to cover the whole range
up to z,000 milliamps., and the resistance
of the shunt should be lowered by using
a larger rectifier disc. " On the other hand,
if the shunt reduces the deflection almost
to zero the instrument loses most of its
effectiveness for reading such small currents ; but if the size of the rectifier is reduced it can no longer carry r amp., and
we must be less ambitious about the fullscale current. Fortunately, the deflection
with r mA falls to about o.8 mA on the
original scale, which seems quite reasonable, and the rest of the scale up to i,000
mA is then calibrated by means of a multi range meter, borrowed for the occasion if
necessary.
The scale having been adjusted at the
top and near the foot, its exact distribution
in between depends on the characteristics

'

R2

By

"CATHODE RAY"

available rectifiers. Assuming that


equal prominence is desired for all parts
of the scale, rather than open readings
here and crowded ones there, the ideal
is a logarithmic scale. In such a scale the
distance between, say, i and 2 milliamps.
is the same as the distance between 2 and
4 or ioo-and 200. In the airangement I
described previously, using a Westinghouse copper -oxide rectifier, more than
half the scale was occupied by the relatively uninteresting readings above loo
mA. If anything, this part of the scale
ought to be more crowded than the rest ;
an effect which, however, does not seem
to be obtainable. A considerable improve of

Fig. 2.-Circuit of suggested arrangement for


increasing the full-scale reading of a mlliammeter from 5 to r,000 while leaving the
sensitivity to small currents practically unimpaired. The rectifier is Type D84 -I-1 (Standard Telephones and Cables) and the meter is
a Ferranti.

ment could be made, using the Westinghouse rectifier specified by lowering the
full-scale current and reducing the meter
resistance accordingly. But if a wide
range of logarithmic scale is wanted, some
tests I have been carrying out show that
the selenium rectifier sold by Standard
Telephones and Cables possesses special
advantages.

Protection Against Reverse Currents

Fig. I.-Method of adjusting the full-scale


reading of the rectifier -shunted meter Ms.
The rheostat R2 is used to adjust the current
to the required amount, shown by M2, and Ri
is then adjusted so that full deflection of Ms i;
obtained. RR are the rectifiers.

For r amp, full scale, the most suitable


standard selenium rectifier is the D84-1-1,
which consists of two discs in series,
tapped at the junction. This is just what
is wanted, for if only one disc were used
there would be no protection against accidental reverse currents. So they are connected as shown in Fig. 2, with one disc
each way. The resulting scale is shown
in Fig. 3, in which it can be seen that
nearly equal room is given to the ranges
z -ro, ro -roo, and roo -r,000, with actually
slightly more for the much -used r-zo mA
range than for the others.
In writing about rectifier shunts previously I pointed out their two disadvan-

JUNE 2nd, 1938.

493

WOplc1
Self-Ranging Milliamipeter--

2
s

10

20

MILLIAMPERES

Television
Programmes

tages. One-the more serious-is the


influence of temperature on their characteristics and consequently on the accuracy
of instruments of which they form a part.
I tested samples of both selenium and
copper -oxide (Westinghouse) rectifiers in

hour's special film transmission intended for the industry only will be given
from 11 a.m. to 12 noon each weekday
An

Q,

Vision
45 Mc's

THURSDAY, JUNE znd.


Night in June," musical pia), including
Queenie Leonard and, Charles Hickman. 3.20,
Gaumont-British News. 3.30, 151st edition of
Picture Page.
9, Repetition of 3 p.m. programme. 9.25,
British Movietonews. 9.35, 152nd edition of
Picture Page. 10, News Bulletin.
3.,

...

Sound
41.5 Mc!s
'

FRIDAY, JUNE 3rd.


3, Suggestions for a Picnic by Marcel Boulestin.
3.25 - 4.15,
3.15, British Movietonews.
" Derby Day," a comic opera by A. P. Herbert,
with music by Alfred Reynolds.
Gaumont -British
an extemporised oven-consisting of a 9, West End Cabaret. 9.30,3 p.m.
programme.
9.40, Repetition of
cardboard box fitted with a small electric News.
9.55, Cartoon Film. 10, Clothes Through the
heater and a thermometer-and found that Centuries. 10.25, News Bulletin.
over the range of atmospheric temperaSATURDAY, JUNE 4th.
ture, 41 deg. -roo deg. F., there was noth- 3, " In Our Garden," by C. H. Middleton.
ing to choose between them. A rectifier- 3.15, Gaumont -British News. 3.25, " Eastern
shunted meter is suitable only for com- Cabaret " a development of the popular
paratively rough tests, with possible errors feature, " Cabaret Cruise."
up to 15 per cent. at extreme tempera- 9, Victoria Hopper in " The Constant Nymph,"
famous play by Margaret Kennedy and
tures, assuming the meter to be calibrated the
Basil Dean. Cast also includes Margaretta
at the probable mean temperature, usually Scott and Doroty Hyson. 10.30, News
Bulletin.
about 65 deg. F.
The other disadvantage is that even
SUNDAY, JUNE 5th.
when the irreducible minimum of one 3-3.45, Polo O.B. from Hurlingham.
rectifier disc is used as a shunt, the volt- 8.50, News Bulletin. 9.5, The Birmingham
Seven for a Secret."
age drop is greater than in the best types Repertory Company in "News.
10.15-10.40,
10.5, Gaumont -British'
of multi -range meter. This is rather a The Ballets Jooss in " The Big City " and " A
nuisance, for example, when measuring Bali in Old Vienna."
filament current, the total voltage of the
MONDAY, JUNE 6th.
circuit being only 2. Using the Westing- 3, Polo O. B. from `Hurlingham-The Empire Cup.
house LT4 rectifier previously suggested 3.40, " The River," a film depicting. the story
(as that was the most suitable type listed of the Mississippi Valley.
at the time, in spite of its two discs in 9, " With Your Permission," a play including
Haydn and Arthur Marshall. 9.35,
series in each path) the voltage drop at Richard
British Movietonews.
9.45, The Vic -Wells
full scale is 1.4, which for the purpose "Ballet. 10.15, News Bulletin.
just mentioned is absurd. But a WestJUNE 7th.
inghouse rectifier with one disc per path, 3, Starlight.TUESDAY,
3.10, Friends from the Zoo.
now
the LT7A, is
available, and halves 3.25, British Movietonews. 3.35, " Rory
the voltage drop. It is, in fact, a shade Aforesaid," a West Highland comedy by John
better in this respect than the selenium Brandane.
9," Speaking Personally." 9.10, Friends from
rectifier. Zoo. 9.25, Gaumont -British News. 9.35,
The advantages of the rectifier-shunted the
Ray Ventura and his Band. 10, News Bulletin.
meter are most realised in fault-locating
WEDNESDAY, JUNE 8th.
and other uses where the current may be
" The Old and Young," a comedy by Louis
very different from what is expected, and 3,
3.15, Cartoon Film. 3.20, Starlight.
high accuracy is generally unnecessary. Goodrich.
3.30, Gaumont -British News. 3.40, The Vic The commonest of all faults-intermittent Wells Ballet.
contact-is the most liable to damage in- 9, Starlight. 9.10, British Movietonews. 9.2C,
struments not provided with rectifier Exploration Talk. 9.35, Cartoon Film. 9.45,
The Vic -Wells Ballet.
10.5, News Bulletin.
shunts.

pedance down to a value that is a reasonably


good match to the centre of a half -wave
aerial.
The high impedance feeder consists of two
7 /o.otin. stranded-wire conductors spaced
approximately /in., the surge impedance of
this line being given as 35o ohms. Calculation based on the wire size and spacing produced a figure of 38o ohms. The small difference could quite well be accounted fr in
the measurements of the wire and the spacing, as an ordinary ruler was employed.
The high impedance feeder is light, compact and flexible, and, unlike most open-wire
lines, the spacing throughout cannot change.
Very tough insulating material is used,
this being described as "chlorinated vinyl,"
for which is claimed a very low power factor.

Fig. 3.-Scale of shunted meter (in Fig. 2)


compared with the original one. It is almost
perfectly logarithmic from 0.5 to 1,000 mA.

High- and low -impedance feeders with


insulated and spaced conductors.

Both these feeders are, of course, equally


suitable for transmitting as well as for receiving aerials.
Supplies are obtainable from the Electrical
and Physical Research Laboratory, 72a,
North End Road, West Kensington, London,
W. 14, the price being 5s. 6d. per 12 yards
for the low impedance feeder and 6s. for the
high impedance line.

Cossor Model 397

"

There is an application where the rectifier shunt has no disadvantages-for pro-

tecting bridge galvanometers. Anybody


who has used a Wheatstone bridge knows
how much care is needed 4o prevent the
galvanometer from damage due to excessive unbalance. What is wanted is an
indicator that is extremely sensitive close
to zero, but will take almost unlimited
current without bad effects ; a sort of
AVC, in fact. That is just what the rectifier shunt provides, and as the measurements do not depend on the scale readings
the effects of temperature are entirely unimportant.

SHORT-WAVE AERIAL FEEDERS

COME examples of feeders for short-wave


Li aerials that are being made in this country have been sent in for examination.
One is a low impedance cable, for which,
however, no values are given, and this consists of two parallel insulated wires. If these
wires were air -spaced the characteristic impedance of the cable would be of the order
of 17o ohms. In the production cable the
size of the wire is to be increased from No.
22 to No. Ig SWG, i.e., 1 mm. diameter,
which, in conjunction with the higher capacity of an insulated line, will bring the im -

TEN stations may be selected automatically by the " Teledial." control in this
new table model AC superheterodyne.
Normal tuning is by means of a two -speed
drive, and 44 station names are marked
on the flood -lit dial. The circuit includes
an RF stage, and two degrees of selectivity
are provided in the IF circuits. A large
triode in the output stage feeds a loin.
moving -coil loud speaker, and the cabinet
presents a large frontal baffle area with a
comparatively- shallow depth from back to
front. The price of the Model 397 is
rij guineas.

The Wireless World, June 2nd, 1938

494

THEN AND NOW


IN

seven years the B.B.C. has


doubled the hours devoted
to gramophone record broadcasts, according to statistics
just prepared showing the
amount of time given to thirteen different types of programme from 1931 to 1937. In
1931 records were transmitted
for 616 hours 41 minutes,
whereas in 1937 they were
allotted 1,246 hours 3 minutes.
Drama broadcasts were more

B.B.C. Takes Stock


Interesting decreases are re-

corded. Dance music showed a


considerable drop over the
period; in 1931 the B.B.C. stations gave us 1,089 hours of
jazz, but in 1937 only 734 hours.
A still bigger drop is shown in
Children's Hour transmissions,
which fell from 1,552 hours in
1931 to 897 hours last year.
The total hours of British
broadcasting increased by relatively little in the seven years

B.I3.C. COMMENTATORS, looking down from this observation box into


the vastness of Rushmoor Arena, will endeavour to convey to listeners
some of the glittering pageantry of the 1938 Aldershot Tattoo. A pre-

liminary broadcast will be radiated at 3.zo p.m. on Tuesday (Reg.) and


three transmissions on Wednesday, beginning at 10.15 p.m., will be,
relayed in the National programme.

In

under review.

HIGH FREQUENCIES IN
NATURE
THE B.B.C. mobile recording
unit is trying to find
feathered songsters or talkers
who can be induced to face the
microphone and, incidentally, to
provide owners of high -quality
receivers with a chance to test
their instruments on nature's
own audio frequency generators.
Last week Mr. H. L. Fletcher,
chief of the mobile " flying
squad," went to Woodford,
Essex, to test the claims of
" Joey," a budgerigar with a
vocabulary of fifty words and a
frequency scale ranging between
256 and 12,000 cycles, and as a
result it is expected that a recording of Joey's voice will
shortly be broadcast.

Synoptic weather information


will be exchanged between the
forecasting centres at Karachi,
Delhi, Calcutta and Poona in
India and Rangoon in Burma.
It is hoped to arrange for the
Poona station to exchange the
information collected from the
other Indian and Burmese stations with synoptic reports from
countries to the east and west.

DELHI METEOROLOGICAL

CENTRE

AFORECASTING meteorological centre" is expected


to be established at Delhi, ani3
a short-wave wireless station to
meet meteorological requirements will be erected at Poona.

1931

THE B.B.C. Acoustic Section


at Nightingale Square, Bal ham, under Mr. John McLaren, is
making a close study of resonant
absorption of sound. There are
two reverberation rooms of different sizes and two experimental studios, also of different
sizes. The reverberation rooms
are used for carrying out routine
measurements on the sound -absorbing properties of various
materials and for laboratory
types of measurements, and the
test studios are erected to try
out various types of acoustical
treatments in practice. The

two reverberation rooms are


lined with tiles. This is not a
new method of changing the reverberation period rapidly, but
of obtaining as long a reverberation period for the room as is
possible so that comparatively.
large samples of material can
beameasured. The tiles are not
moveable (as was recently stated
in these columns), but are
cemented to the walls of the
room in the usual manner.
On the completion of any new
studios, and also when time permits during their construction,
investigation and measurements
are made in order to gain information for future design.

the

variety and
doubled
revue were nearly doubled running commentaries were exactly
doubled, the time given to these
in 1937 being z68 hours as compared with 134 hours in 1931.

than

ACOUSTIC RESEARCH
-Tests with Reverberation Rooms

figure was 12,718 hours 23 minutes ; in 1937 it was 33,737 hours


59 minutes. These statistics do
not include Empire and television programmes.

SUPERIMPOSED IMAGES
IN TELEVISION
COMPOSITE television is the
subject of a patent recently
issued to J. C. Batchelor, of
New York. Ile claims that by

means of his invention one subject can be superimposed upon


another without causing the
ghost effect, familiar to many
viewers in this country.
The apparatus, which is
known as a distortion amplifier,
interrupts the scanning spot
from that part of the background covered by the image of
the main subject.

CHECKMATE ?
THE opening move in a same

of chess between the B.B.C.


and listeners will be broadcast
after the 7 o'clock news on
Friday, July 1st. By the following Monday morning it is hoped
that chess players all over the
country will have sent in their
suggested move to Broadcasting
House, and the most favoured
one will be announced at the
same time as before on Monday

evening.
These short broadcasts on the
progress of the game will continue each Monday, Wednesday

and Friday.

IMPRISONMENT

SAILORS OPERATE TO BROADCAST INSTRUCTIONS

Radio Act now before the


Parliament at Ottawa carries
with it fines up to $500, a year's
imprisonment and the seizure of
the radio set for unlicensed
possession of a receiver. The
revised law also calls for the use
of a search -warrant being issued
to police officers or radio inspectors if there is any suspicion
that there is an unlicensed receiver in a house. Our correspondent says that the radio tax
is the most disliked in Canada.

wireless messages passed between two ships in the Indian


Ocean.
On one, the Greek
cargo boat Shelatros, a member
of the crew was in agony with
an abscess in the back. On the
other, the Port Wellington, the
doctor (a brother of Clyde Fenton, Australia's well-known flying doctor) was answering the
S O S for medical help.
Messages were sent telling the
officers of the Shelatros how to
go about the required operation.
" I don't quite know even now

FOR UNLICENSED CANADIAN LISTENERS


AREVISION of the Canadian

FOR thirty-six hours last week

The Wireless World, June 2nd, 1938

WEEK

THE
what happened," Dr. Fenton
said. " Possibly the only equipment was what the chef could
supply, but the last message was
that the patient was recovering
from the operation and was doing well. I left them with instructions as to his diet."

FROM A.L.
QUARTERS
Thirty-one Million of Us

pirates, the B.B.C.


now estimates that the potential
listener audience is approximately
31,000,000. The figure is based on
the total number of wireless
licences (8,609,800) multiplied by
the size of the average household,
i.e., 3.6 persons.
OMITTING

Television Home Constructor


YOUNG
radio engineering
student, Pat Hansford, of Portsmouth Municipal College, has constructed a television receiver with
which he reports the reception of
excellent pictures from Alexandra
Palace at Bognor Regis. The re-

ceiver has also been used with an


Soft. aerial at the College, where,
although screened by Portsdown
Hill (400ft.) which runs along the

north boundary of Portsmouth,


and with electric trains and trolley
buses in close proximity, pictures
of good contrast have been re-

ceived.
In Exchange
DURING 1937 the Italian broad-

casting organisation, E.I.A.R.,


provided 128 programmes for
foreign countries, and itself received
79
programmes from
abroad. A large percentage of the
former were undoubtedly operas.
"

Fifty Years Ahead

enthusiastic radio subscriber in the world must surely


be C. M., of Belgrade, Yugoslagia. A few days ago he sent
a cheque for 12,000 dinars (about
X54) to the radio authorities to
pay for his wireless licence until
THE most

January ist, 1988.

New York Television Sound


HIGH - FIDELITY transmissions,

such as those of the Toscanini concerts which Londoners have been


enjoying, are looked forward to by
New Yorkers, for, according to a

correspondent, the Vice -President


of Communicating Systems Inc.,
New York, has announced the
marketing of a small three -valve
receiver to cost " as little as $15
(3) for the reception of the
sound channel of `the New York
television transmissions.
Electric Fans and Radio Reception
THE curse of summer reception
in India is not so much atmospherics as the interference caused
by electric fans. According to the
Civil and Military Gazette of
Lahore, the best way to counteract this would be to relay through
the local transmitter the Empire
programmes from the receiving
station at Delhi. The journal

contends that, although this


elallorate receiving plant cost a lot
of money, it is rarely used.

Records Library
historical recordings will be
preserved 'in
Phonethque
a
Nationale which .was recently instituted by the President of the
French Republic.
ALL

Regulating School Sets


use of wireless sets in
schools in Czechoslovakia is limited
THE

to strictly educational broadcasts.


It is forbidden to use the receivers
for political purposes, and listening
to any foreign programme is prohibited.

Siam Calling
HS8PJ, BANGKOK, transmits a
programme for European listeners
every Thursday on 3r.58 metres.
The identification signal consists
of three chimes of an ascending
scale.

Paris Broadcasting House

THE site has been secured for


the erection of 'a broadcasting

house on the Boulevard des Invalides, Paris.


The building is
expected to he completed in the
spring of 194r.

AT THE FOIRE DE
PARIS, wt i h closes
on June 6th, many

receivers have automatic tuning. In


the " Melody " receiver the setting of
the preselection tele dial tuning arrangement is easily accomplished by removing the dial,
thereby exposing the
setting screws.

New Tripoli Station

Tripoli station which


the Italian Government is erecting
on the Oasis of Zanzur is to'commence experimental transmissions
in August and will be officially
'opened on October a13tp1.
Its
aerial arrays will be directional to
the east and to the west.
THE new

Battle Sounds from Loud Speakers


THE Paris correspondent of The
Times states that M. Maxime
Base, a Frenchman, is reported to
be at work oil a, PA system designed to produce most of the
sounds of battle. The apparatus
could be set up in a field, and timid
troops might be frightened into
immobility by nothing more lethal
than a series of gramophone
records played behind the enemy's
lines.
High -power Dutchman

125-k\\' transmitter near


Jaarsveld, in Holland, is expected to be ready in about
eighteen months' time. It will
make use of the wavelength of
301.5 metres, which at present is
allotted to Hilversum II.
A NEW

Sottes Radio Orchestra


the Geneva and
Lausanne studios for the services
of the Sottens radio orchestra has
now been ended by the decision to
contract the famous Orchestre
Romand, conducted by Ansermet,
for broadcasting and to station it
at Geneva. It is pointed out that
Lausanne's big studio will probably fall into disuse.
RIVALRY between

Woman Announcer at Addis Ababa


IT is interesting to note that the
chief announcer at the temporary
I kW short-wave station at Addis
Ababa is a woman, Signorina
Luisa Gasparini. The new transmitter which is under construction,
and wine ready in about twelve
months, will have an aerial power
of 5 kW, which it will be possible

to increase to 25 kW. The station


is at present using a wavelength of
31.25 metres, transmitting at 14.40
and 21.0o local time.
Swiss Licence Increase?
board of the Swiss Broad.

THE

casting Corripany has decided to


ask the telegraph administration
to increase the Swiss radio licence
from 15 to 18 francs per annum to
meet the added cost of " the
spiritual defence of the cation,' `
namely, to provide programmes
for the Swiss overseas and to extend the hours of transmissions to
counteract the effect of broadcasting from neighbouring countries.
Station Moving

transmitter of Florence II
(238.5 metres) is shortly to be
THE

proved from Via Bolognese to Tres piano, and its power increased
from r to 5 kW.
Trespiano,
where the 20 -kW Florence I
station is situated, is found to he
a more favourable site for the

propagation of wireless' waves.


The station will be equipped with
a new aerial system.

P.T.T. Headquarters
French P.T.T. will shortly
be moving to new headquarters
in the Avenues dc Saxe and de
Sgur, Paris.
THE

Marconi Patents

total number of patents


filed by the Marconi Company
during 1937 was 1.351. 252 were
filed in Great Britain, and of these
44 related to sound and vision
reception. There are now approximately 6,000 of the Company's
patents in force in various parts of
the world.
THE

Miscellaneous Advertisements and


Whitsun
\WITH the
approach of the

THE NEW SOUTH REGIONAL station buildings shown above, which are being erected about a mile from
Start Point, are rapidly taking shape although the transmitter is not expected to be in use before July next
year. It will probably radiate, on 285.7 metres, the West Regional programme f'-om Washford Cross, with
which station it would then be synchronised. Its service area, with a population of at least 3,000,000, will be
increased by the use of a second 500 -ft. mast which will serve as a reflector reducing the radiation over the
Channel. The masts will be visible over the slope of the headland shown on the left.

Whitsun holiday slight alterations


are necessary in our printing
arrangements. Miscellaneous advertisements intended for the issue
of June 9th must be received not
later than first post to-morrow,
Friday, June 3rd.

The -Wireless World, June znd, 1933

_1,.;6

to get a decent job. He recently had ar


enforced holiday owing to his firm unfortunately going on the rocks, and, although
he had applied for one or -two jobs, hehad
failed to get them, although, as far as he
knew, he had succeeded in the practical
test of his abilities_ which they asked him
to give.
When he told me the names of the firms
I must confess that I was not reassured.
They were definitely not firms of unimpeachable integrity or anything like it.
Nevertheless, it appeared to me that the
fact that they had the reputation of being
a trifle shifty in their dealings would tend
to cause them to employ any old serviceis why do reputable makers of components turn out shoddy stuff which they are men rather than for them to be sticklers
ashamed to brand with their names ? Are for efficiency.
In the end I decided that, since one of
they making hay while the sun shines and
feathering their nests by battening oh the the vacancies was still advertised, I would
unfortunate set makers, charging fabulous apply for the post myself. Consequently,
prices for indifferent products ? The I duly presented myself at the establishanswer is very definitely in the negative. ment in question and was eventually
The fault, I fear, lies with certain set ushered .by a greasy -looking youth into an
makers who won't pay a decent price for inner sanctum where I discovered a typist
The prices which the in company with a paunchy gentleman
a decent article.
particular set makers I have in mind are wearing spats and a dirty collar and with
willing to pay the component manufac- a large cigar stuck in the corner of his
turers are so low that they leave no hope mouth.
Having made known my errand I was
of a legitimate profit for them unless-they
turn out junk which, of course, they do, taken to a very ill-equipped and badly
but, as we have just seen, through no lighted workshop and bidden to exercise
fault of their own. It is small wonder, my talents on well-known make of retherefore, that they do not wish to risk ceiver which had ceased to function. The
their good name by sticking it on the job was by no means an easy one, but I
shoddy components. It is little wonder flatter myself that I carried it out creditalso that certain makes of set are subject ably, and fully expected to receive the
to as many breakdowns as they are. The appointment forthwith. I was very surnext time your set breaks down, there- prised, however, when I was told they
fore, and you have to foot the bill for a would write to me, and still more surprised
new condenser, or whatever it is,' pity the when, after a lapse of many days, I had
heard nothing, more especially as the job
poor component maker.
was ,still advertised.
It was some time before thetrue artfulServicemen, Beware !
ness of this scheme dawned on me, but
when it had done so I lost no time in inWE hear a lot of talk from time to time
concerning the alleged inefficiency stituting the necessary enquiries, from
of servicemen, many of whom, it is said,. which it appears that a very old dodge is
do not seem to have advanced much further in their _knowledge than swinging Many wireless
coil reaction techniqe.
dealers, when asked why they do not take
the trouble to employ efficient and knowledgeable servicemen, reply that they
would willingly do so but that they are
as scarce as good health in a doctor's
household.
On the other hand, it is alleged that
there are plenty of good servicemen available if the dealers would only pay them
the money they arc worth. Now I do not
propose to enter into an argument concerning this matter as, like a policeman,
"Ushered by a greasy -looking youth into an
inner sanctum."
I do not believe in intervening in other
people's .quarrels, but there is one very
shocking aspect of the problem which has being practised, not only by this firm but
been forced on my attention recently, and by others of a similar shady nature. A
serviceman's job is advertised and, since
I can do no other than relate the bar;
facts.
the pay offered is high, the very best type
A serviceman of my acquaintance,
of man is attracted and the number of
whose knowledge and skill are, as I am applicants is large. Each is given a test,
aware from personal Experience, all that as in my own case, and, of course, the
could be desired, recently approached me shady firm who are running this racket
with a request that I give him a technical get all their service jobs done for nothing.
overhaul as he rather feared that he must The worst part of the whole affair is that,
be getting too old-fashioned in his methods so far as I am aware, it is perfectly legal.

IASED

Pity the Poor Cont.pollt'flt


Makers
IDAnESAY that there are quite a large
number of you who, in your innocence,
imagine that the manufacturer of a wireless se: makes every component of it in
his own factory, and even grows the wood
for the cabinet. I well recollect that more
years ago than I care to remember I was
of the same opinion concerning my perambulator, but a tyre happened to come off
one day and when the nursemaid lifted
me out of the pram to adjust it I noticed
that it ras branded with a different name
to that on the chassis. Even then the fact
might not have impressed itself so forcibly

Hit me over the head with the tyre.

on my memory had not the nurse hit me


over the head with the tyre in a fit of rage,
due to my fumble-fistedness and slowness
in effecting the repair which caused her to
miss ar. appointment which she had made
with a soldier.
Please do not think that I am in any
way eliding you if you do think all the
components of your wireless receiver are
made by the set's manufacturer, for if you
open it up and examine the variable condenser, for instance, you will quite frequently find no indication on it concerning the firm who made it. What more
natural, then, than to think that the maker
of the sit is responsible for this component
also.
Now, I am perfectly well aware that on
reading this the first thought which will
occur to you is that if some other firm
makes certain of these components, why
on earth doesn't it stick its name on
them as a sort of free advertisement,
if for no other reason. Lest you should
jump to the conclusion that they are
turned out by some obscure cheapjack
firms v -ho are ashamed of their reputations, let me tell you that so far from
this being the case the components
in a wireless set are more often than
not made by some very well-known firms
indeed, who are afraid of risking their reputations by sticking their trademarks on
some of the shoddy stuff you find in certain sets which I could name were it not for
the archaic condition of our libel laws.
The next question which naturally arises

BY

FREE

GRID

The Wireless World,

June 2nd, 1938

497

Apart from the fact that undesirable distortion due to this cause has long been

Letters to the Editor__


The Editor does not necessarily
endorse the opinions of his
correspondents

Sunset and Fading


IAM very grateful to the three correspon-

dents who have supplemented my


article " Sunset and Fading." My reference
to weather, which " L. H." quotes, was not
meant to imply that I expected reception to
fit in with weather conditions, but rather to
point out to the weather -influence school
(with whom in general I disagree) that it
did not.
I attach much more importance to the
solar phenomena pointed out by " L. H."
and W. H. Jarvis, even though I am not
aware of any comprehensive explanation
having so far been published of what exactly
happens in daylight propagation of medium
wavelength signals. The old story was that
during daytime one received the ground
wave, which at distances outside the service
area of the station. was weak but consistent;
then as darkness supervened the sky wave
became available, which at its best was much
stronger, but unreliable owing to varying
reflections and interferences between different waves, including the ground wave,
fading generally being worst in places where
the ground and sky waves are approximately
equal and therefore likely to cancel out completely:
My experience is that it 'is the daytime
reception that is entirely 'irregular and unreliable, while reception after dark reaches
'a comparatively constant level, broken only
by downward fades. Not having kept
closely in touch with this branch of the work
I may have missed a newer theory than that
just mentioned, accounting for the actual
facts, and I would be very glad to be referred to it.
Mt. D. A. BelI's deduction seems to be
entirely justifiable. I was a little alarmed
by his suggestion of conducting a set of observations at and before sunrise, but seem
to have a good excuse in the absence of regular transmissions at that hour. On the other
hand, I may take advantage of the Autumnal Equinox to make some tests on Athlone,
although, of course, the distance, angle and
wavelength do not agree so satisfactorily. A
comparison between Athlone and Stuttgart
might be instructive.
" CATHODE RAY."
.

The Fadeout of April 15th


Observagion at G2XC, Portsmouth

LISTENING(son the 28-30 Mc/s band of


frequencies commenced at 08:15 G.M.T.
On the previos day conditions on these frequencies had been very poor 'indeed, no signals at all being heard. This morning, however, there were a number of commercial
harmonics audible at good strength (R7) and
one amateur signal, believed to be J2CE.
The commercial signals appeared to be
mainly of Russian origin. All these were
still audible at 08.41, but at that time a hissing sound, which gradually increased in
strength, was heard. It was realised that
this was probably the hiss which G6DH and
others have reported on various occasions
since late 1935. The tuning range of the
coil in the set was 22 to 32 Mc / s, and it was
observed that the hissing was strongest at
the high -frequency end. The peak strength
was reached at approx. 08.43: there was a
smaller peak about 3o seconds later, -after
which the hiss faded away, leaving the 27Mc f s band void of signals.
-

--

realised, not only in connection with valves,


but with non-linear devices generally (iron
cores, for example), it is probably true to
say that the apparent absence of interest
signifies mute assent. Had the subject been
in contravention of fundamentals there
would probably have been no shortage of
letters to the Editor. In,the case of intermodulation, however, no fundamental principles are attached, and anyone attempting
an article on " Debunking Intermodulation " would, I think, particularly after
Cathode Ray's " lucid exposition, find it
difficult to make out a case.
As a less serious challenge to "Cathode
Ray's " claims to " heresy," and by way
of reassurance to the effect that Harries'
convincing experimental results met with a
measure of response at the time, I may,
perhaps, be permitted to quote a paper of
mine despatched to the Institute of Radio
Engineers on May 22nd, 1937. This paper,
being somewhat comprehensive and mathematical, has not yet appeared in print, but
will, I gather, be issued 'shortly. Section 4
of this paper is devoted to harmonic distortion, Section 5 to intermodulation. Whereas
the results for harmonics confirm that it is
an easy matter to arrange that the total
harmonic distortion is well below 5 per cent.
of the fundamental, it is found that tones of
small amplitude can, by intermodulation
with louder tones, andin virtue of curved
characteristic, be distorted over 5o per cent,
This result would refer to a pentode obeying a 3 / 2 power law.
In the case of a
triode, obeying a 3 /s2 power law, the effect
of the load resistance' in, straightening the
characteristic brings the ftpure down to some
25 per cent. In all cases the valves are supposed to be fully driven to the zero grid axis
and any effect of grid current is neglected.
Generally speaking, .the experimental curves
of, Harries accord well with theory, but
.some of them appear to contain anomalies.
Ilford.
W. E. BENHAM.

A search was immediately made on other


frequencies (to to 16, 5 to 8, and 33 to 49
Mc / s) but no signals at all could he heard.
Every station operating on the high frequencies from 5 Mc/s upwards had disappeared. Repeated searches were made.
The first signals heard were two commercials, PDQ on 10 Mc / s and one unidentified
on 13 Mc/s (time 08.48). At 08.52 GMX
was heard sending (on 15 Mc / s) " JNC de
GMX ZAN ZFO 844 ZMR ZHC? " This
was repeated continuously for at least thirty
minutes. At 09.00 approx. G8QW in Southampton was heard calling " Test " on 14
Mc / s, and was the Only amateur signal
audible at that tim. The 7 Mc is amateur
band was " dead." Other commercial signals were by now reappearing, among the
first being DAN 12Mc / s, ' -DGR 13 Mc / s,
DFC, FYQ and others from the nearer
European countries.. At.o9.2o listening had
to cease, and except for about two minutes
at 09.4o no more Iistening could be done at
all until T1.20. At 09.40 it was observed
that the commercials had returned on 28
Mc / s. At 11.20 a contact was made with
G8WC, of Portsmouth, who reported
Mc / s conditions as " very dud."
During the remainder of the day other
signals heard on 28 Mc /s- (approx.) were
(times approx. only)
11.40 G.M.T., RKA, HAS2,
12.05,
HI7G, VU2CO, OK3TM. 15.1o, ZELJJ,
G6NZ. 17.30, ZELJA, FBRR, G5TP (flutter fade), VP6MR, G2JU (flutter), K4??.
On 56 Mc / s, at 21.06, conditions were
above normal. G2PF was R& instead of
usual R6/7, and signals from G2XC were
R6 instead of usual R4. at G2PF, Chichester.
On i t Mc / s W rXAL was inaudible at
21.55 during its URSIgram broadcast of
cosmic data. Its usual strength at that time
McMichael Model 380
is R6/ 7.
E. J. WILLIAMS.
Portsmouth.
EDITORIAL NOTE.
is pointed out by
Greenwich Observatory that the magnetic
storm type of fadeout, such as that in question,
may very -likely be due to the ejection 'of a jet
of corpuscles from the 'sun, occurring at the
time and in the region of a bright eruption in
the sun's chromosphere, some 24 to 36 hours
earlier. It is realised, of course; that the actual
particles travel much slower than the speed of
light, and, therefore, the magnetic or ionosphere storm, which results in the very poor
propagation conditions on all frequencies, does
not occur until later. By observation of sunspot activity it would seem possible to forecast
such fadeouts some 3o hours ahead.
The fadeout mentioned in the report on
April i5th by G2XC relates, of course, to the
direct effect of ultra-violet light. from the
eruption, an effect which is, naturally, more
or less instantaneous, but is of short duration
and mostly affects the lower frequencies.
In
THREE separate tuning scales for long,
other words, the so-called Dellinger effect may
medium and short waves are a feature
be the forerunner of a much more violent
ionosphere storm when the sunspot in question
of this 94 -guinea AC superhet.-the first
is near the meridian.
of the 1938 series. The circuit consists of
triode-hexode frequency changer, .pentode
" Debunking Harmonic Distortion "
IF, double diode second detector, and AVC
CATHODE RAY " rather gives the im- rectifier and pentode output valve with a
'
pression in his article that the subject rated output of ,24 watts. A two -speed
of intermodulation in valves is a new one,
drive actuates the three tuning scales simulstarting with Harries' February, 1937, Wire- taneously, and a visual indicator is used
less Engineer paper, whereas it is nearly five
for both the volume control and 'the wave years old (see references in Harries' paper). range switch.
.

-It

TF,e TT'irelesz nr7,7,

ew Rane of
SI'ECIAI. DIODE TYPES
FOR AVC PURPOSES
LTHOUGH the low-noise RF pentode in the " E " series is of
especial interest its advantages
are largely confined to the first
stage of amplification, and its low noise
properties confer little benefit in later
stages. Here other factors may be more
important, particularly the variable -mu
ch racteristics. As a result the range includes other types of RF pentode.
A variable -mu valve should have as low
an anode current and as high a mutual
conductance as possible at minimum bias,

CONTROL

CURVE

the variation of anode current with bias


for a series of values of screen -voltage.
With a constant -screen voltage the working point would be on the curve corresponding to the voltage selected.
The
dotted curve shows the effect of using a
series resistance in. the screen circuit. As
the bias is changed the anode current alters
according to this curve, but the characteristic for AC voltages is the solid line
curve which intersects the working point.
The EF9 has input and output capacities of 5F. and 7F. with a grid anode capacity of less than o.003F.
With 250 volts HT supply, the screen
should be fed through a go,000-ohgn
resistance, and the anode and screen currents respectively are 6.o mA. and 1.7 mA.
The mutual conductance is 2.2 mA/V. at
2.5 volts grid bias, and the AC resistance is 1.25 megohm. The maximum
grid bias is about 40 volts.

June 2nd,

1,,

alves

_.

Concluded from page 375 ut


last week's issue
circuits are returned through the usual
filter C2 R2 to the diode load. The seconddiode, however, has its anode connected
to the AVC line and its cathode taken to
a point about 2 volts negative with respect
to earth.
In the absence of a signal D2 conducts
and there is a current through Ri and R2
and this diode. The voltage drop across
the diode is small compared with that

The Duo -Diode


The range includes a duo -diode triode,
the EBC3, but perhaps the EB4 duo-diode
with separate cathodes is of greater interest
in view of the wide variety of uses to which
it may be put. Apart from AFC circuits,
it finds application in noise suppression
arrangements, and one circuit is shown- in
Fig. 5. This is an extremely simple
arrangement, and to clarify the diagrm
the diodes are shown separately.
One
diode is used as a detector and fed from
the IF amplifier in the usual wy, the load
resistance and by-pass condenser' being
The AF volts across this re- Ri and C2.
sistance are fed through the RC circuit C4
and R3 to the AF amplifier.
The cathodes of the controlled values
are returned, to the earth line and the grid
-

4.-When

screen voltage -dropping


resistance is used with a variable -mu valve,
the effective control curve takes the form
shown by the dash line.
a

and the maximum bias needed for control


should be as small as possible. Since the
characteristics of a variable -mu valve are
necessarily curved, there are several possibilities of trouble ; there may be distortion
of the modulated waveform, cross -modulation, modulation hum, and the introduction of harmonics of the carrier. This last
is important in the IF stages of a superheterodyne.
These troubles are minimised by the
adoption of a valve characteristic of exponential form, having a flat slope when
plotted on a logarithmic scale. Such a
curve, however, leads to a low maximum
value of mutual conductance or else a high
anode current. For instance, for a mutual
conductance of 2.0 mA/ V. and a maximum grid bias of - 6o volts, the anode
current would be of the order of 14 mA.
In the case of the EF9, therefore, the
desired characteristic is not a property of
th-_, valve alone, but of the valve in conjunction with the circuit.
The desired
result is secured by feeding the screen -grid
through a voltage -dropping resistance instead of from the more usual potentiometer. The result is that as the grid bias
is increased, the screen voltage rises. Referring to Fig. 4, the solid line curves show

Fig.

6.-The recommended detector and

AVC

circuit for the EB4 is shown here.

across Ri and R2 and nearly the full


2 volts is applied through the diode to the
grids of the controlled valves for their
initial negative grid bias. A fraction of
this.: voltage equal to R, / (R, +Rz) is
applied to the anode-of the detector diode
Di. This diode is consequently nonconductive and inoperative, so that it does
not respond to weak signals and gives

AVC

C4

0.01

C2

R2

0001

nild

R
niLl

R1

C3
0.0001

-Vd2

Fig. 5. - This circuit shows how delayed AVC, detection, and noise suppression can be obtained
with a duo -diode.

Titkw

JUNE znd, 1938.


Valvesnoise suppression. When a strong enough.
signal is tuned in, however, Dr begins to
operate as a detector in spite of the
.small negative bias on its anode ; a current consequently flows through RI and
a potential is developed -across this
-resistance, making'
the diode anode
negative with respect to the cathode.
When' this potential
exceeds 2 volts the
anode of D2 becomes negative with
respect to its own
cathode, and hence
this diode becomes
New Range of

499

WoOpild.
of D2 negative with respect to earth.
When V2 is great enough it overcomesthe
positive voltage on D3 and this diode becomes non-conductive and negative with
respect to earth. The potential of the
AVC line then follows it.

ill M CAI-T FIYIII


ehaaaie sveci

2/22

DUAL UNIT ASSEMBLY

+HT

Fig. 7.-The use of a


triple -diode for detection. and distortionless
delayed AVC can be
seen from this diagram.

non-conductive. The initial bias is then


removed from the controlled stages and
the detector diode, for it has been overcome by the AVC voltage.
For signal
strengths great enough to produce more
than about 2 volts AVC bias, the operation
of the circuit-is identical with that of the
ordinary simple AVC system, for D2 then
plays no part. For weaker signals D2
introduces muting and a small delay, on
AVC.

R, +R,
taken as the voltage at which the delay
action is just.overcome and is about - o.8
volt. V2 is then approximately equal to
the peak RF carrier volts at- which it is
desired that AVC should begin to work.
if this is 15 volts peak, then we have
-

- V R+R5R3
s,

0.8

The Triple -diode


This --circuit- has the- practical disadvantage that the delay voltage is equal
to the initial bias of the controlled valves.
Consequently, if a large delay is needed,
-the sensitivity is greatly reduced. This
can be overcome by applying only a portion of the voltage across CI to the controlled valves. If this is done, however,
the AVC voltage is divided in the same
ratio and the AVC characteristics suffer.
Some compromise in design is thus needed.
The recommended arrangement is shown
Fig. 6.
Another of the new valves is also
designed for Use in AVC circuits ; it is a
triple -diode and is used in the circuit of
Fig, 7. One section Dr functions as a
detector in the usual way and has the load
resistance RI. The second section D2 is
fed from the primary of the IF transformer; it -has the load resistance R4, and
also functions as a detector without delay.
Its output is used for AVC purposes, and
delay is subsequently introduced by the
third diode D3. This is done in order to
avoid the distortion which would be caused
by using a delay voltage on D2.
The resistances R5 and R6 form a potentiometer across the HT supply, and a voltage VI, which is positive with respect to
the earth line, is applied to the delay circuit through R3. This makes the anode
of D3 positive, and it then has a very low
internal resistance. The AVC line is then
very close to the potential of the earth line.
When signal strength increases a voltage
V2 appears across R4, making the anode
in"

The voltage V3 on the AVC line is given


V,R, + V,R,
by V3 _
In design V3 is

and

the-

values

assigned to the parts must satisfy this


relationship. Suitable values in This case
are V, =98 volts, R, -.Z MS.2, and R,
711/112. Then after the start of AVC, V, _
,12.3 - 0.875 V2.
In addition to these special valves, the
" E " series includes two output pentodes
-the EL3 and EL6-and a duo -diode output pentode, type EBL1. This last is
substantially the same as the EL3 with the
additional diode elements.
The EL3 consumes 1.2 A. heater current
and takes 36 mA. anode and 4.5 mA.
screen currents at 250 volts. The normal
bias is -6 volts and the mutual conductance 9 mA/V. The rated ()tnput is 4.5
watts into a 7,00o-ohms load. The EL6
is a larger valve, taking 72 mA. anode and
8.5 mA. screen currents and rated for 8.2
watts output into 3,50o ohms. A pair in
push-pull will deliver 16 watts for a no signal anode current of 90 'mA. ; at full
- output this rises to ro8mA.
A cathode-ray type tuning indicator,
EM3, is included' in the range, and there
are two rectifiers-the AZz and AZ3-taking 2 amperes at 4 volts. The AZz is
directly heated and rated for 500-0-500
volts at ' tzo mA. or 300-o-300 volts at
r6o mA., while the AZ3 is indirectly
heated with a rating of 350-o-350 volts at
I20 mA.
.

"A"

Unit

UNIT

"

A."-Comprises

a newly designed
stage, 4 valve. 6 channel " TUNING HEART."
complete and up-to-date superhet with R.F.
amplifier, triode-hexode frequency, changer, I.F.
amplifier, diode defector, optional band -Width
variation, compensated A.V.C. (an exclusive
McCarthy feature). lVaye-range. 4.5 to 2,200
metres. Easily applied to any existing amplifier
or audio unit, 'accurately aligned and ready for
use. Complete with all instructions and circuit
details, 7 tos.

-A

UNIT

R."-Intended_gs a =counterpart to
Unit " A " but possesses versatile features which
enable it t be readily used 'as a High Fidelity
Amplifier for radio, gramophone or microphone.
Undistorted output to watts.
Price complete
with valves,
ios.'

!ii

'

PRELIMINARY ANNOUNCEMENT-

McCARTHY SHORT - WAVE

COMMUNICATIONS

RECEIVER

newly designed, small and compact receiver


for operation on AC or DC. Intended' mainly
for amateur transmitters, R.N.W.A.R. and
short-wave enthusiasts. in general.
It comprises a radio frequency amplifier,
highljr efficient screened grid detector, separate
triode oscillator for C.W. reception and small
triode output with jack for headphones, high
tension cut-off switch for use in conjunction
with a transmitter, scientific band -set and band spread tuning and designed to operate with
6 -pin inductors from 8 metres upwards.'
Supplied complete with smartly finished black
crackle cabinet with all valves and inductor.
A

Price

Guineas

Direct Recording Blanks

Readers requiring further technical details are


invited to apply at once and are advised to
place their orders,. which will be taken in strict
rotation, without delay.
All models supplied on our usual terms of
seven days' approval against cash.
Easy terms available on application.
Send 3d. In stamps for complete illustrated catalogue
with technical data and circuit diagrams of other
interesting McCarthy chassis of all types, for A.C.
Battery, or A.C./D.C. Abridged list free of charge

The price of the M.E. recording dises is


2s. each, and not as given on page 450 of

44, Westbourne Grove, London, W.2

'

our issue tor May igth.

M CARTi1y RADIC
Telephone :

Ba,tswater 3201/

Ivy

The Wireless World, June 2nd, 1938

Random Radiations
mains and the battery varieties
whose all-round performance is much below
the mark unless they are well and truly
earthed. But, on the other hand, I have
come across not a few which seemed to be
completely indifferent to the quality of the
earth, and some which didn't appear to be
handicapped by the entire absence of an
earth connection. I have often wondered
why this should be, and though I have devised various explanations I am not quite
satisfied with any of them. I suppose that
the metal chassis itself and any external
wiring that may be connected to it-battery
leads, for example-form the equivalent of
a counterpoise ; but one doesn't quite see
why, in that case, of two sets each with metal
chassis of about the same size and each
with a similar amount of external wiring,
one should be perfectly at home without an
earth whilst the other is all at sea.
.. L %
of the

The Drought and Earths


As I write real rain still hasn't come, though

heavy clouds and occasional fat drops


have threatened (or should one say promised?) it for some days. I expect that a
good many of those who live in those places
with gravel soil, whose virtues are so much
extolled by house agents, are suffering front
the effects of absence of rain on their wireless reception, though possibly not all of
them have realised, it. During the great
drought of 1934 one enthusiast of my acquaintance found that his receiving set was
becoming poorer and poorer in its performance as the soil grew more parched. His
conscience wouldn't allow him to break the
existing regulations against watering gardens
by pouring cool and refreshing draughts
from the tap over the spot beneath which
his earth -plate was buried. But he was a
man of infinite resource. Why, he argued,
should used bath water go to waste down the
drains? To his earth-plate all water, clean
or dirty, would be equally wet. Therefore
he contrived an arrangement of piping which
allowed the family's used bath water to be
discharged at will in the place where it was
most needed. The scheme worked like a
charm, and I commend it to you should you
be similarly situated and the drought continue.

Our Queer Words


WHAT queer terms we do invent and colI notice
lect in this hobby of ours
just now quite a number of advertisements
announcing receiving sets of the " communication " type. Offhand, one would have
said that any wireless receiver might merit
that adjective ; it seems, however, that the
the word is now becoming crystallised as a
term for a special kind of set. Designed
originally on the lines of those used for the
reception of messages rather than entertainment, the communication receiver is not intended to appeal to the .mere " wetnose "
!

Curious
Talking about earths brings to mind one
rather queer fact. Nearly all set makers urge
you in the book of the words which accompany their products to provide them not
only with the best of aerials, but also with
earths that are beyond reproach. Most
mains sets are inclined to be noisy if the
earth is not good, and there are many both

listener who wants a receiver with the fewest


possible number of knobs on its cabinet and
the biggest possible number of station names
on its dial. The communication receiver
doesn't try to sacrifice efficiency to sim-

"-

-"

FRIDAY, JUNE 3rd.


Nat.. 7.15, Ray Noble and his
Orchestra. 8.15 and 9.35, The fifth
concert of the London Music
Festival, 1938, con ducted by
Toscanini.
Reg., 7.30, " Under the Cheviots
a story of life in Northumberland.
8, Stanelli's Bachelor Party-Ladies'
Night. 9, Northern Music Hall.

"-

Abroad.

Stuttgart, 7.15, " From ' Rose Marie


to Senorita "-a Friml potpourri.

SATURDAY, JUNE 4th.


Nat., 1.30 and 4.50, The Walker Cup :
Great Britain v. America. 3.45,
Massed Pipers of the Scottish
Regiments from the Royal Tournament. 8, Music Hall, including
Ann Penn, Will Fyffe and Stainless
Stephen. 920, American Commentary. 9.35, Experimental Hour
Matrimonial News," specially
written by Tyrone Guthrie.

-"

Reg.,

7.30,

Behind

the

Lace

Curtains," a play by Esther


McCracken. 8, The Birmingham
Philharmonic String Orchestra. 9,
Ray Noble and his Orchestra.
9.45, Tug -of -War at the Royal
Tournament.
Abroad.

Deutschlandsender, 8,
Grandfather's Day.

Dances

of

SUNDAY, JUNE 5th.


Nat., 10 a.m., Troise and his Mandoliers.
6.30, B.B.C. Theatre
Organ with Alfredo Campoli, violin,
7, Mantovani and his Tipica
Orchestra. 9.5, " The World of
the Spirit, "a programme devised
for Whitsun, with the B.B.C.
Singers (B) and Orchestra (C).

"

ti

"-

MONDAY, JUNE 6th.


Nat., 3, The Locke -King Trophy ;
commentary from Brooklands. 3.45,
Hurlingham Polo CommentaryThe Empire Cup. 7, " Monday at
Seven." 8.40, Final Instalment of
" The Gang Smasher."_ 935,
" Crush Hour," a tubular revue
for straphangers.
Reg., 6, Brian Lawrence and his
Orchestra.
7.45,
" Dunmow
Flitch." the rural trial for happily
married couples. 8.25, " Rigoletto."
Act
of the opera from Covent
Garden.
1

7.30,

" Faust,"

LATELY I have been wondering whether


the alleged " all -wave " set will shortly
be as widely seen in wireless shops and in
the home as it is nowadays. Somehow I
feel that there will be a tendency before
long to return to the two -band receiver, at
any rate in the cheaper models. To some
extent the public was led up the garden by
last year's Exhibition slogan, " The world
is yours with modern radio." or words to
that effect. And it didn't find that everything in the garden was quite so lovely as
it had expected. It was given, though
not perhaps in so. many words, to believe
that it had but to buy any three-band set
at any price in order to be -able to tune in
America or Australia or Siam or Timbuctoo
just whenever it felt so minded. As some
of the cheap sets had short-wave departments of rather elementary design with the
roughest and readiest of tuning arrangements, those who purchased them found
that though they'd got the modern radio the
world still appeared to consist mainly of

Reg., 5, Shanties and Sailor Songs.


6.50, " Forgotten Successes
a
comcdy in three acts by T. W.
Robertson. 9.5, Songs of the
British Isles.
Abroad.
Knigsberg, 8, " The Gipsy Baron,"
operetta (Johann Strauss).

(Gounod).

"

The Future of the "All -wave " Set

FEATURES OF
THE WEEK

Abroad.
Leipzig,

DIALLIST "

plicity ; if an extra knob is going to improve


performance it will- have an extra knob-or
half a dozen for that matter. You won't find
any station names on its dial as a rule, but
you will find either good, open scales of kilocycles and megacycles or a degree scale of
the kind which lends itself readily to calibration. Many of the communication receivers take in television sound frequencies,
and most of them are provided with that
most useful adjunct for short-wave and
ultra -short-wave listening, the beat -frequency oscillator. I am all in favour of
this kind of set-but I do wish that they
had chosen a better name for it.

Broadcast Programmes
THURSDAY, JUNE 2nd.
Nat., 1.15 and 5.45, Cricket Commentaries : England o. The Rest.
6.20, " Forgotten Anniversaries
An attempt on Queen Victoria's
Life. 8, A Formby Do (with
George Formby). 9.40, " Tosca,"
Acts 2 and 3 of the opera by
Puccini from Covent Garden.
Reg., 6, Billy Cotton and his Band.
6.40, From the London Theatre
People of our Class." 8.40,
Hail, Variety
9.20, A Record of
the attempts to mastrr Everest.
Abroad.
Milan Group, 9, " No, No, Nanette,"
operetta (Youmans).

By "

opera

TUESDAY, JUNE 7th.


Nat., 7, The International Staff Band
of the Salvation Army. 8, " The
Silent Melody," a new musical
comedy, including Bebe Daniels
and Ben Lyon. 9.20, " My Best
News Story," by J. L. HodsonThe First Aeroplane Acrcss tie
Atlantic.
Reg., 8, " The Quiet House at
Haworth," a microphone visit to
the Parsonage where the strange
genius of the Bront family lives
on. 825, " Gotterdammerung,"
Act 3 of the opera from Covent
Garden. 935, B.B.C. Theatre
Organ and three grand pianos.
Abroad.
Paris (Eiffel Tower), 8.30, Symphony
concert of music by famous
composers.

WEDNESDAY, JUNE 8th.


Nat., .7, Ray Ventura and his Band.
8, Sir Adrian Boult conducts the
B.B.C. Symphony Orchestra in
Norwich Cathedral. 920, The
Way of Peace. 10.15, 11.15 and
11.40, Relays from the Aldershot

Tattoo.
Reg., 8, Dave Frost and his Band.
8.30, The World Goes By. 9,
" The Silent Melody."
Abroad.
Warsaw, 9.10, Chopin Recital by
Zofia Zabcewicz.

WIlregoo

JUNE 2nd, 1938.

sol

WOrl'ild
Random RadiationsEurope so far as their radio reception was
concerned. Many have, unfortunately, come
to regard the short waves as not much fun
on this account, and I shall be surprised
if in the future ' all -wave " sets of the kind
of which I am talking continue to hav any
strong appeal. If the man in the street but
knew it, he would get a much better bargain in the low-priced set if all the money
that he spent on it went to making it the
best possible performer on the medium and
the long waves.
`

A Luxury Receiver
All of us who go in for short-wave reception know that it does demand a really good
set if it is to be worth while. That's why I
think that the " all-wave " receiver may be
in the future what it should have been in the
past, a luxury, dr at any rate a semi -luxury
set. You have only to look at a list of
stations with their 'frequencies to appreciate
one reason why this should be so. A 300 metre medium -wave station has a frequency
of r,000 kilocycles a 30 -metre short-wave
station, a frequency of ro megacycles. The
short-wave station is at least ten times as
difficult to tune in properly. That naturally
means that if the tuning arrangements are
such as are just about good enough for
medium -wave stations, you are not going
to have a very large bag on the short waves.
For satisfactory short-wave work you must
have band -spreading, you must have tuning
arrangements with real slow-motion and
smooth -motion as well, and you must have
an oscillator that doesn't creep, let alone
gallop, as those in some of the cheaper sets
that I have tried are prone to do_ These
things and other refinements that make
reception really worth while you can't expect (or if you do you certainly won't get
them) in a receiving set, the price of which
in pounds can be expressed by a single
modest figure.
;

'

'

'

A Hot Weather Change


I rather thought might

the case,
ASAIR, the Indian Broadcastingbe Authority,

has had to drop for the time being the use


of the 90.8 -metre wavelength for the evening transmissions from Bombay No. 2.
When this wavelength was adopted it was
predicted that it wouldn't work during the
hot weather on account of the prevalence of
violent atmospheric interference. Listeners
of long; experience foretold that reception
would be impossible on any wavelength
much over 6o metres, and this has turned
out to be true. Bombay is now using 61
metres (4.905 megacycles) for its evening
transmissions. The output rating of the
station, whose call -sign is VUB2, is ro kilowatts, and reception in this country should
be possible when conditions are favourable.
The short-wave transmitter is at work from
r p.m. until 6.3o p.m. BST,
.-

.. ..

Nearing Saturation

THE increase in the number of wireless


licences during April was the smallest
for the last three years, the total being only

This compares with nearly 50,000


for last year, just under 26,000 for 1936 and
between 43,00o and 44,000 for 1935. It
looks as if the upward curve were now really
beginning to flatten out, and we can't be
surprised, for the total is now, in round
figures, 8,60o,000 for England, Scotland,
18,679.

Wales and Northern Ireland. The number


of homes in the whole country is round about
13,000,000, so that there cannot now be

such a very great number of people able to


afford a wireless set who haven't -got one.
That doesn't mean that there's going- to be
no increase in the number of licences in the
future. There will be for a very long time
to come, though naturally we can't expect
it to go on at the previous rate. After all,
it was predicted long ago that. we should
never get much beyond the 5,000,000 mark.
Forecasts have been revised again and again
since we passed it, but most people seem to
agree nowadays that 9,000,000 is about s
far as we can expect to go in the next year
or two.
.

19os

[DNDEN5ER 5PECIALI515

1938

FUR OVER THIRTY YEARS

Inconstant Reduction Gear


Automatic Change -speed Drive
ATWO-SPEED reduction drive between
a tuning condenser and its actuating
knob is common enough, but the speed of
either drive is (ignoring possible accidental
effects of slip) constant throughout its
working range in the conventional arrangement.
The suggestion is now made that in certain cases it would be desirable to arrange
for equal increments of angular movement
of the control -knob spindle to impart unequal increments of movements to the moving vanes of the associated condenser. For
example, it might be desirable to provide
automatically for extremely accurate and
critical tuning over a section of the tuning
scale, adjustments over the remainder being
relatively rapid and coarse.
This might be accomplished by means of
a reduction drive which rotates the condenser shaft through the medium of 'a rack
and pinion, the rack being formed against
the surface of a cam mounted on the control
spindle or on a spindle geared to it. The
cam may be so shaped that the movement
imparted to the shaft of the condenser obeys
any desired law ; the cam would preferably
be arranged in the form of a disc provided
with a suitably shaped slot which would
form a guide for the projection associated
with the rack.
-

THE WIRELESS

Condenser accuracy and reliability can


if you
be above suspicion or doubt
decide on T.C.C. You can accept
T.C.C. facts and figures-as facts. You
are not asked to take them cum grano
sails-with a grain of salt. After all,
32 years of specialisation does count. In
the making of condensers, experience is
everything. It's the " knowing how "
that matters. In 32 years, T.C.C. have
learned a lot. They are still learning.
But in l906, they taught themselves
that the two most
one vital lesson
important factors in condenser making
are accuracy and dependability. T.C.C.
users have been getting both ever since.

INDUSTRY

THE Park Royal factory and offices of the


British Rola Company, Ltd., will be
closed from Friday evening, July 22nd, to Monday morning, August 8th. The Company's
customers are asked to anticipate their require-

ments over this period.

the new Pilot Model B43


all -wave battery superheterodyne has been
issued by Pilot Radio, Ltd., 87, Park Royal
Road, London, N.W.ro.
A leaflet describing

Mr. L. B. Felton, lately Radio and Electrical


Sales Manager and Director of British

Mechanical Products, Ltd., Westminster,


S.W.', has resigned his directorship and
severed active connection with the Company.
.

The Furzehill Laboratories, Boreham Wood,


Herts, have issued an illustrated catalogue of
laboratory equipment. Cathode-ray gear, oscillators, signal generators (including a simplified
model for service work) and other apparatus are
included.

T.C.C.

Dolmetsch Recording, Jesses, Haslemere,


Surrey, notify us that they are producing
cutters for direct recording on cellulose acetate
discs.
Samples and prices will be sent on

CONDENSERS

0 0 0 0

ALL -BRITISH

request.

Sound Amplifiers, Ltd., 21, Queen Square,


Leeds, 2, have issued a leaflet describing the
various kinds of gramophone recording that
they are prepared to undertake.

THE TELEGRAPH CONDENSER CO.LTD.


WALES FARM RD. NORTH ACTON,W.3
4887

The Wireless World,

The British abstracts published here are prepared with the


permission of the Controller of H.M. Stationery Office,
from Specifications obtainable at the Patent Office, 25,
Southampton Buildings, London, W.C.2, price 1'- each.
A selection of patents issued in U.S.A. is also included.

Recent Inventions
ELIMINATING " STA l IC "
STATIC or other local disturbance, picked up by the aerial
lead-in, is automatically balanced
out against similar voltages picked
up on a "dummy" lead. As shown
in the drawing, the aerial down lead A is taken to the centre of
the grid or input coil L, whilst the

LUMINOUS

Brief descriptions of the more interesting radio


devices and improvements issued as patents
will be included in this section,
which requires some degree of
selectivity. In practice the multiplier treats all frequencies alike,
and even if unwanted frequencies
are removed, subsequent to amplification, this does not prevent the
production of cross -modulation'
-

effects.
According to the invention, the
overall gain of a secondary -emission amplifier is made dependent
on frequency by connecting one or
more of the " target " electrodes
to the voltage supply through
tuned circuits. The Figure shows
a wireless receiver in which electrons coming from the cathode C
are deflected by a plate P and a
transverse magnetic field (not
shown) on to a target electrode T,
where secondary emission 'takes
place, the amplified stream being
similarly 'directed, in turn, against
other targets Tr, T2 by the
charged plates Pr, P2 and the
transverse magnetic field. Incoming signals are applied to the input
grid G, and the targets T, Tr are

June 2nd, 1938

INDICATORS

IN a visual tuning indicator

The Figure shows an arrangement which is said to be free from


both defects. For the selective
reception of a distant station, the
switches S and St are in the position shown, so that the primary
coil Li is coupled only to the
secondary coil L2, which is tuned
by the condenser C2. For higherquality reception, the switch S is
opened and the switch Sr changed over to the lower contact. This inserts a coil I3, which is closely

of

cathode-ray
the miniature
type, a rod -like electrode K, shown
in plan in the figure (a) controls
the stream of electrons from a
cathode C,and is so biased that,
in the absence of any signal, only
a very narrow zone AB (where the
lines converge) of the cylindrical
fluorescent screen S is illuminated.
When a signal is tuned in, the control voltage on the electrode K
becomes practically equal to that
on the fluorescent screen, so that
the illuminated zone spreads out,
as indicated by the lines Ai, Br.
If the biasing voltage is increased, the two lines A and B can

Circuit arrangement for suppressing electrical interference.

" dummy " lead At is tapped to


a similar coil Li, which is included
in the cathode circuit of the amplifier, in series with the usual biasing resistance R.
Any fluctuations of grid voltage
produced by static interference will
now be offset by similar fluctuations of voltage applied through
the " dummy " lead- to the
cathode. The amplifier will, therefore, respond only to those grid
variations which are due to the desired signal. A condenser C is
shunted across the grid coil to compensate for the extra capacity
effects of the cathode coil Li.
E. K. Cole, Ltd., and G. Bradfield. Application date, September 18th, 1936.
o

No. 481806.
0

SECONDARY -EMISSION

AMPLIFIERS
THE modern electron-multiplier
is capable of giving enormous
magnification, but has not yet
succeeded in competing with the
ordinary valve amplifier for work

connected to the supply potentiometer through circuits L, Ll tuned


to the carrier -wave frequency. A
parallel -tuned circuit L2 in the last
stage helps to build up voltages
at the signal frequency, which are
rectified at R and applied to a
detector grid Gr.
The General Electric Co., Ltd.,
Application
and N. R. Bligh.
date, September 21st, 1936. No.
481750
o

SELECTIVITY AND QUALITY


WHEN a set is switched over
from a highly selective setting to receive- a less -distant station at better quality, it is usual
to damp the tuned circuits either
by inserting resistance (which
naturally introduces losses) or else
by tightening the coupling. The
latter expedient similarly reduces
efficiency and may also introduce
distortion (lue to the change of
resonance.
"

Circuit giving high or low selectivity and constant gain.

coupled to the coil Lt, in series


with the coil L2, and introduces a
condenser C3 in series with C2.
The condenser C3 is pre-set to a
value which makes the new circuit
resonate at the same frequency as
the current used in the first or
highly slective position.
E. K. Cole,Ltd.; A. W. Martin;
and H. Hunt. Application date,
No.
1936.
November 3oth,
481310.

be made to overlap, as shown in


(b), to form a more -intensely
illuminated zone Z which can be
used to indicate the tuning over a
second range of wavelengths.
By placing control electrodes K,
Kr on each side of the cathode C,
as shown in (c), double zones of

TELEVISION=BROADCAST
RECEIVER
SHORT-WAVE television signals,
well
as the associated sound
as
programme, which' are usually
transmitted on wavelengths of 6.6
and 7.2 metres respectively, are
separately heterodyned in the
same set, the video signals being
fed to a cathode ray tube, and
the audio signals to a loud speaker.
Provision is also made for receivproing ordinary broadcast
grammes on the same set. Long
or medium wave signals are picked
up on a separate aerial, -and are
heterodyned by a local oscillation
which is obtained by combining
the two oscillations used- in the
The two
short-wave circuits.
oscillations in question are applied
to two separate grids of the long
wave -" mixing " valve, the incoming broadcast signals being applied to the third grid of the same
valve. The resulting intermediate
frequencies are then rectified and
fed to the loud speakers used to
reproduce the short-wave programme.
Marconi's Wireless Telegraph
Co., Ltd. (Assignees of A. A. Lin sell). Application date September
i8th, 1936. No. 481893.
A

Diagrams illustrating illuminated


zones on screen of tuning indicator described in the text.

Electron multiplier valve and circuit designed for radio reception.

illumination are formed, as indicated by the dotted lines, to give


" pattern " tuning.
Instead of depending upon
luminous zones, the " dark " space
between them can be used to show,
even more precisely, when the circuits of the receiver are correctly
in tune with the signal.
Marconi's Wireless Telegraph
Co., Ltd. (assignees of H. C.
Convention date
Thompson).
(U.S.A.), June 27th, 1935. No.
481791.

THE
PRACTICAL RADIO

JOURNAL

28 th Year of Publication

No. 80.

Proprietors

THURSDAY, JUNE Writ, 1938.


ILIFFE & SONS LTD.

Editor

EDI TOR IAL

HUGH S. POCOCK.

Editorial,
Advertising and Publishing Offices :
DORSET HOUSE, STAMFORD STREET,
LONDON, S.E.I.
Telephone: Waterloo 3333 (So lines).

Telegrams: "Ethaworld, Sedist, London."


Cov>NrRY
Telegrams:
NAutocar, Coventry."

Hertford Street.
Telephone:
-5z to Coventry.

BIRMINGHAM:

Guildhall Buildings, Navigation Street, 2.


Telephone:

Telegrams:

'Autopress, Birmingham."
MANCHESTER

Telegrams:

"Biffe, Manchester."

2971 Midland (4 lines).

260, Deansgate, 3.
Telephone:
Blackfriars 4415 (4 lines).

GLASGOW : 26B, Renfield Street, C.2.


Telephone: Central 4857.
Telegrams: "Mitte, Glasgow?'

ENTERED AS SECOND
CLASS MATTER AT NEW YORK, N.Y.

PUBLISHED WEEKLY.

Subscription Rates :
Home, LI is. 8d. ; Canada, LI is. 8d. ; other
countries, I 3s. iod. per annum.
As many of the. circuits and apparatus described in !hese
-pages are covered by patents, readers are advised, before
making use of them, to satisfy themselves that they would
not

be

infringing patents.

CONTENTS
Page

Editorial Comment
Serving the Fishing Fleets
Five -Metre DF ..

503
50-E

507

On the Short Waves

508

Television Topics

509

National Field Day

511

How a Receiver is Designed ---XIV

512

Editor

514

Letters to the

News of the Week

515

Philips Portable Receiver

517

Home

Laboratory-VII, Bridges

519

Random Radiations
Broadcast Programmes

522

Recent Inventions

521

522

Television Triumphs
But Public Response Disappoints
HE excellence of the television
transmission of the Derby was
a matter for congratulation to
all those members of the B.B.C.
staff who had a hand in the arrangements, and also to the E.M.I. engineers
responsible for the apparatus employed
for the transmissions from Epsom.
The very fact that this transmission
was such an outstanding success and
that the standard of television transmissions in general has improved so
greatly during the past few months,
seems to us to intensify the seriousness
of the present position in this country in
regard to television progress.
Here we have at our disposal a
scientific achievement, probably more
remarkable than anything which science
has produced for us during the past
fifty years. Very large sums of money
are being expended on the television
service, and yet we are still practically
in the dark as to whether or not
television is going to make an appeal
to the. public sufficient to justify this
outlay and provide a commercial return
for those who have incurred the cost
of developing the apparatus which has
made television possible.
The Radio Manufacturers' Association has decided to give television a
great " boost " at the Radio Show in
August, and there seems little doubt
that the Exhibition will make visitors
to it television -conscious and receptive
to the idea of acquiring a set for the
home. But we must remember that
television was a prominent feature of
the Ideal Home Exhibition recently,
and we believe that there has so far
been little evidence that that publicity produced any appreciable increase
in actual sales of television receivers.

VOL.

XLII.

No. 23.

COMMENT
We would suggest that the time has
come when it is imperative to ascertain
what is the real reaction of the public
to television, with a view to discovering
why there is not greater enthusiasm to
acquire receivers.
The Television Committee might well
consider the possibility of a carefully
compiled questionnaire to be distributed
to the public, perhaps, on the Occasion
of the Radio Exhibition, the object of
the questionnaire being to obtain a series
of answers which would provide an
explanation of why public response is

disappointing.

Finding the Weak Spot


Reasons which one hears put
forward to explain why television sets
are not in greater demand are very
varied and none of them convincing.
They can, we 4hink, be grouped under
three or four heads, as follows
(I) Receivers are thought to be still
experimental and likely to become out
of date if purchased now
(2) The
cost is considered prohibitive and the
public is waiting for price reductions
(3) The bulk of the programme material
is unsuitable
(4) Television is not
wanted by any large section of the
public and never will be, because it is
compared with the cinema but lacks
many of its advantages.
If - a representative cross-section of
the public could be induced to provide
answers to a questionnaire, then it
might well be that we could put a
finger on the weak spots of television
development, but at present we feel
that there is nobody in a position to
explain why this amazing technical
achievement, providing a novel form
of entertainment and interest, on which
very large sums have been expended,
has failed, so far, to catch on with
more than a very small percentage of
those who are well able to afford
receivers at their present price.

:-

504

The Wireless World,

June 9th, 1938

erving
MULTIPLE -CHANNEL

WORKING AT

WICK RADIO
By

J.

AINSLIE

Room at Wick Radio. No. 1


transmitter is controlled from the panel on the
front bench, at which there are two operating
positions. Control of No. 2 transmitter is
similarly effected from the bench in the
Operating

background.

HE advance of wireless communications depends to a great extent


upon improvement in technique
and organisation, and the great
strides forward which have been made are
-largely due to the invention of methods
'of isolating the ever-increasing number of
.'radio stations from the influence of their
,neighbours;; this is equally true in the case
of ship-shore radio services as it is for
broadcast and telegraph and telephone
paint -fo -point ones.
In 1927 there were some 200 British
small craft fitted with radio transmitters
and receivers ; to -day there are over 1,300,
one-third of the total number of British
vessels that are equipped for wireless communication. A decade ago these two hundred trawlers and a few tugs were
served by our coast radio stations on
spark, using frequencies of 1,360, 500 and
375 kc /s ; to -day over six times that number of trawlers, coasters, yachts, drifters,
cross -Channel ships, tankers, tugs, tenders
and lifeboats employ either ICW or RT,
and are catered for on a multiplicity of
frequencies.
British coast stations are concerned with
the safety of life at sea, direction finding,
medical advice and the emission of weather
bulletins, gale and navigation warnings,
as well as with the acceptance and delivery
of radiotelegrams. Wick is the busiest of
the coast stations, for it handles the greater
part of the small -craft traffic load, and here
the problem was how to operate Morse and
radiotelephony services simultaneously on
a number of frequencies on the same site.
It was undesirable on economic grounds
to provide separate transmitting and
operating stations, particularly as arrangements for simultaneous working might
have to be provided at other points at
some future date.
Now, the theory concerning transmission over concentric conductors dates back

transmitter at GKR, operating on 435, 500 and 1528 kc s ICW or CW, 1837 kc s RT,
2505 kc/s ICW or CW, and 2605 kc's RT. The emergency transmitter is on the left.

No. i

some twenty years, but it was only within


the last year or two that this arrangement
came into prominence for high -frequency
transmission purposes. The freedom of a
coaxial cable from the effects of external
disturbances is due -to the electrostatic and
electromagnetic screening effects `of the
outer conductor ; also, a cable of this type
allows of the transmission of a band of
high radio frequencies, with negligible attenuation and distortion, and therefore
appeared -to offer a solution of the Wick
Radio problem of providing a suitable
j lead in " from an aerial system about a
mile from the station. A screened operating room was, of course,_ necessary, together with transmitters and receivers of
a high standard of performance.
`

Multiple Aerial System


The Wick Radio building, in which both
the transmitting and receiving equipment
are housed, lies directly under the main
transmitting aerial, which is suspended between two 14oft. steel lattice towers. In
addition to this aerial, which serves for

frequencies of 435 and 500 kc/s, three


single -wire vertical aerials are available for
emissions on 1,528, 1,650, 1,837, 2,505
and 2,605 kc / s.
The problem of effectively screening the
wireless operating room was made more
difficult by the immediate proximity of the
machine, transmitter and telegraph rooms,
each of which was a potential source of interference in one form or another, particularly where high -sensitivity receivers were
to be employed. The difficulty was overcome by converting the operating room
into what is virtually a tin can ; the walls
and ceilings were metalised, the floor, door
and cable chases copper -lined, and the
windows glazed with wired glass. The
whole screening was thoroughly -bonded
and earthed, and each lead, whether in
the supply or control circuits for the transmitting and receiving equipment, or in the
power or lighting circuits, filtered on entering and leaving the room.
The remote receiving antenna system
consists of three inverted " L " aerials for
use on the 1,500/3,000 kc/s waveband,
and connection between the coaxial cable

th

The Wireless World, June 9th, 1933

505

Fishing Fleets
IN

order to cope with the large and ever-increasing


volume of radio traffic with the fishing fleets in
Northern waters, as well as with its other coast-station
duties, Wick Radio (GKR) has recently been modernised,
provision having been made for simultaneous working
on several channels

leading -in points and the receivers is made


by means of flexible screened cable. A
remote " Adcock " direction -finding aerial
system has also been provided.
In the operating room four manipulative positions are disposed, one on each
side of the two transmitter control panels,
and at each of these receiving points is
fitted a superheterodyne receiver, a microphone, a morse key and a send/ receive
switch. Other simple- switches at the
operators' hands provide for the automatic
sending of the " Alarm Signal " and for
simultaneous speech or WT transmissions
on two frequencies.

Receiver Details
The type of receiver used comprises
an RF stage, triode -pentode frequency
changer, high -frequency pentode IF amplifier, duo -diode triode, output pentode and
a separate beat oscillator for CW reception.
The duo -diode triode functions as second
detector, AF amplifier and source of delayed AVC voltage. The signal -frequency
range is from 183 to 2,750 kc /s in three
separate ranges. The circuit design follows
normal practice ; the IF used is 110 kc / s
frequency suggested some years ago

-a

No. 2

Aerials at GKR, with


station building
between the lattice
masts and official
residence to the
right.

by Mr. W. T
Cocking, of Tbc
Wireless World -and provision is
made whereby the
adjacent channel
selectivity may be
continuously varied
from eight to one
Each rekc/s.
ceiver is fitted with
a simple switch for
remote
receiving
aerial selection purposes.
The receivers are
designed for AC,
and as the local
power supply is
DC they are normally run from rotary converters. They
may, however, be readily changed to DC
operation ; in this case HT is supplied
.

transmitter works on 435, Soo and 1528 kcls ICW or CW, 165o and 1837 kc/s RT, and
2605 kc/s ICW or CW.

from the mains and LT from large -capaBattery -driven concity accumulators.
verters are also installed so that reception
can be maintained in the event of a failure
of the power supply.
The transmitters are remotely controlled
from the operating room, the control
panels being provided with press -button
switches for starting and stopping the hightension and filament -heating alternators
and associated voltage regulators, and also
a switch for the selection of transmitter
frequencies and systems.
The two main transmitters-there is a
third, a battery -driven, low-power one
for emergency purposes-are capable of
operation on any one of six frequencies,
and are so arranged that either may work
independently of the other, provided that
identical frequencies, or frequencies of insufficient separation, are not required.
Interlocking of the control wiring has been
arranged to prevent the second transmitter
coming into operation on, or near, the frequency being used by the other. Pilot
lamps are provided on the control panels
of each transmitter to indicate which frequency is occupied by the other."
Two telephony and four telegraphy frequencies are available on each transmitter;
these are given in the inscriptions to
the accompanying photographs of the

apparatus.
Each transmitter is crystal -controlled

Wfipg@gg

5o6

WpllA

JUNE gth,

19.38.

Serving the Fishing Fleets--

on all frequencies, and comprises three


stages-oscillator, buffer and amplifier.
The input power to the amplifying valves
in the carrier condition is 1.7 kW and
2.4 kW on ICW. The carrier aerial power
is about 600 watts.
The note frequency for ICW working
900 cycles-is obtained by means of a
modulator stage, and CW can be used on
any frequency by switching at the control
panel.
The power supply is from a three -wire
DC system at 460/230 volts, which can
be taken from either of two cables. This
arrangement allows the radio station to be
fed from alternative sections of the power
company's distribution system. The 460 volt supply is used for the motor alternators and the battery -charging equipment
the 230 -volt supply serves lighting, teleprinter, receiver and control circuits.
In general, the transmitters present no
unusual features other than their flexibility from manipulative and control viewpoints. It is their operation in conjunction with the receiving arrangements described which enables Wick Radio to
maintain continuous simultaneous services on the lines and at the ranges indicated on the map. The ship -to -shore
channels utilised are 375, 425, 500, 1,520,
1,650, 2,012 and 2,50o kc/s.

Wireless on the Road


idea of fitting motor cars with wireTHE
less equipment for traffic signalling-rj.s

distinct from receiving-- the broadcast programmes


presents certain advantages.
Radio signals could be used, for instance, in
foggy weather, and as a substitute for the
noisy horn at sharp turns or when approaching cross-roads in daylight. There is also
the possibility of supervising road traffic
from a fixed radio beacon when the use of
coloured lamps might be either inadequate
or undesirable.
The equipment would consist of a combined transmitter and a receiver, in order to
allow each car both to give and receive. signals. In practice it would also be necessary to
use a common fixed wavelength for all cars.
The problem, then, is to prevent the transmitter ort any given car from affecting its
own receiver, because this would shut out
from the latter any warning signal that may
be " on the ether " from another car.

GKR's ' sphere of influence " embraces most of the Northern fishing grounds. Under average
conditions the more distant White Sea and Bear Island grounds are worked on 520 -metre morse
after darkness has fallen at Wick, while during daylight signals on 197 metres morse are exchanged with vessels within a 600 -mile radius. The 400 -mile circle represents the average
maximum daylight range for 163 -metre radio -telephony. In the black areas severe screening is
experienced, while in the shaded areas this trouble is present in a less acute form.

The figure shows one method of overcoming this ,difficulty (Patent 465129). The
transmitter T and receiver R on each car
are alternately connected to a source of energising current through a vibrating switch S
which allows either one or the other to become effective, but not both together. An
interesting feature is that the two-way switch
S is operated in some definitely irregular
fashion, such as by road shocks, or by a
fluctuating movement derived from the
engine, the object being to avoid the possibility of the switches on any two cars being
identically " timed." In other words, it
,fprevents the receiver on one car from being `
switched off at the exact moment when the
transmitter of an approaching car is switched
on-in which case, of course, the former
would not receive the warning signals Meanwhile each switch cuts out the receiver when
its own transmitter is in action, so that it
is not swamped by the local radiation.
The arrangement ensures that a radio
warning signal transmitted by one car must
energise the receiver of any other car in the
vicinity, and vice versa. The incoming signals may be used to flash a light on the dashboard, and simultaneously to light up red
lamps in the front or rear of the vehicle; or
they may sound a buzzer or bell to give an
audible warning to the driver:

Economy or Quality
A Change -over Switch for Battery Sets
.r

Signalling system for cars : the vibrating


switch ensures that transmitter and receiver
will not be operative at the same time.

the interests of HT battery economy


users of battery sets would be
willing on occasion to tolerate reproduction of
a lower standard than the best that the receiver can give. With this idea in view the
proposal has been made that a " quality -

IN many

economy " two-way switch might be provided.


Such a switch may be arranged to insert
(in the " economy " position) a resistance in
the HT lead in order to limit HT consumption when listening to local stations. The
resistance may be placed so as to cut down
the supply to the voltage amplifying stages
only so as to reduce the sensitivity while

maintaining the normal undistorted output


from the last stage, or, alternatively, the
resistance may be arranged to cut down the
supply to all the valves, including the output stage, in which case a somewhat lower
and distorted output is Obtainable.
It has been found possible by this means
to halve the HT consumption for example,
a reduction from 8 mA to 4 mA has been
obtained while still providing reasonable
quality and volume of reproduction on the
local stations. It is expected that the life of
the battery will be extended from 300 hrs.
to 600 hrs.
The arrangement is applicable to both
TRF and superhet battery receivers, but in
the case of the latter care must be taken to
see that the .gscillatr anode voltage is not
too greatly reduced. On the other hand, if
exceptionally good reproduction of local
station programmes is desired and provision
is made to cut down the current of the voltage amplifying stages only, then assuming
that the output stage is biased by the total
receiver current, a larger DC feed to the output stage is simultaneously obtained.
In the case of receivers with AVC, it may
be simpler to arrange for an increase in the
standing negative grid bias voltage on the
AVC line. In this connection it may be
pointed out that, on account of the relatively
poor regulation given by AVC in most battery receivers, the controlled stages are not
sufficiently biased back on local stations, and
so HT current to these valves is wasted.
;

The Wireless World,

June 9th, 1938

57

Five -metre DF
ADAPTING AN EXISTING RECEIVER
By H. B. DENT (G2MC)
THIS summer's programme of field
days has by now been published
by most Radio Societies, and in
the majority of cases some of the
events will be concerned with five -metres.
The attraction of the ultra-high-fre=
quency band is that it is still very much
an 'unknown quantity, though certain
valuable facts have come to light as the
result of work carried out by many experimenters during the past year or so.

The type of aerial will thus be governed


by the nature of the tests to be carried out.
If point-to-point working is to be attempted a horizontal aerial will usually
give the best results ; on the other hand,
if direction -finding experiments are in
view the transmitting aerial must not be
directional, so that for this purpose the
vertical aerial will have to be used.
There is not a great deal of time now
in which to construct entirely new sets,
Perhaps it
so it is worth
might be of some
while to consider
interest to rethe possibilities
ASUGGESTION for improving the
capitulate what
of adapting an
sensitivity and performance of an
so far is known
existing
fi v e ultra -short-wave set when adapted for
about this band.
metre receiver
direction finding experiments. The loop
In the first case
for DF work.
it has been
aerial and detector valve, with its
'The superproved that five regenerative type
associated components, are mounted at
metre signals arc
of set is used
the top of an elevated pole ; in this way
not confined to a
extensively for
the vertical aerial" effect of the necesvisual path and
portable work,
sary connecting leads is avoided.
generally t h e y
as it is compact,
ar audible well
quite sensitive
beyond the horiand economical
zon. It is important that the waves so far as HT and. LT consumption is conget a good start, that is to say, a good cerned, few sets of this kind having more
;transmitting site is essential.
Better than three valves. A typical circuit is
sigals are heard even in a comparatively shown in Fig. i.
poor receiving position if this condition
Adaptation for direction -finding is quite
obtains, while a good receiving position a simple matter, as it only requires that
will nbt be very beneficial if the transmitter th3 coils Li, L2 be replaced by a single is poorly situated.
turn loop. A high order of accuracy can
Again, evidence is available showing hardly be expected with a simple set of
that a horizontal aerial is in general better this kind, but it will answer the purpose
,

+HT
R1

L5

LOUD
SPEAKER

eL1
AERIAL

FEEDER

L3tiC1

entirely by DF, then at least by a combination of wireless and scout -craft.


When altered as suggested, the performance of the receiver will fall much
below that of the original set with an
elevated aerial owing to the low height of
the loop, and unless one happens to be
reasonably near the transmitter probably
no signals will be heard.
This is, of course, a serious drawback
because on starting out the participants
in the event have only the vaguest idea of
the location of the transmitter. It is
obviously essential that signals must b9
heard before any attempt can be made at
DF.
One solution to this problem is to
arrange for the loop aerial to 'be fixed at
the top of a sectional pole consisting of
two four- or five -feet wooden rods socketed
together. The difficulty of feeding the incoming signals to the first valve then
arises, for if an ordinary feeder is employed it might itself act as a vertical
aerial, admittedly untuned but with quite
enough pick-up to upset the directional
indications of the loop.

Elevated Loop -detector Unit

HT

-LT
O o

Fig.

+LT

i.-A typical ultra -short-wave super -regenerative

receiver of a type suitable for adaptation


to direction -finding work in the manner suggested in this article.

for long-distance transmission than a vertical aerial, but the horizontal kind is, of
course, more directional._

for initial experiments, and, if one has a


reasonable amount of luck, will enable
the transmitter to be located, if not

However, as the loop must be raised as


high as convenient the best thing to do is
to hoist the detector valve up with it and
feed only HT, quench voltage and audio
signals by means of the cable.
This can be done by making up a small
unit to the circuit shown in Fig. 2. Only
a two -wire cable will be required, as the
filament of a battery- valve can quite well
be lit from a 3 -volt dry battery with some
resistance in series.
RF chokes joined at the top of the cable,
one in each -lead as shown, will effectively
isolate the detector stage from the quench
and AF portion of the set, and moderately

Wfipehoo

508

WopIld
Five-metre

DF-

good directional effects will be obtained.


Tuning of the loop will call for a little
mechanical ingenuity, but only C2 of the
two condensers CI and C2 needs tuning;

2.-Circuit of the
adaptor unit ; the loop
aerial and components
shown (including a drycell LT battery) are
mounted on an elevated
Fig.

pole.

the other can be pre-se{' at a capacity suffiient to maintain oscillation over the
waveband to be covered. Condensers CI
and C2 must be as small as possible,

secured to the spindle of C2 the condenser


can be operated by means of a cord.
Super -regeneration has the advantage in
a case like this that tuning is not very
critical. If it were, the -remote control
mechanism would need to be very good
indeed.
The receiver would be operated in
exactly the same way as any ordinary
super-regenerative set. Resistance R2 in
Fig. i, or its equivalent in the reader's
set, controls the RF oscillation of the
detector valve, while RI is the quench
control.
Too much capacity in the wrong place
will make a big difference in the size of
the loop, so it might be advisable to experiment with and without condenser C2.
If 'it is omitted tuning will have to be
carried out by CI. However, this idea is
quite practicable though any change in
the capacity of CI will also affect regeneration in the detector stage. Omitting
C2 will enable a much larger loop to be
employed.

On the
Short Waves

ONE really makes no excuses for returning to the subject of 56 Mc / s again,


since during the past fortnight a further opportunity has been afforded to study
iilectrically, as the size of the loop will be
general conditions in Surrey and surgoverned by their capacities. It should the
rounding counties. For example, when in
be quite possible so to reduce the capacity contact with G2MV, of Old Coulsdon,
on
of Cr and C2 that the loop can be made
Sundy morning last, I learnt that he had
loin. or more in diameter.
been in contact with no fewer than 5o staIn altering the set arrangements could tions in the Home Counties on 5 metres durbe made for- the loop and detector valve_ ing the past three months.
About 70 per cent. or more of these stato be mounted on top of the set when
signals are strong enough to dispense with tions are crystal -controlled, and some of
those that are not (such as G3CU at present)
the elevated arrangement.
stable enough to be read on a superhet
Reverting to the question of tuning, if are
when on 'phone.
a wooden disc with a groove in it is
Oyer 90 per cent. appear to be using horizontal polarisation and quite a fair percentage- have steerable aerials or, alternatively,
have available several different aerials with
dissimilar radiation patterns.
My own aerial, now a horizontal halfwave mounted on a piece of sin. 'square
batten, 8ft. bin. long, and fed with a Sin.
spaced open wire feeder three waves long,
is rotatable through 90 deg.-which is sufficient-by means of two guy ropes attached
to ends of the batten.
I would not like to inflict on readers details of the transmitter in use at present,
but suffice to say that it contains 14 valves
in all, the final modulated amplifier on 5
metres being a carbon anode DETI2, which
neutralises as easily in a classical circuit as
if the working wave were 4o and not 5
metres.
Several receivers have been tried, including a two -valve self -quenched superregen
without RF stage, but the best results to
date have been given by the H.M.V. 65o,
to which an acorn (R.C.A. 954) has been
added in place of the normal RF stage in
the set. The output anode circuit of the
acorn feeds directly in the top grid cap of
the X64 '(6L7G) mixer-the receiver otherwise being standard.
The acorn stage is pretuned to the 5 -metre
Fig. 3.-Suggested method of mounting the
frame and detector-valve circuit.
band and the receiver is operated normally.

JUNE 9th, 1938.


On this arrangement 'phone signals from
G2oD in Ascot, Berks, are received in Epsom
at QSAS R8/ 9.
To mention all the stations heard would
be an invidious task.
The provision of a rotatable array being
somewhat of a necessity, considerable

thought has been devoted to the matter,


and a number of helpful suggestions received from G5MA, a pastmaster in this
particular art.
My brightest idea to date involves an
adaptation of the " commutator " used in
motorised tuning. This, the steerable di'
pole, or array, should be motor driven
through a reduction gear, the motor being
controlled by the " commutator," which
would rotate with the aerial (i.e., the equivalent of the condenser shaft).
A multicore cable running from the motor
and switching " commutator " would, as
usual, terminate at the press buttons-each
marked with the call sign of a regular contact. On pressing GIAA's button the aerial
would automatically rotate to the preselected
direction, exactly as does 'the tuning condenser of a motorised receiver.
Before passing on to some brief remarks
regarding short-wave conditions, there is
just a point about push-pull grid -parallel plate ro to 5 metre doublers ; it is that the
L/C ratio of the ro -metre grid circuit
should not be too high, and, although the
inductance may be some distance from the
tuning condenser, the leads from the tuning
condenser to the grids of the 6N7 (or equivalent) should be as short as possible.
If these precautions are not taken the
impedance of the grid circuit will be high
at 56 Mc /s and a tuned grid -tuned plate
56 Mc / s oscillator will result, and the
doubler will be very unstable or will selfoscillate. That is, the grid circuit should
be tied down to ro metres as close to the
grids of the valves as possible, and, since
both valves are acting independently as
Class C amplifiers, this doubler may be
plate -modulated without distortion.
So far as I know, no other- doubler can
be successfully plate -modulated, but even
in this case, for successful operation as a
modulated amplifier, the grid drive must be
approximately twice that required to produce " carrier output." In order to check
this operating condition. 'in all plate -modulated stages, the drive may be progressively
reduced until the carrier output just begins
to fall off ; the grid drive would then be readjusted to twice the value (i.e., twice grid
current) thus found.
The necessity for this overdriving in a
plate -modulated stage arises from the fact
that when the plate voltage is doubled at
the moment of peak positive modulation,
the RF voltage across the tank circuit
should also double-but since the magnification of the valve remains constant it cannot do so if the input RF voltage times
the magnification is only sufficient to produce the carrier value of RF voltage in the
plate circuit.
This grid overdrive has no effect on the
carrier condition-since, in any case, the RF
in the plate circuit cannot exceed 8o per
cent. of the effective DC plate volts.
Since the ionosphere storm of May 11th
short-wave conditions have been stable, but
not too good, although an improvement has
been -noticed during the past few days.
These conditions are typical of the
summer months, and a feature has been
the number of Russian and Western European signals in the region of 26-24 Mc /s.
ETHACOMBER.
.

The Wireless World,

Juxe

91h, 1938

Television Topics
APERTURE -EFFECT AND THE TELEVISION
RECEIVER -II
N the last article, dealing with aperture effect, it was shown that as the light
spot tracing the picture is comparable
in size with the finest elements of picture detail and also has an undesirable

luminosity contour, the receiver must have


a frequency characteristic which compensates for this limiting resolution of the
CR tube, the correction being increased
gain at high frequencies. As it is possible
to introduce multiple outline and other
" ringing " effects when applying aperture
correction it is necessary to arrange circuit constants so that the correction is
applied more as a property of the complete receiver than of one particular
amplifying stage, and an arrangement will
be described by which the experimenter
can investigate the .process of characteristic shaping and attain suitable correction.
The study of aperture effect soon gives
the experimenter a useful knowledge of
the practical aspects of wide-band amplification and the behaviour of circuits under
transient conditions. Before dealing with
a concrete case it will be useful to consider
the behaviour of various parts of the receiver when dealing with the transient
type of signal.
The requirement of sufficient band -

SIGNAL
CARRIER

gether with a high ratio in the coupling


circuit to give a rising characteristic, leads
to free oscillation in the inductance which
dies away after a transient and so falsifies
the output waveform. This is especially
objectionable if the oscillation frequency
is low enough for the light spot to render
it on the screen.
Before the detector stage the same
transition is represented by a sudden
change in carrier level, and similarly at
the end of the transition the IF circuits
can " ring " at the frequency to which
they are tuned, though not quite in the
same manner as if they had been " hit " by
a sudden change in DC. However, the

same requirement as to damping or

10

MEGACYCLES PER SECOND

(a)

OUTPUT

SIGNAL
/

CARRIER

FREQUENCY

IN

10

11

MEGACYCLES PER SECOND

(b)

width has to be supplemented by sufficient


extra gain at high vision frequencies to
correct the overall characteristic of receiver and CR tube.
It was shown that, when dealing with a
vision -frequency amplifier, the effect of a
cut-off frequency which is too low, to -

1,DIA.
TO GRID

.VINDINC

COPPER

Fig.
i.-When a
double -humped resonance curve is used and
the carrier falls in the
trough, the output
waveform
is
distorted in the manner
depicted at (a). With
single-sideband
reception and a single peaked
resonance
curve the distortion is
different and of the
form shown at (b).

ing portion at one end of the characteristic


so that carrier and low frequencies are
amplified less than the higher frequencies,
thus the band -width is reduced, and the
shape of the curve can be made smoother
for results equivalent to those of I (a).
As only one sideband is completely

DISC

1/16TH IC

is

R
found whether the amplifier deals with a
modulated carrier or any other form of
the vision signal. It will be realised that,
for the modulated carrier condition, the
tuned circuits can be in the form of bandpass couplings, or single tuned circuits
which are staggered in their tuning, or any
other arrangement which results in a
characteristic similar to Fig. i (a) which
shows a typical IF amplifier response suitable for a receiver in which any post detector amplification is by circuits
having a normal
amount (2-3 db) of
HF boost.
There is one further method -of reOUTPUT
sponse shaping
which is interesting
to study; it is shown
in Fig. i (b) Here
the IF carrier is
placed on the slop .

FREQUENCY IN

passed the behaviour of this system, on


exaggerating HF boost, is different from
that of the symmetrical arrangement, in
fact, the case may be compared with the
troubles experienced during selective fading on a telephony circuit.
Recognition of the effects in a picture
may help the experimenter in manipulating the receiver, if at any time the oscil-

=:1

`9h
2BA ROD

Fig.

2.-Details

of a typical IF coil with


spade tuning are shown here.

lator of a superheterodyne receiver is


varied so that the IF carrier moves along
the characteristic. Beside each curve of
Fig. i is shown the wave form of a
transient on using over -compensation. It
will be seen that the chief effect of the
single sideband condition is " white before
black," which, in a picture, gives the impression of prophecy in the receiver.

IF Tuned Circuits
In order to construct a receiver which
can be easily varied in its bandwidth and
shape of characteristic the stagger-tune
method has a great deal to recommend it
when there are four or more stages. Here
each coupling unit is a single -tuned circuit which can be varied in tuning over a
range equal to the width of the received
signal. If all the circuits are tuned to the
same frequency the response, is that of a
tuned circuit so many times as sharp as
one of the couplings. On the other hand,
if some couplings are tuned higher and
some tuned lower than the nominal frequency the response is broader and takes
on the double-humped appearance of the
band-pass circuit. By supplementing such
adjustments with damping of the tuned
circuits any shape of characteristic can be
obtained, the gain at any particular frequency being proportional to the total
gain of all stages at that frequency.
In building an IF amplifier on these
lines it is best to dispense with trimming

wheog
wOez

510

JUNE 9th, 1938.

Television Topics

condensers; adjusting the coils to resonate


with the valve and wiring capacity, as inductance values will then be at their
highest, and consequently excessive
damping will not be required. Variation
of tuning is obtained by the " short circuited turn effect of a copper disc,
mounted on a rod and moved in or out of
the field of the coil.
Fig. 2 shows a section of such a unit
mounting a paxolin former on a metal
chassis, the latter being drilled and
tapped to carry "a screw holding the
tuning disc.
Coil and valve screening
will be necessary, and one suggestion
which may ease this requirement is the
use of a mixture of " top grid " and " top
anode " valves to simplify the interstage
wiring.
Considering a 4 -stage IF amplifier.
The IF anode of the mixer is below
chassis. Thus a coupling coil is mounted
under the chassis with screwed tuning
adjustment above chassis and feeding a
valve such as the Cossor 42 MPT, with
grid under chassis, as 1st If. The 2nd
IF is an Osram KTZ4i. with grid at top of
bulb to match the anode at the top of the
42 MPT, and the coupling unit is
mounted above chassis, the tuning adjustment. being underneath. The 2nd IF to
3rd IF coupling now repeats the mixer
to 1st IF coupling arrangement, etc., the
amplifier terminating in a KTZ4r feeding
DC recepa DDL4 as second detector.
tion is obtained by connecting the detector
load direct to any vision -frequency amplifier which may be used, while the anode
circuit of this may be again directly connected to the modulation electrode of the
CR tube if scanning and gun voltage
arrangements will allow this, otherwise a
DC restoring diode arrangement must be
adopted.
It must be pointed out that the arrangement here is intended to be used for experimental studies of HF response, and
so whether or not the DC component of
the signal is retained may become a minor
consideration.
The circuit of Fig. 3 is, therefore, given
with suitable values for manipulation into

Capacity F.

Coupling Stage.

L H for 5 MOIS.

Turns 36 DSC.

(1) 41 STH to 42 MPT

...

...

Anode -E
Grid -E

10.0
14.0

43.0

37

(2) 42 MPT to KTZ 41

...

...

Anode -E
Grid -E

5.0
14.0

52.0

40

(3) KTZ 41 to 42 MPT

...

...

Anode-E
Grid -E

11.5
14.0

40.0

35

(4) As for 2

...

...

52.0

40

...

...

Anode -E

(5) KTZ 41 to DDL 4

'

11.5

Heater -Cath.,
etc. ...
7.5

similar conditions to those of Fig. i, the


IF being chosen with reasonable regard to
IF harmonics around 45 Mc / s. The

small former (about in. diameter). Filtering the diode heater leads is also useful,
the condenser on each heater pin to earth
being important. Similar treatment may
be necessary for the other stages, particularly the mixer.
The oscillator, at 38 Mc / s, can be calibrated with the aid of an existing shortwave oscillator (15-17 metres), using the
first harmonic, exciting the hexode grid
through a loosely coupled loop and inserting a pair of phones in the IF anode
lead, then checking with the signal
from the vision transmitter and all coil
tuning discs at the same setting. Subsequently the oscillator dial can be calibrated in terms of intermediate frequencies, and then any characteristic
measurements are performed by swinging
the oscillator tuning through its range
while receiving a tuning signal or any
other steady output from the vision transmitter, noting the diode current at each
frequency. Owing to the fact that any
vision transmission will contain a band of
frequencies this method is not highly
accurate, but is quite sufficiently so for
comparative measurements if the same
form of steady signal is always used.
As the staggering of the circuits is
altered a considerable variation of gain is
experienced at carrier frequency. Each
change should be accompanied by a check
at carrier frequency so twat the gain can
be set to give a standard reading on the
diode meter.
For the oscillator and RF coils the fol-

shunt coupling uses the anode feed resistance as coil damping, the screen feed
arrangement allowing a fair range -ff
variation.
The table gives tentative figures for the
tuned circuit constants, and the damping
used will depend on the amount of shaping required. For example, if a really
exaggerated double -hump characteristic is
required the final stage may be tuned to
7 Mc/s and well damped
is always
fairly damped on account of the diode
load. The other circuits are divided
equally between, say, 8.5 Mc / s and 5.5
Mc/s tuning, with damping resistances of
some io,000 ohms. The damping values
given in the circuit are suitable for work-

-it

ing with the circuits more evenly distributed in their tune frequencies, though
with all circuits at 7 Mc /s the characteristic will be much too sharp for normal
reception as the response will be about five
times down at 6 and 8 Mc / s.

The Detector Circuit


The filtering of the DDL4 output will
depend for its effectiveness on how well
the output wiring is screened from the
early stages of the amplifier. This subject
lie been dealt with already in Television
T7 sirs. A quarter -wave choke will assist
in minimising IF harmonics ; it consists of
about 6ft. of fine gauge wire wound on to a

+250-2501,
3,0000

50,0000

4,5000
0.00005 mld

--I---.

50.000 n

15,0000

15.000!! (7
0.00005 n,id

/2MPT

/248,112
E.1\

If 5T11

Z3.000n

14,5000

0.00005

Id 15,ao0n

4J

0.0000L0m-id

.2

^MTZI1

II-Id

0.00005

10,000 n

C
5,000

0.00005

MPT

MTZ 41

005 r,m

400

110.05 r1!d

I0.05

Id

0.05 0vd

2001

2,000 .:

Fig. 3. -The circuit diagram of an experimental superheterodyne is given in this diagram together with the more important values
of components.

JUNE

9112,

Whell

1938.

Television Topics-

lowing brief specification is appended:Oscillator.


Former: in. dia.
Grid Coil: 3 turns, 22 SWG. Bare in
0.25in.
Anode Coil: 3 turns, 26 SWG.
DSC
interwound with the grid coil.
Input Grid.
Former: tin. dia.
Grid Coil: II turns, 22 SWG. Bare in
o.75in. Probable grid tap at io. Wind

5rr

WpIlcol
over 2 turns of tape at earthy end and
spring on 2 turns of 18 SWG bare, to
couple to the dipole.
If preferred a similar tuning arrangement to the IF coils can be used. In this
case the i inch former will require 6 turns
in 0.5 inch with a i turn feeder coupling.
There is very little sharpness about such
a circuit, as the input damping of the
mixer is considerable, and so it cannot be
looked upon as much use, compared with
the IF tuning, in characteristic shaping.

National Field Day


A

POPULAR ANNUAL EVNT

THE coming week-end will see t_ _e


majority of the radio amateurs
of this country out in the " field "

operating portable radio gear.


National Field Day is probably the most
popular and best supported of any of the
contests organised by the Radio Society
of Great Britain. Whilst " N.F.D."-as
it is colloquially called-takes the form of
a contest, its real purpose is not so much
to provide a week -end's amusement as to
give members an opportunity of getting
some really practical experience in the
erection and operation of portable transmitting and receiving gear.
In this country national emergencies
necessitating the use of portable radio
THE RADIO CAMP.
Transmitter and receiver
are housed separately from
the living quarters. Note
the aerial equipment is of
the transportable type.

By ARTHUR C. GEE
why we should not be prepared, and it
was to provide an opportunity of getting
experience in field work that N.F.D.
was started. The competitive aspect was
included to stimulate interest, and there
is now keen competition between the
various districts to secure the maximum
number of points.
The contest begins at 1900 B.S.T. on
Saturday and ends on Sunday at 1900.
Each district puts up one or more stations
and transmissions take place on either
1.7 Mc/s, 3.5 Mc/s, 7 Mc/s or 14 Mc/s,
CW only being used. Points are awarded
for contacts with other portable or fixed
stations throughout- the world, the number of points varying with the type and
situation of the station.
.

gear which is truly portable, and in a


number of instances compact rigs having
both transmitter and receiver built into
one cabinet are used. Operation goes on
throughout the whole twenty-four hours,
different operators taking it in turn to do
duty at the key. Those not on duty
usually make the occasion a social one,
and Sunday afternoon is characterised by
visits from the ladies and other friends.
Given good conditions and fine weather,
the event invariably proves a most enjoyable one for both the operators and the
visitors, and when 1900 hours B.S.T. on
Sunday evening comes and N.F.D. is
over for another year, all and sundry vow
that " they will certainly be along next
year " and they'll see that the mistakes
made this year will be rectified by the
time N.F.D. next comes along.
.

McCarthy Dual Unit Assembly


THE basic idea of this new equipment
made by McCarthy Radio, Ltd., 44a,

Westbourne Grove, Bayswater, London,


W.2, is to provide an efficient superheterodyne receiver (Unit " A ") suitable for use
with any good audio -frequency amplifier, or
with the Unit " B " which has been designed

gear seldom arise, although during last


winter's heavy snowstorms and flooding
one or two instances of amateur radio
stepping into the breach did occur. In
other countries where storms and floods
are more disastrous than they are in this
country many instances are on record
where the ability of amateur radio operators to get portable gear efficiently set up
and working has been the means of saving
many lives and much property. One of
the most outstanding examples of this was
in the recent American floods.
Though we may be immune from catastrophes of this nature, there is no reason

For some weeks prior to the contest


there is great activity among those responsible for organising the erection of
stations. Sites have to be chosen and
permission to use them obtaine from
'their owners. Gear must be got together
and arrangements for erecting a good
aerial system made. Some form of power
supply which shall be quite independent
of the mains must be obtained. This
usually consists of accumulators driving
generators, although hand-driven generators and small petrol motor generators are
occasionally used.
The R.S.G.B. encourages the use of

specially for it.


The receiver consists of a six-waveband 4valve unit with RF stage, frequency changer,
IF amplifier and second detector. Wavelengths from 4.5 to 55o metres are covered
in five overlapping bands, and the two remaining positions on the selector switch give
long waves (900-2,000 metres) and provision
for gramophone reproduction.
Unit " B " consists of a 5 -valve ro-watt
" phase -reversed " amplifier with an overall
gain of 8o db and faders for mixing microphone, gramophone or radio inputs. There
is a tone control, and the mains equipment
is independent of external smoothing,
though the HT current available is sufficient
to energise a loud speaker field if required.
Complete with valves, Unit " A " costs
7 ros., and Unit " B " s I Ios.

The Wireless World, .June 9th, 1938

512

How a Receiver

is

Designed--A-W.

Developing a High -Quality


Communication Receiver
SPECIAL REQUIREMENTS TO BE CONSIDERED
this series of articles, which has been
running for some considerable period
The Wireless World, the design of
INin
various types of receiver has been
considered in detail, and in choosing a receiver to form the conclusion of the
articles it has been felt better to consider
the design of a large receiver of possibly
somewhat specialised type rather than to
deal with two or three small sets of more
orthodox arrangement. The latter would
involve a considerable amount of repetition, since there are many factors which
are common to all sets, and the description of a large set will bring out many
points which become of importance in
such equipment.
..
Although the receiver as a whole will be
of an elaborate nature, and in common
with all communication sets will have a
large number of controls, there is no
reason why those parts of it which an individual constructor does not require
should not be- omitted. As the term is
generally -understood, a communication
receiver is one which is primarily adapted
to the needs of the amateur transmitter.
His requirements are extreme sensitivity
and selectivity combined with great ease
of tuning on the short wavebands. The
equipment must include a beat frequency
oscillator for CWV morse reception, and
arrangements must also be made for cutting AVC out of circuit at will. This, in
turn, necessitates the inclusion of a pre detector gain control, and a useful refinement is the provision of some form of
signal strength indicator.

lengths, that a really high standard of


quality must be obtainable, and that the
output must be reasonably large. Before
we can consider the design of the equipment we must draw up a provisional
specification in more accurate terms. It
is clear that to cover all requirements the
tuning range should be continuous from
about 5 to 2,000 metres, except fora small
gap around the intermediate frequency.
This frequency is probably best of the
order of 465 kc / s, partly because this fits
in well with the conflicting requirements
of adjacent -channel selectivity and a low
degree of image interference, and partly
because it falls in a portion of the wavelength scale at which a gap can be best
tolerated, since it comes in a portion of
the 600 -metre shipping band.
The second requirement is that on all
wavelengths tuning should be easily
carried out. This is a really difficult problem and will be discussed in detail later.
The adjacent -channel selectivity should
be extremely high, and for amateur purposes we need not worry unduly about the
presence of a considerable degree of side band cutting, since the aim is to receive
intelligible signals with a low interference
and noise level rather than obtain high -

quality reproduction.
From the point of view of the broad -

quality communication receiver


are dealt with in this article and the
design of the apparatus is begun.
By the term "high -quality communication receiver" is meant a set
having the performance of a cornmuniction receiver on short waves
combined with the ability to give
really high quality of reproduction
in broadcast reception.
cast requirements of the set, however, the
latter is extremely important, hence it will
be necessary to include some form of
variable selectivity, and this control must
permit the selectivity being varied between two extreme limits, one the maximum of which the set is capable and the
other a minimum which will permit nearly
full retention of modulation frequencies
up to io,000 c / s. Experience shows,
however, that the selectivity need not be
continuously variable between these
limits unless it is mechanically easier to
arrange such a control. In practice it is
sufficient to be able to adjust the
selectivity in a suitable number of steps.
For high -quality reproduction an output
of some 6 watts or so is desirable, with a
very low degree of amplitude distortion,
-

+35211 86mA

Broadcast Characteristics
From his point of view quality of reproduction is usually of secondary importance, as is also the ability to cover the
wavelengths used in broadcasting. Many
of the attributes of the true communication receiver, however, could, with advantage, be incorporated in a broadcast
set, and it is felt that the usual specification of a communication receiver is rather
too narrow for most ,people.
It is felt,
therefore, that a receiver of this general
type, which must in any case employ quite
a large number of valves, could well have
its specification extended so that it will
form a first-class broadcast receiver as well
as suiting the more specialised needs of the
amateur.
This means primarily that the tuning
range must include all broadcast wave-

THE requirements for a high -

+HT

ci

0.1 mfd

-HT

Fig.

1.-The circuit diagram


the designer.

of the output stage is shown here in the way it is prepared by


It shows values of components, currents and voltages.

JUNE 9th, 1938.


Receiverand it is very useful, also, to have tone
controls which enable the bass and treble
response to be independently varied. The
detector must be designed for distortion less rectification and the AVC system incorporated must also introduce negligible
distortion. A beat -frequency oscillator
must be included to permit CW morse

Developing a High-lluality

WITA@Og
WOEid
it a tone -control stage giving a moderate
gain. Before this would corne a diode
detector and at least two IF stages. There
would also be a valve for the beat -frequency oscillator feeding into the detector.
A triode-hexode or similar frequency changer and one RF stage would complete
the active chain. A rectifier valve for the
HT supply would, of course, be necessary,

A view of the completed power unit showing the output valves.

reception and must be provided with an


on-off switch. An on -off switch for AVC
will also be necessary, but these two
switches can be combined, if desired, since
it is hardly ever necessary to dispense
with AVC when the beat -frequency oscillator is not employed. There will, of
course, be an AF gain control and a pre detector gain control will also be needed,
if only for the case when the equipment
is used without the AVC control. We
thus find that we shall have six controls,
apart from the tuning and waveband
switching. To meet the requirements of
those who will use the receiver for entertainment purposes, a radio -gramophone
switch must be added, and to meet the
needs of amateur transmitters a muting
switch must be included so that the receiver can be rendered inoperative without being switched off at the mains while
the transmitter is in use. This brings the
controls up to eight in number without
the tuning.

Preliminary Valve Arrangement


Before considering the design of the receiver in detail it is necessary to sketch out
a tentative arrangement which can form
a basis for design and which we may find
we shall have to modify as' we go along.
At first sight it would appear that the
requirements would best be met by a receiver including a push-pull triode output
stage fed from a push-pull resistance coupled penultimate triode stage on the
lines of the Push -Pull Quality Amplifier.
This will be preceded by a phase -splitting
valve, and this, in turn, would have before

and an additional valve might prove desirable for operating a signal strength
meter, and it is even possible that an extra
one in the frequency-changer might be
found desirable on ultra-short waves. The
total number of valves is thus likely to be
about twelve or thirteen.

The Output Stage


The first step in design is to work out
the details of the audio -frequency equipment, then to deal with the detector, the
AVC system and the last IF amplifier. The
attainment of the necessary IF gain and
selectivity then follows, and after this
comes the turn of the general tuning equipment, followed by the details of the RF
and frequency changer.
Turning now to the output stage, a
single PX4 valve is rated for an output of
3.5 watts, so that a pair of these in pushpull will enable about 7 watts to be
obtained quite easily. Such an output
stage should easily meet our requirements.
The valves require 30o volts for the
anode supply and take 5o mA. apiece. A
pair of valves in push-pull would require
the same operating voltages but the total
current will be double. If the valves are
run from a single filament winding on the
mains transformer, so that a common bias
resistance is used, following the usual
practice, the value of this resistance should
be 475 ohms-a non-standard value. In
practice, therefore, it is convenient to use
a resistance of 500 ohms. This results in
a slightly lower anode current for each
valve and a slightly higher grid bias.
Actually, the bias becomes 43 volts and

'513.

the anode current 43 mA. per valve. The


output power obtainable is slightly
affected, it is true, but in practice to a.
negligible extent. As will be shown later,
it is easily possible to obtain 7 watts from
a pair of PX4 valves under these conditions.
We can now draw out the circuit of the
output stage, as shown in Fig. i, and start
to assign values to the various components. The bias resistance, R7, we have
already decided shall be 500 ohms, and
as the current through it is 86 mA. it
must be capable of dissipating not less
than 4 watts. Anti-parasitic oscillation resistances, R5 and R6, of 5o ohms, are
advisable in the anode circuits, and similar
resistances, R3 and R4, of ro,oo ohms,
in the grid circuits. The grid leaks, RI
and R2, should be of as high a value as
possible, but if they are too high there is
a danger of damage to the output valves
should grid emission occur. It is, therefore, advisable to compromise somewhat
at this point, and a suitable value has been
found to be 0.25 megohm. With these
values of resistance, input coupling condensers, CI, C2, of 0.1 mfd., enable an
adequate bass response to be secured. The
output stage will require a total load of
about 8,000 ohms, and if we allow that
the transformer will have a tofal DC resistance for the primary of 300 ohms, the
voltages and currents in the various parts
of the circuit will come out at the figures
marked in Fig. I.
'

WEBB TRIMMING CONDENSERS

WIDE range of trimming condensers is


ZA now marketed by the Webb Condenser Co.,
Ltd., of 32, Hatton Garden, London, E.C.I.
Among specimens which have been sent to
us are multiple trimmers of the postage stamp type with ceramic insulation. These
consist actually of single trimmers with a
ceramic base and a capacity range of 2-3o
F, mounted on a strip of bakelised
material. This material does not provide

Webb multiple trimmer units.

insulation, for it contacts only with the


ceramic bases of the condensers. This type
is available at the price of 9d. per condenser
in the bank, and with a capacity of 100-200
F at rs. 3d.
A range of larger double -trimmers with
ceramic bases is also available. The types
in this range have insulated adjusting screws
and can be mounted with a single fixing
screw. The maximum capacities available
are from 70 F to o.00r F at prices from.
is. 6d. to 2S. 6d.

The Wireless World, June 9th, 1938

,7_

Letters to the Editor


56 Mc s Amateur Band
i may be of interest that at 13.35 G.M.T.
on May 23rd I received signals from
SM5SN; Sweden, on 56.7 megacycles. The
transmission was automatic, calling " TEST
DE SM5SN LUMA SWEDEN," tone modulated morse on a steady carrier which
peaked at R7. Unfortunately, the signals
faded out in ten minutes approximately,
and I did not have a chance of calling
SM5SN to establish contact. The above has
been confirmed by SM5SN, who states that
the transmitter runs automatically every
day from 0700-1600 and is situated at the
Luma Lamp Works.
The period from the evening of May 22nd
onwards gave exceptionally good " intense
E layer conditions, making it possible to
hear UHF broadcast, television, and 'commercial harmonics from many parts.. oaf;
Europe between 500 and i,000 miles. .On
the 22nd, signals were. heard up to 48 Mc/ s
on the 23rd, 56 Mc /s ; and 24th, 57 Mc /s.
It is 'unfortunate that there were no European amateurs active during the period, as
it is quite' certain that several inter-'
European contacts could have taken place'
on the 56 Mc /s amateur band.
I cannot say what conditions were like
after the i'4th, as my station is now closed
down for six weeks (except for automatic
transmission on 56 Mc/s each Sunday),
while I am on a trip to Canada and U.S.A.
'Gt. Ciacton. D. W. HEIGHTMAN.
;

(G6DH.)

Overseas Trade
a regular reader of your excellent
journal and as a wireless engineer, may
I add to your remarks in your recent editorial concerning overseas trade? The
failure of the British manufacturer to improve his trade in this country is entirely
his own fault. May I quote you just one
example of the lack of business efficiency of
British radio traders?
Recently I was asked to recommend to
some friends a reliable radio receiver. I
selected a receiver by a well-known British
firm. Three receivers were ordered from
England, the total cost being in the region
of fifty pounds. After much delay the invoices arrived here and eventually the receivers. To our dismay, the receivers
ordered, the receivers quoted on'the invoice,
and the receivers which actually arrived
were of three different types. Those which
arrived were entirely unsuitable for the purpose intended, and all were damaged, due
to' bad packing. The firm in question has
not even replied to the subsequent letter.
Needless to say, their terms were cash in
advance for overseas orders.
The local agents for British firms are very
badly informed concerning their firm's products, and bear no comparison with agents
for other countries.
J. MORTON, A.F.R.AE.S.
Baghdad, Iraq.
AS

Television Reception
WITH reference to the letter in your issue
of
May
26th
from Mr.
W.
MacLanachan entitled " Television Responsibilities," may I be permitted to take
up arms on behalf of the B.B.C.?
Mr. MacLanachan's report that the trans -

The Editor does not necessarily


endorse the opinions of his
correspondents
mission from Hurlingham was, on the
whole, better than previous outside broadcasts is a complete mystery to me. My own
conclusions coincided exactly with those of
my viewing colleagues and apparently with
the B.B.C. monitors, and were to the effect
that the transmission was a complete technical failure. The receivers on which this
conclusion was based were of a normal commercial type giving a picture somewhat, but
not greatly, less perfect than the transmission. If Mr. MacLanachan has a receiver
which can actually convert a bad transmission into a good one I should be interested
to see it.
It is unfortunate for Mr. MacLanachan
that his condemnation of the B.B.C. television organisation occurs on%a page which
also contains one of the finest week's programmes that have ever been offered, including, as high lights, "Pride and Prejudice," " Friends from the Zoo," " Broadway,'
" Toscanini,"
" The Constant
Nymph," " Derby Day," and (Oh, Triumph
of Incompetence!)
.-

London, N.W.ii.

"The Derby."

L. H. BEDFORD.

Muffled Broadcasting

HOPE The. Wireless World will print


this letter, since whenever I write to
the B.B.C. on the subject about to be discussed, they invariably make some ambiguous or evasive reply, if not a flat denial
of .my allegations.
It is the B.B.C. " blanket effect " which
bothers me, and a good many other
listeners, I suspect, even though they may
not all know what is wrong. This effect
manifests itself in the form of " backwardness " in speech and music, so that everything sounds muffled and uninteresting. It
is due to the following possible causes, and
I will leave it to those concerned to decide
which cause
i: Insufficient modulation of the carrier
:

wave.

2. Unsatisfactory placing of the microphone(s).


3. Studios which are acoustically too
perfect.
Of course, there are several other possible sources of defective transmission of
programmes, such as unsuitable landlines
in outside broadcasts, etc., but the above
suggest themselves as being more likely,
and of the three enumerated, No. i seems
to me the most feasible possibility. I have
noticed that when, for instance, London
Regional fades (which in this part of the
world it does quite often, especially at
night), speech or music become clearer
and more " forward " up to a point,
that is, to the point of distortion,
when the fade is becoming definitely
marked. This would seem to be due to the
fact of the modulation attaining, during
the process of fading of the carrier wave, a
better proportion in relation to it, with a
consequent improvement in tone and
quality of the programme being transmitted, up to the point mentioned above,
where distortion sets in.
The cause of the insufficient modulation

of which I complain is, I think, inherent


in British psychology. The engineers responsible are so anxious to send out broadcasts in good taste (in every `sense of that
expression) that, rather than run the
risk " of distortion they under -modulate

the carrier.
It is a curious fact, but one which cannot
truthfully be disputed, that " special"
(royal, for example.) broadcasts always
come out well! My set was new this year,
and cost 15 guineas.
T. J. E. WARBURTON.
St. Leonards, Sussex.

Fadeout of April 15th


TN connection with the letter from Mr.
D. W. Heightman (G6DH) in The Wireless World of May 19th, the following cosmic
data received from the International Scientific Radio Union (URSI) may be of interest. All times are G.M.T. The MAG
(terrestrial magnetism) report from Cheltenham, Maryland, shows that a disturbance of
moderate intensity began at 08.35 hours on
the 13th and lasted until 24.0o hours on the

i5th. A fresh, violent disturbance began at

05.47 hours on the i6th, lasting until 16.0o


hours. The SOL (sunspots) report for the
period from the Mount Wilson Observatory
is i3th, no observation possible; i4th, eight
groups, 135 spots; 15th, ten groups, 170
spots ; i6th, nine groups, 125 spots ; 17th,
eight groups, 200 spots.
Reports on fadeouts are supplied by
Japan. They show that fade-outs were observed on the 15th at 03.32 hours and at
08.30 hours. The latter time coincides
closely with Mr. Heightman's observations.
It is interesting to note that on April i6th.
the Japanese Ursigram, which ix- transmitted
on at least three different frequencies at
13.0o hours, could not be received in San
:

Francisco.

" DIALLIST."

A.R.P. and Amateurs


space can be found for this letter it may
IF be the means of preventing patriotic

:-

amateurs from
I. Wasting valuable operating time.
2. Jeopardising their position as holders of
experimental Iicences by attempting to
organise communication services, and
3. Offering their stations to A.R.P.
authorities who obviously have no control
whatsoever, directly or indirectly, over
radio communication.
Condition No. 14 of the Amateur licence
can only be interpreted as meaning that the
station will be, as in the last war, closed
down immediately an emergency arises.
The fact that the Postmaster -General
does not contemplate any other step is
borne out by the Home Secretary's reply to
a scheme, worked out over a year ago, in
responsible amateurs were to have
co-operated with the police in forming an
emergency radio link for A.R.P. communications.
Sir Samuel Hoare states that he is advised on technical grounds that, owing to.
traffic -carrying capacity and mutual inter
ference difficulties, the use of wireless for
A.R.P. communications is not considered
practicable.
A.R.P. authorities are being
circularised that the telephone must be regarded as the, normal means of communication and relied upon so far as possible; with
a messenger service as a stand-by. Volunteers for A.R:P. service should mention, at
the time of enrolling, any operating qualifications."
N. P. SPOONER, G2NS.
Bournemouth.

't
j

The Wireless World,

June

91k,

t938

'575

SIR JOHN REITH

INTERFERENCE
SUPPRESSION
How the Authorities

Became

Interested

interesting method of
attack against the annoyance of electrical interference
has been adopted by a large
organisation of 38,000 listeners
in Finland.
They pointed out to the
power authorities that their
annual consumption of electricity
amounted to
approximately
2 million kWh, which means a
yearly income of more than
17,000 for the company. If interference from electrical appliances could be eliminated, or at
least reduced, power suppliers
would benefit from the many
hundreds of listeners who would
promptly change their present
battery sets (which are not so
prone to mains -borne interference) for new all-mains receivers.
The power authorities were
impressed by the argument, and
immediately responded by making a thorough investigation.
It was found that about 5o per
AN

cent.. of electrical interference in

Helsingfors originated from lifts,


and as a result of this discovery
an order has been issued to the
effect that all lifts are to be
equipped with interference suppressors before March ist, 1939.
The necessary installations,
which will apply to some 2,000
lifts, are to be paid for by the
landlords.

OF THE

tions to the contrary, Sir John


Reith has no intention of leaving.
the B.B.C. The organisation of
broadcasting can never be regarded as complete ; it will
always be in a fluid state and
therefore in need of a strong
guiding hand.
The only possibility of a
change in the Director -Generalship might arise in the case of a
national emergency, when the
Government might need the services of such an experienced
organiser elsewhere. Even so,
the feeling in official quarters
seems to be that broadcasting
would be one of the essential services and that Sir John would be
of greater assistance in his present sphere than, perhaps, in
any other.

PEACE...."

will meet in
A COMMITTEE
Geneva on June i7th and

18th, under the auspices of the


League of Nations, to discuss
and report on the means of using
broadcasting in the cause of
peace. This committee will sub.
mit its findings to the International Committee on Intellectual Co-operation, which will
take this as a basis for a report
to the next League Assembly.
A number of broadcasting
companies will be represented,
among them being the B.B.C.,
those of Yugoslavia, Belgium,
Hungary, Czechoslovakia and
Sweden, as well as the European
representatives of the American
companies. Mr. A. R. Burrows,
of the U.I.R., will, for the first
time since taking over duties in
Geneva, speak in public for the
Union.

FIRE ESCAPE AERIAL


FOR TELEVISION
WHEN the tennis tourna-

THE KITE AERIAL, famous for


its application in the pioneer days
of wireless, has come back in
America, where it is being used by
N.B.C. commentators for the
short-wave transmission of outside events to the parent station.

CLEVEDON DIFFICULTIES
AN unexpected altercation has
arisen over the building of
the new B.B.C. station at Cleve don, Somerset. A large site,
contiguous to that selected by
the B.B.C., has been reserved for
an aeroplane landing centre, and
the 375-ft. mast of the broadcasting station would be an obvious danger to landing aircraft.
Discussions have taken place between the B.B.C., the Post Office
and the Air Ministry, but no decision has yet been arrived at.

Rumours Denied
E Wireless World under stands that, despite sugges-

"NATION SHALL SPEAK

ments are televised from


Wimbledon a new aerial will be
used by the B.B.C. mobile unit.
It is understood that this will be
adapted from a fire escape,
some 8oft. in height, to which
will be attached a short mast
giving an effective height of
about rooft. It is estimated
that at least one day will be
saved in installing the mobile
unit when this. aerial is employed, for hitherto the task of
finding a suitable site for the
aerial has absorbed more time
than the actual transmission
tests.

EEK

DEMONSTRATION TEL E ISION


TRANSMITTER
j OR the purpose of demonstrating the possibilities of

EASE OF MANIPULATION is
one of the main features of this
camera used by Philips with their
mobile television station designed
for demonstration purposes.

GROSSE DEUTSCHLAND
RADIO INDUSTRY
Internal Trade Concession
AN agreement has been signed
by representatives of the

television, the Philips' Laboratories at Eindhoven have produced a mobile low -powered
television transmitter, which is
housed in two large trailers. In
one is the scanning apparatus,
whilst in the second are two
transmitters, one for sound and
the other for vision. Two detachable aerials, about ro metres
high, are mounted on the transmitting van. Pictures are transmitted on 405 or 567 lines at 25
per second with interlaced scanning.
No generators are installed, as
power is obtained from the
supply mains. A small studio

German and former Austrian


radio industries that no receivers
will be supplied to, or advertised
in, Austria by the German industry before June next year.
The Austrian firms Eltz, Eumig,
Ingelen, Kapsch and Minerva
will, however, be allowed to
supply up to 30,000 receivers to
Germany during the period from
July 22nd, 1938, to June 3oth,
1939.

The two remaining Viennese firms, Siemens and Philips,


have decided to forgo this privilege to give others a greater opportunity. It is, however, be-

lieved in German industrial


circles that the German radio industry would not consent to an
increase in the number of sets to
be sold in the Reich by Philips,
who are already allowed to
manufacture and sell an established number of receivers in
Germany.
From August, 5938, onwards
People's Receivers will be available in Austria as well as in Germany. The Austrian radio industry will co-operate in the
manufacture of these and the
same prices and conditions of
sale will prevail throughout
greater Germany.

THE TRANSMITTING VAN of


the Philips mobile station showing
one of the two aerials.

set-up is carried, which consists


of an easily dismantled steel
framework. This is fitted with
five r -kilowatt high-pressure
mercury lamps.
When demonstrating, several

Mpehoz

516

JUNE

Woplid

News of the

Week-

receivers are set up in the


vicinity on which the transmissions are received. Should conditions be unfavourable, a cable
is provided for direct link with
the demonstration receivers.
S

0 S FROM EMPIRE
STATIONS

T appeal for information rej lating to the position of the


5,000 -ton cargo boat, Anglo
Australian, was broadcast from
the B.B.C.'s Empire station on
behalf of the Mercantile Marine
Dept. of the Board of Trade. This
is the first occasion on which the
B.B.C. has broadcast a worldwide S O S. Since the vessel wirelessed that she was passing
Fayal, in the Azores, on March
r4th, on her way from Cardiff to
Vancouver, nothing has been
heard of her, and considerable
anxiety is felt for the safety .of
her crew of thirty-eight.
-

" OUT OF TOWN TO-NIGHT" ?

ALTHOUGH the ever-popular


B.B.C. feature " In Town
To -night " ceases, temporarily at
least, on July 3rd, the authorities are already flirting with the
idea of shifting the centre of

gravity to the provincial centres.


There is no reason why Manchester, or Birmingham, or even
Wigan, should not be able to
produce at least one batch each
of interesting personalities within
their frontiers on any night in
the year.
The idea will find an outlet, to
some extent, in the seaside concert party relays arranged for
the summer months, which will
include mobile microphone work
among the crowds on the seashore. This radio beachcombing
may bring as many colourful folk
to the microphone as can be had
on Saturday nights in London.

Repairs by Broadcast Instruction


Two pilots of the Western Air
Express flying over Salt Lake
City were in imminent danger of
making a crash landing when their
machine's landing gear jammed.
\Vireless instructions from Lockheed factory engineers enabled
them to effect repairs in the air,
and the plane landed without
mishap.

ANOTHER LUXEMBOURG ?

Danish 6-k\V shortwave station, Skamlebaek, is now


directing special transmissions to
South America and East Asia on
31.51 metres from 1 to 2.30 a.m.
(G.M.T.), and to North America
and Greenland from 2.3o to 4
a.m. (G.M.T.).

ACONCESSION has been


granted to an English advertising company to operate a
sponsored broadcasting station in
the State of Liechtenstein, as
was foreshadowed in The Wireless World some months ago.
Vaduz, the capital of Liechtenstein, which is situated between the German and Swiss
frontiers, is about 550 miles from
London. According to World's
Press News, it is likely that a
temporary station for testing
will be erected as a preliminary

to the larger transmitter.

N.P.L. Director
Lord President of the
Council has appointed Professor
R. H. Fowler, O.B.E., M.A.,
F.R.S., at present Plummer Professor of Applied Mathematics in
the University of Cambridge, to
be Director of the National
Physical Laboratory with effect as
Profrom October 1st, 1938.
fessor Fowler will succeed Dr.
\V. H. Bragg, who has been
elected to the Cavendish Professorship of Experimental Physics in
the University of Cambridge.

NEW

Valuable Amateur Aid

A.K.P. authorities at St. Austell


are benefiting considerably by the
co-operation of the St. Austell
Radio Club, whose members have
provided a short-wave transmitter
for headquarters and two portable short-wave receivers.
Police Wireless
proposal to equip Blackpool police with a comprehensive
wireless system has received
approval from the \Vatch Committee.
It has been found necessary to
equip the Essex Police Courtesy
Squad with short-wave transmitter -receivers.
TILE

Far ?
the recent talks in the
series, " My Best News Story," all
references to the names of newspapers were cut out by the B.R.C.
Is this carrying the rule prohibiting advertising to the extreme.
DURING

THE

matches

New SW Schedule

Is it Carried Too

FROM ALL
Q UARTERS

30,000 Test Broadcasts


Ix is reported that the Australian Broadcasting Commission
is arranging, .at a cost of 30,000,
to broadcast to listeners in the
Commonwealth ball -by -ball commentaries of all the five test

Radio Luxembourg

understood that the


Luxembourg Chamber has passed
a Bill ratifying Luxembourg's
agreement to the International
Broadcasting Convention's waveThis will mean
length plan.
Luxembourg relinquishing the
wavelength of 1,293 metres.

pose in the Moscow Clinical Institute for Infectious Diseases, according to the official Soviet news
agency. Visitors to the hospital,
who would not normally be
allowed to see infectious cases, are
permitted to look at, and converse with, patients over a closed
television circuit.
The device
may also be used by visiting
specialists who, by direct contact with patients, might tend to
spread disease.
Ceylon Wants More Worlds to
Conquer
Is the world too small for the
radio amateur? The keen worker
will strenuously deny this defeatist attitude, which finds expression in the decision of the
Ceylon Radio Club to discontinue

- FREQUENCY
oscillations
are used for treating acute inflammatory eye conditions in the
Royal Westminster Ophthalmic
Hospital, London.

transmitter at Nigg,
Aberdeen, will start testing in the
next few weeks, and is de to open
in the autumn. It will use the
wavelength of 233.5 metres at
present employed by the r-k\V
Aberdeen transmitter.

is

Diagnosis by Television
TELEVISION serves a novel puI-

Wireless Treatment for Eyes

New Scottish Transmitter

IT

tor some
time been waiting to leave Fcamp
and occupy the new station at
Louvetot. M. Fernand Le Grand,
famous as the founder of Radio
Normandie, says that the new
station is not quite ready for work
as revised wavelength allocations
have necessitated certain modifications of existing settings.
In
addition he stated that official
permission for the working of
Louvetot has not yet been
granted.
Uniform Aerials
THE Polish Minister of the Interior has issued an order which
compels town dwellers to replace
their old aerials with those of a
uniform variety in cases where
ungainly aerials are resthetically
offensive. A similar measure has
been adopted in Amsterdam.

I-IIGH

THE 5 -kW

West of England Studios

New Radio Normandie


RADIO NORMANDIE has

its weekly short-wave bulletin.


As reported in the Ceylon Radio
Tinges, the Club considers that,
with the wonderful progress made
in receiving sets, reports on reception conditions are not now so
necessary.

B.B.C. scours are now searching for sites for new Bristol offices
to become the headquarters of
\Vest Region.
In Plymouth at
least three possible sites have been
found for new studios, the intention being to provide a goodly
percentage of Plymouth programmes for the new Start Point
transmitter.

91h, 1938.

Radio in Trains
BY order of

the Ministry of
Public Works all trains of the
Turkish State Railways are to be
equipped with wireless.
PACIFIC COAST HEADQUARTERS of the C.B.S. in Columbia Square,
Hollywood, which, having cost $1,750,000, was inaugurated a few
weeks ago. Inclined walls and windows, to overcome sound reflection,
with the floor, walls and ceiling, " floating " on special material which
acoustically separates them from the main structure, thus preventing
vibration, are features of the eight studios of the station- KNX, which
the building houses.

Broadcasting House Extension


enlarged
Broadcasting
House is not likely to be complete
for two years. \\'e understand that
the frequently announced demolition of the buildings adjoining
Broadcasting House in Portland
Place will now begin in October.
Cinema Television
PROVISION for Baird television
will he made in the new super cinema which is to be erected in
.the centre of \Vigan.
THE

PA for Travellers
have been carried

EXPERIMENTS

out at Folkestone Harbour, using


PA speakers as a medium for convel'ing directions to passengers
arriving at and leaving the port.
Mobile Recording in India

Indian villages may shortly be included in


the programmes of All -India
Radio. According to the Times
of India, the Bombay station is
.acquiring a mobile recording unit.
RECORDS of talent. in

I.E.E. Council
following
have
been
nominated by the Council of the
I.E.E. for the vacancies which
will occur on September 3oth,
r938:-President, Mr. A. P. M.
Fleming, C.B.E., D.Eng., M. Sc.
(Metropolitan - Vickers);
Vice President, Professor C. L. Forfescue, O.B.E., M.A. (City and
Guilds College) ; Hon. Treasurer,
Mr. W. McClelland, C.B., O.B.E.
(Henley's Telegraph
Works);
ordinary members of Council, Mr.
P. Dunsheath, O.B.E., M.A.,
D. Sc.
(Henley's Telegraph
Works), Professor R. O. Kapp,
B.Sc: (University - College), Mr.
A. P. Young, O.B.E. (British
'Thomson -Houston), Mr. L. G.
Brazier, Ph.D., B.Sc. (Callender's
Cable and Construction Co.).
THE

The Wireless World, June

9111,

1038

517

Philips

PORTABLE
MODEL 225B
Superheterodyne

Battery
Circuit with AVC

THE announcement of this portable was an event of interest


alike to the buying public and
the trade, for it is the first selfcontained receiver to be included in the
Philips range of broadcast sets. It can
be said at once that it is a typical Philips
design both mechanically and electrically.
The tuning condenser, for instance, is a
compact and rigidly constructed unit with
close vane spacing and porcelain insulation. Screening and " earthing " problems-so essential in any portable designed to operate without the stabilising
influence of an external aerial and earth
-have been carefully studied in the
audio as well as the radio and intermediate frequency stages. As a result a.
high overall magnificajion has been
achieved without the slightest suggestion
of feed-back or instability.
An octode frequency -changer occupies
the first stage in the superheterodyne circuit. It is followed by an IF amplifier

with iron -cored couplings in which the


secondary of the output transformer is
tapped down to reduce the load of the
signal -rectifying diode. The AVC diode
is fed from the primary and the control
voltage, which is delayed, is passed to
both IF and frequency -changer stages.
The auto -transformer coupling the triode
portion of the second detector stage to the
output pentode is filter -fed.
The control spindles project vertically
through a black moulded escutcheon plate
in the top of the case and the waverange
switch has coloured dots corresponding to
the colours of the printed station names on
each of the two wavebands. The tuning
scale and pointer are protected by a
domed cover of transparent flexible
moulded material.
Among the many good points in the
performance of this receiver we would put
first the high overall magnification up to
the grid of the output valve. Few portables have given such a convincing demonstration of long-range reception inside
the steel -framed building where initial adjustments and tests are usually carried
out. When used out of doors or in a normal brick -built house the Philips portable
can be relied upon to give as wide a choice
of alternative programmes as the average
table model broadcast receiver, and that
without the trouble of putting up an exterior aerial.

FEATURES. Waveranges.-(t)

200550 metres. (2) 900-2,000 metres.


Octode frequency-changer-pentode IF amplifier-double-diode-triode second detector,
AVC and 1st AF amplifier-pentode output
valve. Automatic bias.
Controls.-(1)
Tuning. (2) Volume and on-off switch. (3)
Waverange. Weight.
lb.
Dimensions.-111in. x 10 ; in. x 7 -tin. Price.
8 guineas.
Make rs.
Lamps
Ltd., 145, Charing Cross Rd., London,W.C.2.

Circuit.-

-16

Philips

Selectivity, too, is of a very high order,


and on long waves the Deutschlandsender
was easily separated from Droitwich and
Radio Paris without invoking the aid of
the directional properties of the frame.
In this connection it is worth noting that
in spite of the inclusion of AVC a welldefined minimum is obtained on most
stations.
The set is commendably free from selfgenerated whistles. None could be traced
on the medium -wave band, and on the
long-wave range a clash between a harmonic of the oscillator and London
Regional was noticeable only when an external aerial loaded the input tuned circuit.
Measurements of current consumption
gave o.5 amp. for the LT and an average
of 8.5 mA from the 90 -volt HT battery.
There is very little change of HT current
under the action of AVC even on strong
signals unless an external aerial is
attached, when the reduction is of the

With transformer coupling following the triode Ist AF amplifier the superheterodyne circuit has a high effective overall gain.
have iron cores which are adjustable for final tuning to the intermediate frequency of 470 kc/s.

The IF transformers

WIpd.cg

-518

JUNE

WopIlcl
Philips Portable Model 225Border of i to 2 mA. An increase of a

similar amount results from overloading


the output stage-a frequent occurrence

seems to be more comfortable than a flexible grip, and when hinged down is quite
unobtrusive. Incidentally, if it is hinged
down the " wrong " way, some additional

VP2

2nd

DETECTOR

VALVE

AERIAL

TDD2A

AND
EARTH

raring the first issue of the club magazine.

The members of the Society will pay a visit


to Speke Airport to view the radio equipment
on Saturday, June 11th. Members and friends
are asked to meet at the corner of Water Street;
by ,the Cunard Buildings, Liverpool, in time
to catch the 3.3o p.m. bus.

North Manchester Radio Society

VALVE

AMPLIFIER

91h, 1938.

Headquarters: 14, Fairfax Road, Prestwich, near Manchester.


Meetings: Alternate Sundays at. 3.30 p.m.
Hall. See.: Mr, R. Lawton, 10, Dalton Avenue, Thatch
Leach Lane, Whitefeld, near Manchester.
It has been decided that the membership fee
shall be 5s. a year, payable in two half-yearly
instalments of 2s. 6d.
Arrangements havd

been made for more instruction to be given


at the meetings, and it has been decided that

SOCKETS

OUTPUT
FREQUENCY
CHANGER

VALVE

2 2

the Society shall have its own receiving equipment, and, later on, will apply for a transmitting licence. It is also intended that commercial types of short- or all -wave receivers shall
be available at the clubroom. The next meeting is on June 12th.

London Transmitting Society

VALVE

Headquarters:

40, Raeburn Road, Edgware.


Meetings: Thursdays at 8 p.m.
Hon. Sec.: Mr. G. Yale, 40, Raeburn Road, Edgware.

FC2A

The Society has decided to purchase a Lissen


Hi -Q4 SW receiver for the use of members.
Agreement has now been reached on the apparatus to be built for the new laboratory.
Morse lessons are given every Thursday by
2DWS. A junk sale is arranged for to -night.

Eastbourne and District Radio Society


Headquarters: The Science Room, Cavendish Senior
School, Eastbourne.
Hon. Sec.: Mr. T. G. R. Dowsett, 48, Grove Road, East-

TheWlreless World

bourne.

COPYRIGHT

Layout of interior of cabinet showing positions occupied by the HT and LT batteries. The valves
which are mounted horizontally are secured by moulded rubber bands.

until one becomes accustomed to the controls. It is only on weak stations that the
set can be fully extended, and under normal conditions of use. a watchful eye must
be kept on the volume control to avoid
distortion. The volume then available is
adequate for outdoor conditions provided
that there is not too much wind about ;
indoors the maximum undistorted output
gives precisely the level one would normally choose for general reception in a
room of, say, 1,25o cubic feet with normal
absorption.
Making allowance for the lack of extreme bass inherent in any receiver of this
size there is no fault to find with the
quality. On the contrary, it is ideally
suited to speech and the lighter musical
programmes. The piano in particular
comes through extremely well provided
one does not strive for too much volume.
The performance is so much above the
average in the matter of range and selectivity that the attention which must be
given to the volume control is a small
price to pay. One does not have to pay
for it in maintenance, for the average HT
current is well within the capacity of the
battery and fluctuations from the average
are small.
The appearance of the receiver is attractive and the silver-grey loud speaker fret
and polished chromium surround look
well against the blue leatherette finish.
There is a firmness and promise of permanence in the shaped metal carrying
handle which is lacking in some of the
straps fitted to cheaper models. In spite
of, or perhaps because of, its rigidity it

protection is afforded to the control knobs


in the event of heavy parcels being placed
on top of the set in the back of a car.

Recently Mr. E. Morey, of Belling and Lee.


Ltd., gave a lecture entitled "General
Interference Suppression Work." He demonstrated the " Eliminoise " anti -static aerial,
and various types of suppressors.

Beethoven Model P.555


DESIGNED for use either as a home transportable or an outdoor picnic portable,
this recent addition to the range of receivers
made by Beethoven Electric Equipment, Ltd.,
Chase Road, North Acton, London, N.W.io,
is housed in a blue leathercloth case 9}in. x
git1. x sin. The controls are concealed under
a hinged lid, and the carrying handle is
detachable.
A four -valve straight circuit with pentode
RF stage is employed, and the 8o-volt HT
battery is provided with quick-fitting contacts.
The price complete with batteries is 6 15s.,
and the weight approximately 121 lb.
.

Club News
Wirral Amateur Transmitting and
Short-wave Club
Headquarters: Bcechroft Settlement, Whetstone Lane,
141rkenhead.
Meetings: Last Wednesday In the month at 7.10 p.m.
Hon. Seo.: Mr. J. R. Williamson, 13, Harrow Grove,

Bromhorongh, Birkenhead.
A successful junk sale was held on May 25th.
There is now a great deal of activity in pre -

AMATEUR FIELD DAY. One of the portable 40 -metre transmitters which took part in a
direction -finding contest organised recently by the Thames Valley Radio Society. The transmitter
employed a straight crystal oscillator using an RK23 coupled to a 132ft. Hertz aerial. The
receiver was of the TRF type. Included in the photograph is GBSMP, the owner of the station,
together with G5LC, G2NN and other amateurs, who took part in the contest.

The Wireless World, June 9th, 1938

519

The Home Laboratory


BROADLY speaking, there are two
sorts of ways in which a thing can
be measured. Meters of various
types, so familiar in all radio
laboratory and service work, are examples
of indirect methods.
In measuring the
voltage of a battery by means of a voltmeter, one does not compare it with a
standard voltage; actually
the instrument responds to
the current passed through
a certain resistance, and
even the current measurement is an indirect one. On
the other hand, in laboratories devoted more particularly to very accurate measurements for
the calibrating of meters, an unknown
voltage is measured by comparing it
directly with the voltage of a standard
cell.
The same choice of methods is available
for measuring resistance. The ohmmeters
commonly incorporated in multi -range
servicing instruments adopt an indirect
method, indicating the current passed
through the unknown resistance by a certain voltage. But when a resistance is to
be measured very accurately it is more
usual to compare it with a standard of the
same kind,v.e,, resistance.

By M. G. SCROGGIE,
sistance is encountered over a rather
B.Sc., A.M.I.E.E.
wider range ; inductance rather less. The
prospect of having to provide accurate
standards for direct comparison covering
all, of these enormous ranges is truly
alarming to contemplate
not matter exactly what the battery voltThat is where the bridge comes in. It age is, nor need it be perfectly steady ; and
is not practicable to measure the diameter
the higher the sensitivity of the meter the
of the sun against a stand- more precisely, ran the comparison be
ard yardstick by applying a made. There is hardly any limit. This
pair of outside callipers is the advantage of the so-called null
directly to that luminary
method.
but by holding the yardNow suppose that Rq., the " unknown,
stick a little distance from is higher than the standard, R3, can go to.
the eye the sun can be If R2 is made, say, ro times R1, then R4
measured if one knows the at balance is ro times R3.
This illusratio of the distances from the eye to the trates the second object of the bridge cirstick and to the sun. A bridge is, first, cuit ; to extend the range of comparison
a convenient system for comparing two beyond that of the standard. In AC
electrical quantities with great precision, bridges this extension applies not only to
and secondly, a sort of electrical panto- quantity but to quality ; not only can
graph for introducing a multiplying ratio Loa) microhenrys be accurately cominto the comparison. The simplest bridge, pared with ioo microhenrys, but it can
the Wheatstone, is a symmetrical network be compared -with r micro-microfarads
of six arms, one containing a source of or 1,000 ohms. Obviously all this makes
current, such as a battery or oscillator, it possible to cut down the number and
and another a detector, such as a galvano- variety of standards enormously. To
meter or phones ; when the impedances of give 'an example of this, a commercial
the remaining four are in proportion, no make of bridge (the General Radio
current flows via the detector arm.
In 650-A), in which everything including DC
Fig. r, showing an
and AC' 'sources is
ordinary W h e a t contained in a box a
stone bridge circuit
good deal ` smaller
GENERAL discussion of .the
for D.C., balance is
than a table radio
1`1 properties and design of
obtained, and the
set, covers o.00r
bridges, to be followed by condeflection of the galohm to r Mf?, 1 mvanometer G is zero,
structional details of a generalmfd. to roo mfd.,
and rH to 100 H.
purpose instrument in which an
when-a =
Standards of equal
inexpensive cathode-ray indicator
which, of course, is
accuracy,
continuthe same as R1 R4=
is used.
ously variable beR2 R3. Obviously,
tween those limits
if three of these are
would cost a small
known, the remaining one .can be ca.lca fortune and require a large part of the
lated. It is not even necessary to know laboratory to house.
the actual values of three ; the value of
The DC bridge of Fig. 1 is simple
one and the ratio between two is enough.
enough, but there are a few practical
Thus, if it is merely known that RI and points to be observed even about it. MaxiR2 are equal, balance is obtained when mum sensitiveness of balance is obtained
R3 = R4.
when all four arms are equal. The nearer
This illustrates the bridge as a means one can get to this condition the better.
of comparing two resistances with greater If the arms R1 and R2 are in the ratio of
precision than could be done in a mor 10,000 to r, the minimum observable dedirect fashion.
Suppose they are com- flection requires a much larger percentage
pared directly, by noting the reading unbalance than if a r to r ratio is adopted.
given on a meter in series with each in More than that ; the ratio itself is not
turn ; if the meter is a good one and has likely to be known to great accuracy when
a very long scale it may be just possible it is large, because extreme values of reto detect a difference amounting to a thou- sistances are not so accurate as medium
sandth part of the deflection. But to get values. Furthermore, a great advantage
this it is necessary for the supply voltage of a r to 1 ratio is that errors may be
to remain constant within still smaller largely eliminated by reversing one pair
limits, and for the deflection to be 'some
of arms and taking the average of the two
where near full-scale.
Generally, one readings.
If the resistance to be meapart in a hundred would be a more likely sured is very large, the sensitiveness of
accuracy of comparison.
There is no adjustment can be improved by increasadvantage in using a very sensitive meter, ing the battery voltage, but if RI and R2.
because it would simply be driven off the are quite low in resistance the resulting
scale. But in the bridge circuit it does current may overheat them.
So it is
!

Part VII.-

.;

BRIDGES

Direct and Indirect Methods


,In each of the above examples the
direct comparison method is used for
accurate laboratory purposes ; the indirect
method for approximate tests. This is
quite typical.
It is natural to expect
greater accuracy and reliability if the thing
being measured is directly compared with
a standard of the same sort than if it is
deduced indirectly. This is particularly
so when the quantity concerned is something passive, such as a resistance.
It
may not be so with an active quantity,
such as amplification.
The disadvantage of direct comparison,
from a practical
point of view, is
that the quantities quite ordinarily, required to

Fig. r.-A
typical DC
brid re -circuit.

be_measured in a radio laboratory include


Taking
such an enormous range.
capacity ; there is-o.00r micro-microfarad
at one extreme (the anode -grid capacity of
a RF valve), and loo microfarads at the
other (a by-pass .condenser for a valve
biasing resistor). They enclose a range of.
a hundred thousand million to one: Re -

Wfipehoo
Would

520
The Home Laboratory-

better for R4 and R2 to be the large resistances, in order to limit the current in
both paths. A variable resistance in
series with the battery is useful.
Although the detector G is not primarily intended as a measuring instrument,
but merely to show the presence or
absence of current, it is in practice used
to make up for the customary absence of
a continuously variable resistance standard. Having found, for example, that
with R3 = 527 ohms the galvanometer

source need not be strictly of one frequency-it is not essential to provide a


perfectly pure wave, free from harmonics.
Another complication with AC is that unless one is very careful there may be
unauthorised arms to the bridge, such as
the capacities between the various components of it. The higher the frequency
the worse the trouble is. And there are
difficulties in making sure that what is
meant to be a resistance arm really is a
resistance and not a mixture of resistance
and reactance. The difficulties in keeping reactances free from resistance are
even greater still.
Looking at Fig. i again, if the arms
RI R4 are all pure resistances it is quite
possible to run it on AC instead of DC.
In fact, if the frequency is about i,000 c/s
the detector can be a pair of phones,
which is cheaper, more sensitive and robust than a galvanometer. The AC source
may be a buzzer or valve oscillator.
Headphones are very suitable for middle
frequencies, but not for much lower or
higher frequencies (e.g., 5o c/s). The resistance measured is, of course, the resistance to AC at the frequency of the source,
which is not necessarily the same as the
DC resistance.
Next, suppose the arms are all occupied
by condensers or inductors. The same law
for balance applies to their reactances ; but
it is necessary for them all either to be
pure reactances or to have the same power
factors (ratios of resistance to impedance) ;
otherwise the unbalanced resistances
obscure the reactance balance. In practice it is highly unlikely that four reactive
arms would balance for reactance and resistance simultaneously, unless special
provision is made for adjusting the quantities independently. In certain types of
bridge, more especially those including
self-inductance, these adjustments are not
independent, and one may work away at
them, first one and then the other, for a
considerable time before finding a balance.
Capacity arms are generally better,
because a good condenser is a fair
approximation to a pure reactance.

R3

Fig.

2.-A simple type of AC bridge, in


which Rs and R2 are the ratio arms.

reads 3 divisions to the left and with 528


it reads 2 to the right, one can see that the
resistance for exact balance would be
527.6 ohms.

Until balance is approached it is essential for the well-being of G to shunt it


down heavily, or reduce B, or both. If
a suitable metal rectifier is used as a shunt
it can be left connected all the time,
because when the signal is near zero its resistance is so high as not to reduce the
sensitivity of G very much, but it prevents
disaster if one of the resistances is accidentally open -circuited when G. is delicately adjusted to balance.
It is usual to have keys in the B and G
circuits, and by tapping the G key in time
with the natural swing period of the
pointer of G, a smaller current can be detected than if it is kept steady. The B key
must be closed before the G key, because
if any of the resistances is reactive, as for
example when the resistance of a transformer or loud speaker coil is being measured, the different impedance of such an
arm to a current that is varying causes a
momentary detector current even when
the bridge is perfectly balanced for steady
currents.
That is the obvious cue to go on to AC
bridges ; a vastly more complex subject.
The most important complication is that
besides resistances there are reactances of
two sorts-inductive and capacitive-and
for an AC bridge to be balanced it is
necessary for both resistance and reactance to balance simultaneously. Then in
some types of bridge the balance depends
on frequency ; in others it does not. Unless one particularly wants to distinguish
between frequencies, the latter types of
bridge have the advantage that the AC

'JUNE 9th, 1938.

shorted and R3 switched into that arm,


giving the simple Fig. i circuit. If X is
a condenser, S is a standard condenser,
which is generally sufficiently good to bet
almost a pure reactance, so for balancing
the resistance of X it is likely that R3 will
have to be on the S side. Unless the condenser to be measured has a bad power
factor (e.g., one of the electrolytic type) a
reasonably good balance may be possible
without R3.
Finally, if X is a coil, a
standard coil must be connected at S. As
a matter of fact, this type .of bridge,- for
the reason already given, is not very suitable for inductance measurements, except
possibly for detecting differences between
coils that are supposed to be the same.
One common type of inductance bridge
balances X against a capacity in the arm
marked here as Ri. Probably the best
bridge of all for inductances employs a
mutual inductometer as the standard.

Other Types
But it is not possible in a single article
like this to go into details about the many
sorts of AC bridges, especially those for
accurate laboratory work. Some of them
are dealt with in the forthcoming book of
which these articles are a foretaste. Considering, then, the requirements for measuring a wide range of components with
moderate accuracy, such as in service
work, it is better to dodge the difficulties
than to overcome them by sheer weight of
finance and precise design and workmanship.
Stray capacities, for instance. The results obtained with a bridge of the Fig. 2
type are liable to differ considerably according to which point (if any) is earthed.
If one side of the oscillator is earthed, any
capacity from headphones to the wearer

Ratio Arms

It is inviting unnecessary difficulties to


make all four arms reactive, and in most
practical AC bridges two of them (known
as the ratio arms) are pure resistances and
the other two-one of them including the
unknown-are reactances with or without
resistance. For example, Fig. 2 shows the
circuit of a very simple but adaptable type
of bridge. Ri and R2 are the ratio arms,
either fixed at some one ratio or variable.
The advantages of using a i to I ratio,
mentioned for DC, are much more marked
with AC, because it is much easier to prevent stray capacities .from affecting the
accuracy, but,. of course, the range of
measurement is much restricted. The
component to be measured is connected at
X and a standard of the same sort at S,
and the switch is set to the position that
puts R3 in the arm with least resistance,
to enable the resistances to be balanced.
If X is a resistance, the S terminals are

F g.

3-A "universal " bridge with a tuning


indicator as a detector.

and hence to earth comes across either the


unknown or the standard. On the other
hand, if the phones are earthed, the oscillator capacity may cause trouble, though
at least it is less likely to be a variable
quantity than is the capacity of headphones. In precise bridges all sorts of
devices, such as screened and balanced
input and output transformers, " Wagner
earths," and so forth, are adopted with
varying degrees of success. By taking
suitable precautions it is possible to run
bridges at high or even ultra -high fre-

.9ffipeillsoo

JANE 9th, 1938.

WopIld
The Home Laboratory-

quencies. But the range of measurement


is very limited.
For covering a wide
range, for general component checking,
even i,000 c/s is high enough to land one
in difficulties.

Using the Mains Supply


But how about 5o c/s?
Assuming
standard electricity supply, there is no
trouble or expense in providing an oscillator just plug in to as much as is wanted.
And at sch a low frequency, stray capacities are correspondingly small in their
effects, and a very moderate degree of
care in this respect is sufficient for general
purposes. But of course that very fact
is awkward when measuring very small
capacities. And another drawback of
5o c / s is that phones are practically useless, as they respond almost exclusively to
the upper harmonics of the supply, and
hence to the strays and errors more than
to the real thing.
Fortunately it is possible to escape these
drawbacks very easily by using as detector
one of the familiar cathode-ray tuning
indicator tubes. Not only is there no
falling off in sensitivity at low frequencies,
but the input impedance is so high;

megohms, if necessary-that it. lends itself


favourably to measurement of the
high impedances corresponding to small
capacity and low frequency. And another
advantage is that the inconvenience .of
headphones with their enslaving leads and
varying stray capacities is avoided, and
response is visual. As we are requiring
the AC mains anyway as our " oscillator,,"
it is easy to provide the feeds for the

valve. As everybody knows, this tube


includes a stage of amplification, so is
sensitive enough without having to provide an external amplifier. The Mullard
TV4 is, again selected because although its
form of indication is not ideal for instrument purposes, it has a greater sensitivity
than any other, not being of the " variable mu " type.
Fig. 3 is a schematic diagram of a
simple bridge according to these suggestions. The item to be measured (" X ") is
balanced against a fixed standard of the
same sort (" S "), the variable ratio arms
consisting of an ordinary rotary potentiometer.
To cover a wide range of
measurement without extreme ratios, the
S arm can consist of a group of standards
selected by a switch. There is no great
difficulty about condensers and resistors,
but this type of bridge is not suitable for
general measurements of coils, though as
mentioned before it is quite good for
matching similar coils against either one
another or a standard. But at 5o c / s the
reactance of coils below about a henry is
too small compared with the resistance for
accurate comparison.
In the next (and final) article details
will be given of the construction of a
simple and inexpensive bridge of this sort,
measuring resistances over a range of io
ohms to io megohms and capacities of
25 m-mfds. to io mfds., and, with somewhat lower accuracy, over considerably
greater ranges. The power factor of large
condensers-more especially electrolytics
-is indicated ; and a separate device
shows condenser leakage. The whole is
very compact and direct -reading resistance and capacity scales are provided.

IIIMcAII-1YIII

Vision 45 Mc;s.

'

"-

new 5 -stage, 4 -channel, b -valve Battery


Superhet with exceptionally lively performance,
unusual wave band coverage and satisfying
output. 19 separately tuned circuits. Circuit
comprises R/F amplifier triode-hexode frequency changer with separate oscillator I.F.
amplifier double diode -triode detector, A.V.C.
and L.F. amplifier double pentode quiescent
output valve. Wave -ranges 12.8-33, 23-8o,
A

1(10-550, 1000-2000 metres.

-A

complete and up-to-date superhdt with R.F.


triode-hexode frequency changer, I.F.
diode detector, optional band -width
compensated A.V.C. (an exclusive
feature). Wave -range 4.5 to 2,200
metres. Easily applied to any existing amplifier
or audio unit, accurately aligned and ready for
use. Complete with all instructions and circuit

amplifier,
amplifier,
variation,
McCarthy

details, I7 ros.

' B."-Intended
as a counterpart to
Unit " A " but possesses versatile features which
enable it to be readily used as a High Fidelity
Amplifier for radio, gramophone or microphone.
Undistorted output to watts. Price complete

UNIT

SUNDAY, JUNE 12th.


8.50, News Bulletin. 9.5, Music-MakersFrances Day.
9.15, Cartoon film.
9.25,
" Miracle at Chester," a play by Reginald

with i'alueS, 111 ]OS.

...

AND FOR SHORT-WAVE FANS


A McCarthy Communications Receiver.

Beckwith and Andrew Cruickshank.

compact receiver
for operation on AC or DC. Intended mainly
for amateur transmitters, R.N.W.A.R. and
short-wave enthusiasts in general.
It comprises a radio frequency amplifier,
highly efficient screened grid detector, separate
triode oscillator for C.W. reception and small
triode output with jack for headphones, high
tension cut-off switch for use in conjunction
with a transmitter, scientific band -set and band spread tuning and designed to operate with
6 -pin
inductors from 8 metres upwards.
Supplied complete with smartly finished black
crackle cabinet with all valves and inductor.
Price 9 Guineas.
Full Technical descriptions of the foregoing and
of the full range of McCarthy products upon:
A newly designed, small and

MONDAY, JUNE 13th.


3, Forecast of Fashion. 3.15, British Movietonews. 3.25-4.20, The Northolt Derby. Three
cameras will give views of the complete race,
and Miss Jasmine Bligh will introduce personalities among the crowd.
9, Hildegarde.. 9.10, Forecast of Fashion.
9.25, Cartoon Film. 9.30, Gaumont -British
News. 9.40, " Charles and Mary," the play by
Joan Temple. 10.40, News Bulletin.

...

AND FOR QUALITY FANS


The New Dual Unit Assembly.
UNIT " A."-Comprises a newly designed
5 stage, 4 valve 6 channel " TUNING HEART."

Sound 41.5 Mc, -a.

TUESDAY, JUNE 14th.


3, Catch-as-catch-can wrestling. 3.20, Gaumont British News. 3.30, " Tele -ho," revue.
8.40, " The Cardinals' Collation " (as on Friday
at 3.3o p.m.). 9.10, British Movietonews.
9.20, Foord v. Phillips, boxing. O.B. from
Harringay Arena of the eliminating contest for
the Empire Heavyweight Championship. 10.30,
News Bulletin.
WEDNESDAY, JUNE 15th.
3-4.10, " Lady Precious Stream," the play
by S. I. Hsiung. Cast includes Esm Percy and
Josephine Middleton.
9, " r00% Broadway," an all-American show.
9.40, Gaumont -British News. 9.50, Bridge
Demonstration, organised by Hubert Phillips.
10.5, News Bulletin.

Television Programmes
THURSDAY, JUNE 9th.
IIl a.m.-12, Trooping the Colour. O.B. from
the Horse Guards Parade, Whitehall, of H.M.
The King's Birthday parade.
3, Ray Ventura and his Band. 3.25, British
Movietonews. 3.35, 153rd edition of Picture
Page.
9, Cabaret. 9.30, Gaumont-British News.
9.40, 154;th edition of Picture Page. 10.10, News
Bulletin.
FRIDAY, JUNE loth.
3, The Vic -Wells Ballet in " Faade "-music by
William Walton, choreography by Frederick
Ashton. 3.15, Gaumont -British News. 3.25,
Cartoon Film. 3.30, " The Cardinals' Collation,"
adapted from the Portuguese of Julio Dantes, by
H. A. Saintsbury.
8.15, (sound only) Relay of last Toscanini
Concert.
9.10, Sheila Barrett in Starlight.
9.20,. British Movietonews. 9.30, Artists and
their Work. 9.45, " Geological work of Ice
Film. 9.55, The Vic -Wells Ballet in " The
Gods Go A -begging." Music by Handel, arranged
by Sir Thomas Beecham. 10.20, News Bulletin.
SATURDAY, JUNE 11th.
3, In Our Garden, C. H. Middleton. 3.10, " The
Happy Family "-a Hans Andersen story,
told by Paul Leyssac. 3.20, British Movietonews. 3.30, Cabaret.
9, " Cabaret Cartoons " Cartoons by Harry
9.40, Gaumont-British News.
Rutherford.
9.50; As on Friday at 3 p.m. 10.15, News
Fiultetin.

..

FOR THOSE WITHOUT MAINS

application.

Orders for the Dual Unit are in excess of production arrangements and early application is advised.
All models supplied on our usual terms of seven days' approval
against cash.
Easy terms available on application.

Send 3d. in stamps for complete illustrated catalogue


with technical data and circuit diagrams of other
interesting McCarthy chassis of all types, for A.C.,
Battery, or A.C./D.C. Abridged list free of charge,

M` CARTy RADIO l'ru


44, Westbourne Grove, London, W.2
i.

Telephone :

Bayswater 3201/2.

-eemen.

The Wireless World,

RANDOM RADIATIONS
A New System ?
DID you, I wonder, listen to the relay of
Mr. Raymond Gram Swing's weekly
talk on Saturday, May 28th? If you did,
and if your critical faculties were at work,
you must have noticed how different it was
from the Transatlantic relays to which we
have become accustomed. What struck
me most was the perfectly silent back-

ground. There was none of that hissing


which has come to be regarded as a necessary concomitant of long-distance relays
using the radio link and none of the " sad
sea waves" noise which some of the uninitiated still believe to be produced by the
rollers of the Atlantic. As a rule, when
there is fading about, AVC makes background noises more and more prominent as
the signal wanes ; but as there were not any
background noises, this effect was completely absent. That there was a certain
amount of fading was obvious, but the
speaker's voice did not blast at the peaks
or become badly distorted at the troughs.
The whole thing was, in fact, so good and
so free from the kind of blemishes that one
associates with relays from great distances,
that I felt at the time that some new system
of reception must be in use.
A day or two later I rang up the B.B.C.
to give them my impressions of this relay,
and to ask whether I was right in thinking that some big improvement had been
introduced in the receiving equipment. I
learnt that the transmission came, not
through the B.B.C.'s Tatsfield Station, but
through the G.P.O.'s Transatlantic system.
My friend at the B.B.C. had not heard of
any special alterations in the receiving gear,
but, like me, he had been vastly impressed
by the relay. Its quality could not, I
think, have been due to anything special

THURSDAY, JUNE 9th.


Nat., 6.20, An examination of post War best sellers, talk by Philemon.
7.40, The Old Music Halls. 8.40,
Seaports-a transport talk by Sir
David Owen. 9.20, Band Boomerang between Max Schonherr and
his Band in Vienna and Peter
Yorke and his Orchestra in London.
Reg., 6.40, Under London, talk by
F. L. Stevens. 9.10, " Safe Deposit," a radio play by James
Eaton and Norman Hillas. 10.30,
Tunes of the Town-intimate
revue.
Abroad.
Strasbourg, 7.30, Wagner Concert,
conducted by de Villers.
Budapest,
8, " Othello,"
opera
(Verdi) from the Royal Hungarian
Opera.

FRIDAY, JUNE 10th.


Nat., 7.30, " Rhythm Express." 8.15
and 9.30, Last Concert of the 1938
London Music Festival, conducted
by Toscanini.
Reg., 6, Alfredo Campoli and his
Orchestra.
8.15,
" Crooners
Comer," compred by Eddie Pola.
9, Solos and Novelty Numbers by
the B.B.C. Variety Orchestra.
9.30, Variety from Plymouth.
L

manual volume control, as a rule, after


touching the button that brings in the
station you want.

Really Automatic
The trouble is that in most localities the

By

"Diallist'
in the way of conditions. Directly it was
over I tried the r9 -metre, the 25 -metre,

and the 31 -metre bands, and found that


nothing seemed to be coming through very
strongly on any of them from the other
side of the Atlantic, but that there was a
good deal of quite deep fading. I wish I
could discover the secret of suppressing
superhet. background when I am engaged in
short-wave listening. The set that I am
using at present is pretty quiet for a superhet., but hiss is certainly annoying on the
weaker far -away stations or when the
strong ones are fading.

Another Misnomer
OFTEN I've had occasion to lament over
the sadly misleading terms that we
have chosen for so many things in wireless.
When AVC was first introduced, The
Wireless World, unless my memory plays
me false, rightly made a strong bid to call
it AGC, or Automatic Gain Control.
Would that it had succeeded And here's
the reason. True automatic volume control should, of course, be a device concerned
with the audio-frequency side of the set
for keeping the output at any pre -selected
level, no matter what station within the
powers of the receiving set is tuned in.
Such an arrangement has always been
desirable ; it has become still more desirable
since the introduction of press -button
tuning, and it has made its appearance
on the other side of the Atlantic in the
newest Scott receiver. Without something
of the kind the press -button set loses half
its charm, for you've got to work the
!

News Awaited

local National and Regional are by far


the most strongly received stations. If you
live in their service area their volume
doesn't vary much by day or night ; but
that of more distant stations most certainly
does. For most people there is a particular
level of sound which gives the most pleasing
reception. A device which can be permanently set to ensure that all stations
worth hearing come in at this level would
be worth its weight in gold. The new Scott
set goes a long way further than that in its
array of automatic fitments. You can
arrange it beforehand to bring in all the
programmes that you select for the coming
twenty-four hours. In place Of a dial
there's nothing to be seen but an ordinary
electric clock. This has an outer rim
driven by a two -to -one gearing, so that it
makes one revolution in twenty-four hours.
By pushing little pegs into sockets you can
take your choice from the items provided
by twelve stations during broadcasting
hours. That doesn't mean that the set is
working all the time It comes into action
only at the right moment and switches
itself off automatically if you have
" pegged " no immediately following item.
But if you have previously selected an item
to follow immediately from another station,
a squelch valve comes into play whilst the
receiver is retuning itself ; then when all
is ready you hear what you wanted to hear.
I shall buy one of these receivers when
ASP is introduced.
ASP?
Oh, just
Automatic Self Purchase.
!

ti

Abroad.
Belgrade, 8.30, European Concert of
Yugoslav Music.
Brussels I, 8.30, Excerpts, " Tannhuser," opera (Wagner)-I.N.R.

Choir and Symphony Orchestra


conducted by Dejoncker.
SATURDAY, JUNE 11th.
Nat., 3.15 and 4.35, An account of
the day's play for the Wightman
Cup. 8, Palace of Varieties, with
the Ridgeway Parade.
9.20,
American Commentary.
9.45,
Music for Ballet and Chorus.
Reg., 6.30, Music by Mozart.

8.30,

" A Bride for the Unicorn," a


modern morality by Denis Johnston. 9.30, Reg Pursglove and his
Orchestra.
Abroad.
Warsaw, 8, Gala Concert from the
Cracow Music Festival.
Stuttgart, 8, " The School for
Laughter," variety.
Budapest, 9.30, Budapest Concert
Orchestra, conducted by Rafter.

ti ti

Americans and Television


THERE is still, I notice, a distinct ten-

dency in the States to belittle our


achievements in television: In a recent
issue of Radio News there is an interview

BroGccast Programmes
FEATURES OF
THE WEEK

June 9th, 1938

SUNDAY, JUNE 12th.


Nat., 12.30, Spelling Bee, 6 : London
y. Dublin. 1.15, Coventry Hippodrome Orchestra. 4.20, Mario de
Pietro and his Estudiantina. 9.35,
Theatre Organ.
Reg., 5, Eugene Pini and his Tango
Orchestra. 5.45, Round the Courts.
9.5, Fred Hartley and his Sextet.
Abroad.
Vienna, 7.10, " Der Rosenkavalier,"
opera (Richard Strauss).
Stuttgart, 8, " The Gipsy Baron,"

operetta (Johann Strauss).

MONDAY, JUNE 13th.


Nat., 7, " The Bungalow Club,"
variety, introduced by Anona Winn.
8.50, Gillie Potter. 9.20, World
Affairs. 9.35, Recital of Spanish
Music by Irene Kohler, pianoforte.
Reg., 7.30, " Gibraltar," the story, in
sound, of our smallest dependency.
8, The B.B.C. Symphony Orchestra, conducted by Sir Adrian
Boult. 9, " Songs of the River "
by the Northumbrian Singers.
Abroad.
Alpes -Grenoble, 8.30, Mozart Festival.

TUESDAY, JUNE 14th.


Nat., 7.40, The Poet Laureateship,
talk by Humphrey Jennings. 9.20,
My Best News Story-Front Page
Fight, by Trevor Wignall.
Reg., 7.30, Swift Serenade. 8, Arthur
Catterall and the B.B.C. Northern
Orchestra, conducted by Arnold
Perry. 9, Joe Loss and his Band.
Abroad.
Strasbourg, 8.30, Sacred Concert
from the Cathedral. Marcel Dupr,
organist of Notre Dame, at the
organ, with Cathedral Choir and
Radio Orchestra.
Brussels II, 9, Alex de Vries, pianoforte, and the Belgian National
Orchestra conducted by Jan Kumps.
WEDNESDAY, JUNE 15th.
Nat., 8, Milestones of MelodyGeraldo and his Concert Orchestra.
9.20, " Hail, Variety." 10, " La
Bohme," Act 3 from Covent
Garden.
Reg., 7.30, The World Goes By. 8,
Recital by Douglas Cameron,
'cello. 8.25 and 9.25, "La Bohme,"
Acts and 2, from Covent Garden.
1

Abroad.
Brussels I, 8, " The Tsarevitch,"

operetta (Lehr).
Lille, 8.30,
William Tell," opera
(Rossini) relayed from Rouen.

WirnIlego

JUNE 9th, 1938.


with Mr. Gilbert Seldes, Director of Television Programmes of the Columbia Broadcasting System.
" We haven't," Mr.
Seldes is reported as saying, " been premature here in America as they have been
in England. . . . They have the sets and
they still have the ' bugs.' When America
starts buying television sets for its homes
it will be able to do so with the knowledge
that the ' bugs ' which give our cousins
across the Big Pond headaches have been
ironed out as far as we are concerned." I
don't quite know how you iron out a bug,
but I take it Mr. Seldes intends to convey
that viewers in this country suffer from a
variety of defects and difficulties in their
reception of the A.P. programmes. If he
really does believe that, one wishes that he
could come over here and look -in for himself. The only serious fly in our ointment
is man-made interference, particularly from
motor cars, and I imagine that that is at
least as bad in the States as it is here.

Not So Easy,
However many bugs may be ironed out
in the course of the long-drawn-out preliminary research work that is being done
in America, they're going to have one big
difficulty in starting television which, happily, did not come our way. Those who
are developing it over there have always
made it plain that, to begin with, television
will be confined to the big 'cities, such as
New York and Chicago. Mr. Seldes estimates that, if these two are chosen, only
about 5 per cent, of the population of
America will be within the first service
area. His figure is on the low side, for by
my reckoning Chicago and New York
between them contain about 71 per cent.
of America's population. Still, even 71 per
cent, is a very small proportion. Our
single station at the Alexandra Palace
covers an area which contains at least
25 per cent. of our people, and three more
transmitters, one at Birmingham and
others in the neighbourhoods of Manchester
and Leeds, would mean that more than half
of the population of Great Britain was
within range of a television transmitter.
To achieve anything like the same result
in the United States a vastly greater number of stations, separated from one another
by enormous distances in some cases, would
be required. Our existing co -axial cables
would probably enable British stations
serving half the population to transmit
programmes originating from a single
centre in London. Tens of thousands of
miles of co -axial cable would be needed
for anything on similar lines to be done
n the United States.

Sunspots and Magnetic Storms


REFERRING to the recent note in which
I suggested that the appearance of
large numbers of spots on the sun's disc
was not necessarily accompanied or followed immediately by terrestrial magnetic
disturbances, a Portsmouth reader expresses
the view that it isn't so much the number
or size of the spots that matters as their
position. He suspects that when a large
group crosses the sun's central. meridian
magnetic disturbances on the earth usually
follow within a matter of hours. I agree
with him up to a point, though not entirely.
As the average time for a complete solar
rotation with respect to the earth is just
over twenty-seven days, any group which
is visible for seven days or more must

523

pd

surely cross the central meridian. Also,


it's interesting to refnember that the
aurora of January 25th and the very severe
magnetic storm which took placer then
both occurred long after a group of spots,
so big that it was visible to the naked eye,
had passed the central meridian. On
January 25th this group was actually very
close to the edge of the sun's disc. However, I am with this reader in feeling that
it would be a very great advantage if the
cosmic data sheets gave some idea of the
position of the sunspots which they report.

1906

[DNDENSER SPECIALISTS

193!

FOR OVER THIRTY YEARS

Business Methods
I have quoted in these notes several
instances of slackness on the part of
British manufacturers in fulfilling orders,
chiefly from abroad, I was very interested
in a recent letter in The Wireless World,
whose writer took up the cudgels in defence
of makers of radio sets and radio components. I grant him willingly that many
-perhaps most-of our firms are pretty
good. But one comes across far too many
instances of slackness and of carelessness in
dealing both with orders and with enquiries
about products. Let me give an instance of
what happened to me recently. I wanted to
use in a piece of apparatus that I am making up an appliance made by a firm of some
standing. I knew that it was by no means
a cheap item, but the price had not been
stated though it had received a certain
amount of publicity. I wrote to the makers
asking the price and the current produced
under certain conditions. After some days
I had a reply from the technical department
giving a figure for the current, but omitting
any mention of the price of the appliance.
A leaflet was sent which gave certain particulars and also mentioned that the appliance was available in two other forms. I
wrote again, asking once more for the price
and the current produced by the appliance
in its other forms. The reply, though giving me the prices, mentioned no figures for
the current from the second and third forms
of the appliance, and, without any comment or explanation, gave me a figure for
the current of the first appliance that was
entirely different from that originally stated.
I therefore had to write yet a third time
to ask for confirmation of the figures given
for the first form of the appliance and to
ask once more for those for the second and
third. The whole business resulted in about
a fortnight's waste of time. It's just that
sort of thing that makes people so irate and
so critical of business methods.
AS

Practically every product that is a leader in


its own particular field is made by a firm
who specialise. Yet, few indeed are the

not-at some time or


branched into sidelines
strayed
from their self-appointed path. One of the
most outstanding examples of intense, single purpose specialisation is T.C.C. In an industry

businesses that have

other

literally bristling with opportunities for the


manufacture of gadgets, T.C.C. have stuck
to their last. Mirabile dictu? (wnderful to
relate ?). Not at all. T.C.C. started to make
condensers in 1906. They decided to make
condensers and nothing else. They've -been
doing it ever since. No wonder setmakers
and amateurs alike rely on T.C.C.

The Wireless Industry


LARGE -SCREEN reception of { he Derby
television broadcast was successfully demonstrated to large audiences by the Baird
system at the Tatler Theatre, London, and by
the Scophony mechanical method at a Kensington store.

<1>

<>

Anglo-American Radio (& Motors), Ltd., are


the appointed distributing agents in England,
Wales and Ireland, for the Meissner Manufacturing Company, whose products include the
Meissner Communications Receiver.

.C.

ALL -BRITISH

The Sturdy Electrical Company, of r, Wesley


Terrace, Newcastle-on -Tyne, announces reductions in the prices of transformer rewinding.
The price of rain. Phono-Disc recording
blanks is 20S. per dozen, and not as given in
our issue of May r9th.

CONDENSERS
THE TELEGRAPH CONDENSER CO.LTD.
WALES FARM RD, NORTH ACTON.W.3
d')63

The Wireless World, June 9th, 1938

ELIMINATING STATIC

speaker. The periods of interruption are so rapid, however, that


the reception of the desired signals
appears to be continuous.
L. .Gabrilovitch.
Convention
date (France), -April 28th, 1936.
No. 482074.

consists of highly damped impulses


of relatively short duration. Such
impulses can accordingly be cut
out from the desired signals by interrupting the operation of the receiver at intervals which are so
rapid that they do not affect the
apparent continuity of speech or
music.
The arrangement is shown in the
Figure, the upper part of which
consists of a semi-aperiodic HF
amplifier A, followed by the usual

SHORT-WAVE AERIALS
shown the aerial consists of
a pair of parallel wires A, Ar,
Fig. (a) bent into almost a complete circle, the free ends r, 2, 3,
4 forming the four corners of an
imaginary square. The length of
each wire is between 0.4 and o.5
of a wavelength, and the wires are
spaced apart by approximately
one -hundredth of a wavelength.
The feed -line may be connected
across the two opposite open ends
marked I and 4, or across the two

ecent Inventions
Erie) descriptions of (he more .'nferesting radio
devices and improvements issued as patents
will be included in this section,
ELECTRON MULTIPLIERS
amplifier, operating by
secondary emission, is made
with a series of " target " electrodes, alternately plane and
cylindrical in shape, and carrying
progressively increasing voltages.
As shown in the Figure, primary
electrons from the cathode C are
accelerated by a grid G towards
the first cylindrical anode A. Here
they produce secondary electrons,
the stream so augmented being
attracted on to a disc anode Al
from which it passes to a second
cylindrical anodeA2.
The process is repeated at the
next stage, as shown by the zigzag " arrowed " lines, the final
output being collected at O and
passing through an external load
resistance R.
The advantage is
that the cross-section of the path
available to the electrons becomes
larger as the multiplication increases, thus keeping the concenAN

the control grid of the multiplier,


so that if the output increases the
grid -is made more negative, to cut
down the supply of primary electrons. Similarly, if the output
current falls off, the control grid
automatically becomes more positive, and the primary emission is
increased.
The General Electric Co., Ltd.,
L. I. Farren and E. P. George.
Applicatin date November 3oth,
1936.

THE invention is based on the


fact that static interference

f1 NE of the defects of secondary-

-7 emission amplifiers lies in the


difficulty of stabilising the " gain "
(or the ratio of secondary to
primary electrons) produced at
each of the target electrodes.
According to the invention, the
output current from the tube is
used to apply negative reaction to

The British abstracts published


bere are prepared with the
permission of the Controller of
H.M. Stationery Office, from
specifications obtainable at the
Patent Office, 25, Southampton
Buildings, London, W.C.2, price
1/- each.

AS

BROADCASTING SYSTEMS
TN common -wave broadcasting
1 the programme is usually distributed from a central station by
line -wire to a number of outlying
stations, which radiate it simultaneously on a common carrier wave. To prevent interference in
places which may " overlap " the
service -area of two or more of the
relaying stations, it is essential to
:

Arrangement of elements in electron multiplier described in the text.


sirable limits.
Inc.
Farnsworth
Television
Convention date (U.,$..A.), June
ist, 1936. No. 482026.

No. 481996.

Circuit

tration of the stream within de-

the radiated carrier-wave


constant, and this can be done by
sending periodical impulses from
the central station, over the line wire connection, to synchronise
the local carrier -wave generators.
Another alternative is to modulate -the carrier-wave, once and for
all, at the central station, and to
transmit it in this form over the
line-wire to the outlying stations,
where it is simply amplified up
and radiated. The snag here is
the severe attenuation of the carrier-wave currents along the wire
link. This is overcome, according to the invention, by first stepping -down the modulated carrier wave at the central station before
feeding it into the wire, and then
stepping it up by a frequency converter at each of the outlying
stations before it is radiated.
Standard Telephones and Cables,
Ltd. (Assignees of H. A. Affel).
Convention date (U.S.A.) July
roth, 1936. No. 481841.

for

suppressing electric interference of the


short period kind.

stages of a standard superhet receiver, and a loud speaker S.


The lower branch of the circuit
consists of a high -frequency stage
Ar which is made aperiodic so that
the static impulses which, together
with the signals, are fed to it from
the aerial keep their original highly
damped form. After rectification
at D, the currents are passed
through a high-pass filter F, which
cuts -off all frequencies below, say,
6,000 cycles. The rectified static
impulses, being higher than this,
pass through the filter F to a low frequency amplifier V, though the

"pulse " or

wires midway along their length.


Or the two points of connection of
the line to the aerial may subtend
an angle of approximately 42 deg.
at the centre of the circle, as
shown in the Figure (b).
The arrangement, which is particularly suitable for transmitting
wavelengths of between 5 and 20
metres, gives a highly concentrated
field in the plane containing the
two wires and in the direction
pointing away from the open ends.
This is said to be due to the fact
that the electrostatic field created
across the open ends opposes the

keep

Compact beam aerial particularly suitable for the ultra-high frequencies.

rectified signal frequencies are


blocked. The resulting pulses of
static are then applied through a
rectifier R to " paralyse the grid
of the amplifier A, for short
periods during which neither signal
nor static can reach the loud

magnetic field which would otherwise be radiated in that direction


from the centre of the system.
Alarcon s Wireless Telegraph
Co., Ltd. (assignees of J. L. Rein arta). Convention date (U.S.A.),
October 8th, 1936. No. 482114.

THE PRACTICAL RADIO

rcrr-404,*i-l

JOURNAL

28 th Year of Publication

------No. 981.

THURSDAY, JUNE 16TH, 1938.

Proprietors

ILIFFE & SONS LTD.


Editor

HUGH S. POCOCK.

Editorial,
Advertising and Publishing Offices :
DORSET HOUSE, STAMFORD STREET,
LONDON-, S.E.r.Telephone Waterloo 3333 (5o lines).
Telegrams " Ethaworld, Sedist, London."
:

COVENTRY

Telegrams

8-10, Corporation Street.


Telephone
52o Coventry.

"Autocar, Coventry."
BIRMINGHAM

Guildhall Buildings, Navigation Street, 2.


Telegrams:
Telephone
"Autopress, Birmingham."
2971 Midland (4 lines).
:

MANCHESTER

260, Deansgate, 3.

Telegrams
"Rifle, Manchester."
:

Telephone

Blackfrias 4412

(4

lines).

CLAscow : 26R, Renfield Street, C.2.


Telegrams " 11,5e, Glasgow." Telephone Central 4857.
:

PUBLISHED WEEKLY.

ENTERED AS SECOND
CLASS MATTER AT NEW YORE, N.Y.

Subscription Rates
Home, r is. 8d. ; Canada, r is. 8d. ; other
countries, r 3s. rod. per annum.
:

As many of the circuits and apparatus described in these


are covered be patents, readers are advised,- before
making use of them, to .satisfy themsd+vs that they would
nst be in/tinging patents.

pars

CONTENTS
Page

Editorial Comment

525

..

526

Capacity and Resistance Bridge

530

Automatic Tuning Systems


The Home

Laboratory-VIII,

More About Fine -metre DF


Unbiased

..

533
53-/

News of the Week

535

Superhet Alignment

537

How a Receiver is DesignedXV, High Quality Communication Receiver ..

Random Radiations
Broadcast Programmes
Recent Inventions

EDITORIAL
Broadcast Distribution
"Group Allocation " Possibilities
THE organisation of broadcasting in Europe has developed
so rapidly in the past few
years, with a succession of
" plans " for wavelength allocation
amongst the various countries, that it
seems perhaps absurd even to consider that proposals for wavelength
allocation made as far .back as 1928
could offer any useful lessons to -day.
Yet we have on this page on more
than one occasion harked back to
proposals for wavelength distribution
in Europe put forward by Mr. Siffer
Lemoine, of the Swedish Telegraph
Administration, in a contribution to
The Wireless Engineer in July, 1928.
There is much of Mr. Lemoine's
scheme which to-day would probably
be regarded as inapplicable to modern
conditions, but one aspect of his
proposals, described by him as " group
allocation " of frequencies, seems to us
to be particularly worthy of consideration to -day if there is any possibility
that it could be put into force.
Briefly the idea was that instead of
frequencies being allotted in Europe
so that the stations of different
countries jostled one another, bands of
frequencies should be allotted to the
same countries s far as possible, so
that each country could please itself
as to how it utilised these allotted
wavebands and could crowd into them
a number of stations of narrow band
width or fewer stations giving better
quality, or again, could have one or
more stations of high quality and
others with restricted frequency bands.
If mutual interference took place it
would be a matter for one authority to
contend with and would not involve
representations to Governments of
other .countries.
-

VOL.

XLII.

No. 24.

COMMENT
Naturally, the " service value '- of
different wavelengths would have to
be taken into consideration it would
not be fair, for instance, to allocate
wide bands of the best frequencies to
one country and less useful bands to
others, but it should surely be possible
to apportion the wavebands fairly.
Countries of small area might well be
content with wavelengths unsuitable
for covering great distances, whilst
large territories should be given a
proportionately larger share of the
longer wavelengths suited to their
peculiar requirements.
;

High -quality Stations


In these days when frequency control
has reached so high a standard that
there is far less inter -station interference. perhaps the most attractive
feature of these proposals in the light
of present-day requirements would be
the ability for stations of very high
quality to be established in each
country by sacrificing quality in the
case of other stations of the same
nationality. At present if it were
desired, for instance, to increase the
frequency band of one of our own
stations for the purpose of improving
quality, we should at once find that
we were encroaching upon the frequencies allotted to other countries
whose stations were located on either
side of our own.
Whether or not the present organisation has been so firmly established
that it must remain unalterable is not
a matter on which we feel we can
express an opinion, but we believe,
that if it were possible to start afresh
with wavelength allocation in Europe
the idea of " group allocation " would
merit the closest consideration, in
spite of the fact that the idea was
launched so long ago.

The Wireless World, June 16th, 1938

526

THE author

shows how

Automatic Tuning

the various systems of


automatic Vining now in
use in America can be divided into
three ,main categories ; the essential
the various
differences between
methods .are described.

A SURVEY OF AMERICAN METHODS

means of a cable. These arrangements


proved to be both expensive and unreDURING a recent visit to the liable, and they soon sank into oblivion.
United States the writer had an In 1933. a German firm started the idea
excellent opportunity of study- of telephone dial tuning. The dial operated
ing recent trends in automatic one of the usual automatic telephone retuning devices. The purpose of the fol- lays, which, in turn, connected various
lowing article is to give a short survey of combinations of fixed capacities to the
the situation encountered at the time, tuning coils. The dial was numbered in
without going - very far into technical the usual way,. and there was a table on
the set giving the "call numbers " for the
details.
Readers of The Wireless World will be various stations which corresponded to
aware of the fact that automatic tuning different combinations of fixed condensers.
devices are by no means a novel inven- Most readers will probably remember
tion, nor did they, it is believed, originate the early automatically tuned British set
that was marketed
several years a g o
by t h e Aerodyne
GANG TUNING
UNIVERSAL
INSULATED INSETS
Company. This set
CONDENSER
COUPLING
had many of the
r1
2
features which are
to -day considered
necessary and expedient.
STATIO
MOTOR SUPPLY W NDI NG
I believe that this
SELECTOR
TRANSFORMER
ON POWER
DISCS
set did a lot towards starting the,
present fashion of
automatic 'tuning.
A somewhat elaborated set, brought
out in 1935 by a
,

Viennese firm.

Fig. 1. --Diagram of motor tuning system with separate contact discs


for each button and reversing switch on motor winding, the latter being
thrown over automatically at each end -position of the tuning condenser.
The two symmetrical windings determine the direction of rotation.

immediate sales
success was n o t
considerable, chiefly owing to the comparatively high price. There is no
doubt, however, that it set the minds
of radio engineers working furiously.
At this point 'I
m a y remind my
readers that o n e
great difficulty had
so f a r prevented
general acceptance
of automatic tuning devices. I am
speaking of t h e
lack of mechanical

in the United States. I remember having


seen the first push-button tuning set as far
back as 1924 at the first Berlin Wireless
Exhibition. It was designed by the wellknown in,ventr, de Kramolin, and based,
if I remember correctly, on the purely
mechanical principle of connecting buttons

and condenser by levers with a variable

leverage.
In those days, however, none of the conditions had been fulfilled that make automatic tuning a really practicable proposition. Most of the tuning had to be done
by way of correction by hand, and the
buttons had only a more or less symbolic
significance. Various attempts at remote
tuning were made in the United States
and elsewhere, but apparently without
success. Most systems were not truly
automatic ; the general plan was to segregate parts of the tuning mechanism, e.g.,
high -frequency or oscillator circuits complete with tuning condenser, from the rest
of the set and connect it to the latter by

(Eltz), can be said.


to be in every way.
characteristic
of
t h e best modern
motorised automatic tuning. Its

The control panel of


a receiver operated
bymechanical means.
The depression of
levers tunes in selected stations. This
Belmont receiver can
also be manipulated
by the usual manual
control.

and electrical stability in circuits and the


great influence of very minute changes on
the precision of tuning. Pre-set tuning
devices can only retain their original setting if condensers, coils, and wiring retain
their capacities and inductances with the
utmost accuracy. The fat that they do
not do so without special measures being
taken has prevented radio engineers from
seriously contemplating the introduction
of automatic tuning before the advent of
some form of automatic correction. This
is where the important American contribution comes in. American engineers
developed efficient and comparatively
simple circuits for automatic frequency
control, and it was very soon recognised
that the realisation of AFC was the first
stepping `stone to a really perfect form of
automatic tuning device. With. -AFC
absolute accuracy of the mechanical parts
of the tuning system was no longer required, because the automatic correction
would correct any possible errors due to
mechanical imperfection.
.

Cost of AFC

It was only after the advent of the first


automatically tuned radios with AFC that
people in America began to delve into
the possibilities of automatic tuning
systems without AFC, -the idea being -to
go one better than the other man and
bring out sets with the same sales appeal_
at very much lower prices. There is, of
course, no denying the fact that AFC is
both expensive and tricky ; it is probably
responsible for at least half the costs of
the entire automatic tuning device. The
question as to whether AFC can be dispensed with or not has yet to be answered,
but I believe that some American firms
are satisfied if their sets tune correctly
when they are first installed, and they
.

The Wireless World, June 16th, 1933

Systems
leave it to the dealer and his customers to
readjust irfegularities which may occur in
course of time. There is, of course,
always the regular tuning knob to fall
back upon in case one or other of the
pre -tuned stations should go out of tune.
There are quite a number of systems of
automatic tuning in actual commercial use
in the United States. They can all be
summarised, however, under the following headings
Mechanical Systems.
Motorised Systems.
Capacity Substitution Systems.
Any of these three systems can be actuated by different devices, such as levers,
telephone dials, or push buttons. All
:

527

By

WOLF E. FELIX

drawback:

the
public does not take
to it as much as to
t h e push - button
sets. A technical
deficiency that can
be mentioned in
its disfavour is the

Capacity

substitution is the system


employed for the
automatic tuning of this De Walde model,
which also caters for normal control.
An Admiral receiver in which motorised
tuning is available
for six
different
stations.

fact that it cannot


be used to tun e
stations on neighchannels
bouring
automatically, the
distance
between
two adjacent dial holes being determined by the size.
of the human finger
and the possible
diameter of the
dial, and not by
the width of the
broadcast channel.
these methods have been put into practice, but there is no longer a shadow of
doubt that the push-button has carried
the field. Its appeal to the public as a
simple and straightforward arrangement is
not to be beaten.
Let us acid a few words to explain the
three systems.
The Mechanical System consists of
coupling the normal variable condenser
with a set of levers or more generally with
a sort of telephone dial. The dial is so
arranged that if you insert your finger
into one of the dial holes you depress a
pin which eventually strikes a stop when
yeu twist the dial. Unlike a telephone
dial, this radio dial does not return to its
original position after you have let go, for
this would mean a severing of the connection between the condenser and dial.
There are various devices for assuring the
greatest possible accuracy and for combining with the dial motion the other desirable functions, such as automatic muting devices and the switching on and off
of the AFC, if any.
This type of set, which has been manufactured in larger numbers than any other
daring the last season, has only one serious

This difficulty

could, of course, be overcome by using


several rows of holes in a staggered position. But this would only accentuate the
drawback of the entire system, which consists in the circular arrangement with its

inherent lack of legibility, as compared


with the linear arrangement in use with
the push-button system.
Another theoretical disadvantage of
telephone dial tuning is the impossibility
of making the drive mechanism serve as
a remote control, a feature which is an
additional attraction with motor tuning.
This point has not been of very great importance so far, however, as remote control presents other difficulties which have
not yet been completely overcome. The
most important of these is the absence of
a practical solution of remote' volume and
tone control.
Motor Tuning_ in its simplest form consists in the addition of a reversible motor
to the ordinary tuning condenser and the
provision of a two-way switch. In the
centre or vertical position this switch cuts
off the current from the motor winding,
while it starts the motor revolving clockwise or anti -clockwise when the switch
lever is pressed to the right -or to the left.
As long as the motor is revolving, the
pointer will travel over the dial in one or
the other .direction, and the switch has to
be turned to the centre position as soon
as the pointer reaches the desired station
mark. It goes without saying that the
.

INDUCTION

INDEXING PIN USED


IN SETTING DISC
FOR DESIRED STATION

STATION

MOTOR
SELECTOR SWITCH

MOTOR
REVERSAL
SWITCH

TO MAINS
TRANSFORMER

Fig. 2.-Schematic drawing of motor tuning system as represented in Fig. r, showing pushbuttons, motor with clutch and contact -springs and the group of contact -discs with the motor reversing switch. These contact -discs are held on their shaft by friction and are easily adjustable
by locking them with a special pin and turning the condenser by hand to the desired station.

WTid,2g

JUNE 16th, 1938.

WopIlc'1
Automatic Tuning Systems-

springs can be displaced along the slots


and arranged in a staggered disposition so
as to touch the periphery of the disc at
any desired points-if necessary closely
adjacent. Each of the two metal half -discs
is connected with one of the shading windings, causing the motor to turn clockwise
or anti -clockwise according to which of
the two discs is contacted. When the
button is pressed the current flows by way
of the corresponding contact on the rail
to the metal half-disc with which this contact is in touch and on to the motor, making it turn in the direction of the station
whose button is depressed. The ,position
of the contact on the rail is so arranged
that the contact spring touches the gap
between the two metal half -discs
when the condenser
is at the correct
tuning position for
the station. in question. The contact
spring comes to
rest on the insulating material,
and the contact is
broken, thus disMOTOR SUPPLY WINDING
ON POWER TRANSFORMER
engaging the clutch
and stopping the
motor. In case the
clutch action is not
swift enough, the
disc will continue to
turn until the conPUSH BUTTON STATION
tact spring reaches
SELECTOR SWITCH
"SERIES CON NECTE'
the other metal
half-disc. In this
case the motor is
energised in t h e
opposite direction
Fig. 3. Tuning system of the " direct homing " type, but with one
and turns backcontact -disc for every button. The smaller half -disc is connected to
the shaft and thence to earth. The larger half -disc is permanently
ward, without,
connected to the motor winding by means of the lower sliding contact.
however,
gaining
Both half -discs are insulated. In position z the smaller, in position
momensufficient
3 and 4 the larger, half -disc is in circuit, causing corresponding direction
tum to over -jump
of rotation. Position 2 shows interruption of current and a station
ready tuned.
the gap a second
time.
A very
motors on the American market the entire simple contrivance facilitates the correct
armature performs a movement in axial adjustment of the contact springs on their
direction as soon as the winding is ener- brackets for the purpose of tuning the
gised. This movement can be utilised various push-button circuits. A special
not only to actuate the clutch, but also to small lamp is provided which can be conmake or break auxiliary contacts for the nected to the disc circuit. The pushpurpose of muting during the tuning button for the desired station is deoperation, and closing the AFC circuit as pressed and the set tuned by hand with
soon as the motor tuning action is com- the ordinary tuning knob. The contact
pleted. A fuse is provided for the protec- spring is now displaced in its slot until
tion of the motor winding.
the lamp is extinguished. This is the case
Different systems on the general prinwhen the spring touches the gap between
ciple indicated have been put into prac- -the two metal half -discs. The tuning of
tice. The simplest and cheapest method
stations for the push-button circuits is
appears to be the design introduced by thus rendered extremely simple.
firms such as Detrola and Midwest and
The arrangement described was by no
recently brought out in England by Ekco. means the first solution on the American
A reversible motor of the shaded pole type market. As a matter of fact, it was one
is used, and there is a disc of insulating of the last to appear. The most successmaterial on the end of the condenser shaft. ful models, especially the RCA 150 -dollar
The insulating disc carries two metal half- set, is far more complicated and expensive
discs, separated by a narrow insulating to manufacture, as it uses a separate congap, their rims being of the same diameter tact -disc for every push-button. I believe,
as the rim of the insulating material. A however, that it has been universally
semi -circular rail surrounds the disc and recognised that the arrangement described
contains one or more slots in which the is so far the most practical solution. Not
These all sets employ motors which will turn in
contact springs are fastened.

method is only possible in combination


with AFC, as accurate tuning is almost
motorised
tuning
impossible. Most
systems work in connection with pushbuttons, which is hardly more complicated, and appeals to the public to a far
higher degree. The push -buttons are connected to contacts which close circuits, including the motor winding. The motor is
therefore started automatically as boon as
one of the buttons is depressed, and goes
on running until the contact is broken.
The breaking of the contact disengages a
clutch on the motor, thus ensuring immediate stoppage, irrespective of the
inertia of the motor armature. In a very
practical design of one of the small tuning

(boas-`.

the direction required to reach the desired


station directly. Some of the motors
move in one direction only, with the result
that the pointer, wherever it stands,
always has to move in the same direction.
If the station happens to be placed on the
other side of the pointer, the latter has to
move to the end of the dial, where it
actuates a switch reversing the direction
of rotation of the motor. It then travels
backwards across the dial to the point required. This takes quite a time and is
certainly less effective than the other
method.
;

Remote Control Possibilities


It is obvious that with motor -tuned
systems there is no difficulty in separating the push-button mechanism from the
set itself and using it as a remote control
unit connected to the set by a cable carrying DC of comparatively low tension. The
push -buttons are generally so arranged
that the depressed button is locked and
released again upon pressing another
button. Other methods are, however,
also used ; for instance, buttons which
have to be depressed during the entire
tuning operation. A separate button is
usually provided to change over.to manual
tuning.
As the appeal of push-button motorised
tuning is universally recognised, efforts
are at present being directed towards its
simplification. Once the American component industry has made up its mind
about what to manufacture, there is no
doubt that all the accessories necessary,
such as push-button strips, complete contact units; and tuning motors will be produced at prices even lower than heretofore. Tuning motors are at present available at prices ranging between 65 cents
and a dollar, which shows that motorisation in itself is not an expensive proposition. The main question seems to be the
inclusion of AFC. It is perhaps interest-

Fig. 4. -Variable condenser with contact disc for " direct homing " system. The
point of the heart -shaped mark indicates
the gap between the metal half -discs, which
are on the rear of the insulating disc.

ing to note that motorised push-button sets


without AFC are already available at
prices below 3o dollars for a six -valve
table model.

JUNE 16th, 1938.

WITGeh2,0

y29.

WOOpIlca1

Automatic Tuning Systems-

Capacity Substitution Systems constitute a simple solution of the problem to


provide push-button tuning without encountering any of the mechanical problems inherent in the two other systems
mentioned. As a general rule, trimmer type condensers are substituted for the
variable condenser of
the set. They may be
connected to the existing tuning coils, or
separate tuning coils
may be provided so
that entire circuits are
substituted. The latter,
however, is not the

coils and condensers, are being specially


protected from the effects of moisture by
immersion in wax compounds (chiefly
ceresin) of high melting point. Special
attention will have to be given to the
arrangement of the wiring, which should
not alter its position. Exhaustive tests
will be necessary with regard to changes

button tuning and in the instantaneous


action of the tuning process as opposed
to the comparatively slow action of motor
tuning. The latter difference is, however,
not sufficient to impress the public. Capacity substitution systems are chiefly used
on the cheaper kind of sets. Their great
drawback consists in the amount of servicing they may require in case of changes
in the wavelength of broadcasting stations
and the cost of adapting every individual
set to the wishes of the buyer in the first
instance. Some firms have found it expedient to tune their push-button circuits
at the factory according to the average requirements to be expected in certain parts
of the country. The tribulations of the
dealer may be appreciably lessened by this
method of proceeding.

Preventing Frequency Drift


A question that has been raised by the
advent of automatic tuning is the stability
of circuits in general. I believe that considerable work is being done in this respect
in American laboratories. The first point
to be considered is the effect of temperature. The positive temperature coefficient
of inductances is being counteracted by
capacitors having a negative temperature
coefficient. All electrical parts, stich as

46 -mm. sound filin projector, defor educational and similar uses, is


announced by the British Thomson -Houston
Company. One of the features of the appara
tus is a new spool arm, .which accommodates
filins of lengths varying between 400 and
1,600ft. The amplifier, which is provided with
an adjustable tone control, has been specially
designed to suit the average sound -track
characteristics of sub -standard film.

ANEW
signed

Blackpool is to be the scene of this year's


Exkle Convention, which is to be held from
June 22nd to 24th; headquarters will be at the
Hotel Metropole, where over too guests will
assemble.

e c
-

'Prix amplifying equipment wits installed at


Buckingham Palace on the occasion of the
Derby Day Ball.

Eight stations, all controlled by push-button,


are available on this
all -automatic Howard
table model receiver.
For this and other photographs of receiver control panels we are indebted to R. A. Rothermel, Ltd.

rule. It goes without saying that one condenser per station has to be provided and
adjusted for every tuned circuit-that is to
say, for the oscillator and at least one RF
circuit. This is the reason why substitution systems are rarely used for more than
six or eight automatically tuned stations.
Six stations require adjustment of twelve
or eighteen condensers, according to
whether one or two RF circuits are used.
As the capacity of the usual adjustable
trimming condenser is but small, additional fixed condensers have to be used
in order to cover the whole range of capacities required. The advantages of the
substitution system consist in the possibility of adapting existing sets 'to push-

The Wireless Industry

of electrical properties due to ageing of


components. If a satisfactory solution to
all these problems can be found, it will
perhaps be possible to dispense with AFC
and thus arrive at truly popular prices.
So far American manufacturers have
mostly sacrificed a certain amount of selectivity. The band -width of the IF circuits
is made large enough to permit a station
being heard even if the oscillator is slightly
off tune. It is doubtful whether this
method would be feasible in Europe,
where considerable selectivity is required
even from the cheaper kind of set. In
adapting American methods to European
conditions It should be kept in mind that

long-distance reception in the United


States generally means short-wave reception, and the push-button feature is not
used for this purpose. There is also a
tendency in the United States to extend the
effective band -width of AFC further than
would appear advisable under European
conditions. I have been told of sets where
this width is 9 kilocycles, which makes
it almost inevitable that the tuning jumps
to a powerful neighbouring station instead
of the desired station if the manual or
push-button tuner is not well adjusted. In
the better type of American set the effective area of the AFC has been fixed at
about 4.5 kilocycles. Even so, the tuning may swing over to the neighbouring
station if there is a deep fading of the
tuned station and unless the band -width is
narrowed down. Automatic selectivity
control would appear to be the only effective remedy.
Mention may, also be made of the fact
that push-button tuning has been introduced -into American auto-radio, about
14 per cent. of this year's models showing
this new feature, which offers the obvious
advantage of allowing the driver to concentrate on his main task.
In conclusion, grateful acknowledgment
is due to Electronics for permission to reproduce the drawings which illustrate this
article.

e.
It is regretted that, in the advertisement of

Ambassador Radio Works on p.5 of our issue


for June .9th, the trade name of the valves included in the Ambassador all -wave chassis
-was incorrectly printed; actually, Mazda valves
are supplied.

The Acoustic Labyrinth


CEVERAL readers have written to point
c 7 out an apparent discrepancy
in the
drawing illustrating the article on " The
Acoustic Labyrinth." The difficulty is one
of simple arithmetic, namely, that it
appears to be impossible to get three equally
spaced shelves and the loin. loud speaker
mentioned by the author into a cabinet with
the overall dimensions shown.
Actually, the shelves are not equally
spaced, and the form of construction recommended is shown in the accompanying
sketch. It may be argued that the change
ORNAMENTAL

GRILLE

SUB -BAFFLE

"

Distribution of " shelves " in the acoustic


labyrinth described in the June 2nd issue.

of cross-section is undesirable, and at higher


frequencies this would be true, but at the
low frequencies considered reflections are
less serious, and it is for this reason that the
sharp bends essential to a labyrinth can be

tolerated.

Trie Wireless World,

June 16th, 19$3

The Home Laboratory


Part VIII. --A USEFUL
the previous article the general principles of DC and AC bridges were
reviewed, and it was shown that most
of the difficulties in designing a convenient form of measuring instrument were
avoided by using the 5o-cycle AC mains
as the " oscillator," and a " magic eye "
as a visual detector. Bridges of this sort,
offered mainly for service work, are sold
by a number of manufacturers, or can be
quite easily made for oneself according to
the following information.
The capabilities of the design to be
described, which has been carried out
specially for this series of articles, are
shown in the accompanying list, from
which it will be seen that it is an exceptionally useful piece of gear. It is not
intended for extreme accuracy over a
narrow range of measurement- (though in
fact it can be made to do better than
within one per cent.), but rather for
moderate accuracy over the greater part
of the whole wide range of components
that have to be dealt with in radio. Such
an instrument is indispensable for service
work ; and in the experimental laboratory
encourages the sound practice of checking
all components used. The more strictly.
laboratory types of bridge being generally
more difficult to use quickly, there is the
temptation not to bother about checking.
The basic principle is shown by Fig. I,
repeated from the last article. The component to be tested, connected at X, is
compared with any one of a number of
standards, S, selected by a range switch.
To avoid the need for continuously
variable standards, the ratio arms are
N

Fig. 1.-Basic principle of the bridge described in this article.

made variable, and are composed of an


ordinary potentiometer, which is calibrated to read ratios directly. It is supplied with a 5o-cycle voltage, and balance
is shown by the cathode-ray tuning indicator. The reading of the potentiometer
at balance, multiplied by the value of the
standard in circuit, gives the value of X
directly ; and as in this present example
the standards are all multiples of Io this

AND

CAPACITY

RESISTANCE

By M. G. SCROGGI.E,

B.Sc., A.:M.I.E.E.

WHAT THIS BRIDGE DOES


Measures resistance from about 10
ohms to IO megohms.
Measures capacity from about 10
micro.microfarads to 10 microfarads,

including electrolytics.

Gives rough checks over ranges a


hundredfold greater than above.
Measures power factor, up to 60 per
cent., of " bad " condensers from 0.1
microfarad upwards.
Compares components, including large
inductances, with any standard of
similar sort.
Detects leakages from about 100
megohms downward.
Provides a continuously variable
50.cycle signal up to 50 volts.
Is compact, portable, self.contained
(except for mains connection), and
direct.reading.
No earth connection needed.
Visual adjustment by " magic eye."
Is not expensive-cost of components,
including " magic eye," from four
guineas.

process demands no
appreciable amount
of mental arithmetic. For instance,
if the potentiometer
reading when balance is obtained is
0.65 and the range
switch is set to loo
ohms, the required
result is of course
65 ohms.
Turning now to
the full circuit diagram, Fig. 2, some
of the other features can be seen.
The special mains
transformer s u p plies 4 volts for the
heater of the TV4
indicator, 150 volts
through a small
metal rectifier and
simple
smoothing
circuits for the
anode of the TV4,
and 5o volts to the
bridge itself. The
The complete resis-

tance -capacity

bridge ; note the


crocodile clips in
place of the more
usual terminals.

CIRCUIT
DIAGRAM

CALIBRATE

RATIO
ARMS

BRIDGE

bridge voltage should be graduated to suit


the impedance -being measured, and this
is done automatically by the i,000 -ohm 3 watt resistor in series with the transformer
winding. For high impedances, such as
grid leaks and small condensers, which
would be difficult to balance sharply without a high signal voltage, practically the
full 5o volts is available ; but for low impedances which at 5o volts would pass too
much current for themselves and for the
transformer, the voltage falls to a suitable
value. The resistor has been chosen so
that even if the test terminals are shorted
no harm will follow. And electrolytic
condensers rated at low voltages will not
be damaged. The i000 -ohm potentiometer
should be a reliable one with a smooth
and uniform resistance element, for it is
the component with which measurements
are actually carried out. The input resistance of the TV4 indicator is kept high,
otherwise it would not be possible to get
results with such high impedances as io
m-mfds., which at 5o cycles is no less than
30o megohms.
The accuracy of measurement is, of
course, no better than that of the standards used. And here there is room for
wide differences according to individual

TV4. CATHODE RAY


POWER FACTOR
BALANCE NEON LEAKAGE BALANCE
INDICATOR INDICATOR

WHEeg2g

JUNE 16th, 1938.

'531

WopIlA

sharp balance ; if not, it is a bad one.


But in the largest sizes most of those now
used are of the electrolytic variety, and
at low. frequencies a relatively large power
factor is not necessarily a ground for
rejection. At the same time it should not
.

be too large. Some electrolytic condensers show a power factor of less than
5 per cent. and are quite acceptable ;
others show 3o per cent. or more and are
not to be recommended. The adjustment
to exact balance when the power factoror, more appropriately, loss factor-is
appreciable is done by the 2,500 -ohm
rheostat, which can be of the same type
as the i,000 -ohm potentiometer.
Calibration of this control will be described
later.
In use, the component to be measured
is connected to the " C and R " terminals,
and the range switch set to what is believed to be the nearest value. In all
probability the screen of the TV4 is nearly
covered with illumination.
But if the
potentiometer is turned, a point should
be reached at which the light shrinks into
a clearly defined cross.
If by careful
adjustment the edges of this pattern can-

How the components are mounted under the,panel.

requirements and opportunities. If one is


tied for cost, and has no chance of getting
standards checked, condensers and resistors of the ordinary receiver type can be
bought within 5 per cent. limits at little, if
any, increase in price. That is good
enough for rough checking. At somewhat
higher prices, resistors are sold by Bulgin
correct within 0.5 per cent., which is quite
good enough for most purposes, and approaches the maximum closeness of adjustment of the potentiometer. Or, if
another bridge is available, resistors can
be wound with Eureka wire to the right
values, taking care that approximately
half the turns are wound in opposite rotation to minimise inductance. Enthusiasm
probably falls short of wire -winding the
one-megohm resistance ; a selected grid leak type of resistor is more practicable.

Capacity Problems
Standard condensers are more difficult.
Apart from the question of measuring
their capacities, the sorts commonly used
are liable to vary with temperature, age,
etc. The smallest should preferably be
one of the new ceramic or plated mica
types ; the middle size a good quality
mica and the largest-well, mica is prohibitive, so a good quality paper specimen
is suggested. If facilities for accurate
capacity measurements can be begged,
borrowed or hired, an attempt should be
made to bring up the condensers to their
exact ratings by shunting small ones
across them. So if those selected are not
dead right (an unlikely stroke of luck) it
is convenient for them to be slightly low.
If one is prepared to spend a pound or
two on accuracy some firms such as H. W.
Sullivan can supply accurate condensers.
;

It is very desirable
for the standards to
be as nearly as possible exactly multiples of zo, for convenience in reading,
but, of course, it is
not inconsistent with
high accuracy for
them to be some w h a t different so
long as the exact
values are known.
For instance, if a
condenser is 1.04
mfds., within 0.5
per cent., it can be
assumed to be z.o
mfd. for direct reading within an accuracy of, say, 5 per
cent., while on occasions when greater
accuracy is wanted
the actual value can
be worked out. The
point is that the cost
of a condenser whose
capacity is guaranteed to a given
accuracy is much
greater if it is re Fig. 2.-Complete cir-

WESTINGHOUSE
+uJ20

rvvvv.

13000 0

mid

NEON

Q
2mLtls_ 150V
2 mAQ

LAMP

o
Q

+1

I0 01

Id

4MO

LEAKAGE

4V

0.3

50 V

C AND R

'O

,000

quired to an exact round number rather


than to a nominal value.
No provision is made for balancing the
resistance of the smaller condensers. It
is generally enough to observe whether
the sample under test gives a reasonably

2%

L1

1.30D

W0n

MATCH

cuit diagram and calibration of the ratio


arms scale.

re,

AC
MAINS

not be made dead sharp, the power factor


of the component must be different from
that of the standard. On the largest
capacity range this can be cleared up by
alternate adjustment of the power factor
knob.

532

Wpemo

JUNE r6h, 1938.

InoPIld

LaboratoryThe leakage test is an optional extra,


If balance falls outside the readings o. i requiring only a neon lamp. The most
to ro on the ratio scale a better result will suitable type is that supplied by Philips
be obtained on another range. If balance for indicator purposes. The lowest availis obtained only at one extreme limit of able voltage lamp should be chosen, but it
the potentiometer adjustment, the com- may be noted that a 23o -volt lamp (which
ponent must be open -circuited or short- 'is the only one that appears to be actually
circuited, or at any rate substantially so stocked at the time of writing) lights up
on the 175 volts available. Though it
in relation to the range in use. A ro-mfd.
condenser would appear as a dead short can be used for detecting DC leakage anyif tested on the ioo-m-mfd. range.
Power Factor Calibration Table.
When measuring condensers on the room-mfd. range, the same sharpness of
Power factor Resistance
balance must not be expected as on the
per cent.
ohms.
higher capacity ranges. It is not that
balance is blurred ; assuming that the
5
160
power factor of the sample is not excep10
320
but
;
good
15
485
tionally bad, balance is quite
20
650
a larger movement of the ratio control is
25
820
required in order to show an appreciable
30
1000
best
The
pattern.
indicator
the
change in
1190
35
40
1400
way is to swing the knob to and fro
45
1610
between positions each side of balance
50
1830
until the exact balance point can be
55
2080
illusbridge
judged. With the particular
60'
2370
trated here, it is possible to observe a
capacity as low as 5 m-mfds., and the where, its main use is for condensers.
readings around roo m-mfds. are surpris- When any condenser is connected the
ingly accurate.
lamp flashes momentarily, due to charg-,
A useful feature is a seventh position on
ing, and in a dim light this should be perthe range switch, whereby an external ceptible with capacities down
to about
the
to
be
connected
can
standard
mfd.
0.005
If
the
condenser
is
a good
" MATCH " terminals. For example, it one it may be necessary to wait quite
a
of
number
a
to
adjust
might be necessary
long
time
for
the
next
flash.
But
a
poor
components to the same value, or to check condenser flashes like a police road
their departures from a standard. This beacon, while a downright bad one shows
is available for inductances of not less
Push-pull trans- a continuous light. This judgment must
than about i henry.
not be applied too literally to electrolytic
formers can be tested for balance of wind- condensers
(which, incidentally, must
occur.
will
readily
uses
other
ings. And
always
be
connected the right way
But how about calibrating the poten- round) because
they always leak to some
it
is
an
enormous
so
doing
In
tiometer?
extent,
but
whether
that extent is reasonhelp if one can use a laboratory resistable
can
be
gauged
by
watching the lamp.
known
one
accurate
least
at
ance box and
A
light
that
remains
bright
continuously
resistance. These are connected to " C
the
has
after
condenser
been
connected
ratios
their
and
MATCH,"
and R " and "
for
minute
leaka
or
two
shows
excessive
set to various values. If the fixed resistage.
Frequency
of
flashing
depends
not
is
roo
"
to
"
MATCH
ance connected
ohms, the other is set to roo, giving the on megohms, but on megohm-microratio " i " to mark on the scale. In- farads, a quantity that is a truer measure
creasing to rio_ ohms gives i.r, and so of the condenser's quality. A r -micro on. There should be two scales, because farad condenser with a leakage of so
the capacity or " C " scale increases in megohms is proportionately similar to a
the opposite rotation to the " R " scale. 0.25 microfarad condenser with a leakage
The " r " marks coincide, of course, and of 200 megohms.
The variable 5o -cycle signal, mentioned
each setting on one scale is the reciprocal
in the list of advantages, can, of course,
of the corresponding point on the other.
be derived from the " LEAKAGE "
The result is shown in Fig. 2.
terminal and one of either of the other
pairs. And, of course, a 50-volt signal
Calibrating With Eureka Wire
with a centre tap (or any other ratio) is
If no resistance box is available a quan- available by using three terminals.
tity of Eureka wire can be used for caliWith regard to construction there is
brating in ratios on the assumption that scope for individuality.
The photoits resistance is proportional to length. graphs give some idea of how it can be
But, of course, it becomes rather tedious done. It was wanted to get it into a
cutting lengths of wire if a large number handy ex -Navy wavemeter box, hence
of scale points are to be found.
the crowded appearance. It would be
To calibrate the power factor adjust- much easier to make if done on a less
ment the i-mfd. condenser is temporarily compact scale. The disposition of the
shorted and the 2,50o -ohm rheostat components is of some importance ; the
balanced against a fixed or variable leads connecting the parts of the bridge
standard in the " C and R " arm. A proper should be short, and the r -MSZ
table is given showing the relationship and roo-m-mfd. standards particularly
between power factor and resistance in should be joined close to the switch and
series with r mfd. at 5o c / s.
have minimum capacity to other parts.
The Home

The Ferranti switch is recommended because the capacity is low, the contacts
good, and the spindle is not live ; but the
type of knob supplied is finnicky and the
contacts are difficult to solder reliably
The 50-volt leads from the transformer
need not be particularly short. But all
AC leads must be kept as far as possible
from the grid of the TV4, the connections
to which should be well insulated. The
cathode of the TV4 is connected to heater,
- HT, transformer screen, and metal lining of box, if any. The last precaution
does not seem to be essential, nor does
an earth connection, but if there is difficulty in getting balance with very
high impedances, one can be tried.
" LEAKAGE- " is available for the purpose.
Crocodile clips are quicker to use and
generally more convenient than screw terminals, but, of course, one can please
oneself about this. Matt ivorine sheet is
very convenient for covering the panel
as it looks good and takes pencil calibration, which can afterwards be made permanent with Indian ink. But remember
it is very inflammable
To enable the TV4 and the neon lamp
to be used in bright light they are shown
with tubular shields projecting some way
above the panel. But it is necessary to
make quite sure that the neon tube is not
kept so much in the dark that it cannot
start to glow on the voltage supplied to
it. The flash voltage is sometimes raised
considerably by darkness.
If the box has a lid, a detailed circuit
diagram should be gummed inside it-a
sound practice with all lab. gear.
!

For 'reference a list of suitable components


follows, but, as already said, there are
alternatives so far as at least the standards are
concerned. With approximate (within 5 per
cent.) standards, the retail cost of components,
including indicators, is about 4 5s.; including
the more accurate standards listed here, the
cost is nearly 3os. more.
The required
accuracy must be specified when ordering.
LIST OF PARTS
Transformer (special)
N. Partridge
I Rectifier
Westinghouse J20
Ratio Arms
Claude Lyons " Clarostat " MI
Power=factor control
Claude Lyons " Clarostat " M21
I Range switch
Ferranti N. 5
Fixed condensers:
i o.or mfd. (special 2 '/, )
Dubilier B.770
i o.or mfd.
Dubilier 4601/S
r mfd. (selected)
Dubilier " BB "
2 2 mfds.
Dubilier " BB "
i loo mmfds. (special
Dubilier " CTS "
Resistances:
loo ohms (0.5%)
Bulgin R20
io,000 ohms (0.5%)
Bulgin R26
i i megohm (selected 5%)
Claude Lyons
12 megohm } watt
Claude Lyons
4 megohm -I watt
Claude Lyons
i ro,000 ohms i watt
Claude Lyons
s r,000 ohms 3 watts
Claude Lyons
6 Crocodile clips
Bulgin CR6
Panel surfacing -yin. matt ivorine
Reliance (Nameplates), Ltd., Twickenham
2 small knobs
Bulgin 1(58 or K92
large knob
Bulgin IC70
Cursor
Bulgin 1(72
Cathode ray indicator
Mullard TV4
Cathode ray indicator holder
Bulgin VH24
Neon indicator, 17 x 52 mm.
Philips SES
Neon indicator holder
Bulgin D18
I

,k

The Wireless World,

June 16th, 1938

533

IN

More About

last week's issue the author


described the adaptation of an existing
receiver for direction - finding experiments with the help of a loop aerial.
He now explains how the directional
properties of a dipole -reflector combination may be used for the same
purpose.

Five -Metre D
COMPARING THE MERITS OF A LOOP WITH A
DIPOLE -REFLECTOR AERIAL
By

11.

B.

T was explained last week how a


super-regenerative receiver can be
adapted for direction -finding on five
metres by separating the detector
stage from the remainder of the set and
hoisting it to the top of a pole. The
signals are picked up by a loop connected
in place of the original tuning coils.
Now a loop is not the only kind of aerial
suitable for direction -finding ; its use was
suggested as it happens to be less cumbersome than some of the alternative types,
and so fitted in very well with the requirements of a portable set.
Let us now examine this idea more
carefully and compare it with the most
attractive of the alternative aerial systems.
A loop receives equally well from two
directions, signals being strongest when
the plane of the loop AB in Fig. i is in
line with the path taken by the incoming
signals, and, in theory though not always
in practice, they are reduced to inaudibility when the loop is turned through go
degrees, as indicated by the line CD.

DEV'l' (G2MC)
original position ; thus the loop only gives
us the line along which the waves are
travelling. It does not give any indication of the true direction of the transmitter, for it can be anywhere along this
line, ahead or behind the receiving position.
On the normal amateur wavelengths this
is not a serious disadvantage, for signals

REFLECTOR

---,
`.

8---------NI\

AERIAL

,
%

I
t
%

--,

/
(a)

Minimum Signal
The practical realisation of the inaudible
condition is- usually only a position giving
a minimum strength of signals. This
position, however, is reasonably well
defined, but the position for maximum
signals is always very broad. Thus in
DF work one uses the minimum setting for
taking a bearing.
If now a loop is positioned for minimum
signal strength and slowly rotated, signals
will rise to a maximum and then fall to
a minimum again at 18o degrees from the

(b)

Fig. 2.-The directional properties of a dipole reflector combination.

are receivable at good strength anywhere


within the area of operations. Five metre signals, however, are not quite so
accommodating, and many positions, often
reasonably close to the transmitter, fail to
provide a signal. Thus some time might
elapse before a second bearing can be obtained giving a definite indication as to
the direction in which the transmitter
lies.

Uni -Directional Aerial

Fig. 1.-Reception by means of a loop (or


frame) aerial is at maximum in the plane
AB and at minimum in the plane CD.

The vagaries of ultra -short waves must


be borne in mind on every five -metre field
day. One or two failures to receive signals must not be taken as an indication
that the transmitter has broken down or
that the receiver is defective.
Conditions being what they are, it would

be much more satisfactory if one could


devise an aerial system that did not possess
the ambiguity of a loop, but gave a definite indication of direction on the first
reception test.
An aerial that will do this does exist,
but it is rather cumbersome.
It is an
ordinary half -wave dipole backed by a
reflector. Its size can be gauged by the
fact that for 57 Mc/s both aerial and reflector- are approximately eight feet long
and they have to be spaced by just over
four feet.
This form of aerial has one
position only for maximum signal strength
and likewise a single position for minimum
signals, these two being at z8o degrees to
each other. Whilst a loop aerial need be
capable of only i8o degrees rotation the
dipole-cum -reflector must be rotatable
through a full 360 degrees.
The polar diagram of a dipole. backed
by a reflector takes the form shown in
Fig. 2 Maximum signal strength is obtained when the incoming waves are travelling from A to B, Fig. 2 (a) and (b),
and minimum signals from the direction
B to A. This arrangement will not give
a silent point, but by careful adjustment
of the length of the reflector the ratio of
fons"ard to backward reception can be
made quite high.
An attractive feature of this aerial
system is that almost any existing fivemetre receiver can be used. No alteration
is required to the set, but direct pick-up
on the feeder must be avoided or the directional property of the aerial will be
affected. A low-impedance- feeder joined
into the centre of the aerial is generally
preferable to any end -fed arrangement as
a better electrically balanced system is
obtained in this way.

Club News
Cardiff and District Short-wave Club
Headquarters: (lobe Hotel, Castle Street, Cardiff.
Hon. Sec.: Mr. H. H. Phillips, 132, Clare Road, Cardiff.

On May 26th Mr. R. T. Mathews gave a


lecture entitled " B.C.L. Interference Cures."
Meetings of the Society are being held fortThe following
nightly during the summer.
programme has been arranged

:-

23rd.-R.S.G.B. Meeting, at which transmitters


will be discussed.
July 7th.-" Propagation," by Mr. H. H. Phillips.
July 21st.-R.S.G.13. Meeting, at which transmitters
will he discussed.
August 4th.-To be announced later.

June

Golders Green and Hendon Radio


Scientific Society
Headquarters: 60, 1',tti.s w Road, Loudon, N.w.2.
Hon. Sec.: I.t.-Col. H. Ashley Scarlett, 60, Pattison
Road, London, N.\V.2.

A 5 -metre field day will be held on June 19th


to which anybody interested is invited. Members will meet at ix a.m. at the cricket ground
on the east side of the King's Langley -Wat..

ford road.

The Wireless tiVorltl, June i611t, 1938

Amateur Telemnitters
HAVE often wondered why it is that
amateur transmitters who provide us
with such an interesting alternative pro'gramnte on Sunday mornings and at other
times have never tried their hands at
"television transmissions. After all, they,
"or at' least their progenitors, among Whom
I include myself, have always been in the
,Vanguard of any movement connected
:with -wireless transmission, from the
early spark days onwards.
Telephony
was heard on the 'air long before the
K.B.C. began. to pollute the ether, and it
:seems a pity that there are no amateur
television transmissions to tune in. It is
not a case of lack of official permission,
'for an enquiry has resulted. in my being
informed that this will be granted if the
applicant can show reasonable grounds.
I have been wondering of late whether
it is a case of degeneration among the
transmitting fraternity or whether, in
reality, we old pioneers of more than a
quarter of a century ago would have
shown similar apathy had we had the
glorious opportunities of the modern
amateurs. As the result of my musings I
became so hot under the collar concerning
this apparent evidence of modern degeneracy that I determined to seek the
views of a friend who used to do DX with
me in the good old Edwardian days.
To my astonishment he told me that I
was being very unjust indeed in censuring
amateurs for an imagined lack of initiative in this matter, and that if I cared to
listen, or, rather, to look round about the
5 -metre mark at certain times, I should
be able to pick up some amateur telemissiens. He, furthermore, told me that
some of the curious noises which I had

Getting
something on
the screen

mentioned as having been picked up by


me on 5 metres and which I have Unjustly
branded as amateur telephon\' were the
sound of the vision signals.
As a proof of his assertions he led me
forthwith to his wireless den, and after a
certain amount of juggling with the controls of a special 5 -metre television
receiver we certainly did succeed in getting something on the screen which was
rather reminiscent of the cinema pictures
we used to see round about the time of
Queen Victoria's Diamond Jubilee. '
Even now I am in some doubt as to
whether what we saw were amateur tele'

AS E D
_

FRE=gGRID

vision transmissions or merely the effects


of local interference. If, therefore, there
are any amateur telemitters on the air I
should be extremely glad to know of it.

Bottled Programmes

Advertising
the cup
that cheers.

ISUPPOSE that a .considerable number


of you listened to the running commentary on the Derby the other day while
as many of you as were able saw the
whole thing televised.
Unfortunately, I
was able to do neither.
My laboratory
work has become so pressing of late that I
really haven't the time to spare for the
frivolities of life.
Nevertheless, I must
confess that as 3 p.m. approached I was
sorely tempted to switch on my television
set, but my better nature prevailed, and I
continued with my research work.
Happening to drop round to see an old
friend that evening we fell to discussing
the Derby, and I found that he, too, had
missed the television as he had been out
on business at 3 p.m. that afternoon. He
somewhat surprised me, however, by saying that it did not matter much as we
would both have a look at it now. I was
somewhat puzzled by his words but still
more so when he crossed over to his tele:
vision set and switched on. To my amazement the well-known scenes at Epsom
leapt into view on the screen and the
whole panorama of the race was unfolded
before our eyes with the customary
running commentary accompanying it.
Quite naturally I immediately demanded to know how it was done, but I
found that like most great and outstanding things it was very simple. Both sound
and, vision programmes had been recorded
during the afternoon on `steel tape using
a home-made instrument of the Blattner phone type. I was perfectly. well aware,
of course, that television can be recorded
after a fashion on gramophone discs or
other form of recorder used for bottling
ordinary sound programmes, but I had
never actually seen it done before.
The most interesting part of my
friend's apparatus, however, Was that it
was entirely automatic in its action, and
he uses it to record any; items among
either the ordinary broadcasting or the
television programmes which may occur
during the daytime when he is away from
home and which he may particularly.
desire to see. The apparatus is switched
on and off at appropriate times by one of
the well-known programme locks which
he sets before leaving the -house.-

The Maple and the Oak


in this old country justly pride
ourselves on our ancient traditions
and point to the long cavalcade of achieve-ments in the world of science which lie to
our credit. There is, however, always a
grave risk that if this sort of thing is
WE

carried too far it will lead to a sense of


false complacency inclining us to rest on
the laurels of our ancestors rather than
to be up and doing in order to wrest still
further secrets from nature.
I cannot help thinking that it is something of this sort that has led us in recent
years to fall so much behind younger
countries in the matter of wireless development. When all is said and done, practically all the pioneering work of wireless
was done in this country, and in the
matter of television it is well known that
we lead the world, leaving even the
U.S.A. limping painfully along behind.
It is not good . enough, however, for,
judging by what I have just been reading,
Canadian engineers are far ahead of us in
modern wireless technique. It was, as a
matter of fact, a reader who brought this
serious state of affairs to my notice by
sending me along a newspaper cutting
in which are reported certain words
of wisdom uttered by the general manager
of the Canadian Radio Broadcasting Corporation.
As is well known, a certain amount of
advertising is permitted in the programmes of the Canadian stations, and
among the things advertised is beer. However, in certain of the. Provinces of
Canada, advertising of the cup that cheers
is forbidden by law and it would be a
shocking thing if these advertisements
were allowed to drift over the border from
some Province where this sort of thing is
allowed, but does this possibility daunt
the great and wise radio engineers of the
Dominion? Not a bit of it, for, according to the Press cutting sent to me, we
have it on the word of the general manager
himself that such advertisements will not
be allowed to stray over the border but
are to be restricted to the Provinces where
they are still legal.
Unfortunately, the general .manager
preserves a strictly hush-hush policy as to
the methods to be employed by -the engineers to keep the offending transmissions
out. I am, however, 'told by a technical
friend that in all probability special reflector aerials are to be 'erected around the
edges of the forbidden territory, such
aerials -being designed ,to resonate to the
wavelength- of the offending transmissions
and to turn them back. It is obvious,
however, that whatever method is employed, wireless technique on the other
side of the Atlantic is far in advance of
anything achieved over here, otherwise
the B.B.C. engineers would long ago have
tackled the Radio Luxembourg problem.
.

The Wireless World, Tune IGlh, 1933

OF THE

WEEK

TELEVISION FOR CINEMAS

TELEVISED

NEWS

Will the Law Step In


THE

535

successful

television

broadcast of the Derby has


made it obvious that this new
medium of entertainment and
news reporting will shortly be a
vital influence on our everyday
lives. The problem of equipping
cinemas with facilities for television reproduction is under
keen consideration, and it is
stated that the Baird equipment
used at the Tatler Gaumont British News Theatre in London
for the projection of the Derby
transmission is to become part
of the permanent installation of
the house. Plans to bring Baird
public tele-viewing sets into a
number of cinemas throughout
the country are in hand, and the
cost of the receivers will probably be no more than that of
talkie equipment.
The activities of Scophony in
the field of big-screen television
have attracted the interest both
of the trade and of the public
since the inauguration of the
B.B.C. television service of
1936, and the installation of this
system throughout the entire
Odeon Cinema Circuit is fore
shadowed in a statement made
by the company's managing
director. Their first cinema installation is under construction
in the new Monseigneur News
Theatre, now being built at
Baker Street, London.
The screen will measure 6ft. x
--

5ft., and a similar receiver to


that which will be installed was
seen at work by a Wireless*
World representative last Thursday during the transmission of
the Trooping of the Colour
Ceremony. At a distance of
3oft. from the screen the picture
lacked nothing in brilliance and
definition, and it is anticipated
that the designers will have
overcome the present minor
shortcomings within the next
six months.
.-

Will Parliament Intervene ?


Curious as it seems the
most important side of public
tele -viewing development remains to be settled, not in the
laboratory but in Westminster.
Mr. De La Bere, M.P., has given
notice of a motion to be placed
before the House of Commons
condemning the use of television
in places of public entertain-

ment. His objection is based


on the monopoly vested in the
B.B.C. and the additional expenses incurred.

' Since," he said, " this was


not contemplated at the time
the charter of the B.B.C. was
renewed this House urges on the
Government the necessity of a
charter revision for the B.B.C.
to enable them to deal with this
development."
No date for the motion has yet
been fixed.
.

DRAMA
recently
made its debut in

America with the


presentation of a 25 minute performance
from the RCA Building, New York. The

transmission was

radiated from the


Empire State Building, about a mile
away from the studio,
on the 7m. waveband.

LIFEBOAT WIRELESS
Its Purpose and Limitations

the

of the annual
INreport course
of the Royal National

Lifeboat Institution,. its chairman stated that nine more


cabin lifeboats on the coast are
to be fitted with wireless during
1938, and an additional fourteen
boats, which are in course of
construction, will be similarly
equipped.
Of fifty-three cabin boats in
the Institution's fleet, twentyseven are fitted with wireless transmitting and receiving
equipment. " The purpose of
these installations," said the
Chairman, " is solely to keep
lifeboats in touch with the
shore when they are out of
sight of visual signals ; it is not
their duty to pick up messages

PHYSICAL DRILL BROADCASTS


Jerks Night and Morning

NEGOTIATIONS for physical

drill broadcasts are now


proceeding, but it seems probable. that the B.B.C.'s part
would be confined to the granting of broadcast facilities, while
the National Fitness Council
would protide the gramophone
records.
Physical jerks by wireless
have always been associated
with the early morning, but a
large proportion of the population probably prefers physical
,drill just before retiring for the
night. It is possible, therefore,
that broadcasting will have to
compromise by offering physical
instruction in the morning between 7 and 8 and at night between so and 10.3o.
It is safe to assume that when
the programmes start they will
be on an experimental basis for
a period, and that no regular
sz'rvice will be introduced until

from vessels in distress. That


duty belongs to the shore
stations, which then pass the
messages to the lifeboat stations
through the Coastguard. It is
through the shore stations that

lifeboat stations communicate


with their vessels at sea."
Two Limitations
For obvious reasons, then, it
is only practicable to use wireless in lifeboats which operate
within range of shore stations.
A second limitation to the use
of wireless is that the gear must
be protected from the sea, sa

the autumn.

B.B.C. TELEVISION AT
220 MILES

that at present its installation

to cabin lifeboats.
The Institution is endeavouring to overcome this disadvantage, and hopes to find satisfactory water -tight apparatus
suitable for use in open boats.
A Case in Point
Early in the year it was
mentioned in these columns
that considerable difficulties
were being experienced in finding sintable wireless equipment
for the l33lymouth lifeboat
owing to screening by the hills
along that part of the coastline. It has been found that
with Gambrell Type 131 radio
telephone equipment the ranges
required were efficiently covered,
and this equipment has been
permanently installed.
is confined

STUDIO 4c, one of the two new Foreign Languages studios in Broadcasting House, embodies the latest developments for talks. The clocks
in the studio show both GMT and BST and of the two control boxe3
mounted on the desk, seen above, one provides for fading in the output
of the microphones and two gramophones and the other enables the
announcer to make his announcement and then obtain either the
National, Regional or Empire programmes, or Big Ben.

Long-distance Reception Record


.

TELEVISION
programmes
from Alexandra Palace have
been received at Ormesby Bank,
Middlesbrough, which is more
than 220 miles from the transmitter. The pictures were received on a standard set installed in a hut 7ooft. above sea
level.
The receiver was fed
from an aerial 8oft. high, and
almost uninterrupted reception
of good quality was enjoyed for
over an hour.
The effect of
weather and other atmospheric
conditions on the signals is to be
studied during a prolonged
period of test.
The previous long-distance
record for sustained reception of
B.B.C. television was fro miles,

.np3Il,S00
%pIlA

536
News of the

Week-

although reports of freak reception have been received from


such widely divergent places as
South Africa and America.
FLOOD HERO

Signal Honour for Amateur


THE William S. Paley Award,

given each year by the


president of the C.B.S. to the
amateur who has contributed
most usefully to the welfare of
the American people, was formally bestowed upon R. T. Anderson, of Harrisburg, Illinois, at a
'luncheon iri New York last
Thursday.
A report from the American
Radio Relay League states that
Anderson achieved this honour
for his work in saving the people
of Shawneetown during the 1937
With all
Ohio River flood.
other forms of communication
broken down he worked his
portable transmitter, W9MWC,
for sixty hours with hardly a
break, and he alone was responsible for summoning aid to the
marooned people of the town.

to his present post in 1929. He


has been closely associated with
broadcasts of national importance, and outstanding amongst
these are the first broadcast by
King George V, which was made
from the Wembley Exhibition
of 1924, the Jubilee broadcasts
of. 1935, and the Coronation
broadcasts of 1937.
-

RADIO ENGINEER HONOURED

MR.

H. BISHOP, Assistant
Chief Engineer of the
B.B.C., receives the C.R.E. in
this year's Birthday Honours
List. Joining the staff of the
B.B.C. in 1923, he was appointed

RE -TIMING THE NEWS

short notice to cope with


microphone interviews on the
beach. Lines will be taken to
the end of piers, and it is whispered that listeners will learn
some of the secrets of fishing
from the pierhead. A mobile
control room will accompany
each expedition.
We understand that Yarmouth will be visited on July
12th, Aberdeen on July 19th,
and Bournemouth a week later.

Scho'arships at Manchester
University
A LIMITED number of Scholarships and Exhibitions leading to
the degree of Bachelor of Technical Science (B.Sc.Tech.) are
offered by the Manchester Education Committee.
The Scholarships are tenable at any of the
three-year full-time day courses at
the Municipal College of Technology.
Intending candidates
should make immediate application to the Registrar, College of
Technology, Manchester, r.

FROM ALL

Loud Speakers for Police Cars


THE familiar sight of a police
officer wearing earphones in his
patrol car will soon be a thing of
the past. Motor vehicles at work
in the Metropolitan area are to he
equipped with small loud speakers
which
will render
earphones

BULLETINS

SMALL but important changes


in the timing of B.B.C.
news bulletins come into force in
Jily. While the First News will
be at 6 p.m., as usual, the
Second News will be delayed
half an hour and will be given
on Regional wavelengths at 9.30.
From July roth, for ope week
only, the Third News will be
broadcast at 9.40 instead of 9.
SEASIDE BROADCASTS BEGIN

will almost smell

LISTENERS
the ozone when, on July

5th, the first of the B.B.C.'s


series of seaside broadcasts
comes from Brighton. During
the tour of coastal towns, John
Watt and Harry Pepper will
escort the microphone not only
to concert parties but to many
dance halls, and the arrangements will provide strenuous
work for the O.B.' department,
who may be called upon at

JUNE 16th, 1935.

Q UARTERS
Lectures by Telev:sion
'Two hundred students of the
New York University recently
gathered before fifteen television
receivers on the sixty-second floor
of the R.C.A. Building, Radio
City; to watch a demonstration
given by their professor in the
television studio fifty-nine floors
below 'them. This marks the first
occasion upon which television has
been used as a. medium of instruction in America

" Tatsfield "


technique, already in
vogue in America, India and elsewhere, is to be copied in South
Africa. We understand that the
South African Broadcasting Corporation is seeking sites for an
elaborate receiving station from
which important programmes
from abroad could be relayed to
listeners throughout the union.
A South African

TATSFIELD

unnecessary.

Muted Strings
seaside orchestras will
have an opportunity to broadcast
during the summer owing to the
holiday absence of the B.B.C.
Symphony Orchestra, and listeners will hear concerts from such
places as Margate, Torquay and
Eastbourne. The B.B.C. Orchestra takes its vacation in two sections. Section C will be away
from June 19 to July 16, and Section B from July 3 to July 3o.
Section A, of course, comprises the
whole orchestra.
FAMOUS

Qevedon Difficulties Overcome


THE difficult situation which
arose when it was found that the
site chosen for the new B.B.C.
station at Clevedon was adjoining
a site chosen for an aerodrome, has
been settled in favour of the
B.B.C.
Broadcasting Houses
annual report of the
Building Research Board states:
" It is quite evident that the
conventional gin. party wall in
semi-detached buildings does not
provide sufficient sound insulation." This statement was made
as a result of many complaints
by householders regarding the
nuisance
of
next-door loud
speakers.
THE

Time Marches On
THE B.13.C. has

announced that

it has been found necessary to


postpone from July ist to July
8th the opening move in the
Chess Tournament between listeners and members of the Corporation's staff. It would seem
that the first move is giving rise
to unexpected mental exertion on
the part of the B.B.C. staff. It is
not generally known that a broadcast chess contest took place in
1924, from the end of June until
August, when the moves were
announced each evening during
the News Bulletin.
Oh Yeah ?

"To Englishmen, the B.B.C. is


something they hold almost in
reverence. It is something far
THE NEW LINES termination bay in the London Control Room, Broadcasting House, is the main control
centre of the permanent network of lines which is rented by the B.B.C. from the Post Office. From left to
right are seen the tone source and transmission measuring set, O.B. and mir_ellaneous lines termination, DC test
panel and variable equaliser panel.

more than the N.B.C. is to


America; far more than the A.B.C.
is to Australia. It is an institution as essentially British as

huntin', shootin' and


Radio Call, Adelaide.

lishin'."-

The TVireless World,

June

161h, 1933

5I7

Superhet Alignment
THE COMPLETE
PROCESS,

"TRIMMER"

By

STAGE

BY STAGE
HE number of superhet receivers
now in common use, coupled
with their dependence upon the
correctness of their trimming and
tracking adjustments, makes the subject
of superhet alignment one of the greatest
importance to anybody interested in practical radio.
In order that this article may be of some
value to all readers, it is proposed to deal
with the subject from a practical point of
view in some detail and from all the different aspects that must be taken into account
owing to the variety of circumstances that
can arise. Some receivers will need complete, others only partial, alignment.
Again, some readers will have ganging
test gear at their disposal, while others will
not be so fortunate.
Before we get down to details there are
some general observations to be made. If
a superhet has to be completely aligned
the process falls into several distinct

jobs:-

IF alignment.
Oscillator trimming.
Oscillator tracking (although not necessary in all cases).
Signal frequency circuit trimming.
IF filter and image rejector adjustments (in some cases).

Ultimate Objectives
It is as well that the ultimate aim of all

the work should be kept very much in


mind. To say that the aim is to align the
receiver is true enough, but not very enlightening. Actually the purpose of all
one's efforts is to get the receiver into such
a condition that(1) The sensitivity is up to standard on
all wavebands.
(2) The station tuning is accurate with
the scale calibration.
(3) The selectivity is normal.
(4) There are either no image signals,
or second -channel whistles, or,
alternatively, such as may show up
are not abnormal for tl3e particular
receiver concerned.
(5) There are no signs of bad " humping " when tuning, and no instability.
Unless the alignment is accurately done
it may be taken for granted that the receiver will be below par as regards at least
some of the above.
If a testing oscillator is going to be used,
then the common incorporation of delayed
'AVC in superhets raises one very impor -

If the output from the speaker

tant point.

is going to be the criterion upon which the

correctness of the adjustments are judged,


it is obvious that the basic action of AVC
is directly antagonistic to requirements
during alignment. When aligning on
speaker output we want the slightest
changes of RF amplitude to produce proportional changes in output, so we must

A FULLY dE ,Ailed description


!`1 of all the operations involved in
" trimming " the circuits of a superheterodyne receiver. Although largely
written for those in possession of a
certain amount of test gear, a later
instalment will discuss the question
of 'alignment without the help of
any apparatus

consider how to prevent AVC from, possibly, masking the indications. One obvious way would be to modify the circuit
arrangements temporarily, so that the
AVC bias is cut off the controlled valves.
But if a modulated test oscillator with a
variable output is being used, there is a
much simpler way. All that is necessary
is to cut down the test signal amplitude
so much that the
receiver's normal
AVC delay voltage
keeps the AVC out
of 'action. There
is a trap in this
that
connection
must be guarded
against, however.
A test signal that
SIGNAL

strong

is not
enough

off"

to

the

" trip
AVC

tude-just sufficient to give clear peak


indications.
We will deal in detail, first, with the
case where complete alignment is necessary and also assume that an accurately
calibrated modulated test oscillator, and
an output meter, are available. Even
those readers who have no ganging test
gear should derive some benefit by reading the following, even if it is only an
appreciation of just where they will need
to be exceptionally careful in the absence
of test gear. We will later go into the
question of aligning without test gear.
Half the battle with complete aligning
is to do the various jobs in the right order.
The first job must be that of getting the
IF stages right. This means more than
mere aligning of circuits ; it means proper
aligning at the correct intermediate frequency.
Fig. i is a diagrammatic sketch indicating the three definite sections into which
the high -frequency part of a superhet receiver falls when considered from the
alignment point of view. The signal frequency section must obviously be tuned
with reference to the carrier frequency
(Fi) of the signal. The intermediate frequency (F3) has a (fixed) value that is
chosen by the designer and is in many
respects an independent value. Certain
features of the receiver design, however,

7fl
INTERMEDIATE
FREQUENCY

F3

'FREQUENCY

F1

FREQUENCY
CHANGER

OSCILLATOR
FREQUENCY

F2

while the receiver


is badly out of

1.-The three
frequencies involved
in alignment adjustment. F2 -Fr =F3.
Fig.

alignment may be more than strong


enough to do so when the receiver is closer
into alignment. There is thus the danger
that, although the AVC may be out of
action to commence with, it may come
into play as the alignment work proceeds
and the signal amplitude builds up. The
cure is obvious : keep cutting down the
test signal amplitude whenever the improvement of circuit conditions permits.
The golden rule is to work at all times
with the smallest possible test signal ampli -

depend upon the choice of IF value. The


oscillator section must be tuned to such
a frequency (F2) as to bring about the
relation F2 FI =F3, or F2 =FI +F3.
The oscillator must also be tracked to,
maintain this relation over the waveband.
It must be understood that F3 is the frequency for which the IF circuits are
designed and to which they are actually
tuned.
The importance of aligning the IF amplifier at the correct frequency cannot be

Mpll@zo
WorAd

538
Superhet Alignment-

over-emphasised. We will not go so far


as to say that it is a hair-splitting matter
and that a kilocycle or so up or down will
matter, but the point is that the oscillator
and signal circuit inductance ratios, and,
in particular, the oscillator tracking
system, are definitely arranged with reference to a certain intermediate frequency
value. It is-, therefore, essential to get
as close to this value as possible.
In a case where only partial re -alignment is required, it is usually easy to find
out by test what the IF value is, but we
are at the moment concerned with the case
where complete alignment is required, and
the original setting of any trimmer cannot
therefore, be trusted as being correct.
In the great majority of cases the IF
will either be a value coming between the
normal broadcasting bands, or one below
the long band. Typical examples of the
first set of values are 45o, 455, 456, 464,
465, and473 kc/s, and of the second 11o,
117.5, 123, 128, and 134 kc/s. It is easy
enough, by test, to find out the group to
which any particular IF transformer belongs, but with our receiver that is awaiting complete alignment it is going to be
possibly an awkward question as to what
the exactly correct IF value is.
As a
matter of fact, it is really worth while to
make an inquiry upon the point from the
manufacturers of the coils or receiver
before the work is commenced. If this
is not convenient there is only one thing
that can be done, and that is to choose
some reasonable value and align on this
in the hope that it is near enough correct,
but with the knowledge that it may become necessary at a later stage in the work
to condemn the original choice and to have
to start all over again.
Now for practical details. First of all,
the receiver should be temporarily modified so that the receiver oscillator keeps
out of action. This can be done simply
by connecting a i- or 2-mfd. condenser
across the oscillator tuning section of the
ganged condenser. Next connect the output meter across the speaker primary. If
an AC voltmetr is used and it is found
that the DC component in the speaker
causes a deflection, it will be advisable to
join a condenser in series with one of the
-meter leads. The two output leads of the
modulated test oscillator should be connected,. one to chassis and the other to
the frequency changer grid, via a o.1mfd. condenser. With the standard heptodes, octodes, and triode-hexodes the
correct grid connection will be at the top
cap.

Determining the Intermediate


Frequency
Next switch on the receiver and the test
oscillator and tune the latter to the correct
intermediate frequency, if known. If the
latter is not known it will -be necessary,
as already stated, to make, some tentative
decision on this point. One useful suggestion is to set the IF trimmers to halfway between maximum and minimum and
to tune the testing oscillator to give the
strongest signal.
.

JUNE 16th, 1938.

There is one more thing to do before


actually starting the aligning, and that is
to cut down the test signal amplitude as
far as possible, still leaving a reading on
the output meter that will show a peak
when the adjustments are being made.
The aligning can now be tackled,
although the details of the procedur will
vary with the following circumstances :
The IF transformers may have coupling
which is not above optimum, and they
will in this case have been designed for
single peaked characteristics ; they may,
on the other hand, have tight coupling
and be designed for band-pass character -

(a)

(b)

Fig. 2.-Incorrect (a) and correct (b) bandpass IF alignment as it would be shown on
the screen of a cathode-ray oscilloscope.

istics ; there is another possibility, and that


is that the receiver incorporates variable
selectivity which will certainly mean an
IF over-all characteristic of single peaked
type at maximum selectivity but of bandpass type at minimum selectivity.
If all the couplings are fixed and single
peaked characteristics can be assumed,
proceed as follows : Starting with the last
IF trimmer (the one associated with the

detector input) and working towards the


first trimmer (anode circuit of frequency
changer), adjust each one in turn to give
a maximum peak indication on the output
meter. Keep cutting down the amplitude
of the test signal as the peak output values
tend to increase. Since the tuning of each
IF circuit is liable to be affected by the
tuning of its companion, it is advisable
to run over the adjustments a second time.
As a check test, rock the test oscillator
some 10 kc / s or so up and down and carefully, watch the behaviour of the output
meter indication. Try to judge the shape
of the output characteristic curve and do
not be satisfied unless it seems to be symmetrical. If it is obviously lopsided, and
particularly if two unequal peaks can be
observed, it will probably mean that the
couplings are of band-pass type after all
and a fresh start should be made, following the procedure detailed below for such
a case.

If the couplings are fixed and are of


band-pass type it is a bad mistake to work
towards maximum peak indications without special temporary receiver modifications. To do so will almost certainly mar
the selectivity of the receiver and possibly
affect the quality of reproduction to a
marked extent. For speedy as well as
accurate band-pass IF alignment a
cathode-ray oscillograph with a frequency
modulated test signal is essential. Without this apparatus the job is still possible,

but time and patience will be needed. It


is going to be necessary when adjusting
the trimmer of any one IF circuit to have
the other circuit which is coupled to it
heavily damped, and this will mean transferring a resistance shunt from circuit to
circuit. There is no critical value for the
resistance, and io,000 ohms can be tried.
If it is not convenient to get at both ends
of a winding the resistance should be
joined in series with a condenser of
0.1 mfd., and the two in series connected
between the appropriate anode, or grid,
and chassis.
The primary of the last IF transformer
should be shunted first a,nd the secondary
trimmer adjusted for a peak indication.
Then transfer the shunt to the secondary
and adjust the primary trimmer for a
peak. Proceed thus with the other IF
transformers, working back towards the
frequency changer valve. After all the
IF trimmers have been adjusted remove
the .shunt from the first secondary, rock.
the test oscillator tuning, and take very
careful note of the behaviour of the output meter needle ; a symmetrical frequency response is, of course, wanted. Do
not be satisfied unless the response curve
appears either to be sensibly flat-topped
or to have two equal peaks (that are not
too exaggerated). Look, too, for sharp
cut-off on each side of the band-pass
range. If the response characteristic is
obviously not as it ought to be, then it
will be necessary to work on trial and
error lines with slight trimmer readjustments. It will be most important to restore a trimmer setting to the original
whenever there is no benefit to be gained
by a readjustment.

Value of CR Gear
Fig. 2(a) shows a possible response
curve with incorrect alignment, while
Fig. 2(b) shows the result of correction.
The statement that, using a cathode-ray
oscillograph and a frequency modulated
oscillator, the response curve is rendered
visible on the tube screen, and the effects
of any adjustments can be clearly seen, is
enough to indicate that this apparatus can
be of the greatest possible value in alignment work. Apart from time saving, it
removes all elements of uncertainty where
hand -pass adjustments are concerned.
There is now left for consideration the
case of the superhet with variable IF
selectivity. Since at maximum selectivity
the over-all IF characteristic will be singlepeaked. the IF aligning should be done
with the selectivity control at maximum,
and the adjustments can be made for peak
indications. It is important, however,
that after this initial aligning the selectivity control should be turned to minimum and a check test made on the shape
of the frequency response characteristic.
If any lack of symmetry shows up it
should be corrected by a touch on the
trimmer adjustments.
When the IF aligning has been done,
if the IF value is known to be correct, a
firm resolution should be made not to
alter the IF -adjustments again. If the 1F

JUNE 161h, 1938.

WpeOg

539

Worild
Superhet Alignmentvalue is a doubtful factor, however, then,

as we have stated, it may later prove to


be necessary to start all over again.
Before we change the subject there are
two odd points to be noted : If reaction
is incorporated in the last IF transformer,
the reaction control should be kept well
back while the aligning is being done.
Some receivers have two different IF
values-one for medium and long waves,
and a higher value for short waves. Needless to say, the aligning must be done
separately for the two values.
Having, at least for the meantime,
finished with the IF adjustments, the condenser shunt across the receiver oscillator tuning condenser must be removed
and the feed from the teat oscillator must
be taken off the frequency -changer grid.
Assuming that the IF stages have been
aligned al: a certain frequency, it is now
necessary that the receiver's oscillator
circuit shall be adjusted to oscillate at a
frequency above that of the test signal
by an amount exactly equal to the 1F
value. It is further necessary that the
oscillator shall " track " properly, i.e.,
that the difference between oscillator and
signal frequencies shall remain constant
for all settings of the tuning control.
The trimming of the oscillator, the
tracking of the oscillator (assuming that
it is not a case of fixed tracking), and the
trimming of the signal -frequency circuits
are jobs that have considerable reference
to one another, and it will be necessary
to be careful as to procedure. The immediate task is to get the oscillator into trim
on a test signal, but in many cases this
adjustment will not be the final trimming
one, as we shall see presently.

Dealing with Separate Wavebands


Having left the IF stages, we must needs
allow for the fact that adjustments now
will have to be made on two or more wavebands. Complete alignment should be
made on the first waveband chosen before
other wavebands are tackled, but at the
outset the position must be sized up as
to whether the order in which the various
wavebands are dealt with is going to
matter. In some receivers there are independent coils, trimmers, and trackers for
each waveband, and in these cases the
wavebands can be taken in any order one
pleases. In other cases, however, the
wavebands should be taken in some particular order. Such cases arise when any
one oscillator or signal -frequency trimmer
is in circuit on more than one waveband,
but an additional trimmer is associated
with it on one particular band. It is
usually safe to assume that in such a case
the order of work should be : short,
medium, long.
As there are one or two special comments to be made about short-wave aligning, we will discuss first the case of a
MW / LW receiver and assume that the
medium waveband is the first to be
tackled.
First of all connect the test oscillator
leads, one to the aerial terminal of the re.

ceiver and the other to chassis. Strictly


speaking, the lead to the aerial terminal
should contain a standard " dummy
aerial " in series, but generally a 0.0002mfd. condenser in series will be satisfactory enough.
Before switching on and commencing
trimming, it is most important to make
certain that the pointer setting of the receiver is correct. Usually there is some
obyious mark On the tuning scale to which
the pointer should be set when the ganged
condenser is at maximum (or minimum).
Having made sure on this matter, the adjusting can commence. The oscillator
trimmer must be adjusted for peak indication on the output meter from a test signal
having a frequency appropriate to a wavelength near the lower end of the waveband. Really the receiver manufacturers'
specified trimming frequency should be
worked to. but if this is not known there
are not likely to be difficulties of any consequence if a frequency of 1,40o kc/s (214
metres) is chosen. The tuning control of
the receiver should, of course, be set to
this reading on the scale before the oscillator trimmer is adjusted (and the receiver

put on MW).
It is possible that two oscillator trimmer
settings will be found to give peak indications on the output meter. If these two
peak indications are equal it can be

assumed that one is correct but that the


other is giving an oscillator frequency
lower than the correct value by twice the
IF value. If this effect is found it is essential to choose the smaller of the two
trimmer capacity settings. As to whether
or not the two equal peaks will be found
in any particular case will depend firstly
upon the value of the IF and secondly
upon the capacity range of the oscillator
trimmer condenser. The lower the IF and
the larger the maximum capacity of the
trimmer the more likely will it be that
the effect will be found.
If several trimmer settings are found to
give unequal peak indications it will be a
sign that harmonic beat effects are occurring. These are more likely to occur with
a strong test signal, so we have once again
an argument for keeping the amplitude of
the test signal well down. The second channel beat referred to in the previous
paragraph may hold a trap for the unwary (assuming that conditions permit it
to occur), but it is usually easy to avoid
trimming on to a harmonic beat. If in
any doubt, trim to the strongest output
peak if there is only one of this strength,
but if there happen to be two equally
strong (and stronger than others), then
choose whichever of these two requires
the smaller trimmer capacity.
(To be concluded.)

G.E.C. NEW SEASON'S PROGRAMME


announced last week as the
of the new 1938-39 programme are in many cases improved versions
of current types which are fulfilling successfully one or other of the diverse requirements
of the broadcast listener. The firm's policy
of strict price control and distribution
through approved dealers is being maintained.
receivers
THE
foundation

" Selectalite 6."-Automatic selection of


five stations by means of a rotary switch is

coupled with an illuminated panel above the


main tuning scale showing the name of the
station to which the set is tuned. There are
five valves and a rectifier, and the set covers
short, medium and long waves. Power output is 6 watts, and *be price 164 guineas.
" Fidelity All -Wave Super 10."-The five
waveranges in this receiver cover II -550
metres and goo -2, loo metres. Twin loud
speakers are provided and the output from
the push-pull stage is 15 watts. The price
is 29 guineas.
Battery receivers are represented by four
models, including one with the " Touchtune " feature. An AC console with automatic station selection and a full range of
radiogramophones round off a comprehensive
programme.

G.E.C. two -waveband A.C.5.

In all there are nearly twenty models to


choose from, and among the completely new
designs the following may be selected for
special mention.
" A.C.5."-Designed for medium and
long waves this AC superhet. (four valves
and rectifier) is ;housed in a horizontal
moulded bakelite abinet of striking design
with vertical tuning scale and visual switching indicators. Price, L7 19s. 6d.

" Touchtune 5."-Press-button automatic


tuning for five stations (four medium -wave
and one long -wave) and a ' Chromoscopic "
dial for general reception are features of this
all -wave AC superhet. (four valves and
rectifier). The short-wave range is 16.5 to
5o metres, and the price is 12k guineas.
`

G.E.C. " Touchtune 5 " with press -button


tuning for one long -wave and four medium wave stations.

The Wireless World, June 16th, t933

Developing

How a Receiver

HghQuaty

Communication

is

Designed-XII.

Receiver

It consists of
two triode assemblies with a common
heater and cathode, built into a single
glass envelope. Each triode section has 'n
AC resistance of the order of 25,000 ohms
with -.a mutual conductance of about Y.3.
Its attractiveness lies in the fact that one
6N7 will do the work of two of the 6J7
type, and we shall consequently decide to
use it.
The design of resistance -coupled amplifiers was dealt with in earlier articles in
this series and so we need not enter into
the exact process for the determination of
is the 6N7 double -triode.

1 H E AF EQUIPMENT

country. We must remember, however,


that a quality communication receiver is
one which naturally ha's a special appeal
overseas and there the American or Intervalves requires a maximum. input equal to national octal base types are probably the
the grid bias for full
most readily obtainoutput, or 43 volts
CONTINUING in this article able. The side -contact types are, it is
peak ; the total inthe design of a quality comtrue, available on
put needed by the
munication receiver, the push-pull
output stage, is thus
the Continent and in
Australia, but so are circuit values here. The circuit takes the
86 volts peak. In
penultimate 11F stage is discussed
the octal -base valves. form shown in Fig. 2 upon which the
the writer's opinion
together with the phase -splitting
The American values of components are marked.
this is rather too
stage which feeds it, The design of
octal -base types are Coupling resistances 'R3 and R4 of ioo,000
great to be obtained
directly from a a tone control which enables the bass now standard in ohms are suitable and with an HT supply
phase -splitting stage
America, but our of 35o volts each half of the valve takes
and treble responses to be indepenchoice of this range 3.3 mA. For a total output of 86 volts
embodying a valve
with, anode and dently raised- or lowered is treated does not mean that peak calculation gives the total input as
in considerable detail.
we are forced to use 3.42 volts, so that the stage gain is about
cathode coupling reAmerican valves. 25 times.
sistances, for to
Before this stage we need one for phase obtain linearity the mean voltage drop The more important types are included in
across the coupling resistances would have the International series and are made in splitting and experience shows the most
to be at least 60-70 volts, and preferably this country by several firms. As far as satisfactory arrangement to be that of Fig.
more. This represents an undesirably possible, therefore, we shall choose valves 3 ; a suitable valve is the KTZ63 or 6J7
large voltage between heater and cathode ; in this range so that the constructor can connected as a triode. The coupling resistit is not necessarily too high, but it is use British- or American -made valves as ances should be of as low a value as poshe prefers or as he is able to obtain them. sible in order to maintain the difference
better to avoid it if possible.
The alternative phase -splitting circuit is We shall not confine ourselves entirely to of potential between heater and cathode at
Good results are secured
sometimes called the paraphrase connec- this range, however, for if we can obtain a low value.
tion.
One output valve is fed directly a better performance or reduce the cost with a value of 1o,000 ohms.
from the preceding amplifier and a por- through using a
tion of its input is also) applied to a phase - British valve for
reversing valve which feeds the other which there is no
+35V
3.321:1A
output valve. With this circuit careful American equivalent
the
penultior
an
American
needed,
is
usually
balancing
mate stage does not operate in true push- valve for which
pull, and a perfect balance at very low there is no British
we
and very high frequencies is not secured. counterpart,
In the writer's experience, the best shall do so.
R1
In the British course is to use two valves in a true pushINPUT
pull amplifier for the penultimate stage; made types with
OUTPUT
3.42
86V TOTAL
TOTAL
and phase -splitting can be adopted at the the octal -bas e,
there are few
input to this stage.
triodes, but certain
tetrodes and penThe Penultimate AF Stage
todes can be used
2
The first step is obviously to choose the as triodes by strapmid
valves, and we know that triodes with an ping the appropriAC resistance of 10,000-30,000 ohms with ate electrode s .
an amplification factor of 20-40 will be Thus, th Marconi
suitable. Before we can select the actual and Osram KTZ63
type, however, we must select the general can be used as a
type to be used throughout the set. There triode with an AC
Fig. 2.-The circuit diagram of the push-pull penultimate stage, for
are now several distinct ranges available resistance of 10,000
which a double -triode is used, is shown here.
which are not conveniently mixed ; there ohms and an ampliare the standard 4 v. -heater types With fication factor of
It is possible to use anode and cathode
British 4-, 7- and 9 -pin bases ; there are the 20 ; in other makes and in American types
4 v. -heater types with the British octal this valve is the 6J7. Two of these valves resistances ' of the same value provided
that the bias resistance is shunted by a
base; there are the 6.3 v. -heater types with can be used in the penultimate stage.
It we look through the list of American condenser of very large capacity. This
the Continental side -contact base ; and.
there are the 6.3 v. -heater types with the valves, however, we find one which has condenser, however, can be omitted if the
no British counterpart but which is par- coupling resistance and bias resistance in
American octal base.
All types are readily available in this ticularly attractive for our purpose. This the cathode circuit are together equal to
N

the last article of this series details

of the output stage were decided, and


we now have to consider the penultimate stage: Each of the two output

V p

0.1

JUNE 16th, 1938.


High -Quality Communication Receiver-

the coupling resistance in the anode


circuit. Referring to Fig 3, it is necessary
for R3 to equal R4 + R5 ; as R3 is 1o,000
ohms and a bias resistance R4 of 1,000
ohms is needed, correct results are secured
R2
40,0000
1W

+210V

3.6m11

10,000

(1

0.5 w

C2
+174V

+36

1,000 Q
0.5 W

WcpIlcol
gain of 1.96/0.707=2.78, or say 3, times.
The best output for the detector depends
upon its type and must be discussed later ;
it will not, however, be less than 0.5 volt
RMS. if it is greater, we shall have to
throw away some of its output, but we
cannot economise
by providing less
AF gain if the am3s4
plifier is to be effective for gramophone work.
The question of
using a microphone
should receive attention. For a good
carbon microphone,
such as the transOUTPUT
3.42 p
verse -current type,
TOTAL
the amplifier should
work with an input
of about 0.05 volt
only. Many higher
V

3.6 V

INPUT
1.96V I,

+ 32.4 V

9,000!l
0.5W

by giving a value of 9,000 ohms to R5.


On the input side it is necessary that the
grid leak R1 should be as large as possible; in general, it is unwise to. exceed
2W2 for a grid circuit resistance if it can
be avoided. We accordingly choose this
value, and it is then unnecessary for the
coupling condenser C1 to exceed o.orpF
to ensure the full bass response.
As shown the stage will take 3.6 mA, so
that the voltage between heater and
cathode will be 36 volts-quite a reasonable figure. Owing to the heavy negative
feed-back along the cathode resistance,
the gain is very low and actually works
out at 1.75 times between the input and
the total output.
The maximum input
needed is thus 1.96 volts peak.

3.-The phasesplitter is of simple


and reliable type
using an RF type
tetrode connected as
a triode.
Fig.

quality types give a much smaller output.


if we are to cater for a microphone, therefore, we must provide additional AF gain
of at least loo times instead of merely
3 times. This will not be economical, and
as a microphone is rarely required we
shall not do it. This omission does not
prevent the use of a microphone, but en-

541

also laid down in our initial specification

that independent bass and treble tone con-

trols should be included. An AF stage


giving very low gain is the right place to
obtain tone control when these words are
used to denote a control which enables the
response to be increased as well as
lowered.
Experience shows that continuously
variable controls are unnecessary and that
most requirements are met by two 5 -way
switches, one acting on the bass and the
other on the treble. One position of the
switches gives a flat amplifier response
curve ; the other positions allow two
degrees of bass lift and fall and two
degrees of treble lift and fall in any combination. Experience also shows that the
major audible effect of a tone control
should be that of a tone control.
This
may seem too obvious to need mentioning,
but it is a fact that many widely used
circuits have the main audible effect of
changing the volume.
The response
curve is altered, certainly, but the amplification is changed at the same time.

The Tone -control System


These 'tone -control troubles usually
occur only when it is required to increase
the response at low or high frequencies.
As far as the response curve is concerned
it does not matter whether we increase
the amplification at low or high frequencies, leaving it unchanged over the
middle range, or whether we keep the
gain constant at low or high frequencies
and reduce the amplification over the

The First AF Stage


Now the amount of AF gain required
additional to that provided by these stages
depends upon the output of the AF source.
This will normally be the detector and can
be made anything we like within quite
wide limits ; it may, on occasion, be a
gramophone pick-up or a microphone,
The output of a pick-up
however.
measured with standard frequency records
varies from .about 0.25 volt RMS to about
1.5 volts ; with some types even higher
outputs have been recorded. The peak
output on loud passages of music often
exceeds these figures, however, and experience shows that an amplifier requiring an input of 0.5 volt RMS can be fully
loaded from the less sensitive types of
pick-up and easily overloaded with the
more sensitive types. We can thus say
that if full output can be secured with an
input of 0.5 v. RMS or 0.707 v. peak the
amplifier will have sufficient gain for all
current pick-ups and for the majority of
the older patterns. This calls for an extra

A view of the amplifier and mains equipment.

The phase-splitter can be seen at the front,


with the double-triode behind it and the two output valves at the rear.

tails the use with it of an external preamplifier.


We thus see that we need one extra AF
stage to give a gain of three times ; we

middle range.
tone controls do
must adopt the
ever, a limit to

The " volume control "


the latter ; therefore, we
former. There is, howthe possible gain with a

0
Wwlc

rll

542

JUNE 16th, 1938.

High -Quality Communication Receiver-

however, has a resistance of 25,000 ohms


valve. This figure cannot be exceeded with mutual conductance of 1.3 mA/V.,
at maximum boost ; cohsequently, the the amplification factor being 32.5. If we
normal gain of the stage must be less than connect the two halves of the valve in
the maximum possible gain by at least the parallel the resistance will become 12,50o
amount of boost required. Thus if a ohms and the mutu.il conductance will be
boost of 20 db. is needed, the normal gain 2.6 mA/V., the amplification factor recannot exceed one -tenth of that possible maining unchanged. This valve is the most
By suitable in the octal -base range and we
if tone -control were not included.
normal gain is meant the amplification shall accordingly select it.
If the valve is to have a reasonably
over th middle register and over the
linear
characteristic it should work -into a
the
conwhole range of frequencies when
load not much less than twice its own AC
trol is set for a flat response.
We have already decided on the normal resistance. The majority of tone -control
gain needed ; it is about 3 times. Be- circuits are such that the load is less than
fore we can design the control circuit, we the valve resistance ; with these there is
also want to know the amount of rise and a greater risk of amplitude distortion and
fall in the characteristic. This must be this is particularly bad in such a stage
determined experimentally and experience since the importance of harmonics is in We
shows that a rise or fall of 7 -Io db. is about creased by the use of " top-lift."
right for the first step and 15-2o db. for shall, therefore, adopt the circuit of Fig. 4
the second. Whether or not we can ob- because this enables the valve to be
tain a rise of 20 db. with a normal gain worked into a reasonable load. The cirof 3 times depends upon the valve charac- cuits (a), (b), (c) and (d) show the basic
arrangements for bass and treble lift and
teristics.
At first sight there should be no diffi- bass and treble cut respectively, and on the
culty, for it is easy to obtain an amplifica- right the equivalent electrical circuits are
tion of 6o times from a resistance -coupled shown. The condenser Cr is included to
stage. The kind of valve necessary for prevent the HT being short-circuited
this, however, has a high AC resistance through the tone -control network ; if it is
and must be worked into a high resistance large enough it has a negligible effect on
load.
Stray circuit capacities then be- the performance and is consequently
come important and may prevent correct omitted in the equivalent circuits.
operation of the tone control at high freIn tone -control circuits it is
quencies.
The Value Good
wise to keep all circuit resistances at a
The minimum load on the valve is equal
moderate value if possible.
Now octal -base triodes have fairly low toR,(R2+R) / (R,+R+R). In
mutual conductances-a normal figure general, R will be a good deal smaller than
being about r-2 mA /V., with amplifica- R2, so that the load is roughly equal to
tion factors around 15-25. The 6N7, RI and R2 in parallel. If we make their

combined vale twice the valve resistance,


therefore, we shall have satisfactory
operating conditions as regards linearity.
It is also convenient, although by no
means essential, to make RI and R2 of
the same value. As in our case the valve
resistance Ra is r2,500 ohms, this gives
us RI = R2 = 50,000 ohms.
As far as the calculation of the tone control .circuit is concerned, this network
of resistances can be replaced by a single
resistance R' equal to RI and Ra in
parallel in series with R2 ; that is

R-_
+R, +R5'_
In this case R'=6o,000 ohms.

The
generator representing the input voltage
delivers a voltage e' equal to.e,R, / (Ra
Rr) where e, is the input to the grid circuit. The ratio ;lei =A is the amplification of the stage.
Here we -have the
generator voltage e' equal to 26 e,.
Now when the response is flat only R'
and R are effective and e2 = e'R / (R +
R') = 26e,R / (R + R') ; therefore, A =
26R/(R+R') and R = AR'/ (26 - A). As
A=3 and R'=6o,000 ohms, we find R=
7,82o ohms.
This is not a standard
value, so we will take R=7,5o0 ohms,
which will give A = 2.89.
This will be
satisfactory, for the required gain calculated earlier -was 2.78 times and we took
3 times as the nearest round figure.
The minimum gain with the controls set
for " boost " will be 2.89 times ; the
maximum possible will be 26 times. The
relative boost will be 26 /2.89 = 9 times or
some 18 db. Actually, it will be less than
this because the gain will never reach the
" maximum possible." We cannot, however, obtain greater boost without reduc1

R1

--+

Cl
7l

-T

e2

(a)

(b)

C2

(c)

Fig.

4.-The basic tone -control circuit

(d)

for bass lift is shown at (a), for treble lift at (b), for bass cut at (c) and for treble cut at (d).
case the equivalent electrical circuit is shown on the right.

In each

WHire@20

JUNE 16th, 1938.

Wollid
High -Quality Communication Receivering the normal gain or using a valve of

higher amplification factor.


Consider now the bass boosting circuit
of Fig. 4 (a) ; at any frequency e_! e'
vi+w2C2R2/ V i+2C' (R .-R')2 and for

543
-

the steps of bass boost we have S=6.3


and 2.5 at 5o c / s so that C2R3 = 5.12 x
ro -4 and 1.385 x 10-3 respectively. 1f R3
is 0.25 MSZ, C2 must be 0.00204 F. and
0.00554 F. ; 0.002 F. and 0.005 F. are
suitable standard values.

(R + R').

From this we have C3R"

/ -i / in this caseas R"


and we can take
6.9
S2

w ;

is 6,66o ohms

and 2.28 at
io,000 c / s to give drops equal to the rises.
This gives the values of C3 as 0.00163 F.
and 0.00491 F.
The nearest standard
values. of 0.015 IF. and 0.005 F. are
likely to be satisfactory.
The complete circuit of this stage, including switching, can now be drawn and
is shown in Fig. 5.
Apart from questions of decoupling and bias components,
which can be settled on the usual basis, it
only remains to choose Cr.
The reactance at the lowest frequency must be
small compared with the effective circuit
S

0.005 mfd

10.015 mid

Fig. 5.

The various items of the tone -control, which are discussed in the text, are here put
together to form a complete whole.

this particular case A=26 e2/e'.


this

C=,I-67o/w

(R + R')2A2/ 670

From

- R2.

This value taken for A must be less than


26, and 20 would seem a reasonable figure ;
if we take the frequency as 5o c / s we can
find C straight away. It is 392 x io "F.
=0.0392 F.

'

Choosing Circuit Values


The nearest standard value is 0.05F.,
so let us try this. We find that A= 18.2,
giving a bass boost of 18.2/2.89=6.3
times or some 16 db. This is satisfactory,
and for the intermediate step we need a
boost of 8 db. or 2.5 times ; giving a gain
at 5o c/s of 7.25 times. Inserting values
in the formula we have C= o.I775F.
The nearest standard value is o.2 F., and
with this A=6.6. The rise in bass is consequently 2.28 times or 7.2 db. This,
again, is satisfactory.
We have now to deal with the treble
booster of Fig. 4(b). The procedure is
exactly the same save that the equations
now become
e2/ = 4,/R2+,.;2L2,../(R+R')2+w2L2
and
L=(R+R')2A2/ 67o-R2/f,f /Vi -A-/67o.
For A=2o and 7.25 at 10,00o c/s we have
L =1.3 H. and 0.518 H. respectively for
the two steps.
Turning now to Fig. 4 (c) for bass cut,
the values of R and R' have a very small
effect upon the performance if R3 is very
large compared with R and we can reckon
the response on C2 and R3 alone ; the relative response at different frequencies is
1/ %/I + I / C2,R23. Calling the ratio of
response at medium frequencies to that at
low frequencies S, we have
S2=i+1/w2C22R32,
whence C3R, = r / (04/S2- i. If we make
the steps of bass attenuation the same as

At high frequencies the circuit is that


of Fig. 4 (d) and the relative response
is 1/ i+w2C23R"2 where R"=RR'/

resistance which is 67,500 ohms in this


case. If weuse a 0.5-F. condenser for
CI, choosing the value because it is the
largest capacity id the tubular range, its
reactance at 5o c / s will be 6,370 ohms,
so that its presence will cause a negligibla
loss at this frequency.
It may be remarked that on measurement certain discrepancies in response
may be found, because the circuit has
been considerably simplified for calculation purposes. A precise formula, taking
into account every possible effect regardless of its magnitude, would be impossibly
complicated for the determination of
circuit values.

Two New Cossor Receivers


MAINS AND BATTERY SUPERHETERODYNES
BOTH these " all -wave " sets are superheterodynes; one is for AC mains and
the other for battery operation. The shortwave range in each case is from. 16 to
approximately 52 metres.
The battery set (Model 439) has a fourvalve circuit with triode-heptode frequency
changer, pentode IF amplifier with ,permeability -tuned couplings, double -diode -triode
second detector, AVC and first AF amplifier,
and pentode output valve. The chassis is
rubber-mounted to reduce microphony and
the glass -protected dial carries 43 station

Cossor Model 439 battery superheterodyne for


"all -wave " reception.

Without batteries the price is


7 15s.
A radio -frequency amplifying stage is included in the circuit of the Model 396 AC
mains receiver. There are five valves excluding the rectifier, and the final stage is a
triode. The cabinet is of the horizontal type
and the price is 91- guineas.
names.

New Hivac Cathode -Ray 'Tube


HIGH VACUUM TYPE CR3
ANEW cathode-ray tube is announced by
the High Vacuum Valve Co., Ltd., of
III -117, Farringdon Road, London, E.C.i.
It is a hard tube of the two -anode type. Its
cathode is indirectly heated and consumes
2.0 amperes at 2.5 volts. It is rated for 1,200
volts maximum second anode potential and
with this the first anode should be about 350
volts. Approximately -5o volts grid bias
is needed for current cut-off. The tube can
be operated with as little as oo volts for
A2 and 175 volts for Ai. At the higher
voltage the deflection sensitivities are 0.25
and 0.27 mm/ volt DC for the D1, D2 and
D3, D4 plates respectively. At the lower
voltage the sensitivities are doubled.
The plates D2 and D4 are internally connected to the second anode. Under normal
conditions the time -base is connected to Di
and the work voltage to D3. A shield is
included between the two sets of plates to
eliminate distortion.
The overall length of the tube is xin.
and it has a screen diameter of 3M.; the
screen colour is green. The tube has a 7 -pin
base, and is priced at 2 guineas.

The Wireless World, June 1Glh, 1933

S,g

RANDOM RADIATIONS
Quick Work

By "DIALLIST"

THE Indian broadcasting authorities are to

be congratulated upon the extraordinarily rapid development of their inAt the


genious broadcasting system.
beginning of the year four new broadcasting
stations, Lucknow, Lahore, Delhi' z and
Bombay z, were opened, all within fourteen
weeks, and three more are expected to be in
operation before the end of June. These
three are Delhi No. 3 and the medium- and
short-wave transmitters at Madras. The
problems facing All -India Radio when they
worked out their broadcasting scheme were
terrific. To put it in a nutshell, A I R's
task was to devise, with the comparatively
small amount of money at its disposal, a
system which would provide a reasonably
good service over the whole of a country as
large as Europe. Really high-powered
stations were ruled out by their cost, and no
use could be made of the long waves since
atmospherics are so severe. The way in
which the system has been worked out is
very clever, and it has gone a long way
towards achieving its object, though, naturally, it isn't perfect.

How It Works Out


The basis of the scheme was to divide the
map of India into nine great service areas.
For each of these a central medium -wave
station is either projected or already in
operation. This is intended to supply
broadcasting to an area immediately surrounding the transmitter with a radius of
about 5o miles. The area lying more than
5o miles but less than 50o from each transmitting centre is to be served by a shortwave station with a wavelength in the neighbourhood of 3o, 6o or 90 metres. But it is
also desirable to have one station which can
cover, by itself, a very large part of. the
country for the dissemination of national

news bulletins and for relay purposes. This


is the object of Delhi No. 3, a 5 -kilowatt
station, which will use a wavelength of about
19 metres. It probably won't be heard
much within zoo or 30o miles of the capital,
but that area is served by Delhi No. z.' Outside this area the 19 -metre station should,
generally speaking, be heard pretty well in
most parts of India.

-.

is amazing how quickly wireless textbooks become out of date nowadays,


or perhaps I should sayhow often those
published only a few years ago are found to
contain definite statements which have since
proved to be complete nonsense. This was
brought home to me the other day when I
happened to be looking up a point in an
authoritative work of some 700 pages published as recently as the autumn in 1932, or
just five and a half years ago. It was at
the time, and still is in many respects, one
of the best text-books going. But how is
this for a statement that hasn't quite stood
the test of time? It is laid down categorically that radio waves whose length is below
a certain limit pass right through the reflecting layers into outer space and are lost.
The author states that experience has shown
that no waves of shorter length than 8-11
metres can be bent back to earth in the daytime and that by night the shortest that
' can be so bent back are between 15 and 25
metres. Of shorter wavelengths he remarks,
" long-distance -communication at these frequencies is hence impossible "
The only
safe course for anyone who writes a wireless text-book would seem to be to eschew
all such definite words as " is," " are," or
" will," and to write in their stead, " appear
I1

FEATURES OF THE WEEK

Abroad.
Rome, 9, " Der Rosenkavalier," opera

(Richard Strauss).
Brussels, I, 9. English Music played
by the I.N.R.. Symphony Orchestra.
FRIDAY, JUNE 17th.
Nat., 6.30 and 9.50, " Die Meistersinger," Acts I and II of Wagner's
opera from Covent Garden. 7.50,
Alec Rowley and Edgar Moy at one
piano.
8.15, An excerpt from
Cochran's show " Happy Returns "
with Beatrice Lillie and Flanagan
and Allen.

How We Progress

Broadcast Programmes
THURSDAY, JUNE 16th.
Nat., 7, The Band of H.M. The Royal
Dragoons. 7.30, " The Skipper's
Birthday "-a harbour night's entertainment.
8.15, Discussion on
Transport and the State. 9.20, The
Western Brothers present " Cads'
College."
Reg., 2.20, Commentary on the Ascot
Gold Cup. 6.40, From the London
Theatre. 8, Commentary on Trout
Fisherman at Work. 8.45, Dance
Cabaret from Newquay.

%I

Reg., 7.30, Eddie Carroll and his


Orchestra. 8.15, First Orchestral
Concert of International Society
for Contemporary Music, 1938.
Abroad.
Hilversum, I, 7.40, Mass in B Minor
(Bach).
Beromunster, 7.55, " The Count of
Luxembourg," operetta (Lehr).

SATURDAY, JUNE 18th.


Nat., 8, " Music Hall " including the
two Leslies and Issy Bonn. 9.20,
American Commentary.
Reg., 6.35, " The Organ, the Dance
Band and Me." 7.30, The Free
Church Choir
Union Jubilee
Festival Concert from Alexandra
Palace. 8.20, " Weep for Polyphemus," the riddle of Jonathan
Swift. 9.20, Jay Wilbur and His
Band.
Abroad.
Radio Eireann, 7, Dublin Banjo Club
Band Concert.
Milan Group, 9, " Der Rosenkavalier," opera (Richard Strauss).

to be " and " may be," with lavish use of


qualifications such as " possibly," " probably " and " apparently.
Another statement which " dates " even in so recent a
book appears in a discussion of service
areas. We are told that the power required
to enable any broadcasting station's actual
service area to approach the maximum possible dimensions is of the order of Soo kilowatts ; " so it is much greater than the
most powerful broadcast transmitter in
operation." WLW and Moscow No. r
have been using 500 kilowatts for quite a
m.

Long-range Television
THE reception of the whole of an Alexandra Palace programme at Ormesby,
near Middlesbrough, is an astonishing feat.
A correspondent writing in the Sunday
Times stated that he saw the entire 70 -

minute programme, reception being excellent except for occasional interference. It


must be admitted that the reception took
place under almost ideal conditions. The
aerial was some 7ooft. above sea level in a
locality well away from houses and tall trees.
If you look at a physical map of England
you will see that except for the Yorkshire
Wolds, which are presumably to the east of
a line joining the receiving aerial and the
A.P., there's nothing worth calling a hill in
the path of the ultra -short waves. But
whatever the circumstances, the reception of
television and the maintenance of sync. at a
distance of 220 miles is an amazing business.
There has, by the way, been no revision of
the official estimate of A.P.'s service range
since the new sync. apparatus was installed
last year. The range up to which good reception is likely must be a good deal longer
than it was. Wouldn't 5o miles be hearer
the mark than the official 25.3o?
.n

.. .-

More O.B.'s Wanted


WHENEVER 1 discuss the question

of

the Alexandra Palace programmes with


owners of television sets I find, not a bit
to my surprise, that they prefer outside

SUNDAY, JUNE 19th.


Nat., 2.20, Medvedeff's Balalaika
Orchestra in Russian Sunday Music.
6.40, Theatre Organ. 7.15, Mantovani and his Orchestra.
9.5,
Recollections of Lord's Cricket
Ground, 1787-1938. 9.35, Flotow's
" Martha."
Reg., 6.40, World Theatre-Marlowe s
" Doctor Faustus." 10.5, Charles
Ernesto and his Quintet with Anne
Ziegler.
Abroad.
Rome Group, 9, " Barber of Seville,"
opera (Rossini).
MONDAY, JUNE 20th.
Nat., 5, Tennis commentary from
Wimbledon. 6.20, Chopin Recital,
by Nina Milkina, pianoforte. 7,
" The Bungalow Club."
7.45,
Descriptive Music on the B.B.C.
Theatre Organ, assisted by the
Effects Department. 8.40,
A
Ravel Recital. 9.20, World Affairs.
Reg., 6.40, Victorian Reminiscences
by Phyllis Scott and John Rorke.
7.30, Trial of Sir Walter Raleigh.
8.20, " Radio Olympus." Cast includes well-known Immortals!
9.30, Peter Yorke and his Orchestra.
Abroad.
Luxembourg, 10.20, The Luxem-

bourg Cathedral Choir.

while now.

TUESDAY, JUNE 2I st.


5, Tennis Commentary. 6.25,
Rachmaninoff Recital by Cyril
Smith.
7.35, Poetry as a Best
Seller-Discussion. 8, " The Silver
Spoon."
9.20, My Best News
Story-W. L. Andrews tells of
the Battle of Neuve Chapelle.
Reg., 7.30, " The Pig and Whistle "
truly rural episode. 8.20, Constant Lambert conducts B.B.C.
Orchestra (F). 9.20, Theatre of

Nat

-a

Variety.
Abroad.

Strasbourg, 8.30, " The Damnation


of Faust," opera (Berlioz).
WEDNESDAY, JUNE 22nd.
Nat., 5, Tennis Commentary. 6.45,
" Don Giovanni," Act I from
Glyndebourne. 9.20, Jay Wilbur
and his Band with Billy Caryll and
Hilda Mundy.
Reg., 6.30, Jack Hard s Little Orchestra. 7.30, " Blackpool, The
Pirate," a play by H. Hamilton
Earle, with music by Michael Sayer.
8.30, The World Goes By.
9,
" Parnell."
Abroad.
Radio Eireann, 7.20, Great Irish
Names in Modern Music, talk -by
Victor Herbert.
Kalundborg, 8.50, Songs. from " Snow

White."

WHpehgo

JUNE rth, r938.

5f

Wopllcl
Random Radiationsbroadcasts of current events to anything
else in the bill of fare provided. Cabaret
seems to be fairly popular so long as it is
well done, and some plays go well, though
I don't find any vast enthusiasm for plays
as a whole. News reels and other films are,
perhaps, the least welcome items. I have

always felt that the outside broadcast,


whether it comes from the theatre, musichall, the cricket field, the racecourse, the
sports ground, the boxing ring or just the
streets of London, was the field which
offered by far the best opportunity for the
development of television. The Alexandra
Palace organisers do us pretty well in this
way already, and I am sure that they'll be
wise if they concentrate more and more on
outside broadcasts.
After all, there's
always something happening in London,
and O.B.'s, difficult though they may be
to arrange and carry out, may be less expensive than plays, which can't be presented without a great deal of preliminary
rehearsal. The more the O.B, side is
developed, the quicker will be television's
progress towards wide popularity.
9a

ti

Guarantees
TT seems to me that it's quite time that
there was some kind of standardisation
of the guarantee that accompanies wireless
sets. As matters are, a few makers guarantee a receiver for a year, though most do
so for three months. All undertake to
make free replacements of defective components, but some charge for the labour
entailed, whilst others don't. Some, again,
make the owner of the set pay carriage
both ways if it has to be returned to the

factory during the guarantee period, whilst


others are more accommodating. Then
there's the wording of the guarantees themselves. I have seen some so loosely worded
that they might mean almost anythingor nothing. The whole position needs
straightening out, and the sooner this is
done the better. If set-makers only realised
it, the man in the street who buys their
products has an earnest desire to know
exactly where he stands, and they would be
helping themselves as well as him if they
took steps to make everything perfectly
plain sailing. A standard form of guarantee, plainly and simply worded, would be
very welcome.

Hard Cases
No one, I think, looks upon the present
state of affairs as regards the servicing of
wireless sets under guarantees as perfectly
satisfactory. In many-perhaps mostinstances the manufacturer undertakes that
the set shall be put right if it goes wrong
within the guarantee period, but makes the
shop which sells the set responsible for
carrying out any necessary work that is
within the powers of its assistants; only
those repairs which they cannot deal with
are to be sent back to the works for attention. there. And that is one of the big
snags. Too many makers don't choose
agents who understand wireless servicing
themselves, or employ first-rate service men.
The result is that the silliest little breakdowns baffle some local men, and if the
owner of the set is under obligation to pay
carriage on it both ways, he may be put to
a good deal of expense that should have been
quite unnecessary. Manufacturers should
exercise considerably more care in the
choice of their agents, and I do think that
it would be a graceful action on their part
to pay the carriage when a set is returned

to them, purely and simply because the


local man is incompetent.

Our South American Broadcasts


SOME cuttings from the Buenos Aires
Herald which have just reached me seem
to show that our Spanish and Portuguese
broadcasts to South American countries
didn't exactly set the Amazon on fire when
they were started. Things may be better
now, for these cuttings have been some
weeks on their travels. One sincerely hopes
that they are. The B.B.C. apparently
thought that the way to attract South
American listeners was to give them music
of the local brand. They get plenty of that,
probably better done, from their own
stations, and the B.B.C. is roundly accused
of sending " coffee to Brazil," which is the
local equivalent of sending coals to Newcastle. Another point made by some of the
writers is. that when they tune in English
news from Daventry they hear nothing that
they haven't already read in their evening
papers. That these foreign broadcasts ever
became necessary is one of the saddest
aspects of wireless, but if they are necessary
then surely it's up to us to see that they
are done in the best way otherwise the
B.B.C.'s efforts are worse than wasted.

H.M. THE KING

LAUNCHES WORLD'S
GREATEST BATTLESHIP
.

H.M.S. DREADNOUGHT
TAKES TO THE WATER

AT

PORTSMOUTH

Television Programmes
hour's special film transmission intended for the Industry only will be given
from 11 a.m. to 12 noon each weekday.
An

Sound 42.5 \1 s
THURSDAY, JUNE 26th.
3, Eric Wild and his Band. 3.25, Gaumont British News. 3.35, 155th Edition of Picture
Page.
9, Cabaret, including George Robey. 9.25,
British Movietonews. 9.35, 156th Edition of
Picture Page. 10, News Bulletin.
FRIDAY, JUNE 27th.
3, Starlight-Hildegarde. 3.10, British Mm'ietonews. 3.20, " Le Mdecin Malgr Lui," by
Molire, adapted from Lady Gregory's version
" The Doctor in Spite of Himself."
9, Starlight. 9.10, Gaumont -British News.
9.20, " Lady Precious Stream," a Chinese play
by S. I. IHsiung. Cast includes Esm Percy and
Josephine Middleton. 10_30, News Bulletin.
SATURDAY, JUNE 18th.
3, In Our Garden, C. H. Middleton. 3.10, New
Dance Steps demonstrated by Alex Moore and
Pat Kilpatrick. 3.25, Gaumont -British News.
3.35, Cabaret, including George Robey.
9, " Tally -ho," revue including Nelson Keys and
Valerie Hobson. 9.30, British Movietonews.
9.40, Spelling Bee. 10, News Bulletin.
SUNDAY, JUNE 19th.
8.50, News Bulletin. 9.5, Irne Prador. 9.10,
Film. 9.20-10.30, " A Hundred Years Old
a comedy by Serafin and J. Alvarez Quintero.
MONDAY, JUNE loth.
2.30-4.30, O.B. from the Centre Court at
Wimbledon.
9, Cabaret, including Horace Kenny. 9.35,
Film. 9.50, " The Old and Young," a comedy
by Louis Goodrich. 10.5, British Movietonews.
10.15, Agnes de Mille, with Henry Bronkhurst
at the piano. 10.25, News Bulletin.
TUESDAY, JUNE 21St.
2.30-4.30, 0.B. from the Centre Court at
Wimbledon.
9, Hildegarde. 9.10, Gaumont-British News.
9.20, " Le Mdecin Malgr Lui " (as on Friday
at 3.20). 10, News Bulletin.
WEDNESDAY, JUNE 22nd.
3-4.15, " Badger's Green," a comedy by R. C.
Sherriff. Cast includes Louis Goodrich and
Richard Fleury.
9, Starlight. 9.10, British Movietonews. 9.20,
" A Hundred Years Old " (as on Sunday at
9.2o). 10.30, News Bulletin.
Vision 45 Mc/s.

"-

.. that was ii
1906
in 1906. H.M.
King Edward VII launched the then
most formidable battleship the world had
ever seen-Dreadnought-the forerunner
of all heavily-armed fighting ships. Little
things happened, too some of them
destined, with the years, to grow big in
power and prestige. T.C.C., for instance.
Founded in 1906 to make condensers,
T.C.C. have been busy making condensers
-nothing else-ever since. T.C.C. were
making efficient, dependable condensers
32 years ago. They are still making
Big things happened

them. Little-unknown--in 1906,


today the name T.C.C. is known and
respected wherever condensers are used.

T.C.C.
ALL-BRITISH

CONDENSERS
THE TELEGRAPH

WALES FARM

CONDENSER CO.LTD.
NORTH ACTON.W.3

RD.

5027

Cte

The Tireless World, June r6th, 1938

sists of an aluminium surface


covered with a thin layer of aluminium oxide, upon which is deposited a monatomic layer of an
alkali metal such as caesium.
As shown in the figure, a photo
sensitive cathode C under -the
action of a ray of light L emits
primary electrons, which are
focused by an external winding Wort to a secondary emission electrode T of the kind described
above. The amplified beam produced as the result of the impact
is similarly focused on to an output electrode O, from which it

Recent InventIons
Erief descriptions of the more interesting radio
devices and improvements issued as patents
will be included in this section.
SECONDARY -EMISSION

AMPLIFIERS
THE Figure (a) shows a compact
form of electron multiplier in
which all the electrodes are
arranged around a common centre
between upper and lower supporting discs D, Di.

Primary electrons emitted from


the cathode C are coerced by the
magnetic field from an external
winding W, and by the electrostatic field from the field -plate F,
so that they follow a curved path
on to a target electrode T. here

from a previously prepared


calibration curve, the corrected
figure being the true bearings. Or
the correction may be applied
automatically by means of a cam
with a suitably shaped contour.
The invention describes a direction -finding system in which the
bearings taken by the aerial are
recorded as a " line of light " on
the fluorescent screen of a cathoderay tube. The necessary correction for quadrantal error is made
by using a voltage derived from a
ray of light which passes to a
photo -electric cell through a semitransparent mask, the latter being
shaded to correspond with the calibration- curve.
Telefunken Ges. fur drahtlose
Convention
Telegraphic m.b.h.
date (Germany) July 24th, 1936.
off

No. 482101.

WIRELESS

TRANSMITTERS
periods of loo per
cent. modulation, the ampli-.
tiers at a transmitting station are
called upon to handle four times
'the normal carrier-power, so that
in order to meet occasional
" peaks " the whole of the ampli
fiers must have a power -rating far
in excess of average requirements.
The. object of the invention is to
avoid this unnecessary expense by
increasing the efficiency Of operation.
Instead of radiating the modulated carrier-wave from the same
aerial, three different aerials are
used. One is fed with the unmodulated carrier-wave alone,,
whilst the two others are fed with
the upper and lower side -band
frequencies respectively. The three
aerials are preferably spaced at
least a wavelength apart, so as to
avoid " radiation coupling." The
effect of the outgoing waves on a
distant receiver is exactly the same
as if the signals were radiated in
the usual way, but the power to
be handled at the transmitting
end is more evenly distributed.
Marconi's Wireless Telegraph
Co., Ltd. (Assignees of G. H.
Brown). Convention date (U.S.A.)
July 161h, 1936. No. 481855.

D(H1(.

Constructional details of electron multiplier described in the


text.

they produce secondary electrons,


the amplified stream being collected by an output anode O.
A section through a similar tube
containing five target electrodes T
which, with the cathode C, are
arranged oh an inner circle is
shown in Figure (b). The same
number of field -plates F, together
with a collector or output plate O,
form an outer ring, the curved
path of the electron stream from
target to target being indicated in
dotted lines.
Ferranti, Ltd.; M. K. Taylor;
and S. Jackson. Application date,
October 16ti, 1936. No. 482454.
.

QUADRANTAL ERROR

WHEN taking wireless hearings

from a ship or aeroplane the


presence of. fixed metal parts in
the vicinity of the receiver introduces what is called quadrantal
error, an effect which is due to re radiation of the incoming signal
energy from the fixed conductors.
It is a fluctuating factor which
varies, more or less sinusoidally,
according to the particular direction in which the direction-finding
aerial is pointing at the moment.
In practice it is usual to add to,
or subtract from, the observed
bearings. amounts which are read

In order to avoid this addition,


one of the existing low -frequency
amplifiers is made to serve the

required purpose. For instance.


the output circuit of the last L --F
stage is provided with a relay
winding, which is insensitive to
the normal anode current, but responds to a rectified impulse
applied from the selective " control " circuit and immediately
applies the tuning brake.
N. V. Philips' Gloeilatnpenfabrieken. Convention date (Germany) August ,4th, 1936. No.
481858.

DEFLECTING COILS FOR


TELEVISION
IN television it is sometimes necessary to deflect an electron
stream, representing in crosssection an electron image of the
picture, bodily across a scanning
aperture. For this purpose it is
essential to keep the magnetic control-field homogeneous over the
whole area of deflection. Also for
high -definition work, it is desirable
to keep the inductance of the coils
ids small as possible in order to
reduce the power required to
operate them.
Fig. r shows tu -o pairs of coils
A, B, one for horizontal and the
other for vertical deflection, the
direction of the current flow being
represented by the conventional
signs + and O. The windings L
are arranged along the axis of the
tube as shown in Fig. 2, the end
turns E lying outside the area
within which the electron stream is
to be controlled. The wires are
wound closer together the further
away they are located from the

Electron multiplier and circuit


arrangement providing a high
order of amplification.

may be applied to operate a relay


R.
The emission of secondary electrons is not instantaneous, but
persists after the primary impacts
have ceased, owing, it is said, to
the formation on the outer layer
o a -positive surface-charge, which
continues to extract further electrons from the sensitive material.
The action of the outer layer is
compared with that of the grid of
a thermionic valve.
Marconi's fireless Telegraph
Co., Ltd. (assignees of V. K.
Zworykin).
Convention elates
(U.S.A.) September 6th, 1935, and
April 3oth, 1936. No. 481170.
LOW -LOSS COILS

-VOR high -frequency currents, the


ordinary ohmic resistance of a
conductor is increased by the so-

called skin -effect, which includes


eddy currents, and leakage into the
dielectric. To reduce such losses
a core of insulating materials is
covered with a thin coating of a
metal of high conductivity, such as
silver, which may either be
sprayed on, or deposited from
vapour in the same way as valves
are metalised.
The thickness of the conductive
coating in relation to the diameter
of the core is a critical factor. The
correct ratio is determined by
measuring the ohmic. and RF resistances by a resonance method,
or on a balanced bridge.

TUNING ARRANGEMENTS
IN one of the modern methods of
" easy " tuning, a brake is
automatically brought into action
when the circuits of the set are
set accurately in tune with an incoming signal. The brake " jams "
the control shaft and so makes it
impossible for a listener to " overshoot " the mark. The brake is
controlled by a rectified current
which is rapidly built up, at the
moment of resonance, in a highly selective circuit associated either
with the high -frequency input, or
with one of the intermediate frequency stages of a superhet set.
The rectified control current
must, of course, be 'amplified to
enable it to operate the braking
device effectively, and this involves the provision of one or more
extra valves.

Fig. 1.-Deflecting coils for


" shift " control of CR tube.
Fig. 2. -Schematic arrangement
of windings on magnetic "shift"
coils.

E. Friedlaender. Convention date


(Germany), January 8th, 1936.
No. 481319.

horizontal and vertical sections of


the tube, respectively.
Fernseh Akt. Convention dale
(Germany), September 301k, 1935.
No. 482513.
o

ELECTRON MULTIPLIERS
ATARGET electrode capable of
producing a high ratio of
secondary electrons from each impact cif a primary electron con-

The British abstracts published


here are prepared with the
permission of the Controller of
H.M. Stationery Office, from
specifications obtainable at the
Patent Office, 25, Southampton
Buildings, London, W.C.2, price
1; -

each.

The
THE
PRACTICAL RADIO

JOURNAL
28 th Year of Publication

THURSDAY, JUNE 23RD, 1938.

No. 982.
Proprietors

ILIFFE & SONS LTD.


Editor

EDITORIAL

HUGH S. POCOCK.

Editorial,
Advertising and Publishing Offices :
DORSET HOUSE, STAMFORD STREET,
LONDON, S.E.r.

Directorship of the

Telephone Waterloo 3333 (5 lines).


Telegrams : " Ethaworld, Sedist, London."

A Modified System of Control?


HE resignation of Sir John
Reith from the DirectorGeneralship of the B.B.C.
has provoked the thought in
many minds that the present time is opportune for introducing drastic changes
into the internal government of the
Corporation. In particular, there seems
to be a feeling that a more democratic
system than that prevailing under the
autocratic powers with which Sir John
Reith was popularly invested would
be more in keeping with our national
institutions and tastes.
In this matter there is surely a
danger in regarding the B.B.C. as
precisely analogous to other national
institutions and organisations with
which it is often compared. Actually,
there' is nothing truly comparable
with it, and so any attempt to seek

B.B.C.

COVENTRY

Telegrams

%
,1*,jiii1

8-10, Corporation Street.


Telephone

"Autocar, Coventry."

52x0 Coventry.

BIRMINGHAM

Guildhall Buildings, Navigation Street, 2.


Telegrams
"Autopress, Birmingham."
:

MANCHESTER: 260,

Telegrams
"Iliffe, Manchester."
:

Telephone

2971 Midland (4 lines).

Deansgate, 3.
Telephone :
Blackfriars 4412 (4 lines).

GLASGOW : 26e, Renfield Street, C.2.


:
" Iliffe, Glasgow." Telephone : Central 4857.

Telegrams

PUBLISHED WEEKLY.

ENTERED AS SECOND
CLASS MATTER AT NEW YORK, N.Y.

Subscription Rates :
Home, r ts. 8d. ; Canada, i is. 8d. ; other
countries, t 3s. rod. per annum.
As many of the circuits and apparatus described in these
pates are covered by patents, renders are advised, before
marking use of them, to satisfy themselves that they would
not be in/tinging patents.

CONTENTS
Page

Editorial Comment
The Aerial Connection

..
..

How a Receiver is Designed-XVI.


High -Quality Communication
..
. .
..
Receiver . .
Superhet Alignment (concluded) ..

Pilot Receiver Reviewed . .


Unbiased ..
..
The Great Ohms Muddle

..
News of the Week
Television on the Continent

..
..
..
..

Magnetic and Ionospheric Storms


Letters to the Editor
Random Radiations
..
..
Broadcast Programmes ..
..
Recent Inventions..

..

547
548

550
553
556
558
559
561
563
564
565
566
566

... 568

guidance from existing precedent are


bound to fail. One can hardly imagine
anything more disastrous to the future
of British broadcasting than a directorship of which the sole aim and object
was to give everyone what they wanted
-and which in consequence would fail
to please anybody. Programmes produced under such a system would
necessarily be scaled down to the
lowest level of intelligence and broadcasting s a vital national force would
cease to exist.
Much as our natural instincts may
incline towards a truly democratic
form of control, in the sense in which
that expression is generally understood,
there is another and very practical
objection to the governance of the
B.B.C. by a body representative of the
almost limitless number of conflicting
interests which might plausibly claim

VOL.

XLII.

No. 25.

COMMENT
a hearing. Such a body would inevitably be unwieldy, and nothing
short of a miracle could prevent its
time being wasted in fruitless discussion on matters (e.g., those of
taste) to which no solution can possibly
be found.
Even the most uncompromising opponents of autocracy are usually ready
to admit that no other system of
control would have given British broadcasting its present pre-eminence. Mistakes there have been, but it is perhaps
the greatest tribute to Sir John Reith's
work that the broad outline of the
system he created has proved entirely
workable, needing no major alterations
during fifteen years of trial.
It seems to us that .the real answer
to the basic problem is summed up in

the somewhat trite statement that the


issue between autocracy and democracy depends entirely on the qualities
of the autocrat.
If those whose
responsibility it is to appoint Sir
John's successor are fortunate enough to
find a man of equal capabilities for the
task, the present system will probably
survive for many years.
An eventuality that would, we think,
be most damaging to the future of
British broadcasting, and which would
establish a most dangerous precedent,
would be the appointment of a Director General whose main qualification to the
position was the holding of views
acceptable to his sponsors in the
Government. It may be argued that
the efficient machine created by Sir
John Reith would go on working
satisfactorily without a strong guiding
hand, and to those who hold such
views the attractions of a " safe " man
are obvious. But it is no disparagement of Sir John's work to say that the
task he set himself fifteen years ago is
not finished broadcasting has not
reached finality and is never- likely
-

to do so.

The Wireless World,

June 23rd, 1938

The Aerial Connection


EXPERIMENTS

WITH THE

"BIG

PRIMARY"

COUPLING

SYSTEM

By M. G. SCROGGIE,

ERIAL coupling is a problem. One


can imagine the difficulties of
designing a receiver if, for example, the valves to be used
with it were unknown, being any that the
purchaser of the set might plug in at random Yet that is something like what the
designer is up against in arranging that
very vital part of the receiver that leads
the signals in. He does not know whether
the aerial is to be a bit of wire around the
picture rail, a full hundred feet out of

arrangement with both top and bottom


capacity coupling and possibly inductive
B.Sc., A.M.I.E.E.
coupling as well.
The advantages of using high -inductance primary coil were explained theoextra amplification because that brings up retically in an article by W. T. Cocking2.
unavoidable noise as well.
The following -is an account of some exSome of the many possible methods of
periments devoted to finding how it works
coupling the aerial are shown in Fig. 1.
out in practice.
The first-the series condenser methodThe tests were confined to the medium
at one time used to be much more popu- waveband. Particulars of the tuning coil
lar than now. Some years ago' I showed are given in Fig. z ; it is fairly typical,
doors, or a modern
that, while it has having an inductance of 16o microhenrys
anti - interference
the merits of sim- and a Q (inclusive of the condenser, valve
system ; but he has
plicity and easy ad- and other associated parts) of rather more
to. arrange things
AFTER discussing the various
justability, in the than ioo.
The whole measurement
so that no matter
matter of misturi system is shown m Fig. 3. In addition t
problems incidental to coupling
what is connected
ing for a given the usual tuning condenser there is a small
an aerial to the input tuned circuit
the set makes the
signal transfer it variable very accurately calibrated from
of a receiver, the author goes on to
best of it.
compares very un- o -I2 mmfds. The method of calibration,
Even when one
favourably with by the way, is to use it to control an
describe a method of measuring the
particular aerial is
the next the
effects
of
this
connection.
The
given, the thing is
tapped coil. The
results of his tests will be given in
not entirely simple.
capacity thrown
PA
TUBE
29N DIA.
The requirements
a concluding instalment
across the tuning
are :
condenser by the
(i) To get as
latter method of
much as possible of
connecting the
the signal transferred to the tuned circuit,
aerial is reduced approximately in the proand in so doing :
portion of the square of the tapping ratio ;
100 TURNS
(2) To reduce the selectivity of the so if the coil is tapped low, say across one N?32 DSC
tuned circuit as little as possible, and
twentieth of the turns, the aerial capacity
37mtn.
(3) When ganguning is used, to avoid
is reduced to one four-hundredth, and
mistuning due to aerial coupling.
there is no necessity to take great care to
Finally (4) to do all the above things keep it very small. The aerial cap even
209 TURN
over the whole tuning range.
be run around the house in lead -covered
14th TURN
Of course, these requirements are con7th TURN
wire-a thing that would be quite unworkflicting.
If the aerial is very loosely able with the series condenser method.
E
coupled, (2) and (3) are achieved at the
If the aerial coil in the third diagram
expense of (I). As the coupling is in- consists of a few turns closely coupled, it
creased, up to a point (i) is improved ; is equivalent to the second method ; but
COUPLING COIL 554N
but beyond that it falls off, quite apart more often now a coil of comparatively
from the losses due to reduced selectivity high inductance is used.
Fig. 2.-Details of the coil used for aerial
and tuning accuracy.
The foregoing are the fundamental
coupling experiments.
In a big set with plenty of valves it is methods, but there are innumerable comparticularly important to consider the binations and trick circuits-especially for oscillator of known frequency giving an
effectiveness of signal transfer, for while balancing out image interference in super- audible beat note with another oscillator
selectivity can be gained elsewhere, poor hets. The last of the four shows an and to calculate the change in capacity
signal pick-up cannot he made good by
The Wireless World, February 2nd, 1934
required to tune through zero beat frequency to the same beat frequency the
other side of zero. The audible frequency
is synchronised with a standard audio
oscillator. Things can be arranged so that
one such movement of the small tuning
condenser is equal to i mmfd.
This experimental aerial tuned circuit
can be set into oscillation by a dynatron,
and the grid bias corresponding to the
start of oscillation read on the large voltmeter V. The dynatron3 was previously
calibrated for negative resistance by the
!

'

The Wireless World, November 4th, 1937.


For a description and photographs of this
apparatus see." The. Home Laboratory " (First
Series), The Wireless World, August 7th and
3

Fig.

1.-Four typical methods

of aerial coupling, as described.

14th, 1936

'

Wfii@ll go
WOplicl

JUNE 23rd, 1938.


The Aerial Connectionmethod I described in The Wireless

Engineer (Oct. 1933, p. 536) ; so by, reading


the voltmeter V at the starting point of
oscillation, the dynamic resistance R of
the tuned circuit can be derived by referring to the calibration curve.
.

549

tivity) due to the reactance of th aerial


mistuning the circuit. In the measurements to be specified,, the circuit was tuned
to the signal in each case, so only the resistance loss is shown ; but the mistuning
loss is calculated for comparison.
Another important point is that a mis:

RECEIVER

(TO DETECT
OSCILLATION)
DYNATRGN

MA[DA

AC S2)

ARTIFICIAL
AERIAL

Q
STANDARD
SIGNAL
GENERATOR

OPTIONAL

COUPLING

COIL

+50V

+00

-H

Fig. 3. Complete set-up of apparatus for the experiments. L is the coil shown in Fig. 2.
Coupling is effected either by the tapping as shown, or by connection to the high -inductance
coupling coil. Alternatively, also, a typical outdoor aerial is used.

Knowing the inductance of the coil, and


its dynamic resistance at any frequency,
the Q (or " magnification ") can be
R
where o = 2rf), and
worked out (Q =
wL

the effect thereon of connecting an aerial


can be noted. The selectivity of a tuned
circuit is proportional to , so very easily
follows. The mistuning effect is measured
by restoring the original frequency of
oscillation, observed by the change in
beat note in the receiver. Lastly, the
efficiency of signal transfer from the aerial
is arrived at by measuring by means of a

valve voltmeter the signal voltage developed across the tuned circuit at resonance
due to a known signal in the aerial. If
the same signal were injected directly into
the tuned circuit it would be magnified
by the amount O. The valve voltmeter
is a special one with an acorn valve probe,
imposing very little extra loss on the circuit to which it is connected. A description of this instrument appeared in The
Wireless World of April 28th. The combined effect of dynatron and valve voltmeter are reasonably similar to that of the
first valve in a receiver ; so the whole
arrangement simulates working conditions
quite fairly.
An alternative to the generator and artificial aerial was a. typical outdoor aerial,
with which all but the signal transfer
And the
measurements were made.
alternative coupling consisted of a small
lattice -wound litz coil, inductance 554
microhenrys, near the earthed end of the
tuning coil. Two degrees of coupling
were tested.
In considering the loss of signal in
transfer, it is necessary to distinguish
between the reduction in Q due to aerial
resistance. affecting the tuned circuit, and
the loss of signal (and, of course, selec-

selectivity

tuning effect consisting of a constant capacity at all, frequencies-even if rather large


-is relatively unobjectionable, because it
can be compensated for any particular
aerial by one adjustment of the condenser
trimmer. But a capacity effect varying
with frequency causes the ganging to go
out of line, however the trimmer is set.
Also, when the effect of the aerial consists
of a change of inductance that is constant
with frequency and for all aerials it can
be allowed for in the original design of the
tuning coil. But an inductance trimmer,
adjustable for each aerial, is not common.
In considering the seriousness of a certain mistuning, account must be taken of
the frequency at which it occurs ; for example, a capacity change is much worse
near the minimum of the tuning condenser
than near the maximum.
To make the procedure clearer, it will
be described in detail for one set of conditions, say 8o kc/s and the tapped coil
coupling.
The dynatron, is set going ; and the
signal generator, not connected to the coil,
tuned to 800 kc/s and picked up by the
receiver to serve as a standard for adjusting the dynatron oscillation to that frequency. The dynatron negative grid bias
is increased until the division between stop
and start of oscillation is reached, and the
bias voltmeter read. The calibration curve
(not shown) indicates this reading to correspond to an R of 91,000 ohms. Q. is
therefore i33, and the selectivity Q, or
w

u,

as already defined, is 22.5.

u,L

mmfds. to restore the original frequency


(as shown by zero beat note against the
signal generator in the receiver). The
dynatron bias has meanwhile had to be adjusted to re-establish oscillation, and the
new R is 83,00o ohms, and the selectivity
20.5. Then, cutting off the power to the
dynatron anode, and with the signal
generator giving.o.i volt, the valve voltmeter is turned on and its reading found
to be 0.95. The actual signal step-up is,
therefore, 9.5. This, of course, is with
the aerial circuit right in tune. The loss
due to. the mistuning already noted can
either be measured or calculated. Adopting the latter method, the frequency offtune corresponding to 2.7 mmfds. in the
circumstances named is found to be 1.8
kc / s, from which, knowing the selectivity,
the loss in signal strength can be calculated. It is zo per cent. Measurement
would be easier, but it happened in this
instance that all the in -tune tests had
already been made.
Results of measurements are most conveniently shown in the form of curves.
The dynamic resistance R, the " goodness " or " magnification " Q, and the

is

calculated in ohms, henrys, and kilocycles


per second, as that gives convenient-sized
numbers. Now each aerial is connected in
turn to each tapping. With the artificial
aerial to tap 2, it is found that the small
tuning condenser must be shifted by 2.7

(which, incidentally, is pro-

portional to L, where r is the loss resisr


tance of the tuned circuit, regarded as
being in series with L) for the tuned circuit alone are given in Fig. 4.
This is
quite typical of circuits tuned by variable
condensers, and shows that when the condenser is at its minimum the tuned circuit
at resonance is equivalent to a very high
resistance, but the selectivity is relatively
poor. And vice versa with the condenser
at maximum. The Q, on the other hand,
is fairly constant over the whole range.
160,000

160

120,000

120

30

20

Q
R eo.000

so

Q
40,000

40

FREQUENCY IN KILOCYCLES PER SECOND

Fig. 4.-Results of measurements on the coil


of Fig. 2, without aerial. R is the dynamic
resistance, Q the " magnification," and Q
is a measure of the selectivity.

In superhets, where most of the selectivity


is obtained at a fixed frequency, the varying selectivity of the preselector circuit or
circuits does not matter so very much ;
but in " straight " sets the performance
varies very seriously with the tuning position unless something is done to counteract it. Inductance tuning is for this
reason to be preferred to condenser tuning;
but is not so easy to contrive.
(To be concluded.)

The Wireless World, June 23rd, 1938

;()

Des\/dopng

How a Receiver

High -Quality

Communication

DROCEEDING with the design of a communication receiver, the


problems associated with the attainment of distortionless detection
are discussed in this article. The question of AVC and the voltage
handling capacity of the last IF valve are also treated.

DETECTOR AND
N the last article in this series the AF
equipment was dealt with and we saw
that the amplifier would need an input of 0.707 volt peak for full output.
It is the business of the detector to deliver
this output from a modulated intermedi-

ate frequency input.


There are four possible
detectors -the grid, the
anode bend, the diode
and the so-called infinite
input impedance detector. This last is really a
form of anode bend detector used with heavy
negative feed-back.
The grid detector is,
in general, unsuitable for a large receiver
which incorporates AVC, for it is much
too critical in respect of the signal input at
which it operates. The anode bend detector is better from this point of view, but it
introduces too much amplitude distortion
for our purpose. The diode can be nearly
distortionless and can provide the AVC
voltage ; furthermore, its input voltage is
by no means critical. Its disadvantage is
that it has quite a low input impedance
when it is designed for distortionless reproduction, especially when it provides the
This makes it somewhat
AVC voltage.
difficult to feed from the IF amplifier.

LAST IF

STAGE

HT supply if there is sufficient surplus


voltage available, but in the writer's experience it is difficult to prevent motor boating effects, and the system is in any
case rather complicated. Many of the
difficulties can be removed by using a
separate HT supply for
the AVC amplifier, but
the system is still somewhat complicated and
more open to trouble
than the simple diode
arrangements. We conclude, therefore, that
even if the AVC characteristics are less perfect
it will pay us to use one
of the extremely simple diode types.
We now come back to the detector. If
we have to use a diode for AVC we may
as well do so for the detector, particularly
as the same diode will do for both. To
use a diode for
AVC and an `` infinite input impedance" detecto r
would confer little,
if any, benefit, for
the AVC diode will
in any case have a
fairly low input
impedance.
Most of the difficulties in the diode
are
brought about by
the limitation to
the maximum resistance in the grid
circuit of a valve.
This is usually 2
megohms, but if a
resistance is common to the grid
circuits of more
than one valve, its
value multiplied. by

Obtaining
Distortionless
Rectification
and AVC

The Real Drawback


The infinite input impedance detector is
on a par with the diode from the point of
view of quality and the same difficulties
in the input circuit do not exist. The input impedance is not infinite, however,

but usually contains a negative resistance


component for which feed-back through
the grid -cathode capacity is responsible.
This makes the detector one which is
likely to lead to instability. This objection
is not insuperable, however, and the real
drawback to the detector lies in the difficulty of obtaining AVC. With this detector it is still necessary to use a diode for
producing the AVC voltage unless the
complication of a DC amplifier is resorted
to.
This leads us to another question :
Should AVC be amplified or not? In
general, amplified AVC demands a voltage
source negative with respect to the
cathodes of the controlled valve by 50-150
volts. This can be obtained from the main

Designed-XVI.

is

Receiver

FC and first IF stages. Later on, if we


alter the number of controlled stages, we
must modify the detector circuit to suit.
The circuit is shown in Fig. 6.
Here
RI CI, R2 C2 and R3 C3 are the individual filters in the grid return circuits of
the controlled valves. In some stages
they may not be necessary, in others they
may appear in modified form. The total
effective grid circuit resistance for any one
valve is 3 (R4 + R6) + RI (or R2 or R3)
and should not exceed about 2 megohms.
This value of 2 megohms is by no means
critical and the fact that it is the maximum recommended value in many cases
does not mean that there is any harm in
exceeding it slightly. Nothing disastrous
will happen, for instance, if it becomes
2.1..M. Consequently, we can for the
present ignore RI, R2 and R3, since in
most cases there is no need for them to be
greater than 50,000-100,000 ohms. Ignoring these resistances R4 + R6 should not
be greater than o.66 Mn and preferably
somewhat less.
For distortionless detection of deep
modulation the ratio of the AC diode load
resistance RAC to the DC diode load resistance RDC must be as high as possible.
Actually, the deepest modulation which

the detector can handle without distortion

eAF

detector

Fig. 6.-The basic


diode detector and
circuit
is
AVC
shown here.

AF

0.5m ti
0.5 w

Ave

the number of valves must not exceed 2


megohms. We do not, of course, know
how many valves will be controlled by the
AVC system until the early stages have
been designed, but we can tentatively
assume that there will be three-the RF,

is equal to RAC / RDc. Now RDc = R6+ R,

and RAc = R,

I`

The resist -

Rs+R4+R
ance R5 is the grid leak of the first AF
stage and we have already settled its

Wpe00

JUNE 23rd, 1938.

551.

WOpll
High -Quality Communication Receivervalue as 2 Mfg ; R7 is the IF filter resistance after the detector. So far as filtering
is concerned its value is chiefly important
in conjunction with C6 ; it should, how-

ever, be small compared with R4, R5 and


R6, all in parallel. It is by no means
6.0

1.0

exceeds 91 per cent. This would appear


good enough and we can settle on these
values and write them in on Fig. 6. As
the effective value of R4 R6 is 3 x 0.55
=1.65 MSZ only, as far as each of the controlled valves is concerned, Ri, R2 and
R3 can be as high as 0.35 M!) and we shall
still be within the 2 Me limit.
The efficiency of the detector is usually
reckoned as the ratio of the steady voltage across RDC to the peak unmodulated
carrier voltage applied to the detector, or
EDc /ERF. In the ideal case the AVC
voltage eAvc would equal EDC and the
AF output voltage (peak) would equal
EDC for zoo per cent. modulation.
In
practice both are smaller, and eAvc=EDc

xR6/(R6+R7) while eAF=EDCX


I-

In this case eAvc = 0.83


eAF=0.76 EDC.
X RDC.

cc

C/\\

TWB3

R6
R6

+R7

EDC

and

Detector Input Required

fa

01

The actual rectification efficiency depends upon the valve, and also upon C7,
but is not likely to exceed about 6o per
cent. for the low value of RDc which we
have decided to use. Taking this value,
we have 0.5 and 0.455 as the ratios eAvc/
EAF and eAF / ERF respectively. As the
first AF stage needs 0.707 volt peak for
full output, the minimum detector input
must be 0.707/ 0.455=1.55 volts peak if
the output stage is to be fully loaded on
zoo per cent. modulation. The AVC voltage will then be 0.78 volt. During zoo per
cent. modulation the RF input will vary
at modulation frequency between zero and

f
Z
i

i
I-

%B6
-0.01

The detector and last IF stage of an experimental receiver embodying the principles
discussed in this article.

instance, if 3o volts AVC bias is needed


for a strong signal, the detector input must
be 6o volts peak and up to double this
figure on deep modulation. The AF output is, of course, then much more than is
needed, but it can .be thrown away in the
volume control R5.
The point is, however, that the IF stage
feeding the detector must be capable of
giving quite a large undistorted output
and this is made difficult by the low input
impedance of the detector. It is about
36,000 ohms only in this case. Before we
can design the last IF stage we must
determine at least approximately the
maximum detector input on a strong
signal. For the time being we shall
assume that non -delayed AVC is used and

3.1 volts.

0001
o

-10

-20

-30

-40

-50

GRID VOLTS

Fig. 7. Mutual conductance-grid bias curves


for the KTW63 and X65 valves are given in

The predetector amplification must be


sufficient to provide a detector input of
1.55 volts peak from the weakest signal
from which full output is required. When
receiving strong signals, however, this
gain must be reduced by the AVC voltage ;
this must naturally rise and the detector
input will also rise in the same degree. For

this illustration.

critical and may be varied within wide


limits without appreciably affecting the
performance. Experience shows that a
suitable value for R7 is zo,000 ohms.
To determine precise values from the
equations is troublesome and usually leads
to non-standard values of components. It
is consequently rather easier to pick likely
values and then to see whether they will
be suitable. Now R4 + R6 must not be
greater than o.66 MSI, and if 'RAc /RDc
is to be reasonably large J24 must be fairly
large compared with R6. Suppose we
make R4 =0.5 MSZ, then R6 can be o.r
M9 and R4 + R6 will be o.6 MSI only.
The DC load resistance will be RDc=o.ir
MSI and the AC load RAc=o.o9 MSI; the
ratio RAC / RDC = 0.82 ; consequently, the
detector will be distortionless up to 82 per
cent. modulation only. This is not as
good as we should like, so let us try R6 =
0.05 MSI ; this gives RDC = 0.06, RAC =
0.0545, and RAC / RDc = 0.91. Distortion
will not occur until the modulation depth

50

SIGNAL

Fig.

8.-The

AVC

60

INPUT

70

IN

80

90

DECIBELS

characteristics for three controlled stages with non -delayed AVC are shown
by this curve.

WheDisoo

552

JUNE 23rd, 1938.

WoeIlcl

High-Quality Communication Receiver

mutual conductance, columns 7 and ro


represent the change of gain for single
stages. For three stages the total change
in gain is expressed by multiplying column
7 by two and adding column to; this gives
us column Ii. We want to correlate

that there are three controlled stages, two


employing KTW63 (6K7) valves and one
the X65 (6J8) ; we shall also assume that
the steady voltages apart from the AVC

bias on the valves remain constant irrespective of the AVC


voltage.
Furthermore,
we
will
+253
+100 VA
1.9n.A
7.6neA
assume that a detector -input of 1.55
500.t
500
volts peak will be
W
0.5 W
obtained for a
signal input to the
first valve of, say,

5o V. (peak) and
that the strongest
signal will be 5
I1
volts peak.
We
know that for the
NTW
5o V. signal there
63
will be a detector
.}3V .ti(`i
3.5mA
o
input of 1.55 volt.,
o
V

f1

0.5

063

..

Fig. 9. -The simplest


coupling
between
the IF valve and the
detector is the

300 1
0.5 W

familiar
" tunedgrid " type.

detector input and signal input to the first


valve and we do this by adding the figures
of columns 4 and tt, which gives column
12. We then plot column 12 against
column 4 and obtain the curve of Fig. 8.
From this curve we can read off the rise
iri detector input for any change in signal
input. We decided to choose a maximum
input of too db. over our arbitrary zero,
which gives 1.55 volts peak detector input
and 0.78 volts AVC bias. Fig. 8 shows
that the detector input will rise by 25.2 db.
or 18.2 times. AVC thus smooths out a
signal input variation of 1oo,000: t to a
detector input variation 18.2: t. The maximum detector input will be 1.55 x 18.2
28.2 volts peak, and on loo per cent.
modulation it will rise to twice this figure,
or 56.4 volts peak. The maximum AVC
bias will be 0.78 x 18.2= 14.2 volts.
We thus have to provide a last IF stage
capable of developing nearly 6o volts peak
without distortion in the input impedance
of the detector -36,00o ohms.
The simplest. type of coupling is that
shown in Fig. 9. We are unlikely to attain
a circuit with a dynamic resistance higher
than about 200,000 ohms and it will be
near enough to take the effective dynamic
resistance of the circuit when shunted by
the detector at the round figure of 30,000
ohms. With the KTW63 operated at -3

peak and 0.78 volt AVC bias will be


developed ; the problem is to determine
the detector input and AVC bias for a
signal of 5 volts peak.
The ratio of signal inputs is 100,000: r
or 100 db. The first step is to plot the
curves of valve mutual conductance
against grid bias, as in Fig. 7. The normal
bias for the valves will be -3 volts, to
which must be added 0.78 volt for the
AVC bias at a signal input of 5o V. This
gives
3.78 volts bias for our normal
" zero level." We next prepare a table as
In the first column is listed a
shown.
series of bias voltage values and in columns
5 and 8 the corresponding values of
mutual conductance for the KTW63 and
X65 respectively. The second column s
prepared from the first by deducting the
value of initial grid bias (- 3 volts) ; this
gives the variations in AVC bias which are
expressed as a ratio in column 3 and in
decibels in column 4. Mutual conductance
for the KTW63 is expressed in terms of
ratios in column 6 and in decibels in
column 7 ; similarly for the X65 in
columns 9 and io.
Since the AVC bias is proportional to
detector input, column 4 gives the detector input in decibels relative to our " zero
level " of 1.55 volts peak. Since the amplification is very nearly proportional to

Ratio
Grid
bias

AVC

of AVC

bias

bias
increase.

-3.78

-0.78

-5

-10
-15
-20
--3025
-35

-2
-7

-12
-17
22
-27
-32

2.565
8.96
15.4
21.8
28.2
34.6
41.0

KTW63

X65

3 stages
(2 x

Ratio

db

Ratio
g(mA;V)
3

0
8.2
19.04
23.76
26.8
29.0
30.8
32.22

1.38
0.9
0.28
0.12
0.06
0.04
0.024
0.012

of g
6
1

'

db

g(mA/V)

of g

0.

0.21
0.18
0.07
0.0155
0.007
0.0041
0.0025
0.0014

0.652
3.72
0.203
13.84
0.087
21.2
0.0435 27.2
0.029
30.72
0.0174 35.2
0.0087 41.2

0.857
0.333
0.0737
0.0333
0.0195
0.0119
0.00666

KTW63
x X65)

db
10

db

0
1.36

9.54
22.64
29.54
34.2
38.5
43.5

11

8.8'
37.2
65
84

95.6
108.9
125.9

Signal
input
db
12
0
17

56.2
88.8
110.8
124.6
139:7
158.1

volts grid bias, the required output can be


obtained with the circuit of Fig. 9 for a
second harmonic of about 4.5 per cent.
This does not represent second harmonic
of the modulation but of the carrier -the
modulation distortion will be less. This
is satisfactory for our purpose and we shall
accordingly adopt this arrangement.
The stage gain is 42.1 times, so that for
a detector input of 1.55 volts peak the last
IF valve needs an input of only 0.0369=
36.9 mV. peak=26.1 mV. RMS. The
amount of amplification needed before this
stage depends on the weakest signal we
require ; if we take this, Ls before, as
5o V. peak=35.4 V. RMS, the gain
needed is obviously 735 times. This could
easily be obtained from an RF stage and
the frequency -changer, except on very
short wavelengths. We have not yet considered the question of selectivity, however. Taking this into account, as well as
the short-wave performance and stability
and whistle problems, we shll be wise to
use an additional IF stage. The details
of this, however, must be deferred until
we have considered the selectivity
problem.

BEHIND THE SCENES: Stage amplification,


on a rather smaller scale than was described
in our recent article, is used in the Little
Theatre, Jesmond, Newcastle-on -Tyne, which
seats only 200. The 8 -watt amplifier, installed by Mr. W. A. Davis, of Newcastle, is
used mainly for sound effects, but can also be
adapted for music.

THE WIRELESS INDUSTRY


ANNOY sound equipment, installed temporarily at Westminster Cathedral some
six months ago, has now been converted into
a permanent and complete installation feeding
no fewer than 38 speakers. Automatic gain
control is employed, and provision is made for
automatically switching off speakers adjacent
to the microphone actually in use.

c o 0 0

Antiference, Ltd., r76, Wardour Street,


London, W.', has sent us a pamphlet describing the "Rod " vertical aerial, designed for
mounting on the gutter -board of a building.

Film -Strips, a substitute for the oldfashioned lantern slides, are described in a
booklet issued by Ranald Small and Partners,
Ltd., Bush House, London, W.C.2. 'The uses
of the strips in conjunction with sound -reproducing equipment are described.

The Wireless World, June 23rd, 1938

Superhet Alignment
SIGNAL - FREQUENCY

AND
OSCILLATOR CIRCUITS
By " TRIMMER "
T TENTION

may now be directedd


to the signal-frequency circuits.
By this expression we mean those
which come in front of the fre-

quency-changer valve, including the input


circuit coupled to the aerial or a band-pass
input, and also all tuned circuits associated with any HF stages that precede
the frequency changer.
The setting at which the oscillator
trimmer condenser has been left is not
necessarily to be regarded as final. If the
receiver has variable oscillator tracking a
return will certainly have to be made later
to the oscillator trimming, but before proceeding to the question of tracking it will
be as well to attend to the trimming of the
signal -frequency circuits.
Keeping the test signal frequency unaltered the various signal frequency circuits should be adjusted for peak output,
working from the frequency -changer valve
towards the aerial. Do not forget to seize
every opportunity of cutting down the test
signal amplitude.
If there happens to be a band-pass
coupling on the signal frequency side of the receiver the final touch on
the band-pass trimmers
can be left over until the
tracking is done and the
receiver is practically `` in

(Concluded from page 539 of last week's issue)


The IF
the calibration discrepancies.
alignment should be gone over again at a
a receiver slightly different frequency, the oscillator
containing specially shaped vanes in the and signal -frequency circuits trimmed
oscillator section of the ganged condenser again, and then a second check made over
It should now have become
the tracking only holds correctly, without the scale.
circuit modification, on one waveband. readily apparent as to whether the original
Generally, the medium waveband is the IF value was the cause of the trouble,
one chosen, and extra condensers must be and, moreover, in what sense (up or
down) will it be
looked for on the
necessary to make
other wavebands,
r
further alteration to
as (ii) and (iii)
IN the preceding instalment a de- put
matters right. '
above.
A similar story
tailed description of the process of
If specially shaped
to the
above
oscillator contrimming an IF amplifier was given
applies to the case
denser plates comthe author now deals with the reof the receiver with
pletely control the
maining circuits of a superheterodyne
a fixed tracking
tracking, the initial
condenser.
trimming
should
and also discusses the question of
When the trackbe all that is necescarrying out adjustments without the
is
brought
ing
sary, as far as the
help of test gear.
about by an adoscillator circuit is
L
justable condenser,
concerned, but it
should be made
will be advisable
to check the accuracy of the tuning in the following sequence
After trimming the oscillator and signal
against the receiver scale calibration: If
it is found that the calibration does not frequency circuits at 1,40o kc/s, the refit in with the tuning over the waveband ceiver tuning and the frequency of the test
then the possibilities of either the original signal should be set to a value near the
choice of IF being wrong, or the oscillator upper end of the waveband. The manuhaving been trimmed to the wrong facturers' specified frequency ought to be
beat must be considered. Circumstances used, but if this is not known try 600 kc/s
The tracking condenser
will generally indicate which of these (50o metres).

tracking condensers are often referred to


as

" padders."
It must be noted that with

:-

shape."
With regard to the
oscillator, different tracking arrangements will- be
found in various cases,
and it can be anticipated
that one of the following
systems will be found :
(i) tracking by specially
shaped vanes in the oscillator tuning condenser,
(ii) by a fixed series condenser, (iii) by an adjustable series condenser
(which may, or may not,
be associated with a fixed
condenser in parallel,
according to circumstances).
The oscillator circuit of
Fig. 3.--A typical superhet circuit (omitting output and rectifier). The condensers that would have to be adjusted
Fig. 3 shows an example
for complete alignment are indicated by the dotted circles. CI, C2, C3 and C4 are the IF trimmers, C5 the oscillator
trimmer, C6 the oscillator tracker, C7 and C8 the signal -frequency band-pass input trimmers. Signal frequency and
of tracking by an adjustoscillator coils for one waveband only are shown.
C6.
able series condenser,
It will be noted that in
this particular case there is a fixed parallel two alternatives is the more probable. should be adjusted for a peak indication
If the IF value becomes suspect a care- on this signal, but since the trimmers of
It
condenser connected to the tracker.
note should be made of the nature of the oscillator and signal -frequency cirful
here
that
be
mentioned
should perhaps

VIpg00

554

WopN!

Superhet Alignment-

cuits must not be disturbed while the


tracking is being done the ganged condenser tuning control should be rocked
slightly, and the best combination of
tracking condenser capacity and ganged
tuning setting chosen.
The adjusting of the tracking condenser
is bound to upset the original oscillator
trimming, so a return must be made to the
trimming frequency, and the oscillator
trimmer must be readjusted.
In some
cases it may even be necessary to go back
for another touch on the tracker, but,
generally, " trim, track, trim " will be all
that is necessary.
If it is found that " trim, track, trim "
still leaves wide adjustments to be made,
if, in fact, no amount of trimming and
tracking work will pull the calibration
into line, then the possibilities of wrong
oscillator beat, or of incorrect IF value,
should be investigated.
If all has gone well the final touch on
the oscillator trimmer should be the last
job required on the particular waveband
concerned, unless there is a band-pass input system, in which case a slight readjustment of the band-pass trimmers may
be beneficial, from the selectivity point
of view.
With a band-pass input it is
advisable to apply a test signal and to
rock the test oscillator tuning control. A
slight touch on the band-pass trimmers
should be made if there is any sign of lack
of symmetry in the behaviour of the output meter readings.
Oscillator trimming and tracking and
signal frequency circuit trimming on the
long waveband obey similar rules to
those given above for the medium waveband.
It will be found that with certain receivers there is only oscillator trimming to
attend to on Jong waves. In such a case
it is advisable to rock the ganged condenser control while trimming. In other
cases, however, there will be just as much
(and similar) work to be gone through on
the long waves as on the medium waves.
The manufacturers' specified trimming
and tracking test frequencies should, if
possible, be ascertained and used. If in
doubt try 30o kc/s (1,000 metres) and
1,600 kc/s (1,875 metres) for trimming
and tracking respectively.

On the SW Bands
Alignment on short waves is more
tricky than on MW or LW, partly because
of the sharpness of response to trimmer
adjustments, and partly because there is
greater risk of getting on to the wrong
beat when trimming the oscillator. It is
necessary to be particularly careful regarding the latter point, and the reader
may like to make a note of a useful check.
This consists of pushing up the amplitude
of the test signal (after the oscillator trimming has been done) and searching with
the receiver tuning for the second -channel
" image " signal. With a very strong
test signal it should be possible, if all is
correct, to find an image signal when the
receiver is tuned to a frequency equal to

test signal frequency minus twice IF.


Trimming and tracking should, of
course, be carried out near the lower and
upper ends of the waveband respectively,
but there is not much point in suggesting
particular frequency values, as those
specified for different receivers vary quite
considerably.
It is hoped that those readers who do
not possess ganging test equipment have
studied the foregoing, because half the
battle when tackling superhei alignment
without test gear is to know just where the
chief difficulties will arise.
One of the most obvious of these is in
connection with IF alignment. A test
signal at the intermediate frequency is out
of the question, and the aligning must
necessarily be done on a signal picked up
on the aerial. Since the signal will only
reach the IF stages if the oscillator and
signal -frequency circuits are in some sort
of shape it needs little imagination to
picture the complexity that may arise if
complete alignment of the receiver is
required.
We cannot say that complete alignment
is impossible with no other help than that
given by outside signals, but considerable
time and patience will be required. We
would most certainly advise against the
attempt if the IF stages are designed for
band-pass characteristics, however.

Judging by Ear
The question as to what will be done
about peak indications is one of the first
to settle, for we are now assuming that
no test gear is available.
If the worst
comes to the worst the ear will have to be
used, judging the intensity of the loud
speaker output.
Receivers containing tuning indicators
can, with one possible complication, be
aligned with the aid of the tuning indica-

tor.
The complication referred to is in
connection with the trimming of the last
IF secondary and arises when the AVC
diode is fed, not from the secondary, but
from the last IF primary. Although it
is possible under favourable circumstances to use the tuning indicator (minimum indication) for trimming the last
secondary it is perhaps advisable to use
the ear when adjusting this particular
circuit.
If' a tuning indicator is going to be
made use of when carrying out aligning
work it necessarily follows that signals
sufficiently strong to give clear peak indications must be chosen, and it is obvious
that the AVC action is being utilised. On
the other hand, if the ear is going to be
used for the alignment it will be important
to use the weakest signals that can be
found of suitable frequencies. Alternatively, and perhaps better, the AVC
could be temporarily cut out.
This is usually an easy matter. In the
case of the receiver shown in Fig. 3 the
AVC line could be disconnected from the
AVC diode load resistance (see point
marked X).
The AVC line should be
earthed to chassis, to avoid leaving the
grids of the valves " in the air."

JUNE 237d, 1938.


If complete alignment is required the

IF stages must receive first attention.


The first problem will probably be that of

finding a signal to work on, for quite


possibly the alignment may at the commencement be so badly out that the receiver is " dead."

Preliminary Adjustments
Set the IF trimmers at approximately
half -way between maximum and minimum capacity and then search on LW for
a signal with the ganged tuning control.
As soon as one can be heard bring the
signal frequency and oscillator trimmers
roughly into line (rocking the gang if
necessary).
Then peak the IF trimmers on the
signal. Needless to say, it is a case of
" hope for the best " as regards the frequency upon which the IF stages are
being aligned. Later it may be necessary
to realign them at a different frequency.
When nothing more can, for the meantime, be done with the IF stages, verify
the setting of the receiver tuning pointer,
switch the receiver to the proper waveband, and search for a suitable oscillator
trimming signal. Look for a signal near
the lower end of the waveband and preferably choose an identified station, so
that the receiver's tuning can be set to the
correct point on the scale. Then trim the
oscillator and signal-frequency circuits.
If tracking adjustment is necessary
look for a suitable signal near the upper
end of the waveband.
l
As the IF value is a doubtful factor it
will be most advisable, before proceeding
to other wavebands, to make a close
check over the scale to see how the cali-`
bration holds. If there are signs of
trouble try tracking and trimming once
again, but if this is of no avail there will
be nothing for it but to return to the IFi
stages and start all over again. Do not
tackle the other wavebands before it is'
certain that the IF stages are correct.
e
Fortunately, the majority of cases that
arise away from the production benches
are cases where partial realignment only
is required. Such cases can arise from a
variety of circumstances. A misguided
non -technical owner may have " had a
go " at the trimmers ; usually only the
very accessible ones will have been
altered. A coil or condenser replacement
may have been made which will necessitate only partial readjustments. Vibration (and insufficient sealing) may have
caused a trimmer to shift.
In the absence of ganging test equipment the art of handling such cases is to
restrict the first test readjustments to the
trimmers or trackers which obviously
need adjustment and to avoid touching
any of the others, unless circumstances
finally compel one to do so.
Every advantage should be taken of
the fact that those trimmers which are
still -in correct adjustment can act as
" guides " for the setting of the others. A
typical case would be that of a receiver
that has had its IF alignment upset. If
there are no band-pass complications the

wllg

JUNE 237d, 1938.

555

Wwlcol
Superhet Alignment-

IF trimmers can be peaked on a signal


and with the comfortable knowledge that
the oscillator circuit will force the IF
alignment on to the correct corresponding
frequency.
Where extreme caution is required is
in the case where lack of alignment is
suspected, although it is not definitely
known that there has been any tampering
with the adjustments or that any trimmer
has shifted. It is vitally important here
to put the receiver through its paces and
to take careful note of the results.
If
results are satisfactory on, say, medium
waves but are below standard on long
waves it can be taken as practically certain that the IF stages are in order, and
that the trouble, if it is due to alignment,
is associated with the LW trimming or
tracking.
The fact that the oscillator frequency
takes charge of the tuning settings of a
superhet is useful to keep in mind. If a
calibration check over a waveband shows
that stations are tuning in accurately but
the sensitivity of the receiver .is below

normal the oscillator trimming or tracking


should not be disturbed.
If " pulling " is experienced when adjusting signal -frequency circuits on short
waves, i.e., if the signal -frequency circuit
adjustments have the effect of changing
the oscillator frequency, it is advisable to
rock the gang control while carrying out
the signal -frequency trimming and to work
to the best combination of settings.
There remain two adjustments, which,
though perhaps not strictly associated with
alignment, should be mentioned for the
sake of completeness. To set an IF filter
the receiver should be switched to LW
and tuned to maximum wavelength. From
a modulated test oscillator a strong signal
at intermediate frequency should be applied to the receiver's A and E terminals
and the filter then adjusted to give minimum receiver response. The adjustment
of an image rejector can easily be done
on the signal from a local transmission.
Tune the receiver until the second-channel
whistle (or a second -channel " image ") is
heard, and then adjust the rejector for
minimum response.

Telefunken TO 1001 Pick-up


SUPPLIES of the improved Telefunken
pick-up are now available in this country through Pye, Ltd., Cambridge. Such
changes as have been made are chiefly of a
mechanical nature since the electrical characteristic of the earlier model published in
The Wireless World of October 22nd, 1937,
was as near perfect as makes no matter. As
a check, a characteristic of the new model
was taken without a transformerand found
to agree within less than z db with the curve
first published. The output of the new design has not been reduced by the wider
air gap which it has been given, and the
longer magnet system gives if anything a
higher sensitivity. Surface noise was too
low to be measured, and the light weight of
the pick-up head, combined with the lateral
spring loading which makes the permanent
sapphire needle follow one side of the
groove, reduced the effects of eccentrically
pierced records to a minimum.
A really clever idea is to be found in the
roller device for protecting the sapphire
from damage if the pick-up should be accidentally dropped on to the record. The
roller, which is rubber -covered, rotates
against an internal coil spring, and there is
a distinct flat on one side which is normally
held uppermost against a stop. The round
part of the roller stands out more than the

quite independently of the care or otherwise


with which the tone-arm is lowered during
the first stage. During the playing of the
record the return spring in the roller is pressing the trailing edge of the flat on the record,
but as the pressure is on the " land " between grooves and the spring tension is light
no wear will take place, though dust might
be pushed into the grooves.
No bass boost is allowed in the pick-up
as this would result in harmonic distortion,
but a tone correction transformer is available. The price of the TO Iooi pick-up
remains at 5 guineas.

News from the Clubs


Edgware Short-wave Society
Headquarters: Constitutional Club, Edgware.
Meetings: Sundays at 11 a.m. and Wednesdays at
8 p.m.
Hon. Sec.: Mr. F. Bell, 118, Colin Crescent, London,
N.W.0.

On June 8th a lecture on " Meters " was


given by Mr. Lawton, of Ferranti, Ltd.
A series of lectures on transmitting apparatus and recent aerial developments will shortly
be given by the President of the Club.
The Club is now affiliated to the R.S.G.B.
field day
and a party visited the divisional
_camp on June 12th.
The Club has now a membership of thirty,
over twenty of whom attend regularly. It has
been decided to continue the meetings during
the summer, providing that 5o per cent. of
the members attend.

London Transmitting Society

needle point from the underside of the pickup, so no matter how far it is dropped it
cannot damage either the sapphire or the
record. On the instant of contact the rotation of the record drags the roller round until
the flat surface is reached, when the needle
is lowered the remaining bin. on to the
record at a speed depending only on the
linear speed of rotation of the record, and

Headquarters: 40, Raeburn Road, Edgware.


Meetings: Thursdays at 8 p.m.
Hon. Sec.: Mr. G. Yale, 40, Raeburn Road, Edgware.

A successful junk sale was held on June 9th.


On June 3oth the Society are erecting a Soft.
aerial mast. It has been decided to employ
a 28 -megacycle system using 4 in -phase aerials

backed up by four reflectors concentrating the


radiation in the direction of the transmitter
which is being received.
Membership is free to holders of transmitting licences. Application for membership

Diagram showing action of safety


roller : (al at instant of contact with
record, (b) roller turning with rotation
of record, and (c)
needle lowered in
groove.

(Inset)

Underside

of

latest Telefunken
TO Ioo1 pick-up
showing safety
device.

Curve of Telefun-

ken

pick-up

through a 1:15
transformer. Zero
db = r volt RMS
and dotted curve
is characteristic of
test record.

(a)
+ 10

db

r-

must, however, be made on a QSL card and


not by letter.

..-..

.:-e----...

Eastbourne and District Radio Society


Headquarters: The Science Room, Cavendish Senior
School, Eastbourne.
Hon. Sec.: Mr. T. G. R. Dowsett, 98, Grove Road, East

wirele : N'"rid
COPV.ICHT

bourne.

10

i- 15o

w
N

FREQUENCY

8
o

U)

(D

oo

On May 3oth Mr. E. Cholot, of Lissen, Ltd.,


gave a lecture and short-wave demonstration.
He showed a large number of Lissen Hi -Q
short-wave components. He also stated that
the firm are bringing out several sets to compete with the American communication receivers.

The Wireless World, June 23rd, 1938

Pjlot

MODEL B.43

Battery Superhet, Making Efficient Use of


Moderate HT Current
FROM the outside this receiver is not
immediately recognisable as a Pilot
product, for the characteristic
clock-faced tuning dial has given
place to a typically English rectangular
scale with vertical pointer. It is a boldly
printed scale and one which makes the
search for station names a much more
comfortable process on all wave bands,
but more particularly on medium waves
where the settings have been grouped in
echelon.
An ingenious indicator has been devised
to show in which position the waverange
switch happens to be ; an arrow, pointing
to .the appropriate scale, appears successively in apertures -at the right-hand end
of each scale. There is also a pilot light
to show when the set is in operation-an
important point, as the background noise
of a battery set, and this set in particular,
is extremely low between stations.
The rectilinear character of the tuning
scale. is repeated in the loud speaker fret
which is lined with light-coloured birch wood.
The unit behind this grille is a
very efficient 8-inch permanent magnet
moving coil well matched to the pentode
output valve. One's first impressions are
of a three -watt triode, for not only is the
volume much higher than that usually
provided by single output valves in a
battery receiver, but the quality is remarkably free from harmonic distortion

FEATURES.

-(1)

Waveranges.

16.5-52 metres. (2) 180-565


metres. (3) 750-2,200 metres. Circuit.
-Triode pentode frequency changer-var. -mu pentode IF amplifier-doublediode-triode 2nd. der., AVC rect. and
1st AF ampl.-pentode output valve.
Automatic grid bias. Controls.(1) Tuning. (2) Volume and on -off
switch.
(3) Waverange. Price. -9 guineas (without
batteries).
Makers. Pilot Radio Ltd., 87,
Park Royal Road, London, N.W. l0.

and the blurring associated with crossmodlation.


There is no tone control, bat this ;s
not necessary as the balance is just right
for medium and long waves and the slight
excess of top for short wave work can be
used by those with the necessary skill as
an indicator for accuracy of tone.
We
were particularly impressed with the good
reproduction of pianoforte tone, which is
a searching test for clear quality, and on
other types' of transmission the results
were such as to -invite longer listening than
was strictly necessary to arrive at an
estimate of the tonal balance.
In the matter of sensitivity the receiver
maintains the high standard which the
'

Pilot designers have always set themselves,


and the short-wave range is outstandingly
good from this point of view. American
transmissions were picked up in the places
where one expected to find them at full
programme strength' and the only indication that this was not one of the more
expensive mains models with an RF stage
was the prevalence of double tuning points
and self-generated _whistles.
In some
cases, however, it was possible to avoid a
whistle by going to the repeat point of the
station higher up the dial.
Selectivity on long waves was sufficient
to enable the Deutschlandsender to be
heard between Droitwich and Radio Paris,
but in the absence of a tone control the

Circuit diagram of the Pilot Model B.43.


As the extension loud speaker jack switch breaks the anode circuit of the pentode output valve the jack
should not be inserted without connecting the external loud speaker or an equivalent load.

Wpe02,

JUNE 23rd, 1938.


Pilot Model

557

WOOF'sild

B.43-

side-band splash was a little too strong for


prolonged listening.
Elsewhere on the
long -wave -range separation of stations
adjacent in wave length presented no
difficulty, and on the medium waves not
more than 2 channels were lost on either
side of the London Regional transmitter r t
a distance of 15 miles.
Measurements of current consumption
gave 0.74 amp. from a 2 -volt accumulator

strengthening fillets which in the ordinary


way would be pinned. The overall
dimensions are 171 in. x 14 in. x 9 in.
To sum up, the B.43 is a battery set
with unusually bright and clear quality of
reproduction, a lively performance on all
three wavebands and only second channel
interference to distinguish it from more
expensive models. An ideal second set for
the week-end retreat in the country or by
the sea.

mutual conductance values just given are


for operating voltage of 120 only, which is
the usual amount of HT supplied for a battery set. The filament current is o. r amp.
at 2 volts in both cases, and the valve will
stand a maximum of ro mA " cathode
current," by which is meant the sum of the
anode and screen currents. The valves are,
of course, directly heated.
With 120 volts on anode and screen grid,
the SP2D requires -r4v, grid bias, under
which conditions the anode current is
r mA. The VP2D would in the quiescent
state be giving a grid bias of -3 volts when
the anode current is about 3.5 mA. The
anode current cut-off point for this valve is
ro volts grid bias.
approximately
Even when the valves are operated with
lower screen potentials, quite good mutual
conductance values are obtained; the
VP2D, for example, with 75 volts on the
14- volts GB, has a slope of
screen and
1.o5 mA/V. The anode current then falls
to 1.3 mA, and the screen current is o.6 mA.
Thus quite economical operation is possible
if necessary, yet still maintaining quite high
efficiency in the valve.
Some tests were made with these valves
in the detector stage of a short-wave receiver, regeneration being obtained by joining the negative of the filament to a tap on
the coil and inserting an RF choke in the

BATTERY
SHELF

,SUPPORTS

2nd
DETECTOR

VALVE

L22DD

FREQUENCY

CHANGER
VALVE
T P 23

OUTPUT
VALVE

AMPLIFIER
VALVE

PEN.

24

VP22

AERIAL

positive filament lead.


There was little to choose between the
two valves oh wavelengths down to about
12 metres, but below this the VP2D was
definitely the better, as oscillation was much
easier to obtain. Indeed, the valve oscillated readily down to just below 5 metres
using quite an orthodox circuit.
The top grid connection contributes to its
efficiency on the ultra -short waves, as the
input capacity is reasonably small.
The valves are not particularly small
physically, for they measure 4jin. high overall, and the bulb diameter is ri`in. at the
widest part. They cost rrs. each.

EARTH

TWireless World

EXTERNAL SPEAKER
PLUG -SWITCH

COPYRIGHT

General view of interior of Pilot B.43 with battery shelf removed to show positions of valves.

and an average of io mA from a 12o-volt


HT battery. Fluctuations of total HT
current under the influence of AVC or
from outer causes did not amount to more
than 1 mA.
The circuit is simple and straightforward
with a single -tuned circuit preceding the
triode -pentode frequency changer on all
On the short-wave
three wavebands.
range the anode potential on the oscillator
is increased. The intermediate frequency
is 451 kc / s and the first IF transformer
AVC derived from the
is iron cored.
primary of the output IF transformer is
applied to the grids of both IF and frequency changer valves. A delay voltage
is taken from a tapping point on resistance
providing automatic bias for the pentode
output valve.
There is provision of an external loud
speaker of the high -impedance type which
is connected through a plug switch with a
two -position rotary action.
Without batteries the set is remarkably
light, but the cabinet is well put together
and screws are used for many of the

New Tungsram RF
Pentodes
BATTERY VALVES FOR USE ON
SHORT AND ULTRA=SHORT
WAVES

TWO battery RF pentodes just introduced


by the Tungsram Electric Lamp Works
(Great Britain), Ltd., will interest battery
set users, as these new valves have 'been
designed to give a good performance on the
short- as well as on the ultra -short wavelengths.
The control grid is brought out to the
top cap in both valves, while the other electrodes connect to a seven -pin base of standard pattern.
Particularly good for battery valves is the
mutual conductance of these new pentodes,
it being 1.7 mA/V for the SP2D, and
2 mA /V for the VP2D. The first mentioned
is a " straight " RF pentode, and the other
is a variable -mu type.
The screen grid will take the same potential as the anode, and 15o volts is the maximum for these electrodes. However, the

PORTABLE PA. Intelligible speech can be


heard up to oo feet on a zo-degree beam
with this new Telefunken outfit. The amplifier output is rated at zo watts.

The Wireless World, June 23rd, 1938

558

UNBIASED
The Real Reason

By

IHAPPENED to drop into my local


radio dealers the other morning with
the cathode-ray tube from my television
set in order to get its emission tested, as,
when carrying out some experiments the
other day, I accidentally got the HT and
LT connections mixed up, and it has
never seemed quite the same since. While
the dealer was searching round frantically
for his test gear among the other old junk
which usually clutters up the counter of
the average radio retailer, I fell into a
conversation with him about the excellent
results which the B.B.C. have had lately
in connection with their outside telemissions, more especially the Derby. In the
course of our conversation he warmly commended the recent Editorial in The Wireless World wherein it was stated that, in

FREE GRID
natural that a slump should follow when
the reception of these programmes in
Brighton and one or two other places had
revealed that from the gaiety point of view
the Paris programmes left a lot to be

desired.
On mature consideration I cannot help
feeling that there may, after all, be a good
deal in this suggestion, as I know full well
from personal experience that people who
have never been to Paris have an altogether erroneous impression of its so-called
gaieties and have got in their minds a
totally wrong idea of what -a casual stroller
would be likely to see were he passing
through Montmartre on a fine Sunday
morning.

when orchestras were first introduced into


restaurants as a background to eating.
The orchestra was originally brought into
use in restaurants when people's manners
in eating were even worse than they are
to-day, and the music was intended to
drown the noise which some people insist
on making when consuming their soup.

The Reward of Invention


IT

is always gratifying to an inventor to


find that his ideas have proved of value
to the community at large even on those
occasions when he is not reaping a
pecuniary reward commensurate with his
labours. It was, therefore, with a warm
glow in my heart that I observed in the
pages of The Wireless World the other
week a brief note which indicated that it
is now possible for people practising on
an electronic organ to wear a pair of headphones to ensure that only they can hear
the horrible noises they are producing.

Television and the Daily


Drool

IF

IIIIIINN1IIJ1I

Its so-called gaieties_

spite of these outstanding successes, the


public still remain apathetic towards television.
The most interesting fact which emerged
from our conversation, however, was that
during the few weeks preceding the Derby
sales of television sets had been comparatively good and had only recently suffered
a decline.
This situation seems very
paradoxical, as one would have expected
that the great success of the Derby tele mission would have boosted sales still
further. The dealer had, however, his
own explanation of this apparently contradictory state of affairs, and I must say
that there seems to be something in it, and
I am, therefore, passing it on to you for
what it is worth.
He contended that the increased sales
of a few weeks ago had nothing whatever
to do with Derby Day anticipations, but
were brought about by the fact that there
had been rather a lot of talk about the
recently started regular series of television
programmes from the Eiffel Tower station.
The increased sales, said the dealer, were
solely due to the totally false idea which
people possess of the supposedly much
greater gaiety of Paris television programmes compared with those emanating
from Alexandra Palace, and it was only

there is one thing more than another


which pleases me about the development of television it is that when it
becomes really universal it will, to a very
large extent, counteract the horrible habit
which many people have of letting their
loud speakers drool away all day as a sort
of background to whatever activities they
are pursuing. Although it will not occur
for many years, eventually, of course, all
programmes will be accompanied by vision
and this pernicious habit will be checked.
If I had my way I would fill in the interim until the full consummation of the
great invention of television by cutting out
the ios. licence business and fitting each
receiver with a coin-in-the -slot meter.
People would think
twice before they kept
on putting their
pennies in to listen to
some of the rubbish
that is churned out on
the ether, while, at the
same time, owing to
the large number of
programmes to which
people really are prepared to pay to listen the B.B.C. would
reap a far bigger revenue than it does at
present, and the extra money could be
devoted to a speeding up of the television
development plan, thus hastening still
further the final end of this horrible habit.
This diurnal drooling business, although
fostered to a Iarge extent by broadcasting,
had its origin many years ago, of course,

Only they can hear the horrible noise.

I find on reference to my laboratory


notebook that it was just four years ago
that I invented this device in connection
with one of the little female Grid Leak's
piano lessons, and I actually published
details of it in The Wireless World of
June 29th, 1934. This problem of the
distracting din made by children at their
piano lessons is, of course, centuries old,
and evidence is available that it was not
unknown in the Stone Age, as specilpens
of primitive pianos have been discovered
by the side of which have been found the
fossilised remains of children whose skulls
bore the evidence of having been struck
with what police surgeons usually describe
ass "some blunt instrument."
In the case of my invention my first
efforts consisted of merely enclosing the
entire piano, with the exception of the
keyboard, in a sound -proof cabinet, a
microphone being connected to the headphones worn by the little Grid Leak and
its music instructress. This crude idea
did not satisfy me for long, however, as
the whole piano had to be taken out of
its sound -proof case when I wished to use
it personally to entertain Mrs. Free Grid.
Eventually, therefore, I rigged up a PA
system in the room, a switch being
arranged so that this could be connected
to the microphone inside the piano whenever I gave a personal performance.

The Wireless World,

Jane 23rd,

1938

The Great Ohms Muddle

\D THE

S my fan -mail does not amount to

such dimensions as to necessitate


the help of a calculating machine
for its analysis, after the manner
of a recent effort by the B.B.C. Listener
Research Department, the following classification of readers is pure surmise. There
are some who are properly trained and
can knock off impedances with a slide
rule as easily as grandma tells the time
by looking at the clock. At the opposite
extreme there are those who make no
attempt to understand even such elementary technicalities as my highly simplified and predigested explanation of
Ohm's Law published some time ago. But
Z believe that the vast majority belong
to what might be described in current
political terms as the centre party. That
is to say, they-probably you-can talk
about shoving in a bit more capacity here,
or dropping a few more volts by increasing the resistance there, and can ask the
man in the shop for a three-o's-five condenser, but want to change the subject
when somebody starts talking about reactance.

Confusing the Ordinary Mind


It always seems to me that unless one
has had the advantage of a proper technical -school training, or possesses that
natural brilliance of intellect that one
reads about in books with titles like
" Pioneers in Science," the theory of radio
must be terribly confusing. This sort of
thing :
" Ohms are the units of resistance, and
the current in a circuit can be calculated
by dividing the volts by the ohms (Ohm's
Law). But that applies only to DC ; in
AC circuits the current is equal to volts
divided by impedance, and impedance is
made up of resistance and reactance (but
not just by simply adding them), and reactance is of two kinds, one made up of
frequency and inductance, and the other
of frequency and capacity, and if you add
both sorts of reactance together the result
is less and may even be nothing at all
(this is resonance). And both sorts of
reactance are measured in ohms, too, but
they are different ohms from the resistance
kind, because they have nothing to do
with the power in the circuit, and they
depend on frequency. Impedance is
measured in ohms as well, but they have
to be multiplied by the power factor for
calculating power. Inductance and capacity' are not measured in ohms (thank
goodness !) and do not depend on frequency (until one gets into the advanced
" and so on. And if that sounds
class)
too easy there are always conductance
and admittance and reluctance and
susceptance and remanence and leakance
to bring up as reserves.
It rather looks as if the fellows who
worked out these definitions and things

...

tried to make it as difficult as possible so


as to keep the reputation for learnedness
to themselves. Actually, that is quite
wrong, and it may surprise you to hear

By

"CATHODE RAY"
that calculation in electrical units is so
much simpler and more convenient that
people who have difficult mechanical
problems to solve sometimes convert their
masses, forces, and so on, into the analogous electrical units and then back again.

Like learning to swim or drive, or-if


we could remember it-walk, the ability
to visualise impedance presents its worst
difficulties at the start and requires a
somewhat determined effort to accomplish, but is worth while to anyone who
wants to understand circuits, for it is
quite truly the key. In AC circuits impedance takes the place of resistance in
Ohm's Law for reckoning the current due
to a given voltage. Because I guess that
most readers have not yet safely crossed
this pons asinorur (forgive the veiled insinuation) I usually try to steer clear of
impedance and reactance and all the rest
of them for fear they would just be con -

OL

in frequency. The reactance of a component can be almost anything, and, indeed, several different things at one and
the same time if currents of several different frequencies are flowing simultaneously ; so it seems to be very much " up
in the air " and difficult to visualise. That
is unfortunate, for, as regards understanding how circuits act, it is reactance that
is easy to apply, and inductance and capacity that are more distantly concerned.
Of course, lots of much more capable
exponents have taken a hand in explaining the whole business in simple and clear
fashion, but they all seem to approach
from the inductance and capacity side,
which makes the problem seem far more
complicated, even if it does inspire a certain amount of confidence by starting off
with familiar quantities. I want to try
the experiment of starting with what for
the time being may be unknown-reactance-and linking it up later with what
for many readers must be the comparatively familiar ground of inductance and

capacity.
First to dispose of the great ohms
muddle. How can there be different sorts
of ohms, and why? Imagine, if you will,
a game of blow -football (it gives one less
of a headache to imagine than to play it).
If only one person blows down the table,
he brings a certain' force to bear on the
ball and it moves down the table. The
force might be stated in ounces, or preferably a smaller unit, such as grammes. If
more people blow in the same direction
their forces are added to give the total.
That is the straightforward sort of business we all like.

Complications
But now suppose somebody at the side
of the table decides to complicate matters
by blowing. He can blow with a force of
so many grammes. But to get the total
force acting on the ball you cannot just
add his force in with the rest. It is at
right angles to the others, and, combined

Fig. 1. One way of adding things that are


the same but not quite the same. The lines are
drawn to scale to represent the quantities
indicated.

fusing. Yet it seems to be permissible to


refer to inductance and capacity quite
freely in semi -technical circles. I suppose
the reason is that one can talk of the inductance or capacity of a component as
something definite, without having to drag

with them, tends to make the ball take


an oblique path. If you draw lines representing to scale the forces on the ball you
can get the total by the simple geometrical
construction shown in Fig. i, and if you
remember anything about the famous
Theorem of Pythagoras (all about squares
on hypotenuses) you will be able to get
it by calculation ; thus Z (the total force) =
4/R2+X2 where R and X are the forces
down and across the table respectively.
And now introduce third party, sitting opposite the cross -blowing person.
He blows across the table in the opposite
direction, and if his blow is exactly as
strong as his opponent's the two forces

Weg@gg

-6o

The Great Ohms Muddle-

will cancel out and the ball will be impelled down the table just as if the people
at the sides didn't exist. But if the side
blowers are not the same strength, then,
as they are exactly opposite, it is easy to
calculate the total effect due to them by
subtracting their forces. Or another way
of saying the same thing, one that appeals
more to the mathematical mind, is to distinguish one of the side forces by calling
it negative and then adding it to the
other. Then, if one sidesinan exerts a
force of XL grammes and his opponent
blows Xc grammes, it is easy to see that
the total force on the ball due to all three
blowers is 1/R2 + (XL Xc)2.
The object of this game has been to
show that you can have a number of
things measured in the same unit
(grammes, for example, or ohms) and yet
not quite the same. Just because everybody round the table is blowing so many
grammes, it is not right simply to add
them all together and say that is the total.
If you have ever been so misguided as
actually to play this game, you will know
that everybody can be blowing his hardest
and the ball stands more or less still in
the middle. You must be careful not to
follow this illustration any farther, because ohms do not correspond with forces
or directions, but it does happen that the
total of ohms in a,n AC circuit is calculated in exactly the same way, and for
this purpose it is helpful to picture the
various sorts of ohms as acting in different
directions. But, of course, this must not
be applied literally to directions in a
circuit. Impedance, the total impeding
effect in a circuit, is denoted by Z ; resistance, of course, is R, and reactance is
X, subdivided into XL, the reactance due
to inductance, and Xc, due to capacity.
As with the forces at right angles to one
another, R can never be simply added to
X to give the total, Z. One must use the
formula already given. Or it can be done
by drawing lines on paper, as in Fig. r.
But first of all, if there are both XI. and
Xc in the same circuit they should be combined into one term X by simple subtraction.

JUNE 23rd, 1938.

WOHCo1
screen -grid valve connected as a dynatrdn. Reaction coupling is another way of
introducing negative resistance. So it is
possible to wipe out resistance in a circuit,
just as it is possible to wipe out inductive
reactance by bringing in an equal quantity
of capacitive reactance. That accounts for
many of the things one does in radio circuits to get certain effects.

-800 OHMS

200

VOLTS

;300

Negative Resistance
XL and Xc are opposite numbers and
can both exist in a circuit together without making any difference to the impedance Z if they -happen to be exactly
equal. By the way, I suppose you have
noticed that if reactance is nil the formula
Z= VR-+(XL-Xc) reduces to Z=R'?
That is a very important state of affairs
and is the object of tuning. But, leaving
that for the moment, is there a similar
opposite number to R ? Well, there is such
a thing as negative resistance, although it
cannot exist as a property of a simple component, because as resistance absorbs

power, negative resistance obviously must


be capable of putting power into a circuit,
and that involves batteries or generators
of some sort. One of the simplest forms
of negative resistance is provided by a

OHMS

perly been fitted already with a minus


sign) add XL to Xc to give the net X.
That is - 240 ohms, and, being negative,
shows that it is a capacitive reactance.
Now square it, giving 57,60o. Note that
the minus sign disappears. The square of
R is 9o,000. Adding we get 147,600. The
square root of this-384-is the impedance in ohms. So if the voltage applied to the circuit in Fig. 2 is, say, 200,
the current is given by the simple Ohm's
Law as 384, or 0.521 amp. Easy? And
if you do not care for square roots you
can do it with the help of a ruler on paper,
as in Fig. r, allowing, say, loo ohms per
inch or any convenient scale.

Reactance, Capacity and


Inductance

560 OHMS

Fig. 2-Example of an AC circuit that


can easily be calculated as described.

The foregoing method of reckoning


applies only to resistances and reactances
all in series. Parallel circuits and complex
circuits of all sorts can be derived from the
same fundamental formula in various
ways.
Still granting that we may pot be clear
about what reactances really are (that is
one of the next things to tackle), but
assuming they are given to us in sealed
parcels with their numbers written on the
outside, we should now be able to calculate the impedance of any series circuit.
To inspire confidence about this, here is a
simple example (Fig. 2)
inductive reactance (XL) = 56o ohms.
Capacitive reactance (Xc) = - 800 ohms.
Resistance (R)
-=300 ohms.
Impedance (Z)
=a
Well, first of all (as Xc has very pro -

:-

This ability to work out impedances is


by itself not of much practical value, because Wireless World circuit diagrams
never have reactances marked on them,
although they do have resistances. And
for the very good reason, already mentioned, that the reactance depends on the
frequency of the AC that is or may be
applied. A single condenser may have
to,,deal with a frequency of 5o c/s from
the mains, with anything up to about
10,000 c/s audio signal and anything up
to 1oo,000,000 c/s radio frequency. And
its reactance will have correspondingly
different values. So the next thing will be
to get a firm grasp on the way reactance.
capacity and inductance are related.
And then we shall have the key to the
reasons for the choice of certain values for
components, and the innumerable effects
that can be got by juggling about with
these three things, R, L and C.
Continued in our next
!

Television Programmes
Sound
41.5 3_Ijcs.
THURSDAY. JUNE 23rd.
3, Cabaret. 3.25, British Movietonews. 3.35,
157th Edition of Picture Page.
9, Swing music presented by Eric Wild. 9.20,
Gaumont-British. News. 9.30, 158th Edition of
Picture Page. 10, News Bulletin.
FRIDAY, JUNE 24th.
11.30 a.m.-12.30, O.B. from Lords, the Second

Test Match between England and Austrialia.


2.30, O.B. from Lords, continued. 3.30,
" Yours Faithfully," entertainment by Marcella
Salzer. 3.30, Gaumont-British News. 3.50-5,
O.B. from Lords, continued.
9, Starlight. 9.5, British Movietonews. 9.15,
A.R.P. Demonstration of Gas -proofing a Room.
9.30, Film. 9.45, " The Old Firm's Awakening,"
a comic opera in one act by A. J. Talbot, the
music by Alfred Reynolds. 10.5, News Bulletin.
SATURDAY, JUNE 25th
11.30 a.m.-12.30, O.B. from l.orils of the Test
Match.
2.30, O.B. from Lords, continued. 3.30, In
Our Garden, C. H. Middleton.
3.40, British
Movietonews.
3.50-5, O.B. from Lords,
continued.
9, Cabaret.
9.25, Gaumont -British News.
9.35, " Thread O' Scarlet," a play by J. J. Bell.
10, :yews Bulletin.

Vision
45 Mies.

SUNDAY, JUNE 26th.


8.50, News Bulletin. 9.5-10.15, " The Tragedy
of Julius Cxsar," by William Shakespeare.
Title role played by Ernest Milton, Antonius by
D. A. Clark-Smith and Marcus Brutus by

Francis L. Sullivan.
MONDAY, JUNE 27tH.
11.30 a.m.-12.30, O.B. from Lords of the
Test Match.
2.30, O.B. from Lords, continued. 3.30,
Hildegarde. 3.40, British Movietonews.
3.50-5, O.B. from Lords, continued.
9, Cabaret. 9.30, Gaumont -British News.
9.40, Talk. 9.55, Cartoon Film. 10, Music
Makers. 10.10, News Bulletin.
TUESDAY, JUNE 28th.
3, Excerpts from " Wild Oats." 3.45, GaumontBritish News. 3.55, Cartoon Film.
9, " Badger's Green," comedy by R. C. Sheriff.
10.15, News Bulletin.
WEDNESDAY, JUNE 29th.
3, "Follies of 1938." 3.30, British Movietonews.
3.40, " The Old Firm's Awakening " (as on
Friday at 9.4.5)
9, Starlight. 9.10, Cartoon Film, 9.15, Friends
front the Zoo. 9.30, Gaumont -British News.
9.40, Clothes Through the Centuries. 10, News
Bulletin.

The Wireless World, June 23vd, 1938

AIR TRANSPORT

'561

N EWS

Wireless Components by
Aeroplane

RECENT traffic census


carried out by Imperial
Airways reveals the remarkable
extent to- which air transport is
used in the wireless industry.
Not only does this form of conveyance reduce the time element
to a matter of hours instead of
days, but it dispenses with
elaborate packing and makes
breakages practically unheard

OF

NATIONAL
EMERGENCY
SERVICE

THEWEEK

Three Stations to Cover Britain


problem which is
exercising the mind of the
B.B.C. is whether two, or perhaps three, zoo-kilowatt stations could cover the British
Isles effectively in the event of a

TO-DAY'S

NEW B.B.C. CHIEF


Points Appertaining to the Succession
ALTHOUGH Sir John Reith's
not been
announced at the time of going
to press, it is hardly likely that
the B.B.C. will be without a
Director -General for any length
of time after his final departure.
There is no doubt that the
Government will influence the
Board of Governors in the
matter of the new appointment.
Administrative
experience
must be a necessary quality of
the new Director-General, and
both Mr. Cecil Graves, Deputy
successor

of.

Firms who at one time found


it necessary to keep large stocks
of components at their branches
abroad, to ensure against running short of supplies, now find
that urgent orders can be fulfilled in a few hours. The result
is that supplies in hand can be
kept down to a minimum with a
subsequent saving in floor space
and the certainty of stocks being
fresh.
While heavy batteries and
accumulators still go by steamer,
during practically every working day throughout the year a
consignment of wireless valves
leaves Croydon by air, and the
General Electric Co. uses this
transport medium for well over
5o per cent. of its deliveries to
Paris.

has

tor-General is 6,000 a year,


but an extra sum is granted by
way of honorarium in connection with expenses of the office.
In Sir John Reith's case this
amounted to 1,000 per annum
over some considerable period.
Finally, it is of interest to observe that under the section
" Organisation " in the B.B.C.
Charter it is stated that : " The
Corporation shall appoint such
officers and staff as they may
think necessary (including any
Director-General) for the efficient

national emergency assuming


such serious proportions that
the closing -down of most of the
transmitters became unavoidable. It is a foregone conclusion
that only those transmitters
which are more or *less remote
from air raids would be able to
continue in service. In the construction of Start Point, therefore, provision is being made for
a power unit of zoo kilowatts,
although, it should be added,
that power may not be used
when the station first comes into
service next spring. Burghead,
in Scotland, operates at present
on a power of 70 kilowatts,
capable of increase to roo kilowatts. These two transmitters,
with the addition of Droitwich,
can, it is estimated, serve the
whole of the British Isles.

EARPHONE INDUCTION
SYSTEM
Independent Listening in Public
Rooms
THE principle of inducing

AN AMERICAN ON

TELEVISION
They Have a Poor Impression
of Our System

visitors to the
States,
notably
B.B.C. officials, several of whom
have been over there recently,
have been surprised to note the
scepticism which exists respecting television in England. The
idea appears to be widespread
among Americans that such
television as has been carried
out in this country can but be
elementary and unreliable, that
nothing in the nature of a regular service is available for
viewers. Mr. John Royal, Vice President in charge of proof the
National
grammes
Broadcasting Company, who
was in London a few weeks ago,
is doing a good deal to correct
this impression. He has just
stated in an interview that television is far from being a dismal
failure in England. While he
was here, he says, he was given
facilities by the B.B.C. for witnessing many television programmes, and they were very
successful. Among his statements
in the American Press is the following " I saw, among other
things, the Scotland -England
football game on a television
screen. I *had never seen that
sort of contest before; nevertheless, it held my interest. The
photographic detail was' excel-

BRITISH
United

Sir John Reith

lent."

Director - General,
and Sir
Stephen Tallents, Controller of
Public Relations, possess this
quality.
Mr. Graves has the
wider knowledge of broadcasting, and he is commended in
certain influential circles for his
successful launching of the Empire Service, to which the
Government attaches the utmost
importance. It is true, however,
that there has never been any
right of succession at Broadcasting House for any position.
In fact, it has been the invariable rule to pass over those who
appear to be the most likely
candidates and make unexpected appointments.
The basic salary of a Direc-

transaction of their business, and


shall fix such rates of remuneration, including that of the
Director -General as they think
proper."
The control of the Corporation
is in the hands of a Board of
Governors which is constituted
by politically appointed members.
Whether a parliamentary
grant will be made to Sir John
Reith for his services remains to
be seen, but it is almost certain
that his retirement from the
B.B.C. will carry a peerage
with it. He is a man of great
capabilities, with the profoundest
sense of responsibility and devotion to duty.

electrical energy into earphones by means of a widely


distributed magnetic field has
been receiving enthusiastic attention from the Press. One of its
practical applications was demonstrated last week by Mr.
C. M. R, Balbi at Grosvenor
House, London.
A turn of wire from the extension loud speaker terminals of a
wireless receiver was taken
round a room in the hotel.
Chairs in the room were f urnished with coils of wire round
their legs, and it was shown that
signals of comfortable intensity
could be heard by means of earphones wherever the chairs were
placed.
The system is particularly well
adapted to hotel reception halls
and public rooms where the use
of loud speakers is obviously impossible.

"IN TOWN TONIGHT"


ENDING

Its Outstanding Successes


ATURDAY, July 2, sees the

last of the present series of


In Town To -night " broadcasts, a feature which, since the
lamentable passing of A. W.
(" Bill ") Hanson, has been
conducted by C. F. (" Mike ")
Meehan. The producer has himself formed a definite opinion as
to the most successful of the
season's output. Beauty, the
'

Wfir@Ilmo

562

JUNE 23rd, 1938.

WopIlc

News of the

of signal will be dealt with

Week-

talking budgerigar from Bradford, heads the popularity list.


Mary Lamb, the young Cumberland shepherdess-" the girl

with the open-air voice " and a


name that stamps her as having
been born to the life of a tender
of sheep-was the most successful woman broadcaster. Among
the men whom " In Town Tonight " has featured during the
series now ending, the most successful has been Robert Donat.

LOOKING AHEAD
Vault to be Opened in 8113 A.D.

SARNOFF,
DAVID
President of the Radio Corporation of America, recently
delivered the address in dedication of the stainless steel door
of " The Crypt of Civilisation "
at the Oglethorpe University.
This is an airtight vault in which
MR.

at

the receiving station although it


is hoped that CW and ICW will
predominate.
The tests are held in connection with the RSGB Annual 56Mc /s. Field Day, and owners of
stations wishing to arrange
schedules for the Saturday tests
should write to Mr. Mitchell,
" The Flagstaff," Colwyn Bay,
as soon as possible.

EXPERIMENTAL
TELEVISION
THE telecommunications division of the Municipal College, Portsmouth, is on the air
with television. At present, lowdefinition

pictures

are

being

radiated on 3o megacycles and


they have been well received
by one of the students at his
home in Bognor Regis. Progressive experiments with 405 -line
pictures are in hand at G6PU.

will be stored away every con(including


ceivable
broadcast receivers) which typifies the period 1900-1950. The
inscription on the door is appended by the names of President Roosevelt, Eugene. Talmadge (Governor of Georgia),
and the President of the University, who was responsible for
the founding of the crypt. Posterity is placed upon its honour
not to unseal the door until the
year 8113 A.D.

article

SHIP -TO-SHORE RADIO


ABOUT two hundred of Iceland's fleet of seagoing fish-

RECORD " O.B."


SCHEDULE
ARECORD mileage of Post
Office lines will be used by
the B.B.C. during July for a
series of broadcasts of sporting events.
The calendar of
sporting transmissions will include
the
following : -The
Wimbledon Tennis Championships on July 1st and 2nd ; the
King's Cup Air Race from Hat-

field on July 2nd; the 'Varsity


Cricket Match from Lords on
July 2nd, 4th and 5th; the
Third Test Match from Old
Trafford on July 8th, 9th, nth
and 12th ; the Gentlemen v.

Players

Cricket Match from


Lords on July 13th, 14th and
15th ; a Village Cricket Match
on July 16th ; the Fourth Test
Match from Leeds on July 22nd
and 23rd ; Polo from Hurlingham on July 4th; the Open Golf
Championship from Sandwich
on July 7th and 8th ; Great
Britain v. Norway Athletic
Meeting from the White City on
July 9th ; the A.A.A. Championships from the White City on
July 16 ; another Athletic Meeting from the White CityPrincetown and Cornell v. Oxford and Cambridge-on July
23rd ; Water Sports from Wembley on July 9th the Fourth
Speedway Test Match-England
v. Australia-from West Ham,
on July 12th ; and the Final
Stage of the King's Prize Competition from Bisley on July
16th.
;

ing vessels are equipped with


Post Office radio - telephonic
Calls can be put
apparatus.
through to any subscriber ashore
at the rate of 1.5 kroner
(approximately Is. 4d.) per
period of three minutes.
This service is the result of
experiments successfully carried
out by the Icelandic Post Office
in 1932 when the significance of
such a scheme was appreciated
by the authorities and then

FROM ALL
QUARTERS
Radio in Schools

number of schools registered for listening in April, 1935,


was 3,656; in April, 1938, it was
8,25o; and by the end of last
month this number had increased
to 8,477. Of the total 8,250, 891
were secondary schools and 7,359
were elementary and other schools.
THE

quickly taken advantage of by


owners of small craft.

LISTEN TO SNOWDON
APORTABLE 56 -Mc / s station
will be operated from the
summit of Snowdon by Mr.
David Mitchell, GW6AA, from
17.00 to 23.0o hours (BST) on
July 2nd. At the close of the
tests the associated receiving
station GW6AAP will stand by

Thou Shalt Not

amateurs have been hear


using the 14 Mc/s band for short distance messages, thereby preventing trans -oceanic stations on
this DX band from being worked
by other local stations.
Increasing use of the local 1.75 and
3.5 Mc/s bands is being made by
the more thoughtful home operators.
MANY

/s for calls from stations which have logged but not


56 -Mc.
contacted Snowdon.
transmissions will recommence
on July 3rd at 09.00 hours and
continue until 15.00 hours, when
GW6AAP will be ready to
receive reports until about 17.00
hours. All reports should give
the exact time that signals were
heard as aerial systems will be
continually changed ; any type

Mr. A. Parsons, senior lecturer


in telecommunications of the
College, is anxious to hear from
those interested in wireless
research who would like to take
part in the work.

on 1.7 Mc

Listening Groups
Not
TELEVISION ESCAPE.
part of an elaborate set ready
for a thrilling rescue before the
cameras, but the new method of
raising the transmitting aerial
of the B.B.C. mobile unit. It is
an improvement on the mast
aerial, which took almost as long
to erect as the period of test
transmissions

rapid development of listening discussion groups in Britain


has resulted in spreading an entertainment -with-instruction form of
leisure activity throughout the
country, and the total number of
groups in the spring of the present
year comes to 756, as against 407
for the corresponding period in
THE

1937.

U.LR. Programmes

examinations of
the readjustment of European
wavelengths based on the findings
of the Cairo Conference are taking
place at the summer meetings of
the International Broadcasting
Union at Ouchy, Lausanne. These
meetings will in all probability be
terminated on July 2nd. The
eventual settlement of the present
wavelength problem will be made
during the 'conference of the
European Administration which
will take place in Switzerland next
February.
PRELIMINARY

New Noise Law

operation of excessively
noisy loud speakers in Bristol will
be a punishable offence under
new by-laws which come into
THE

force on July 1st.

Daventry ARP Shelter


SPECIALLY
designed ARP
shelter for the protection of the
staffs of the Empire and Air
Ministry radio stations at Daventry is being constructed in
Borough Hill.
A

Traffic Controlled by Radio


o?der to facilitate the management of congested traffic in the

is

Preston and Blackpool districts,


radio control boxes are being built
for the police.

British Film on N.B.C. Television


" THE Return of the Scarlet
Pimpernel," Korda's film production, was televised in its
entirety in New York from the
Empire State Building. This is
the first American broadcast of a
full-length feature film, and just
how long the film industry will
allow such transmissions to continue is a matter for speculation.
W3XAL Expanding
BRITISH listeners to American

short-wave transmissions are to be


provided with improved facilities
by the National Broadcasting
Company of America. Two new
25 -kilowatt short-wave stations
are in course of construction at
Bound Brook, designed to give
greater signal strength in Europe
and all parts of Central and
South America.
These new
stations will operate through four
directional beams and two nondirectional aerials.
Go -Ahead Columbia

the past six months


over seventy pr cent. of stations
belonging to the Columbia Broadcasting System have increased
their power, or have installed
various types of new high-fidelity
equipment and vertical antennas,
besides introducing other improvements. Most of the C.B.S.
stations have this year installed
a new automatic programme amplifier, which provides an average
increase in signal reception that
is equivalent to doubling the
transmitter power.
DURING

Conservation of Matter
exceptional demand for
current to work wireless receivers
picking, up the Test Match commentaries in Sydney, Australia,
has imposed such a strain on the
local power station that 4o tons
more coal than usual were used.
THE

,;

The Wireless World, June 23rd, 1938

Television

on the

Continent

THE POSITION IN FRANCE


AND GERMANY
N Europe we are standing more or
less on the threshold of television,
which has been promised to the
public many times, but, except in
England, has failed to materialise as a
practical service. We, in this country,
have now had a good year's experience,
and the B.B.C. presumably know what to
expect both as regards the expense of running television and the public response to
it. The British wireless industry has also
had time to take stock, and clearly intends to make next winter a television
one.

Profiting by our experience, .France


took the plunge last March and opened a
Transmis455 -line high-power station.
sion standards will shortly be stabilised
officially to allow the industry to embark
on a programme of receiver construction
in the assurance that no radical change
will be made for several years.
Germany is on the threshold, but much
less information on future plans is obtainable in Berlin than in either London or
Paris. So far as anything approaching
a regular service is concerned, the i8oline system, complete with a 25 -frame
flicker, still prevails in the original form
in which it was introduced in 1935. But
to anyone who has seen (as I have) demonstrations of 441 -line pictures, it is
obvious that, technically speaking, German engineers are well capable of producing good high -definition pictures, and
in fact a 441 -line service is shortly to be
established. It is known that two mountain -top transmitters are under construction, but with these and a third low-level
station Germany will only be able to serve
25 per cent. of her population ; roughly,
the same proportion as is served in Eng-

land by the single transmitter at the


Alexandra Palace.
Doubt has been expressed as to whether
the extra 5o lines (455 lines as compared
with our own 405) of the pictures put out
by the Paris transmitter are really worth
while. By the time this appears in print
the French authorities may have announced a final standard of perhaps 405
or 441 lines.
Be this as it may, most

Le Materiel Telephonique (L.M.T.), the firm


that installed the Eiffel Tower Station, is
carrying out field -strength tests around Paris
with the help of apparatus installed in a van.

siderably more detail, particularly noticeable in big scenes. ' The picture is surprisingly clear and steady. M. Mallein, Chief
Television Engineer of the P.T.T., kindly
arranged for me to visit the studios and
also demonstrated the new film scanning
apparatus, which is now undergoing
tests. It seems very satisfactory, and is,
I believe, entirely French.
L.M.T., the firm responsible for the
A reproduction of this picture forms the
Eiffel Tower interval signal.
Paris television transmitter installed in
French engineers seem to be in favour of the Eiffel Tower, was equally accommothe larger number of lines, and, after dating, and allowed me to accompany
of its engineers' on a trip in a motor
careful comparison of reception in both one
van
to investigate signal strength at
Paris and London I have reached the conclusion that the French system gave con- various distances. An ordinary commercial receiver was installed in the van, on
which was mounted a doublet aerial with
a co -axial feeder connected at the centre ;
maximum height was about 21 feet.
At a position about 21 miles north of
Paris near the banks of the Oise, some
220 feet below the direct visual path from
the top of the Eiffel Tower, we had satisfactory and clear reception of the afternoon programme.
The receiver was
operated from batteries through a DC / AC
converter, and the only interference encountered was from passing cars.
L.M.T.'s engineer is continuing his tour,
'and hopes to find a spot where both Eiffel
Tower and Alexandra Palace will be
receivable He thinks that good pictures
should be obtainable from E.T. on the
South Coast of England.
Efforts are being made by means of
public demonstrations to interest the
Parisian public in television, and the industry is busy with the design of receivers,
which will presumably be released in time
In the Paris Television Studio: this photograph, taken from the visitors' gallery through a window,
for the Grand Palais Exhibition in the
shows Mlle. Suzy Vinker, the announcer.
autumn.
!

The Wireless World,

June 23rd, 1938

Magnetic and Ionospheric Storms


1;;

W.

'd'.

BE\ \INGTON

ON April 16th of this year there


occurred a " magnetic storm " of
exceptional severity; in fact, of an
intensity which has very seldom
been equalled during the present century.
This was considerably greater than that
of the severe " storm " which occurred on
January 25th this year, and in connection
with which, it will be remembered, a remarkable
display of the Aurora
Borealis was seen.
The term " magnetic
storm " is here taken to
mean only what it actually
implies, i.e., violent and
abnormal fluctuations of the
terrestrial magnetic forces. It
does not include (as it sometimes is made
to do) the associated abnormalities in
radio wave propagation. These are more
properly defined by the term " ionosphere
storm," since they are evidently due to
the ionosphere, and not to the magnetic
disturbance. In this article, therefore,
the radio fade-out will be referred to as
an " ionosphere storm," and this will also
serve to distinguish it from fade-outs of
the Dellinger or " short-period " type.
Records of the magnetic disturbance
were obtained on the magnetographs at
the Abinger Observatory, some details of
which were published in Nature of April
23rd and 3oth. From these it appears that
the magnetic storm began at 0548 G.M.T.
on April 16th, with a sudden change of
45 minutes in' the declination. Magnetic
declination is, of course, the angle between the magnetic meridian and the
geographic meridian, and a change in it
thus represents a change in the direction
of the earth's magnetic field.

are associated with, particular characteristics in radio wave propagation, then


they do in fact form part of that science.
And there are several points in connection
with this particular event, or rather
sequence of events, which are of sufficient
significance to warrant attention.
The first point to notice is that April
16th is 81 days from January 25th, the day on which
the Aurora Borealis was
seen in England, and previous magnetic and ionosphere storms occurred.
The mean time taken for
the sun to complete one of
its rotations is about 27
days, so that it had made
exactly three rotations between January
25th and April 16th. Furthermore, it
would present a similar part of its "surface to the earth on April 16th as it presented on January 25th.
On April 16th a large number of sunCause of the Disturbances
spots were visible, among which two
appeared to be in a highly active state.
On the whole, it does seem justifiable
The first appeared on the sun's east limb to assume that it is corpuscular radiation
on April 8th, when their area was 1,50o from the sun which causes these magnetic
millionths of the sun's visible hemi- disturbances, although our knowledge is
sphere. Situated in solar latitude 27 N., as yet incomplete.
If the corpuscles
they crossed the meridian on April 14th were ejected at an angle normal to the
and reached the west limb on April 20th. sun's surface from a position near the
When the magnetic
meridian they must
storm started they
have travelled at a
were thus about
speed of roughly
ADISCUSSION of the relationtwo days past the
600 miles per
ship between the severe magnetic
meridian; a very
second in order to
significant point.
cover the distance
storm of April 16th and the assoFor if, when on the
in the time inciated disturbances of radio propameridian and,
volved in the storm
gation. Although these matters are
therefore, " pointof April 16th. The
ing " directly at the
sunspots were
not completely understood, our
earth, they had
known to be in an
knowledge of their nature grows with
been emitting radiaeruptive state long
each succeeding disturbance.
tion of a corpuscubefore they reached
lar type, this corthe meridian, and
puscular stream
if the solar radiawould have been able to reach the earth. tion producing the disturbance had been
Furthermore, it would have done so of the electromagnetic-wave type the
when the sunspots were past the meridian storm would thus have occurred much
as seen from the earth. If it is justifiable earlier.
to assume that the 'magnetic storm is
Another point is that the disturbances
caused by these corpuscles, then the were, as is usual, more intense near the
lapse of time between the meridian pas- earth's poles. If the particles possess an
sage of the spot and the start of the electric charge, as seems likely, they
storm is a measure of the velocity of the would be attracted towards these regions
corpuscles.
by the magnetic forces of the earth.
The evidence from the disturbance of
There is a further interesting point in
January 25th is, however, not as favour- connection with the disturbance of April
able, for on that date no sunspots were 16th. Although the magnetic storm did
in a position just past the meridian. A not commence until 0548 of April 16th,
very large sunspot, and one that has the ionosphere storm was already in
been thought to be responsible for that progress by the evening of April 15th.
particular disturbance, was, in fact, just As far as can be ascertained American
disappearing over ,the west limb. At broadcast stations on the 21, 15 and
first sight it appears that the disturbance
11 Mc/s bands faded out some time beof January 25th was one which did not tween 2 and 4 p.m. G.M.T. on that day.
obey the rules at all.
Certainly by 6 p.m. G.M.T. very few long-

Nature of the
Recent
Disturbances

Abnormal Magnetic Conditions


Almost immediately after the storm
started phenomenally large ranges in the
magnitude of the terrestrial magnetic forces
began to occur, such as to render it difficult for the magnetographs to follow
them. The declination varied by as
much as 5 degrees 7 minutes, while both
the vertical and horizontal components
of the earth's field underwent large
changes in magnitude, the maximum
changes in the horizontal force amounting to about one-twelfth of the total force
in that direction. The greatest activity
took place between o600 and o800
G.M.T., but it was not until 163o G.M.T.
that day that magnetic conditions again
became normal.
It may perhaps appear that terrestrial
magnetic phenomena, and even the solar
disturbances which give rise to abnormalities in them, are not an essential part of
the science of radio communication. But
in so far as these occurrences produce, or
.

It must be remembered, however, that


the 27 -day rotation is only a mean. The
sun's rotation is, in fact, not uniform
over its whole surface, and for the position occupied by the spots of April 16th
a slightly longer time would be taken to
complete the rotation. This, however,
does not help much, as will be evident
after a few moments' consideration. It
may be possible, however, that the
January 25th storm was caused by corpuscles ejected at a different velocity,
and so took longer to reach the earth
than those of April 16th.
It is of interest to add that the sunspot
group of April 16th again appeared on
the east limb on May 4th, and reached
the meridian on May loth. Though of
smaller area than during its last meridian
passage, it still appeared to be active, and
was responsible for another magnetic
storm which started on May 11th. On
this occasion the storm was of a lesser
intensity.

WfilleIlgg

JUNE 23rd, 1938.

565

'lpDcl
Magnetic and Ionospheric Storms-

distance signals were audible on these


bands, and no American broadcasters
were among them. At 9 -p.m. G.M.T. only
very few 9 Mc / s stations were heard, and
these were weak signals and subject to
deep and rapid fading. Conditions were
still very bad on April ith and 17thin fact, it was not until the afternoon of
April 18th that reception began to become
normal.
A peculiar feature is that at the height
of the disturbance some long-distance
signals on very high frequencies, i.e.,
28 Mc / s, became audible for a short
period. This has been noted in previous
disturbances, notably during that of
January 25th. It seems possible that
these waves may be propagated at these
times via a lower layer whose ionisation
level is somehow increased as a result of
the disturbance.
As far as normal propagation is concerned, however, it is generally assumed
that in this type of disturbance communication fails, because of inadequate bending of the F layer, owing to the fact that
the ionisation level there is reduced by the
storm. This must -be so, because it is
always the higher frequencies that fade
out first during these disturbances, and,
further, measurements of the F layer criti-

cal frequencies indicate that on magnetically disturbed days these are always lower
than normal. The F layer critical frequency is, of course, that which just penetrates it at vertical incidence. From this
it seems certain that during ionosphere
storms propagation deteriorates because
the waves can penetrate the F layer.
But why should the ionosphere storm
commence so long before the magnetic
storm? It is almost certain that both are
due to the same cause, i.e., bombardment
of the ionosphere by corpuscles from the
sun. Yet radio -wave propagation failed as
a result of this, about 14 hours (in this
case) before the earth's magnetic forces
became affected. Note also that the magnetic storm did not commence gradually,
as one might expect if it were due to -some
cause to which the ionosphere was more
susceptible, but started with a violent
change in the magnetic forces, and reached
its maximum intensity within an hour.
It will be seen, therefore, that the
matter is as yet by no means clearly
understood, though, with each succeeding
disturbance more and more knowledge is
gained. It seems certain that the answer
to these problems must eventually be
found, and the subject appears to be one
which is particularly suitable for future
observation and investigation.

Letters to the Editor


The Editor does not necessarily
endorse the opinions of his
correspondents

Relays
a considerable amount of debunking
AS going
on in the pages of your journal,
is

(harmonic distortion, for instante) .,may I


take this opportunity of doing a little debunking myself, especially as regards the
letter of Mr. T. J. E. Warburton, published
in May 19th issue, and the subject of Relay

schemes in general?
How very true Mr. Warburton's second
paragraph is, until he decides, presumably
for anyone else but a Relay Subscriber, that
the system is inefficient.
The proof of the pudding is in the eating. The writer is connected with the running of a relay scheme, and from his experience can honestly say that the only limit

to the continued expansion of stations is the


return expected on capital involved in an
enterprise that does not know what the
G.P.O. will do.
That a Post Office, or any other Relay,
would be a less satisfactory system than a
set to the average listener in the long run
has not been proved in The Wireless World,
and the fact that losses to a Relay Service
-in some cases 90 per cent.- are nearly
always due to circumstances other than dissatisfaction with the service or system
makes the writer believe there is, and must
continue to be, room for both sets and
Relay.
To close, if I may encroach on your space
a little more, I would point out that the
most delightfully simple method of guiding
a wave has eluded your writer of April 7th,
who tried carefully to disprove the practicability of relaying television. What I
refer to is the use of one line and that good
conductor of nearly infinite cross-section,

the earth. Ope company has had an O.H.


line insulator in use three years which caters
for this method.
PRAXIS."

of them) it might never have been. I would


like to quote some of Espley's five-year-oid
Proc. I.R.E. paper to show why, but am
afraid of provoking a lightning strike of
To
The Wireless World compositors.
describe it as mathematical would be putting it very mildly. Then Bartlett wrote
some plain English in The Wireless -Engineer
in 1935 that interested me in the subject.
And then Harries.
My remarks on harmonic distortion being
relatively unimportant were not claimed to
be " heretical " on the grounds of novelty
or departure from fundamental principles,
but because there is singularly little evidence of its being the accepted view even
among the highest-browed professionals,
much less the humbler devotees. I have
hundreds of manufacturers' laboratory
valve sheets dealing with harmonic distortion, but except for those prepared by
Harries I have seen none at all suggesting
that such a thing as intermodulation exists.
Can it then be well known among the beginner's section of The Wireless World
readers to whom I hopefully address my
words?
" CATHODE RAY."
.

Unusual Interference
interference described by Mr. B. H.
THE
Grose in your issue of May 19th appears

to be due to cross-modulation, probably


caused by an oxydised contact between the
water -pipe and some other mass of metal.
When the pipe is disturbed this contact is
either made good or entirely disconnected,
so causing interference to cease.
If this is the case, then efficient bonding
and earthing of all metal parts adjacent to
the pipe should cure the interference. Alternatively, as the field of this type of interference is usually fairly low, a good outdoor
aerial with screened down -lead may effect a
cure.
L. J. WALMSLEY.
Nottingham.

Receiving Licence and Buying


been a regular subscriber to your
JHAVE
journal for years, and have always been
under the impression that it was published

Superhet Nomenclature
still seems to be the custom to refer to
Il' the
detector stage in superheterodyne re-

ceivers as the " second detector." Surely,


now that the term " first detector " has
been superseded by the more correct terms
" frequency-changer " and " mixer," no
confusion is likely to arise if the word
' second " is omitted.
A. CHESTERMAN.
Christchurch, Hants.
`

Debunking Harmonic Distortion


BENHAM describes my deof harmonic distortion as
lucid (I rise to bow) but deplorably unnecessary (I drop back again discomfited).
It is very disconcerting to the history
master, who is revealing to his class that
the date of William the Conqueror's accession to our throne was 1o66, when Prof.
Oman walks in and says he has heard that
one before. The criticism seems unfair,
somehow.
So it is when a radio engineer comes into
my elementary class and tells it that Mr.
C. Ray is putting one across them by
representing intermodulation as something
hot off the press.

Of course, it has been dealt with before ;


but so far as my imagined readers are concerned (Mr. Benham is not meant to be one

largely for the keen private experimenter


and constructor.
In a recent issue the writer who hides
himself under the alias of "Diallist " upholds a suggestion which has previously
appeared in your columns, viz., that a receiving licence should be shown when purchasing radio apparatus.
This obstructionist idea would be extremely inconvenient to the home constructor, since, as you must be aware, we have
to order most of the stuff we need through
the post, and the occasions when components, etc., are bought over a shop
counter are comparatively rare. Are we
to send our licences to the dealer with every
post order?-.
Again, how would " Diallist " define radio
apparatus? I might require valves and
components for a gramophone amplifier, and
not use a radio receiver at all. Would he
propose making a licence necessary for all
gramophones?
In case you should imagine that I am a
" pirate" and " denounce " me to the
P.M.G., I would like to say that I am a
H. BLIGH.
licence holder.
London, N.4.
.

W. E.
lz.bunking

The Wireless World, June 23rd, 1938

Random Radiations

"DIALLIST"

By

Why Sunday Morning ?

normally preferred." The report goes on to


say that it has been found so difficult to improve the " sound " insulation of existing
buildings that new ones should be most
carefully planned. Just what a nuisance a
noisy loud speaker next door (or some distance away in summer time, when windows
are open, for that matter) many know by
bitter and maddening experience. The
worst of it is that any distortion present in
the receiving set is brought out to the full
when the strains of its loud speaker reach
you either at close quarters through a wall
or at a distance through the air.

APITY-wasn't it?-that the London

versus Dublin Spelling Bee was marred


by a good deal of interference. Apparently
the trouble was with the land lines, so that
any " technical hitch " (blessed phrase )
that occurred really was outside the
B.B.C.'s control. But why on earth did they
choose Sunday morning of all times?
Strictly speaking, it was afternoon since the
time was 12.3o, though most of us reckon
the morning as ending at lunch time rather
I
than when the clock strikes twelve.
should imagine that the number of listeners
was very small, for at that time on a fine
Sunday most people would be out of doors.
Surely the end of the afternoon or the middle
of the evening is a far better time for broadcasts of that kind. There may, of course,
have been some difficulty in getting the
teams together except in the morning,
though I should hardly think this could be
!

so.

Words, Words, Words


So much for that particular Sunday; now
for a plaint about Sundays in general. The
single news bulletins that we have on Sundays are the subject of my grouse. I have
never been able to understand why such a
large proportion of them is devoted to quotations from speeches. It's true that there
is a lot of speechifying done by politicians
and others on Sundays; but many of the
speeches made (and quoted i:t extenso in the
news bulletins) are of the kind which may
be described as using a multitude of words
to say nothing that really matters. " Speaking to -day at the Annual Conference of Hairdressers at Little Hogsbury, Mr. Bohun-

Hedde said that, dark and difficult as the


outlook was, he was confident that there was
a bright future ahead if every man, woman
and child would pull together to ensure the
prosperity that is the age-long inheritance
of this country." And that kind of thing.
As we get only ten minutes in the news on
Sundays I think that the B.B.C. might very
well cut the cackle and come to the 'osses.
Incidentally, if they did so they would lay
themselves much less open to those charges
of political bias that are flung at their heads
by people of such widely different shades of
opinion.

ti

No New Thing
As a matter of fact this problem of preventing the transmission of unwanted sounds
from one building to the next, or from an
upper room to that below, is no new thing,
though it has come ihto prominence during
the last few years owing to the fact that
something like two homes out of three are
now equipped with loud speakers: In the
pre -wireless era the nuisance was usually due
to little Miss Jemima's scales and five -finger
exercises on the piano, or to young Master
Willie's painstaking though often fruitless
efforts to scrape the fiddle with a minimum
of wrong notes. Our forefathers went in as
a rule for something rather more effective
than mere nine -inch walls. And they knew
one most valuable tip which may even be
revived by the modern builder.
Their
method of sound deadening was to use a
thick layer of oyster shells or cockle shells
packed between the floor of one room and
the ceiling of another, or built into a party
I don't know why it should have
wall.
worked, though work it certainly did. One
of the quietest houses I ever knew was,
strangely enough, the home of a large
family of very noisy youngsters. When it
was pulled down to make way for new buildings masses of shells were found; there must
have been tons of them.

ti ti

The Englishman's Home


TO judge from its recently published
report, the Building Research Board of
the Department of Scientific and Industrial
Research has had a pretty busy time during
the past year in dealing with wireless
problems. At first blush such things might
seem to be rather outside its line of country;
but they aren't really. The radio queries
that come the way of the Board are concerned mainly with ways and means of preventing the nuisance caused by loud
speakers that speak too loudly in the homes
of next-door neighbours. It is rather surprising to read, as reported in last week's
Wireless World, that " the conventional
nine -inch party wall in semi-detached buildings does not provide sufficient insulation
to reduce to tolerable limits the sounds
transmitted from a wireless loud speaker or
gramophone working at the sound level

Broadcast Programmes
FEATURES OF THE WEEK
THURSDAY, JUNE 23rd.
Nat., 7.25, " Rhythm Express," with
Ben Frankel and his Orchestra.
8.40, " Airways and the Future of
Transport," talk by Nigel Tangye.
Reg., 6, " The Silver Spoon," a
comedy with music. 7.30, Talk by
F. L. Stevens on Rivers and Canals
under London. 8.40, An excerpt
from " Follies of 1938." 9.20,
" Abracadabra "-Rites, Spells and
Incantations.
Abroad.
Munich, 7.15, " The Mastersingers,"
opera (Wagner), from the Opera
House, Nuremberg.
Vienna, 7.25, " Pagliacci," opera
(Leoncavallo), from the State Opera.

Reg., 1.15. Test Match Commentary.


7.30, Sid Merriman and his Music.
9, Hungarian Gypsy Party. 9.45,
" A.R.P."
Talk by Herbert
Morrison, M.P., and Commander
Firebrace.
Abroad.
Stuttgart, 8, Festival Concert for first
Reich Students' Congress, relayed
from Heidelberg.

FRIDAY, JUNE 24th.


Nat., 5.30 and 6.25, Commentaries
on First Day's Play of the Second
Test Match, England v. Australia.
7.30, Madrigals-B.B.C. Singers
(A). 8, " The Old Music Hall."
9.20, Your Visit to Scotland;
advice by Compton Mackenzie.
9.35, International Society for
Contemporary Music ; orchestral
concert.

Reg., 6.40, Roy Fox and his Band.


8.15, Emlyn Williams in " We Are
Not Alone," a radio play by James
Hilton and Barbara Burnham.
9.15, An excerpt from " Pleasure
on Parade."
Abroad.
Cologne, 8.15, " The Merry Widow,"

SATURDAY, JUNE 25th.


Nat., 12.30 and 6.25, Test Match
Commentaries. 6.40, " The Playwright and the Box Office
discussion. 8, Palace of Varieties,
including George Robey, Harry
Hemsley and Tommy Handley.
9.20. American Commentary.

"-

operetta (Lehr).
Leipzig. 9 p.m. -1 a.m., Radio Ball
from Dresden.

SUNDAY, JUNE 26th.


Nat., 12.15, Olive Groves and George
Baker in Musical Comedy Songs.
5.30, Sonata Recital by Arthur
Catterall, violin, and R. J. Forbes,
pianoforte. 9.5, Theatre Composer
Series-II. Franz Lehr:
Reg., 5, Harry Davidson and his
Orchestra. 6.45, " Diplomacy," a
romantic comedy. Cast includes
Yvonne Arnaud, Ronald Squire
and Esm Percy.
Abroad.
Radio -Paris, 8.30, Anglo-French Concert from the Salle Gaveau -Raugel
Choir and National Orchestra,
conducted by Inghelbrecht.

MONDAY, JUNE 27th.


Nat., 5.30 and 6.20, Test Match
Commentaries. 7, The Bungalow
Club. 8.40, " Mixed Doubles."Variety.
9.20, World Affairs.
9.35, Julian Clifford conducts
B.B.C. Orchestra (B) with Leopold
Meunzer, pianoforte.
Reg., 12.30 and 1.20. Test Match
Commentaries. 6.30, Teddy Petersen and his Band from Copenhagen.
8, " Wool," a story of Yorkshire
life. 9, " Hail Variety " 9.45, A
Visit to the Empire Exhibition at
Glasgow.
Abroad.
Cologne, 7.55, Upper Bavarian Folk
Melodies.
Bucharest, 8.35, "Quartet in E Minor,"
(Verdi).
!

TUESDAY, JUNE 28th.


Nat., 4.40, The Royal Visit to Paris.
Commentary by. Thomas Woodrooffe, from the Place de la
Concorde, during the passing of
Their Majesties. 5.30 and 6.25,
Test Match Commentaries. 7,
Carroll Gibbons and his Orchestra.
8, Film Musical, " Jack Ahoy."
9.20, My Best News Story.
Reg., 12.30 and 1.20, Test Match
Commentaries.
8,
" RaggleTaggle "-through Eastern Europe
with a fiddle. 8.30. Canterbury
Festival of Music and Drama. The
Boyd Neel Orchestra from the
Cathedral Cloisters. 9.40, Rhythm
Classics.
Abroad.
Vienna, 7.20, " Madame Butterfly,"
opera (Puccini).
Radio -Paris, 9.30, Shakespeare Gala,
from the Comedie Franaise.
WEDNESDAY, JUNE 29th.
Nat., 6.40, 7.45, 9.50 and 10.50,
The opera " Figaro " from Glyndebourne.
Reg., 6.30, " General Release," songs
from current films. 7.45, From the
London Streets-II, -with Jay
Wilbur and his Band. 8.30, The
World Goes By. 9, Dance Cabaret
from Bournemouth. 9.40, Speedway Commentary from New Cross ;
England v. Australia.
Abroad.
Vienna, 8, " So we Live," German
Folk Songs from Klagenfurt.

WpC_3Pg

JUNE 23rd, 1938.

567

OpIld
Not So Bad as All That
IT was rather surprising to find a professional musician of eminence, Mr. Edric
Cundell, to wit, Principal of the Guildhall
School of Music, roundly accusing the
B.B.C. of having missed a golden opportunity of educating the public's taste for
good music.
I should have said myself,
though I am no musician, that the -B.B.C.
had almost worked miracles in that way
in less than sixteen years. Of course, there's
light and frivolous music in the programmes,
a good deal of the sort of stuff that was once
described as sounding like a very sticky
sweetmeat, and no small amount of dance
music. But can Mr. Cundell seriously contend that the man in the street hasn't now
opportunities galore of hearing good music
that couldn't possibly have come his way
without the aid of the wireless set and the
loud speaker? I am sure that in his heart
of hearts he can't. There's plenty of good
music in the programmes most days, and
when you come to think of the " Proms,"
opera from Covent Garden and Glyndebourne, the Toscanini concerts, relays from
Salzburg, Paris, Berlin, Budapest, Stockholm, and other European cities, you'll see
how unfounded this charge is. Perhaps the
surest proof that the B.B.C. has not missed
its opportunities is to be found in the vastly
increased knowledge of music shown by the
ordinary man and woman now as compared
with sixteen years ago.
-.

--

-.

to 3o feet above its source, I have certain


doubts on that point. My own transmission line short-wave aerial is quite 3o feet
above the neighbouring road. It certainly
lessens this kind of interference, though it
doesn't entirely get rid of it. And still we
have no legislation on the subject, and still
one reads of more and more new cars, many
with strongly radiating ignition systems,
going on to the roads every week. We certainly can't hope for any immediate relief,
for when we do get an anti -interference law
at least three years of grace will probably
have to be given to cars and strong pressure
may be brought to bear to make the period
of grace five years or more. And that's

SWEEPING LIBERAL -

LABOUR SUCCESS
Conservatives & Unionists
Soundly Trounced

Government's 354 Majority


A Personal Triumph For
New Premier

that.

L -.
Those Demonstrations
HOW badly receiving sets
%

are often de monstrated to the would-be purchaser


by the would-be vendor
It's by no
means uncommon to find appallingly bad
!

local interference when a set is switched on;


I've known this caused by a charging plant
on the premises
The average uninitiated
listener who hears any station that is tuned
in accompanied by volleys of crackles and
bangs quite understandably concludes that
the set is not all that it might be and is not
particularly impressed by the demonstrator's airy comment, " Oh, that's just local
interference don't pay any attention to
those noises " He can't help paying attention to them. And haven't you often heard
the set that isn't tuned to exact resonance?
And the one that is shown off with its tone
control knob in the most boomy position?
I'm quite sure that you have.
!

;
!

Long Range Interference

IN

the full report of the reception of the


Alexandra Palace television programme
near Middlesbrough it is stated that most
of the interference experienced came from
motor cars-or, rather, from their ignition
systems. It is also stated that the aerial was
some 300 yards from the road along which
the cars were passing. Such a long range
for interference radiated by ignition systems is probably exceptional actually, the
receiving apparatus had to be made specially
sensitive owing to the great distance
between its Aerial and that of the television
transmitter. But even with a normal super het containing a good radio-frequency stage
and one efficient IF stage I should put down
the horizontal range of car interference at
a good 15o yards. This means that every
vehicle with a radiating ignition system that
travels on the roads carries with it a circular zone of interference some 300 yards in
diameter.
And despite published statements that the height to which such interference rises vertically is not more than 25
;

Scientific Acoustics PA
loud speaker with Junior
PM unit and three section 72 -inch horn.

Scientific Acoustics PA Loud


Speaker
THE moving-coil unit upon which tests
were carried out was the "Popular"
PM model at 5 guineas. Two horns were
tried, the " Junior " at {3 5s. for mobile
work with 38 -inch air column and i8 -inch

flare, and the 72 -inch horn with 32 -inch


flare at L7 17s. 6d. The latter is built up
of cast aluminium sections with a spun
metal flare.
In both cases we were very much impressed by the high electro-acoustic efficiency of the equipment and the obvious
concentration of the energy in the band of
frequencies most likely to give good articulation in speech and clear-cut reproduction
of the type of records generally selected for
PA work. Percussive transients were projected with excellent attack, and although
there was some bias towards the higher frequencies
sybilants were
not overemphasised.
The frequency response showed a smooth
rise up to 4,000 cycles, and a fairly rapid fall
above this frequency, checked at about
9,000 cycles by a subsidiary resonance. The
lower cut-off in the case of the small mobile
horn was in the vicinity of zoo cycles, but
the larger model gives uniform response
down to no cycles, which conveniently
avoids any residual hum which may be
present in the amplifiers.
The unit tested has an " Alnico " magnet
with a flux density of 12,000 lines and a
fabric -reinforced alloy diaphragm.
The
power-handling capacity is conservatively

rated at 10 watts.
The makers are Scientific Acoustics, Ltd.,
Wembley Hill Estate, Middlesex.

Britain's New Prime MinisterSir H. Campbell-Bannerman


(Elliott & Fry Ltd.)

.. that was is
1906
In these days of Tariffs, it is often forgotten
that in the General Election of 1,906, the Free
Traders-led by Sir H. Campbell-Bannermanscored a smashing success
majority of no
less than 354 seats in the House of Commons.
How things have changed
And Policies, too.
But not all things, nor all policies. T.C.C., for
example. Started in 1906, T.C.C.'s policy has
remained constant. For 32 years T.C.C. have
made condensers-nothing else. They have made
th:m better and better. They have increased
efficiency a hundred -fold. And the constant factor

-a

has

been-and

always will

be-dependability.

Unknown in 1906-famous today. Known and


trusted wherever condensers are used-T.C.C.

T.C.C.
ALL-BRITISH

CONDENSERS
THE TELEGRAPH

,WALES

CONDENSER CO.LTD.
FARM RD. NORTH ACTON,W.3

59'2g;

The Wireless World, June 23rd, 1938

Recent Inventions
DIRECTION -FINDING

THE directional response of a


frame aerial can he represented as a figure -of -eight curve,
drawn to polar co-ordinates. In
such a curve, the rate-of -change of
radius is greater in the minimum
or " zero " position than in the
position of maximum signals, so
that the former is used to give the
more accurate bearings of a dis-

tant transmitter.

The object of the invention is


to improve the sensitivity of a

frame or other directional aerial


in such a way that the rate -ofchange of signal strength is increased both for the maximum and
minimum positions. This can be
done, for instance, by varying the
" gain" of an amplifier valve
coupled to the aerial, so that it
accentuates any change of signal
strength at either of the two
" critical " positions. Or a nonohmic rectifier, the resistance of
which decreases with increasing
current, may be used to secure the
same result.
L. L. Kaess. Application date
June 22nd, 1936. No. 481961.
o

MOSAIC SCREENS FOR

TELEVISION

THE picture to be transmitted

is projected by a lens L on to
a photo -electric screen M of the

mosaic-cell type. Electrons are


emitted from the screen in varying
numbers according to the degree
of illumination of each elementary
area, and corresponding positive
" point charges " are set up and
stored on the screen. A parallel
mesh -work grid S is located in

Television transmitting CR tube


described in the text.
close proximity to the screen M.

The scanning stream from the gun


C of the tube is focused (by means
not shown) so that it passes
through the meshes of the grid S
on to the screen M. The potential
of the screen must be held negative, relatively to the cathode (or
source of the stream), so that the
latter is retarded after it passes
through the grid S where its
density becomes subject to control
by the point charges on the
screen. The resulting signal currents are collected on a transparent
collecting plate P and lead away
for amplification.
Since the negative bias of the
screen M makes it difficult to focus
the electron stream sharply on its
surface, the auxiliary screen S is,
according to the invention, given
a positive bias relatively to the
mosaic screen M so as to produce a
positive field in the immediate
vicinity of the screen. This is

The British abstracts published here are prepared with the


permission of the Controller of H.M. Stationery Office,
from Specifications obtainable at the Patent Office, 25,
Southampton Buildings, London, W.C.2, price 1/- each
A selection of patents issued in U.S.A. is also included.

"load." In assembling the magnetron it is usual to mount the


cathode across two supporting
wires which are sealed into the
glass " pinch " at one end of the
tube, the anode being supported
from the opposite end.
a lens L on to the mosaic screen S
It is essential for efficient operof a cathode-ray tube T. The re-_
sulting stream of electrons is ation that the cathode should be
accurately centred between the
focused by the usual means (not
shown) on to a fluorescent screen two halves of the anode, and the
normal method of assembling the
F, and the picture so produced is
electrodes renders this difficult.
then scanned by an electron stream
According to the invention, the
cathode and the two halves of the
anode are both carried by supporting wires which are scaled into
W
the hase or " pinch " of the tube.
jT
This makes it possible to centre
the cathode between the two anode
P7
N.,
plates, before sealing both the electrodes into the glass in one operP2
ation.
The two anodes are connected
W1
together by a single loop of wire,
which extends upwards and forms
the main oscillatory circuit. This
Scanning system for television
is coupled to a pair of Lecher
transmitter when films are used.
wires, which are sealed into the
top end of the tube and extend
downwards.
from the " gun " or cathode which
N. V. Philips Gloeilampenis located at the far end of the
Fabrieken. Convention date (Gertube from the screen F.
many) June 12th, 1936.
No.
The compensating movement
482557.
necessary to immobilise the picture
0 0 0 0
on the screen F, in spite of the
CATHODE.
constant movement of the film P, A DUAL-PURPOSE
RAY TUBE
is imparted to the electron stream
IN
addition
to
the
main stream
by the control field from external
of electrons, which passes
windings W, \V1, which are eneraxially through a cathode-ray tube
gised by a saw-toothed current on to the fluorescent screen,
the
supplied from a suitable source.
cathode C is coated with a lower
Telefunken Ges fur drahtlose
emitting -surface as shown at CI.
Telegraphic m.b.h.
Convention This gives off a lateral
stream,
date (Germany), November 23rd,
which is amplified by a cylindrical
1936. No. 482812.
grid G and anode A, the output
o
o
o o
being used to supply the operating
CATHODE-RAY TUBES
potential for the first accelerating
TWO open -mesh grids are placed anode Ai of the main stream. Or
parallel to each other, just it can be applied to the deflecting
in front of the fluorescent screen
plates D. It will be observed that
of a cathode-ray tube. One carries a higher voltage than the
anode, and so serves to accelerate
the stream. The other, which is
nearer the fluorescent screen, is
fed with high-frequency oscillations from an auxiliary valve
generator.
Each positive pulse
from the valve serves to intensify
the impact of the electrons on the
fluorescent screen, so that the incoming picture signals can be apAl
plied to the grid of the auxiliary
valve, instead of to the grid of
the cathode-ray tube, provided the
valve oscillates at a sufficiently
high frequency.
A cathode-ray tube of this type
requires only comparatively low
operating voltages so that it can
be worked if necessary from DC
mains.
V. Zeitline, A. Zeitline and V.
Kliatchko. Application date October 21st, 1936. No. 481917.
CR tube which generates operao
o o o
ting voltage for one of the
SHORT-WAVE GENERATORS
accelerating anodes.
THE split-anode magnetron, as
used for producing ultra -short
although a common cathode is
waves, consists of a tube in which
the cathode is mounted between used, separate emissive surfaces
are used to supply the main and
two half -cylindrical anodes. The
latter form part of the main oscil- auxiliary streams.
Radio-Akt D. S. Loewe. Conlatory circuit, and are connected,
vention date (Germany), October
usually by a Lecher -wire coupling,
to the output aerial or other 14th, 1935. No. 483012.

Brief descriptions of the more interesting radio


devices and improvements issued as patents
will be included in this section,
stated to increase the effective
storage capacity of the screen S,
and to produce a more sensitive
response to 'the incident light from
the projected picture.
Baird Television, Ltd., and
P. W. Willans. Application dates,
October 8th and December loth,
1936, and February 25th, 1937.
No. 482959.

0000
INCANDESCENT SCREENS
THE usual fluorescent screen of
a cathode ray tube is replaced
by one consisting of particles of
tungsten embedded in carbon,
upon which an incandescent picture is formed by the bombardment of the scanning stream.
Although it is possible to produce
more brilliant effects in this way
than can be obtained from fluorescent light, the incandescent screen
tends to " lag " somewhat in its
response to the action of the electron stream, owing to thermal

inertia.

According to the invention, this


difficulty is overcome by subjecting the screen (during the interval
between successive scannings) to
a moderated bombardment by
secondary electrons, which are derived from the scanning stream,
and serve to maintain the screen

at a temperature just below the


" glow " point.
This not only
prevents any "lag," but also re-

duces the power expended by the


scanning stream in producing incandescence.
The metallised screen is spaced
a short distance away from a
meshwork grid, and a high -frequency voltage is applied between
the two. This produces a stream
of secondary electrons, which persists for a short time after each
scanning interval and serves to
keep the screen at a threshold

temperature.
Marconi's Tireless Telegraph
Co., Ltd., and L. M. Myers. Application date August loth, 1936.
No. 481434-

0 0 0 0

TELEVISING FROM FILMS


of scanning the film
INSTEAD
directly, the picture is first projected on to a mosaic photo -electric surface of the kind used in
the Iconoscope transmitter. This
introduces a " storage " effect
which helps to intensify the
strength of the signals. At the
same time, since the film is moved
at uniform speed past the projection apparatus, it is necessary to
introduce a compensating movement in order to keep the picture,
as projected on the photo-electric
surface, stationary during the
scanning operation.
According to the invention the
required movement is applied
through an electron -optical system.
As shown in the Figure, the successive film pictures P, Pr, P2 move
steadily downwards and are projected one after the other through
.

'

THE
PRACTICAL RADIO

JOURNAL
28 tit Year of Publication

THURSDAY, JUNE 30m, 1938.

No. 983.
Proprietors

Editor

EDITORIAL

Editorial,
Advertising and Publishing Offices
DORSET HOUSE, STAMFORD STREET,
LONDON, S.E.s.
:

Telephone Waterloo 3333 (3o lines).


Telegrams "Ethaworld, Sedist, London."
:

8-10, Corporation Street.

Telegrams
"Autocar, Coventry."

Telephone

32xo Coventry.

BIRMiNCHAM :

Guildhall Buildings, Navigation Street, 2.


Telegrams

Telephone

"Autopress,'Birmingham."
MANCHESTER

2971 Midland -(4 lines).

260, Deansgate, 3.
Telephone :
Blackfriars 4412 (4 lines).

Telegrams
" [lite, Manchester."
:

GL.Ascow : 26s, Bonfield Street, C.2.


Telegrams : " 18e, Glasgow." Telephone Central 4857.
:

PUBLISHED WEEKLY.

ENTERED AS SECOND
CLASS MATTER AT NEW YORK, N.Y.

Subscription Rates :
Home, Ls is. 8d. ; Canada, Ls is. 8d. ; other
countries, Li 3s. sod. per annum.
As navy -of the circuits and apparatus described in these
pages. are careered by patents, re.,ders are advised, before
mating use of them, to -satisfy thrmselnes that they would
not

be

intringing patents.

CONTENTS
Editorial ..
Choke and Transformer Testing
How

XLII.

No. 26.

ILIFFE & SONS LTD.

HUGH S. POCOCK.

COVENTRY

VOL.

is Designed.
Quality Com-

Receiver

XVII. --High

..

Page
569
570

munication Receiver

572

On the Short Waves

575

Notes on the Short-Wave Three

..

576

Unbiased ..

578

The Aerial Connection (Concluded)

579

C.E.C. Cathode -Ray Tube

581

News of the Week

582

Key to Circuits

. ,

..

584
585

Letters to the Editor

Random Radiations
Recent Inventions..

,.

588

590

Television Progress
Demonstrations in the Home
N the Editorial of our issue of June
9th we enquired why television, in
spite of its recent technical
triumphs, still failed to attract the
general public. None of the reasons that
are generally adduced seem to be in any
way convincing and we put forward the
suggestion that a carefully planned
questionnaire should be instituted.
Some of our correspondents have implied that in this article we ignored what is,
to them, the obvious reason-the smallness of the picture reproduced on ordinary
television receivers. It is, perhaps, significant that almost -without exception those
who put forward this view (with which incidentally we cannot agree) do not claim
to be viewers themselves ; in many cases
they admit that their ideas of ,television
and its possibilities have been formed as
a result of attending public demonstrations.
Those who actually possess receivers in
their own homes are almost unanimous in
agreeing that the present size of screen is
amply sufficient for domestic purposes,
and one is forced to the conclusion that
the demonstration of domestic television
receivers to unduly large audiences fails
to achieve the object of stimulating desire
for a set.
On the subject of television demonstrations in general the opinions of Mr.
G. R. M. Garratt, of the Science Museum,
South Kensington, seem worthy of the
closest attention. During the long series
of public demonstrations at the Museum,
which were attended by upwards of half
a million visitors, Mr. Garratt must have
had an unrivalled opportunity of studying public reactions. He suggests that the
psychological atmosphere of public demonstrations is not such as to fill the average
spectator with a burning desire to possess
a television set, even though he may be
more than willing to agree that it is a
marvellous technical achievement. But
the psychological reactions of such a man
to television in his own home are entirely
.

COMMENT
different ; put a receiver into his sitting
room and he will probably become wildly
enthusiastic, even up to the point of making every effort to retain the set in his
possession.
The inference of this is obvious.
If
demonstrations fail to attract, the industry
must, if only to break the ice, devise a
selling scheme whereby receivers are installed on approval, without -any obligation, in the home of the prospective, but
lukewarm, purchaser. Technically there
shold be little difficulty, as a transportable aerial for temporary installation could
easily be devised. Commercial difficulties
in the way of this plan undoubtedly exist,
but if home demonstrations are indeed so
valuable as has been suggested in inculcating the desire for television, it should
be worth while taking some trouble to get
even a few receivers into homes, as each
one so placed would help to sell others to
the newly converted " viewer's " friends.

B.B.G. Publicity
Apart altogether from the question of
demonstrations, however, there is a widespread feeling among television enthusiasts that the B.B.C. does not make effective use of the power at its command to
give sufficiently wide publicity to the
attractions of television and its achievements.
Within the last week or so -an
improvement in this direction has been
made by giving details of the evening television programmes at the end of the early
news bulletins, but we believe that . far
more could be achieved by the televising
of popular sound programmes, such as the
variety shows from St. George's Hall.
There can be no insuperable technical
difficulties, and the idea of being able to
see such shows as well as hear them would
be a tremendous " draw." Skilfully
phrased announcements during the show
itself would have a wide influence in
stimulating public interest in the advantage of vision. Further, no opportunity
should be lost of giving publicity to television broadcasts of national events. We
are convinced that such " actuality "
.transmissions are extremely attractive to
the public.

The Wireless World, June 3oth, 1938

Choke and
transformer Testing
THE IRON -CORED COMPONENT IN PRODUCTION
B

e'

" TEST ENGINEER "

10 many enthusiastic amateurs the

shorted turns is fundamentally simple, but


LF Choke is perhaps the least is capable of various applications. A
interesting item in a receiver. laminated iron core is constructed, with
Tucked away in some obscure projecting limbs over which the test windcorner of the chassis, it does its appointed ing will be placed. Balanced " pick-up "
job without " blue-glow " or noise, windings are arranged symmetrically on the
needing no adjustment, the strong, silent core, and an energising winding located
member o f the
to excite the iron
electrical fraternity.
circuit at a freYet to the engineer
METHODS of routine testing
quency usually
responsible for
as used in factories for
between 250 to 500
mass - production
checking audio - frequency_ chokes,
cycles per second.
testing, these iron A high -frequency
iron -cored transformers and similar
cored inductances
excitation current
components. Tests for insulation
present problems
will allow an inresistance, short-circuited turns, inquite as intriguing
creased flux density
dctance
value,
etc.,
are described.
and often -more inin -the test limb, and
volved than do the
hence produce a
more spectacular components.
higher voltage in the test coil. This will
The Test Specification for a typical obviously increase the possibility of breakinductance will probably stipulate the down in a coil where the insulation between
following
turns is suspected. A schematic drawing
I. DC Resistance-usually with wide is given in Fig. i.
tolerances. 2. Shorted turns test details.
When a coil with shorted turns 's placed
3. Breakdown test. 4. Insulation resiston the test Iimb, the induced current in
ance test. 5. Inductance, and for trans - the shorted winding will react on the flux
in the limb and
upset the balance of
+HT
the " pick-up " circuit. The " out of
TUNED TO
EXCITATION
FREQUENCY
balance " signal is

:-

fed to an indicating
device, usually an

amplifying valve
voltmeter, and a
limit figure is given,
derived from an

MT

BOBBIN UNDER TEST

Fig. 1.-Connections of the iron core, shown above, on which bobbins


are tested for short-circuited turns.

formers, both output and intervalve.


Ratio.
With test No. z the engineer's troubles
begin. As the completed bobbins leave
the winding machines, each is tested for
centinuity or DC resistance on a simple
galvanometer circuit, and if satisfactory is
passed to the short-circuited turns test.
An inductance with short-circuited turns
would prove unsatisfactory in use, its
value being low, while the induced current
in the short-circuited section would cause
local heating and probably a burn-out.
The system adopted for detecting
6.

average of a number of production


coils.

The windings are


then " ironed up "
and the gap pieces

inserted.

These
may be bakelite or

2.-A simple
form of bridge for
routine checking of
inductance values.
Calibration of the
control is in percentage inductance.
Fig.

Arrangement of core and bobbins for the


short-circuited turns test shown in Fig. z.

fibre strips, the dimensions of which are


standardised by the laboratory. The completed component then passes to the test
bench.
This section includes the equipment
necessary for the final tests of iron -cored
components, and is located at some
strategic point between the winding and
assembly shops. Here the completed
article is given the third of its specification
tests for breakdown.
The component must withstand a pressure of r,000 volts AC at 5o c/ s. The
safety of the operator is ensured by arranging for the parts to be jigged, a number at a time, and enclosed in a steel cage.
On closing the lid, the test pressure of
1,000 volts is " jumped" from windings
to windings, and from windings to core.
A breakdown will show by blowing out a
trip device or lighting a lamp or similar
indicator.
A megger or insulation resistance test
follows, consisting of the application of
50o volts DC through a limiting resistor,
the leakage current showing on a microammeter calibrated in megohms.
Test 5, for inductance, has given the
designer furiously to think.
The limit
tolerances for inductance are usually wide,
.

WhAQOg

JUNE 3oth, 1938.


Choke and Transformer

571

%Acl

Testing-

the minimum value alone may often be


stated, while for different ranges of
receivers different test conditions will
be stipulated. Power factor readings arc
of small.. interest to production and limits
are seldom given.
It will therefore be necessary to provide
equipment covering a wide range of inductance values, say from o.5 to so henrys,
to supply ripple voltages varying from 0.5
to 25, RMS, and standing currents up to
zoo milliamperes DC.
The obvious solution is a form of AC
bridge, and this is adopted by many
manufacturers. To cover production requirements it may be decided to supply
comparison standards, with the attendant
disadvantage of storing some 25 standard
inductances.
Alternatively, a single
standard inductance may be included in
the bridge with switched multipliers covering the necessary ranges. A simple form
of test bridge is shown in Fig. 2.
Provision is made for adjustment of DC
and ripple volts, while a resistor is included to increase the discrimination of
the bridge ; this can be calibrated to give
a direct indication of power factor.
In connection with general test procedure, a few points occur which are worthy
It is preferable to provide
of interest.
clamping devices to reproduce the gap

3.-A " continuity test " of inductance. The meter M is calibrated to read
inductance directly; its deflection depends
upon the voltage dropped across the noninductive resistance R.
Fig.

Two further circuits for ratio testing arc


given in Fig. 5. The first method (a)
gives a direct comparison against the
applied primary voltage and has the
virtues of simplicity and convenience.
The resistor R is
calibrated directly
+HT
in ratio, so the apRs
plication of the test
METER
SHUNT
is limited, but both
methods are Inde-

to the transformer primary and to measure


the output voltage across the secondary.
Precautions to be observed when so doing
are to load the secondary to the approximate working impedance, and to use a

O STANDARD
TRANS.

R1

pendent of test

voltage variation.
The second test
(b) simulates the
output stage in a reZERO
TEST
DJU STER
TRANS.
ceiver, the test
Q
transformer and the
standard comprisHT
ing the anode load
of the output valve.
The test frequencies
Fig. 4.-Schematic
are applied to the
diagram of a "ratio PLE MIETER
grid, the supply
meter."
SCALE
main forming a
convenient 50 -cycle
source, while a
local oscillator is
high-resistance voltmeter. A valve volt- arranged to provide an upper test fremeter is almost essential, even a high quency, usually 4 00o c / s. The middle
grade, 2,000 ohms -per-volt instrument will register is hopefully disregarded.
It is not claimed that such equipment
at best give approximate readings when
will
give laboratory accuracy; present
transformers.
intervalve
with
dealing
production requirements do not call for
such refinements. But there are signs of
the long-awaited public interest in quality
HT
reproduction, and the test engineer, in
designing equipment to cover such requireNt
ments, will perhaps not regret the headaches developed in so noteworthy a cause.

ti

CONTROL CALI 6 RATED


DIRECTLY IN RATIO

INDUCTANCE
UNDER TEST
240
SO

'\.

RIPPLE
VOLTS

16

iIds

HT

DC

ADJUSTMENT

SOURCE

CONTROL
POT.

dimensions obtained when the component


is screwed to the chassis. It is also advisable to provide shock -proof connections
to such gear, the " kick " experienced
when breaking quite small currents
through a high inductance is one to be
remembered.
A bridge test may be considered too
expensive or too slow, and a form of
continuity test, as shown in Fig. 3, may
The accuracy of the
be substituted.
bridge method is, in such a case, sacrificed
in order to gain a saving i operation
times.
The question of ratio testing on transformers is finally to be considered. The
simplest test, and one which is sufficiently
accurate for most purposes, is to apply the
mains voltage-presupposing AC mains.

Production, again, requires rapid and


more effective tests, and the " ratiometer "
has been developed to cope with this
demand. The basic circuit is simple, the
principle being to " back " the test transformer against a standard, and to measure
any out-of -balance volts on a suitable
indicator. A typical test circuit is shown
in Fig. 4.
The transformers are connected to the
anodes of a double diode, th rectified
output developed across load resistors, Ri,
R2, being applied to a valve-voltmeter. It
suitable " plug in " standard transformers
are used, correction shunts, Rs, can be
simultaneously thrown across the milli ammeter, and a simple scale calibration
made to cover a wide range of transformer
ratios.
-2

5.-Two other methods of checking


primary -to -secondary ratio. In circuit (a!
the resistance R is varied until " test " and
" check " readings of V are equal. The
control potentiometer of (b) is calibrated in
" percentage ratio."
Fig.

The Wireless World, June 3oth, 1938

Developing a

How a Receiver is Designed-XTIII.

High -Quality Communication Receiver


N the preceding article we finished a
the point where we had decided upon
details of the last IF stage and the

detector. We now have to consider


the IF amplifier as a whole, together with
the circuits which are responsible for providing the adjacent channel selectivity.
The attainment of the necessary amplification is. quite an easy matter, and it is
also easy to obtain it with almost any desired degree of selectivity. In practice,
however, difficulties come in because we

THE I.F. AMPLIFIER-Amplification and Selectivity


at Intermediate Frequency

tolerate a very large degree of sideband


cutting. Obviously, therefore, best results are obtained by making the selectivity variable so that the optimum compromise for any conditions can readily
be found. This has been recognised for a
long time, and many methods of obtainusually want
ing variable selechigher
selectivity
tivity have been
ARIA,BLE selectivity is an
than is possible if.
developed.
the highest moduusual
The
important item in the design of
lation frequencies
is o
arrangement
any large receiver, and in this article
are to be reprobuild a convensome of the difficulties encountered
duced.
tional IF amplifier
Since stations are
-using pairs of
with the usual arrangements are
spaced some 9 kc / s
coupled tuned cirdiscussed.
The development of a
apart, it is hardly
cuits between the
new system to overcome these diffipossible to build
valves and to vary
culties is described and curves
equipment which
the coupling for
will always eliminvariable selectivity.
illustrating its performance are given.
interference
a te
In general, with
from an adjacent
two IF stages three
channel and at the same time reproduce couplet pairs are used and the coupling
modulation frequencies higher than about in two of them is mechanically variable
by a panel control. What should happen
5, 00o c/ s. This particular case probably
represents the best compromise between with such an arrangement is illustrated by
the conflicting requirements of selectivity the diagrams of Fig. io, in which curve
and quality if a receiver is to have one (a) shows the selectivity at " high,"
Actually, curve (b) " medium," and curve (c) at
degree of selectivity only.
however, the best compromise will vary
low." It is possible far these theoretion different stations because the amount cal expectations to be realised in practice,
of interference present will vary accordbut, unfortunately, it can be done only if
ing to the relative strengths of the wanted extreme care 'is taken. What usually
and unwanted signals.
happens when the selectivity is varied is
In local reception it is possible to repro- that there is some shift in the peak freduce the highest modulation frequencies, quency. This is illustrated by curve (h)
and no interference is. found in spite of of Fig. II, and when the coupling is
the use of an unselective receiver, because further increased'. the correct approach to
the local station is so much stronger than a flat top is not obtained. Instead of a
any other. For the reception of a very response such as that shown by curve (c)
weak signal, however, immediately adja- of Fig. io, it often approaches curve (c) of
cent to a strong one, we shall need all the Fig. ir.
selectivity we can get and usually have to

Stray Inter -coil Capacity

Fig. io.-The theoretical form of resonance


curves for an IF amplifier incorporating
variable selectivity is shown here.

One reason' for this behaviour is a


change in the tuning capacity of the IF
cells, generally accompanied by an alteration in the capacity coupling between each
coupled pair of circuits, and often assisted
also by feed-back effects. The coupling
between the circuits is usually supposed to
consist of mutual inductance only. In all
ordinary transformers, however, there is
some stray capacity coupling as well, and
when the coils are moved physically in
relation to one another this is changed in
some degree. Moreover, the movement of
the. coil in relation to the screening can
change the capacity between the coil and
the can, and therefore the tuning of the
circuit.
Furthermore, even screen -grid

valves have an input impedance which is


not entirely negligible and which is dependent upon the applied grid bias. Any
change in the coupling affects the gain of
the amplifier, and therefore the AVC bias
applied to the valves, and so affects the
tuning slightly. These effects are .often
quite noticeable in the operation of a receiver, and the particular distortion of
the curve shown by (c) of Fig. II often
results in audible distortion. These effects
are well brought out if a cathode-ray oscilloscope is used with a frequency -modulated. oscillator to show the resonance
curve, and such gear affords a very good

Fig. 1 i.-In practice, resonance curves like


these are usually secured instead of the
symmetrical ones of Fig. to.

demonstration of how critical the tuning


of over -coupled circuits is.
We all aim at producing an approach
to the ideal resonance curve shown in
curve (a), Fig. 12, which has steeply
sloping sides and a flat top. In practice
we can approach this by using tuning circuits correctly damped and coupled to the
correct degree and we obtain a curve such
as (b), which is a very good approach to
a flat top but is actually somewhat
rounded. It is found, however, that it is
almost impossible to adjust such circuits
without the aid of cathode-ray equipment.
A Simplified Method

If the trimmers are adjusted in the usual


way for maximum response the curve invariably degenerates to the form shown in
(c). How critical the tuning is with such
circuits can -be realised when it is said that
the mere pressure of the screwdriver on a
trimmer screw will shift the peak of curve
(c) from one side of resonance to the other.
Very good -quality trimmers are needed to
adjust a circuit of this nature to give the
correct response curve, and for this

JUNE

30111,

Wfinehoo

1938.

WopIlcl

High -Quality Communication Receiver-

response curve to be maintained afterwards.


In view of these difficulties and because
comparatively few people have cathoderay equipment available for the adjustment of their receivers, it has been felt

FREQUENCY

Fig. 12.-The square -shaped curve (a) shows


the ideal form of band-pass curve, while the
more rounded curve (b) shows the results
which can be obtained in practice. Unless
cathode-ray equipment is used, however,
the curve invariably becomes lop -sided as
in (c).

that the only course is to abandon the use


of over-coupled circuits and to adopt
methods which can be trimmed properly
with the aid of nothing more elaborate
than an ordinary test oscillator. These
difficulties prevent us from adopting the
conventional methods of variable selectivity because we shall have to employ
fixed coupling between circuits. We shall
need at least six good circuits, i.e., three
coupled pairs, to obtain the requisite degree of selectivity for bad conditions. The
obvious method of reducing selectivity is
to shunt each circuit with a variable resistance, but it is clearly impracticable to go
to the length of using six variable resistances ganged together. Furthermore, this
course would not actually be very satisfactory because the change in selectivity
would be accompanied by a very large
alteration in the gain of the amplifier.

amplifier design by using switches to connect damping resistances across the coils.
This is certainly more practicable than the
use of variable resistances, but is open
to the same objection of varying the gain
considerably, and it usually offers
mechanical difficulties in the layout of
components since everything requires well
screening. There is, however, no reason
why the conventional IF amplifier should
be adhered to. In this amplification and
selectivity are obtained together, i.e., the
circuits which provide the selectivity are
used as intervalve couplings. As an alternative it is quite possible to build an
IF amplifier which gives the required
gain and very little in the way of selectivity and then to obtain the requisite
selectivity from a series of circuits inserted
together at a suitable point. For instance,
we might build an IF amplifier using, sy,
heavily damped tuned -anode couplings,
which is substantially flat over the side band range of frequencies and then insert
between this amplifier and the frequencychanger our selective circuits.

Use of

Gate " Circuits

Apart from the convenience of this


arrangement there are certain electrical
advantages in that at high selectivity the
interfering signal is largely eliminated at
a point where the signal voltages are very
small. When the selectivity and amplification are distributed, as in the conventional arrangement, the interfering signal
may reach a much higher value in the IF
amplifier and may, in certain circumstances, cause interference through overloading one of the valves. In other words,

573

used if we pr:,vide an entirely separate


chain of tuned circuits for each degree of
selectivity. At first this sounds wasteful,
but in actual practice it is doubtful
whether it would cost any more than a
system utilising the same circuits for the
different degrees of selectivity, in view
of the complicated arrangements which
would have to be made in order to maintain the correct tuning of the various circuits with their different connections.

Some Practical Considerations


The suggested arrangement is outlined
in Fig. 13. For low selectivity the
switches are in position 3 and a single
transformer T5. couples the frequency changer and first IF valves. This transformer must be designed to pass a wide band,
and for this it will require the connection
of damping resistances across the windings
if the coils are of the usual efficiency. In
order to preserve the normal gain as much
as possible when the windings are damped
the coupling must be much tighter than
In fact, it must be of such a
usual.
degree that in the absence of resistances
a double -humped resonance curve would
be secured. It is actually possible to employ a standard IF transformer for T5 by
picking one which has over -coupled windings so that it normally gives a double humped response, with a peak separation
of the order of io kc; s. The resistances
are then selected so that a single peaked
resonance curve is secured. Usually, with
standard components, the resistances will
be of the order of ioo,000 ohms.

For medium selectivity the switches are

in position 2, and T4 then comes into cir-

Continuous Variability Unnecessary


Now, extensive experience with receivers incorporating variable selectivity
has shown that it is not necessary for the
selectivity to be continually variable. All
ordinary requirements are met by a stepby-step variation, and, in general, three
degrees of selectivity are sufficient. These
three degrees, which we may term low,
medium and high, should give at low selectivity a very well -maintained response up
to to kc / s off resonance, and at high selectivity the response should be at least
t,000 times down at io kc/s off resonance.
The medium selectivity should approximate more to the degree obtained in an
average small superheterodyne, but can
well be a little lower if anything. A
response of the order of 30-50 times down
at to kc/s off resonance would seem

adequate.
Such step-by-step variation of selectivity can be obtained with a conventional
`

This photo shows the experimental IF amplifier with the five IF transformers forming the
variable selectivity portion mounted on a small adjacent chassis.

the suggested arrangement may give less


interference than the conventional for the
same paper selectivity curve. This is, of
course, quite a minor point since the
trouble is only likely to arise when one
i3 trying to receive a weak signal on a
channel adjacent to a very strong one.
One advantage of the proposed arrangement is that very simple switching can be

cuit. The precise arrangement adopted


will naturally depend upon the precise
at
selectivity required
of
degree
" medium," but with good coils the writer
is of the opinion that a single transformer
will just meet the case if the coupling is
somewhat sub-optimum and care is taken
that the circuits are not damped externally.

/npell@gg

.574

JUNE 3oth, r938.

Wog A

High -Quality Communication Receiver-

When the switches are moved to position i a mor complex network is inserted,
and this is represented by the three transformers Ti, T2 and T3.
These can

coupling are available. The two degrees


of coupling involve no mechanical alteration in the interior, but are brought about
through the use of a small additional coil
tightly coupled to the primary, which can

was used, but advantage was taken of


the separate " earthy " end leads for the
coil and condenser to use a bottom capacity coupling with a condenser of o.os F.
With this arrangement the curves of
Fig. 14 were obtained. Curve A shows
the IF amplifier alone and the other curves
show the results with the IF amplifier in
conjunction with the selective circuits just
described. Curve B is for low selectivity,
C for medium and D for high.
A close
examination of the curves shows that the
initial Iining up was not quite perfect
since the peaks are very slightly displaced.

Compensating for Low Gain


Actually, however, this could not be detected in an ordinary listening test and
could have been avoided by little more
careful initial adjustment.
Cathode-ray
equipment was not used for the adjustment, which was carried out in the
ordinary way for maximum signals just
as any constructor would do it. For a
drop in response of 6 db. the bandwidths
at low, medium and high selectivity are
21.2 kc/s, 6 kc/s, and 3.5 kc/s respectively, while for a drop of 40 db. the bandwidths for medium and high selectivity
are 34 kc / s and io kc / s. At 6o db. the
bandwidth is only 15 kc / s at high selectivity, and at io kc / s off resonance the
response is 2,000 times down (66 db.).
A general test on signals showed this
arrangement to be the best yet handled
and to meet all normal requirements. It
had, however, one defect. There were
considerable changes in gain between

Fig. 13.-A switch -controlled variable selectivity system is shown here which is free from the
defects of over -coupled systems. The IF amplifier itself has very low selectivity and is preceded
by a chain of selective circuits appropriate to the degree of selectivity required.

actually be three conventional IF transformers of the type employed for T4


coupled together by the condensers CI,
and C2. Very loose coupling between the
transformers is necessary if correct tuning
is to be obtained, for if any attempt at
over-coupling is made at this point very
peculiar-shaped resonance curves will be
secured. In practice CI and C2 would be
about i F only.

An Experimental Amplifier
Unfortunately, the design of the IF
equipment is not so readily carried out as
that of AF apparatus, especially if one
`wishes to make use of standard components, for there are so many unknown
factors. Figures are rarely quoted for the
:inductance of the coils, the mutual con'ductance between them and the effective
RF resistance of the circuits of commercially available IF transformers. It is, of
,course, alwas possible to design one's
own, but again this must be largely experimental, and it is simpler and more
economical to utilise existing components
where they are suitable. At this stage,
therefore, the design of an IF amplifier
usually resolves itself into looking over
the IF transformers available and picking
out the types which appear most suitable,
then building an experimental amplifier,
measuring its performance and determining experimentally such factors as damping. resistances and coupling condensers.
This was done in the case, of the circuit of
Fig. 13, using the Varlet'_ Type BP124
transformer througho'ut.. This transformer was chosen because it' embodies
high -efficiency coils and two degrees of
-

be included in series with the secondary or


not, as desired.
This coil was connected in series with
the secondary to give tight coupling in the
case of T5, and
both primary and
secondary
were
shunted by resistances of ioo;000
ohms in value. For
T4 the same transformer was used
without the damping resistances and
without the internal
coupling coil connection. A g a'i n ,
these transformers
were used for Ti,
T2 and T3, and
again no use was
made of the extra
coupling coil. CI
had a value of
1F, but the connections between
T2 and T3 were
slightly different.
No condenser C2
Fig. 14.-: -Measured
selectivity curves are
shown here for the
arrangement of Fig.
13 in conjunction
with an IF amplifier.
Curve A shows the
response of the amplifier alone, and

curves B, C, and D
the overall response
at low, medium and
high selectivity.

- 40

30

20

10

10

kris OFF TUNE

20

30

+40

Wfipegeg

JUNE 3oth, 1938.


High -Quality Communication Receiver-

different degrees of selectivity. The gain


was highest at medium selectivity because
only a single transformer was used and in
its most efficient condition. It was somewhat lower at low selectivity because the
transformer vas fairly heavily. damped.
This, however, is no great disadvantage,
because one normally wants to use low
selectivity chiefly on strong signals. The
greatest drawback, however, was that
the sensitivity was much lower at high
selectivity than in either of the other two
positions, and this is the one place where
one normally requires sensitivity most.
This is, of course, only to be expected,
because even with fairly tight couplings
the gain with three transformers can only
be about one-third of that with one. In
practice one has to employ rather loose
couplings, so that the gain is even lower.
The remedy is easy, but involves the use
of an additional valve. Instead of the
high -selectivity chain of Fig. 13, consisting of six coupled circuits, one can use
four coupled circuits following the frequency -changer and then introduce a
valve before the last two. That is to say,
the secondary of 12 in Fig. 13 will be
joined to the grid of a valve, and T3
would be fed from its anode circuit. This

valve will be utilised, not to increase the


gain of the IF amplifier as a whole, but
to make up for the losses in the chain of
circuits, and it will be adjusted so that
the sensitivity of the receiver at high
selectivity is the same as, or slightly
higher than, that at medium selectivity.
The valve will, of course, be only employed in the high -selectivity position of
the switches, for in the other two positions it will not be in the signal chain.
In choosing operating conditions for
this valve it is desirable to employ the
normal anode and screen volts and then
pick the bias resistance so that there is
little change in gain between positions i
and 2 of the switches, all circuits, of
course, being trimmed accurately. Quite
a high bias is likely to be needed, since
the stage must give only low gain, and
we should consequently pick a variable mu valve for this position in order to
reduce the possibility of distortion
through non -linearity. Also, as the valve
must be considered as maintaining the
efficiency of the selective circuits rather
than an amplifier proper, it will not be
controlled from the AVC system. The
efficiency of AVC will, therefore, remain
unaltered in the different positions of the
selectivity switch.

On the Short Waves


IDON'T believe that many in high places
realise just how efficient an amateur
communication network on 56 Mc /s
can be. Recently G5MA took out a portable
crystal -controlled 'phone transmitter, employing a total of three valves, and with a
National One-Ten receiver worked the following stations from Polesden Lacy, near
Dorking : G2GG Newbury, G8MG Reading,
G8OS Billingshurst, G6OT and G8SK in
N. London, as well as G8IX, G2OD, G5RD
Abbots Langley, H'erts, and G5KH. The
most distant station with which good communication was established was G2GG, 44
miles away, and it should be borne in mind
that, apart from the zoo -volt HT battery
on the receiver, the only source of power
supply was the 6 -volt car accumulator. This
transmitter is of the type previously described in these notes, i.e., 6L6 tritet with
20 -metre crystal driving a 6N7 double triode
as a push -push doubler, this doubler being
plate -modulated by another 6L6. A rectifier
is not required when the HT is supplied by
a self-rectifying device operating from the
car battery.
Whatever may be the official opinion regarding amateur co-operation of a general
nature in the event of hostilities, this experiment by G5MA only too clearly demonstrates what picked amateurs with " standard " gear of this type could do.
A purely personal observation is that the
responsible authorities are not entirely out
of sympathy with the idea of obtaining
assistance from the amateur, but are appalled at the task of directing the energy
which would be released by a general ukase.
Then one suggests that, as a basis for further discussion, a limited scheme should be
tried, the entry qualification being the possession of a 56 Mc/s crystal -controlled transmitter and receiver having a potential range,
'phone, of 5o miles, and capable of operat-

575 -

WopIlcl

ing for a certain number of hours from one


6 -volt accumulator.
The reasons why one chooses the 56 Mc /s
band will, I am sure, be apparent to most
readers.
These advantages are, roughly (1) for a
given mast height the efficiency of an aerial
increases as the wavelength is decreased.
That is, the " polar diagram " is a function
of the height above the ground of the aerial
in wavelengths, and for an optical path the
losses on 5 metres are not appreciably greater
than on ro metres. (2) Signals on 5 metres
are, except very occasionally, inaudible outside of a 50 -mile radius. (3) There are a
great many clear channels in the 5 -metre
band, and this bard
is not subject to
interference from
foreign stations. (4)
Car ignition interference is possibly
less severe on 5
than on ro or 20
metres.
(6) Only
small coils and other
components are required, and the apparatus is therefore
less bulky. (7) The
small physical size
of even quite complex
directional

aerials.
As

it

to

point

G6CJP working on 14

Mc/s during the

R.S.G.B. National Field


th and
Day on June
12th, when the British
Isles were represented
by 27 portable field
stations.

these remarks on 5 metres, G8TX and


G5KH have already been heard testing
on 21-, metres, and I believe that a year
or so ago G2AW also carried out some
tests in the 112 Mc/s band.
Both G8TX and G5KH are, I think,
crystal -controlled on 2j- metres, and I hope,
too, shortly to be radiating about ro watts
of crystal -controlled 'phone down there.
It will be most interesting to see, as one
suspects, whether with a given mast height
and power for power, the range on 21 will
not be greater than on 5 metres for quasi optical transmissions.
To leave the ultra -short waves, it must be
recorded that conditions above to metres
have been very good recently.
The G.E.C. Schenectady transmitter
WzXAD on 15.33 Mc/s still continues to
head the list for fine and stable performance, but W3XAL on 17.78 Mc/s has been
a much improved signal in the early evenings, and is now of good programme value.
On Saturday, June r8th, W2XE on 17.76
Mc/s was a particularly fine signal in the
afternoon, surpassing W3XAL both in carrier strength and modulation depth. With
correct tuning a weak heterodyne from DJE
was practically unnoticeable until quite late
in the afternoon.
I believe this 'use of
19.76 Mc/s by W2XE is a temporary
measure, and that he will ultimately revert
to 21.52 Mc /s for afternoon transmissions.
Judging from the performance of the
Lawrenceville 'phone transmitters, the optimum frequency from the U.S. in our afternoons and early evenings is about 19 Mc/s,
which means that the broadcasters must
choose between the 21 and 17 Mc/s band,.
The former often gives excellent results.
but the latter is probably the more reliable
at this period cf the year. It is, however,
interesting to note that peak " summertime " conditions do not generally occur on
the England-U.S.A. route until July. Even
the ionosphere seems to suffer from a hangover!
At the time of writing a large stream of
sunspots, showing signs of spectroscopic
activity, is approaching the sun's meridian,
so don't forget to look out for sudden daylight short -period fade-outs, and the ionosphere and magnetic storms which may
occur some 36 hours later if the particles
emitted by the eruption reach the earth.
.

'

ETHACOMBER.

TN Wireless World, June 30th, 1938

576

Notes on

the-

Short-wave Three
Improving Detector Efficiency and Extending
Waverange to 190 Metres
By

II. B. DENT

IN this article the author explains


NYONE who has designed and built
a short-wave receiver will agree
that, no matter how much thought
is given to it before the set takes
practical form, there are always a few
improvements that can be made after it
has been in use for some time.
If all goes well during the early tests
and the set is definitely better than any
previously handled, one is reluctant to
" fiddle " with it, but after a time and
when the newness is beginning to wear
off, the urge to see the effect of a change
here and there becomes overpowering and
a few modifications are accordingly made.
Short-wave sets do not wear out ; admittedly they go out of date in time, but the
set of the enthusiast rarely exists long
enough in its original form to become a
museum piece.

Extending the Waverange


The Short-Wave Three which was
described in the issues of May 12th and
igth last has been subjected to a few
searching tests of this nature, mainly, it
must be admitted, in regard to investigating the possibilities of extending the
wave -band coverage, firstly, to take in
five metres and, secondly, to fill in the
gap between 8o and 200 metres.

how an improvement can be


effected in the detector stage and
then gives the winding data for a
new set of coils to cover the 1.7
Mc/s. amateur. band. Five -metre

reception

this set
discussed.

on

is also

In the process it transpired that a


general improvement could be effected by
changing the AF coupling in the anode of
the detector from resistance to choke capacity, the modifications suggested
being shown in Fig. I.
In addition to
this, resistance R6, in the original circuit,
which forms one link of the detector
screen -grid potentiometer, is reduced to
25,00o ohms and the 50,000 -ohm resistance removed is inserted between the
slider of R7 and the screen -grid connection on the valve -holder. This is shown
in Fig. I as RY. The RF by-pass condenser C10 must be joined from this point
to the earth line direct and not left joined
to the slider of R7 as formerly.
An AF choke of high inductance is required in the anode circuit of the detector
in order to give an adequate impedance at
the low audio frequencies, and this
>+ T
is conveniently obtained with a Bulgin
type LF37 AF
26,000 0
transformer
by
joining the primary
a n d
secondary
Cl
windings in series.
fl--->
This transformer
M

A F

Rx

CHOKE

+eo,000

CF

A R

bc

has

R7

different

coloured leads, the


series connection
being obtained by
o

CHOKE 2d

)
iLT

Fig. r.-Revised circuit of the detector

stage in which choke


capacity coupling is
used. Values of the
few extra components
required are also
given.

joining the grey and the green together,


connecting the yellow to the anode of
the valve and the red to HT.
It provides an inductance of about zoo henrys,
and in order to maintain the impedance
reasonably constant over the audio range
it is shunted by a resistance (Rx) of
100,000 ohms.
Better detector efficiency and an improvement in the quality of reproduction
accompanied this change and many
stations hitherto only a good headphone
signal became strong enough to put on
to the loud speaker. It was also noticed
that oscillation on the ultra -short wave
range, covering the sound transmission
.

One of the new coils is shown plugged into


the detector coil -holder while just in front
of it is seen the 50,000 -ohm resistance RY
joined to the screen grid terminal of the
valve -holder.

from Alexandra Palace, was more readily


obtainable.
Very little success has so far attended
the attempts to bring five metres into the
range of the set. Such difficulties have,
in fact, been experienced with other TRF
receivers not intended primarily for ultra short wave reception. The fact must be
faced that for really satisfactory five metre reception a set designed especially
for the ultra -high frequencies will have to
be used.
The position is that some SG 220 valves
will oscillate down to five metres but
others will not. Out of three tried, one
oscillated quite readily when the. metallising was removed ; another oscillated
down to about 5.5 metres when treated in
the same manner, but the third specimen

JUNE

30111,

WfIp@Il@og

1938.

Notes on the Short -Wave Three-

ceased to oscillate below about 6.5 metres.


In view of this uncertainty of operation,
it is felt that no good purpose would be

577

WopIlcl
they are not sufficient for aerial coupling.
On the other hand, 15 turns are far too
many for the detector stage, as the valve

arm. Incidentally, R3 is intended to be


used as an RF volume control. It could
be omitted and a fixed resistance of the
same value used in its place, though it is
a useful control when wearing headphones, as there is no other means of cutting down the vlume of signals when
receiving CW transmissions.

oscillates with such a low screen voltage

News from the Clubs


Bootle and District Amateur Transmitting
Society
Han. Sec.: Mr. C. E. Cimlilie, 368, Stanley Road, Bootle,

Liverpool,

20.

This Society is open to any person interested


in amateur transmitting, SW reception, quality
or high-powered amplifiers, and general radio
engineering. Those interested are invited to
apply to the Secretary for full particulars and
an application form.

Dallis Hill Radio Communication Society


Headquarters: Braiateroft Schools, Warren Road, Loadon. N.W.2.

Meetings: Alternate Tuesdays at 8.15 p.m.


Hon. Sec.: Mr. E. Eldridge, 79, Oxgate Gardens, London, N.W.2.

On May 22nd a party took part in the Field


Day organised by the Golder 's Green Society.
On June r9th a 5 -metre Field Day was held in

the Hatfield district.


Owing to holiday arrangements the series of
talks to be given by Mr. S. C. Ash has had to
be postponed.

Surrey Radio Contact Club


Headquarters: The Alhambra, Welles'ey Road, Croydon.
Meetings: First Tuesday in the month at 8 p.m.
Hon. Sec.: Mr. A. B. Wilshire, 14, Lytton Gardens,
Wallington.

The AF choke can be accommodated quite easily underneath the chassis, being shown
here mounted between the output valve -holder and the small stand-off insulator. The resistance RX is the 100,000 ohms shunted across the choke.

served by proceeding further with the


matter.
The fact that oscillation was not obtained does not necessarily mean that the
v'alves are unsuitable for use on the ultrahigh frequencies ; it only indicates that a
different kind of circuit with a more suitable layout is. required.
One can, however with confidence
undertake an extension of wavelength at
the other end of the range, though a departre from the practice adopted on the
four ranges for which coils were given has
It will be recalled that
to be made.
identical windings were used for both
aerial and RF coils, but this no longer
holds good for the fifth range.

Coils for 1.7 Mc/s Band


The coils for this range cover 8o to 190
metres ; they are wound with No. 24 SWG
DSC wire and in three sections, the connection being the same as the coils for
ranges 3 and 4. Both coils have 6o turns
which are close -wound, that is to say, the
turns are not spaced as on all the other
'coils.

On the RF coil the section nearest the


top of the former has six turns, the next
'one down 39 turns and the lower section
15 turns.
In the case of the aerial coil, the top
section consists of 15 turns, the middle
one has 30 turns and the lower one 15
This dissimilarity comes about
turns.
because while six turns are adequate to
produce oscillation in the detector stage

that the detector

is not operating at its


best. To avoid confusion, identifying
marks should be inscribed on the top of
each coil former.
This opportunity twill be taken to point
out that when assembling the two Bulgin
volume controls R3 and R7 the insulating washers must be used, as their spindles
are in electrical contact with the moving
Sound
41.5 Mc,'s.

On June 7th a meeting was held at,


which members were selected at random and
called upon to give a talk of not less than
five minutes' duration on a technical subject
chosen by the Committee.
Several of the club members co-operated in
erecting a station for the 1 .S.G.B. Field Day.
The 14 -megacycle band was used. The transmitter was a single 6L6 tri -let. using members'
7 -megacycle crystals in order to provide
changes of favourable frequencies. The input
was -12 watts. The receiver was the Club's 56megacycle 0-V-1, which uses plug-in coils.
The next meeting will be on July 5th, when
a member will give a talk entitled, " Hints

and Kinks."

Television Programmes

THURSDAY,

j t

\ l

30th.

2.30, O.B. from the Centre Court at Wimbledon


of the Tennis Championship Meeting. 3.40,
'Stith edition of Picture Page. 4-5, O.B. from

'Wimbledon continued.
9, Cabaret, including Talbot O'Farrell and the
Music Hall Boys. 9.25, British Movietonews.
9.35, 'Goth edition of Picture Page. 10.5,
News Bulletin.
'FRIDAY, JULY ist.
2.30-5, O.B. from the Centre Court at Wimbledon of the Tennis Championship Meeting.
9, Speaking Personally. 9.10, Film. 9.20,
Cooking Demonstration by Marcel Boulestin.
9.35, Gaumont -British News. 9.45, " Rogues'
Gallery," a revue of the songs of law -breakers.
10.15, News Bulletin.
SATURDAY, JULY 2nd.
2.30-5, O.B. from the Centre Court, Wimbledon,
of the Tennis Championship Meeting.
9, " On the Spot," the play by Edgar Wallace.
Cast includes Arthur Gomez, Gillian Lind and
Queenie Leonard. 10.30, News Bulletin.
SUNDAY, JULY 3rd.
8.50, News Bulletin. 9.5, Colonel W. de Basil's
Ballet Russes in a studio rehearsal. 9.35,
Cartoon Film. 9.40, Gaumont-British News.
9.50, Scenes from Shakespeare.

45izcn;s.

:MONDAY, JULY 4th.

2.50-4, Polo O.B. from. Hurlingham-India v.

The World.
9, " Androcles and the Lion," an old fable
renovated by George Bernard Shaw. Cast
includes Esm Percy and Guy Glover. 10, News
Bulletin.
TUESDAY, JULY 5th.
3-4.10, " The Tragedy of Julius Caesar," by
Shakespeare. Title rle played by Ernest
Milton, Antonius by D. A. Clark -Smith and
Marcus Brutus by Francis L. Sullivan.
9, Cabaret, including Ronald Frankau, Afrique,
and Charles Higgins. 9.35; Cartoon Film.
9.40, Golf Demonstration. 9.55, GaumontBritish- News. 10.5, Music -makers.
10.15,
News Bulletin.
WEDNESDAY, JULY -6th.
3, Forecast of Fashion. 3.15, Cartoon Film.
3.20, Starlight. 3.30, Gaumont -British News.
3.40, " First Prize a Lady," an operetta, by
Offenbach.

Forecast of Fashion.
9.15, BritishMovietonews. 9.25, " Bardell against Pickwick," scenes from the " Pickwick Papers," by
Charles Dickens. 9.50, Tennis Demonstration
by Danny Maskall. 10, News Bulletin.
9,

The Wireless World, June ,3olh, 1938

UNBIASED
Send This to Your M.P.
IHAVE always been one to pride myself on the fact that when I undertake
any job I invariably throw my whole
heart and soul into it, being a great believer in the old saying that what is worth
doing at all is worth doing well. Consequently, when Mrs. Free Grid recently
informed me once more that she hadn't a
rag to her back and in addition the household vacuum cleaner was falling to pieces,
hastily telephoned through for a bag of

the very best assorted rags, together with


the most expensive vacuum cleaner obtainable fitted with the latest type of
interference suppressors.
Unfortunately, the bag of rags was not
well received, but I had at least expected
a word of commendation for the vacuum
cleaner, which was the very best that
money could buy. It was, I noticed,
viewed with extreme suspicion and later
in the day I noticed that Mrs. Free Grid
went out for an hour, during which the
maid behaved strangely, constantly
switching the cleaner on and off just as
though she were endeavouring to signal by
means of the morse code.
It was not until Mrs. Free Grid came
back that I had any inkling of what it
all meant. On her return she peremptorily
ordered the thing to be packed up and
returned to the shop and a " really decent
Mrs. Free Grid herself
one obtained."
went along to choose the new machine
and, somewhat mystified, I awaited its
arrival. I must say it looked expensive
enough with its gleaming chromium plate,
but somehow or other I was suspicious of
it and a little investigation proved that
my suspicions were not ill-founded, as not

" The maid behaved strangely."

only were there no suppressors fitted but


its suction powers were very poor as it
completely failed to lift the cat when applied to its back, a rough-and-ready test
which I always find very effective. The
lack of suppressors was easily remedied,
but when I opened up the cleaner I was
appalled by the mingy specifications of
the motor and was still gazing at it when
Mrs. Free Grid came into the room and to
my amazement rated me soundly for try -

By

FREE

G!D

ing to fit suppressors, and it was only then


that I learnt the truth.
It appears that in these degenerate days
not only is it every woman's ambition to
go one better than her neighbours in
clothes, but this state of affairs often
extends to vacuum cleaners. The unusual
point of the whole affair is, however, the
women's method of assessing the value of
a vacuum cleaner, which is none other
than its ability to create the most noise on
neighbouring wireless sets. It appears
that when Mrs. Free Grid disappeared on
the arrival of the vacuum cleaner I had
bought, leaving the maid to do a sort of
amateur morse code business, she had
immediately gone to a neighbouring house
to try and listen in to it.
Modern salesmen have not been slow
to take advantage of this aspect of female
psychology, and the best selling vacuum
cleaner is the one that creates the most
interference on neighbouring wireless sets.
It is obviously of little use the P.M.G.
appealing to the better natures of electrical apparatus manufacturers while this
sort of mentality prevails, and the sooner
legislation is passed the better. I am
sending these rough notes to my M.P.,
and advise you to cut them out and do
likewise to yours.

The Desert Song


IDON'T know if many

of you listen to
the foreign languages transmission from
Daventry. Personally, I don't, as I am
bothered by the skip -distance effect and
I cannot, therefore, say from my own experience whether these particular programmes maintain the high standard of
interest which they ought to do. From
time to time, I must admit, I have heard
certain derogatory remarks concerning
them, but I usually treat such malicious
gossip with the contempt it deserves, preferring to make my own criticisms.
Recently, however, I heard a rumour of
such a serious faux pas which the B.B.C.
Arabic programme department were about
to commit that I made a special journey
by 'plane to the Sahara in order to listen in, as this happens to be a part of the
world where Daventry's " Arabic " sky wave comes down for a breather, and so
signals are abnormally strong.
The
rumour, which proved only too true, was
to the effect that one Auni Daoudi, an
Arab gentleman who is a graduate of Cambridge and at present pursuing his studies
at Oxford, was to address the B.B.C.'s
Arabic listeners on the " History, Organisation and Functions of the Universities
of Oxford and Cambridge."

Now, as I have had occasion to mention


before, I have a fair smattering of the
variations of that great group of languages
usually referred to somewhat .loosely as
Arabic, and at the same time a considerable knowledge of the manners and customs of the peoples who speak these
tongues. This knowledge, as my older
readers will recollect, was culled during
some very specialised radio research work
which I undertook " out there " on behalf of the Government in the War years,
and about which I wrote at some length
in these columns a year or two ago.
It was with considerable misgiving,
therefore, that I listened to this ponderous
and learned talk on the origin of our great
universities, as, frankly, I cannot imagine
how it could appeal to an Arab resting

" Beside me in the wilderness."

at a lonely oasis in the burning desert


and sitting with his camel and his portable
wireless set under the shade of a friendly
palm tree ; in fact, I think it would be
distinctly irritating. When a man and his
sweating beast are snatching a brief respite
from the scorching heat ot the desert, he
does not feel in the mood to enter into
the scholastic calm and detachment of
our great universities, as I found by personal experience.

Coincidence or Piracy?
IHAD occasion the other day to complain of the way in which self-styled
inventors " pirate " the various ideas for
radio and scientific improvement which I
put forward from time to time in the pages
of this journal. I gladly publish these
ideas without fee or favour, my sole
reward being that inward satisfaction that
comes of having done something to benefit
my fellow -workers in the scientific world.
I think, therefore, that the least they
might do would be to make some small
acknowledgment when they " borrow " an
idea from these pages.
I am moved to utter these words of
rebuke owing to a newspaper cutting
which a kindly reader has sent me in
which it is stated that a patent has just
been granted in Washington for a " silent
horn " for motors. The details given of
this device read suspiciously like those
which I published in these columns on
December 16th last.

The Wireless World,

June 30th, 1938

579

The Aerial Connection


Concluded from page 549
of last week's issue

THE HIGH - INDUCTANCE


PRIMARY METHOD

EXPERIMENTS WITH

By M. G. SCROGGIE, B.Sc., A.M.I.E.E.


ready to investigate the mistuning is restricted to 0.5 F.
the effect of connecting the On the other hand, it must be remembered
aerial, and Fig. 5 shows the that it is kc/s mistuning rather than F
capacity disturbance due to that counts, and in this respect F are
this addition. Evidently the outdoor aerial worse at the high -frequency end than at
has a lower capacity than the artificial the low. Also it is clear that the trimmer
aerial. Note that the effect of coupling adjustment recommended would be badly
if
another
out
through the high aerial, having the
inductance coil is
of
characteristics
equivalent to a
TAT the first instalment of this
were
the
artificial,
negative capacity ;
the
the
author
messed
L
st
article
substituted ; wherein other words, an
importance of the aerial coupling
as with the high -L
inductance. T h e
from various points of view. He
coupling coil the
outdoor aerial,
now describes the result of experichange of aerial
being low in capaments on the properties of the " big
makes little differcity, therefore resoprimary" type of coupling, which
ence except at the
nates at a higher
helps to reduce misalignment of the
low frequency end
frequency and
ganged tuning system of a receiver.
where capacity
causes more miserror matters less.
tuning than the
And not only " do
higher capacity
F count more heavily at the high -freaerial.
Looking at these curves, one might sup- quency end, but they impair selectivity,
pose the tapped coil (or low-L coil) method which is already relatively poor.
So to give a truer picture the next thing
to have the advantage. Not only does the
high-L coil show the greatest number of is to work out the kc / s mistuning. Before
F mistuning, but the amount varies plotting the results of this in Fig. 6 the
enormously over the tuning band ; whereas capacities have been adjusted by a conwith the tapped coil it is so nearly constant stant amount (to simulate trimmer adjustthat a large part of it could be neutralised ment) for each coupling to give what was
by the trimmer. Even with the closest judged to be the best compromise for the
coupling (tap 3) and outdoor aerial, by artificial aerial. No readjustment has
reducing the trimmer capacity by 4.9 F. been made for the outdoor aerial. As a
matter of interest, here are the actual adjustments, which can be compared with
Fig. 5 :
10
Tapped coil : tap 1
...
... -0.7 F.
WE are now

tivity due to mistuning-only that due to


damping introduced by the aerial. The
effects of mistuning would of course tend
to accentuate the results shown.
Coming at last to what most readers
will regard as the essential internal organs
of the matter, Fig. 8 shows the signal stepup. One gathers from it that the high -L
coupling gives a signal transfer that is
rather small, but very uniform over the
waveband. The uniformity is particularly marked when account is taken of
signal loss due to mistuning, shown by
dotted lines. Increasing the closeness of
coupling increases the signal transfer (up
to a point, which is not exceeded by any
of the couplings. tested), but it also in -

e
cr

TAP 3
O

High -L coil
O.

TAP2 p
O

11

} TAP 1
LOOSE

K
O

TIGHT

loosely coupled...

tightly coupled...

...

-3.8

...
...

+0.5
+2.0

The magnitude of the mistuning which


may result if the tapped coil is not
trimmed to its particular aerial is now
revealed. With No. 3 tap the 'connecting
of the outdoor aerial results in about 3
channels mistuning at the high-frequency
end Not only is the high -L coupling less
dependent on aerial characteristics, but on
the whole the mistuning is less. Still, it
cannot be ignored that the worst mistuning occurs below goo kc/ s, where the most
important medium -wave channels are
situated.
Another picture of the situation is Fig.
7, where the selectivity is plotted against
tuning. Its story can be summarised by
saying that the tapped coil tends to increase the already wide natural difference
in selectivity over the waveband, whereas
the high -L coupling tends to level it out.
No account is taken here of loss of selec-

TAP1` -

TAPTAP
32{

-.

LOOSE(

1``

f`

V.

'
I

/<\

TIGHT

\\ .

Z
Z

10
O

e
o

\\

W
41

W
A.

\\
I

\I

20

\
/

\\

op

pp

pp

30

FREQUENCY IN KILOCYCLES PER SECOND

Fig. 6.-The results of Fig. 5 expressed as


kilocycles mistuning, after allowing for
trimmer adjustment to suit the artificial
aerial. Dotted lines again show results with
outdoor aerial.

?-10
I_

20

FREQUENCY IN KILOCYCLES PER SECOND

Fig. 5.-Capacity added to the tuned circuit by


connecting the aerials in the ways indicated.
The full lines refer to the artificial aerial ; the
dotted lines to the real aerial.

creases the mistuning, and as can be seen


at the extreme low -frequency end the loss
may outweigh the gain. The low -L coupling or tapped coil gives a very much
stronger signal on the average, but the
advantage is mainly towards the high -frequency end. Obviously, on the evidence
shown, tap 2 would be chosen in preference to 3, for the net signal strength is
almost identical, while the selectivity and
mistuning are considerably better.
" Cathode Ray " has in the past stressed
the importance of a good signal transfer
in long-range receivers, not entirely be-

W
The Aerial Connection-

cause of signal strength as such (for that


is easily obtained by using a sufficient
number of valves), but to get a good
signal/noise ratio. When more than about
four valves are efficiently used, one gets
into the region where inevitable valve and
circuit noise is.,heard, and further amplification only increases its loudness. It is
then important to secure the highest pos 30

z0
9F

,
\

\9f

r'.

)7. ` l
20

cIS

' \.. '. \>


.

,` \

10

\\\\\\

TAP

}TAP2

`, I TAP

8,

FREQUENCYIN KILOCYCLES PER SECOND

Fig. 7.-Showing effect of aerial coupling on


selectivity. The additional loss of selectivity
due to mistuning is not taken into account.
Full lines, artificial aerial ; dotted lines,
outdoor aerial. T and L indicate tight and
loose coupling respectively.

sible transfer of signal from the aerial. In


most normal circumstances the best
signal/ noise ratio is obtained by a coupling even closer than "optimum," but,
because of the resultant mistuning, that is
generally impracticable except perhaps for
reception on one fixed frequency.

could by no means exceed

this reduced amount. In fact, as V, is


only indirectly connected with the tuned
circuit, and has aerial losses (r0) to contend with on the way, there is good
reason to expect
to be considerably

Vt

less than half the original Q. And that is


borne out in practice ; but it is not universally true. Theoretically ,there is no

limit to

which could even be much


greater than the original Q
How that
comes about isthat if ra is very small it
is possible to employ a high step-up ratio
from Li, to Ls without materially increasVs

OpS\MM

co

" Optimum " coupling is that which

TAP 3

TAP2

iv TAP

GJP

/4

GQ

.,

20
,'

,;

/,
,,

Ai/

10

ing the losses of the tuned circuit or losing the signal in r0. But as aerial losses
are ,generally a good deal worse than

Fig. 9.-Theoretical circuit diagram of an


aerial coupling system.

those in tuned circuits, such favourable


results are not commonly achieved.
As it happened, the resistance of artificial aerial and generator used in the
experiments was rather large, being rated
at 52.5 ohms and found by measurement
at about 800 kc / s to be 5o. There is a
very simple formula -for optimum signal
transfer :
V,
ig
Vi 2Yra
R being the dynamic_ resistance of the
tuned circuit with no aerial coupling.

Optimum Coupling
Working this out for the experimental
circuit, a curve of theoretical optimum
transfer is shown on Fig. 8. This confirms that tap 3 satisfies the conditions at
1,40o kc/s. A final experiment was performed with a primary coil L,; approximately the same as -Ls. The signal
generator was tuned to the frequency
that. made Lp resonate with Ca (s cutting
--out the mistuning effect). This frequency
was 82o kc/s. The coupling was then
adjusted until the greatest reading was
obtained on the valve voltmeter. It was

fat

30

'Signal Transfer
gives the greatest possible signal transfer.
Let us look into this a little more closely.
At any given frequency the aerial can be
represented by a signal generator in series
with a resistance and capacity (Fig. 9).
There may be inductance, too, but as
that is equivalent to a negative capacity
it can be allowed for in reckoning C1.
However, in putting together an artificial
aerial some inductance is usually included
in order to get an approximation to a real
aerial over a band of frequencies.
represents the coupling, which may
take the form of an actual coil as shown,
or may be a tapping on the tuned coil Ls,
or may even represent a capacity coupling. L.C. is the tuned circuit, which at
resonance is equivalent to a comparatively high resistance R, and has a
magnification " Q.
The meaning of
the latter term can be appreciated by
supposing a signal of, say, z volt injected
at the point X in some way so as to cause
no increase in the circuit losses. Then if

JUNE 3oth, 1938.

Wowld

the circuit is tuned to that signal, a


voltage Q times. as great is developed
across the input to the valve.
But in reality the signal comes from
the aerial (it is represented in Fig. 9 by
V1), and the coupling that is necessary
to communicate it to the tuned circuit
unfortunately communicates some of the
aerial's resistance and reactance (capacity
or inductance effect) also. This has been
confirmed by the foregoing experiments,
in which the aerial coupling has caused
the paralltl resistance R to fall (corresponding to increased series resistance)
and the tuning to be shifted due to aerial
reactance.
It can be proved mathematically that optimum coupling is that
which causes R to be reduced by a half.
This condition is very closely reached by
tap 3 from the artificial aerial at 1,400
kc / s, and it is seen that that happened
to be the highest signal transfer gained.
The fact that tap 2 is only very slightly
lower at that point does suggest that it is
nearing the limit or optimum. As the
tuned circuit Q is now also down to a
half, one might suppose that the signal

transfer
o

rll

/r,,
'

should

TAP1

..

_---

2.0. So
was 20, which
very near
V2
the theoretical curve.
It would fall
nearer if allowance were made for the
resistance of the coil Lr which in this
instance was known to be about ro ohms.
So total rA. is 6o, and R (from Fig. 4) is
95,000 ohms. Therefore, by calculation

TIGHT
LOOSE

FREQUENCY IN KILOCYCLES PER SECOND

Fig. 8.-Signal transfer, or voltage developed


across tuned circuit for each volt picked up
by aerial ; V2 in Fig. 9.
All results are for

artificial aerial only ; dotted lines include


signal loss due to mistuning. The " optimum "
line shows the highest result obtainable with
the equipment used.

be

60 =19.9.

The
disagreement of only 0.5 per cent. is not
claimed to be evidence of superlative
experimental skill, but rather a stroke of
luck !
V2

Recapitulating :
(1) For maximum signal and particularly for best signal/noise ratio the
required coupling is considerably closer
than that commonly employed.
(2) To obtain such a degree of coupling
it is necessary for the aerial tuning and
coupling to be adjusted for each different
frequency and such adjustments hold
good for only one aerial.
(3) So for practical receivers it is necessary to sacrifice a large proportion of the
signal in the interests of simple gang
control and applicability to aerials of. differing characteristics.
The method of
coupling must therefore be a compromise.

581

JUNE 3oth, 1938.

Woplcl

The Aerial Connection(4) Series condenser coupling causes a

large reactance transfer for a reasonable


signal transfer, so is not suitable for
receivers without separate aerial tuning.
aerial coupling
(5) Low-inductance
(which includes tapped coils and step-up
transformers) gives a good signal transfer
for a reasonable mistuning, but, unfortunately, with a condenser-tuned circuit
the coupling varies greatly over the
tuning band, falling off at the low -frequency end. This is especially serious
in " straight " sets employing two, three,
etc., tuned circuits, for the non -uniformity
is squared, cubed, etc., respectively.
With superhet. receivers it does not matter
so much because most of the amplification and selectivity are obtained in the
IF circuits ; and there is the compensating
advantage that the coupling efficiency for
signals around the IF is very_ low, thus
minimising risk of interference from them.
It should be initially trimmed for eacfi_
aerial as the mistuning approximates to
a constant capacity.
(6) High -inductance aerial coupling,
resonating at a frequency just lower than
the tuning range, has the disadvantage in
superhets. with an IF of 465 kc / s of
encouraging interference from signals
around this frequency. Also the coupling
efficiency is relatively poor unless one is
prepared for serious mistuning near the
low frequency end of the band. On the
other hand, it gives very uniform signal
transfer and tends to correct the non uniformity in selectivity experienced with
condenser tuning; so is advantageous in
" straight " receivers, both for aerial and

intervalve coupling.
Other advantages
are that the mistuning approximates to a
constant inductance for all aerials, so
trimming to the aerial is not needed ; and,

G.E.C. Cathode -Ray

Tube
ANEW cathoderay tube of
the h i g h vacuum type has
been produced by
the General Electric
it is
Co., Ltd.
known as the G.E.C.
Monitor, Type 405r.
It has an indirectly
heated cathode consuming o.9 ampere at 4.0 volts and is of
the two -anode type. The second anode is
rated for 500 volts maximum but can be
operated at lower voltages down to 250
the first anode voltage must be adjustable
for focusing and should be 50=100 volts,
according to the second anode voltage.
Brilliancy is controlled by the grid bias,
which must be adjustable over the range
of o -.-^o volts relative to the cathode.
Two pairs of deflecting plates are included and are all brought out, so that
push-pull deflection can be employed. The
X -plates are those next to the second anode
and have a sensitivity of 82/V mm. per
volt, while the Y -plates have a sensitivity
of 73/V mm. per volt, where V is the
second anode voltage.
The tube is cylindrical in shape with a
length of about 6,in. and a screen diameter
;

0.1

red

mlds

l8 mlds

muta
FOCUS

INPUT

20,000

T
A

2--^

S1-10

350-0- 350 pt
o

BRILLIANCE

Al

MO

5,000n

411.

IA

o
o
o

a o

Ovo

0.1

mld

4V
SYNC

AMPLITUDE

AMPLITUDE

50,000 e

0.1

0.1 MO

a
o

4VO

Id
VELOCITY S
25,000 U

NewMiniature

Type
for Oscillographs

50.000 iz

4051

because the smaller the aerial the nearer


it resonates with the tuned circuit, there
is some degree of compensation for
reduced pick-up.

S7

MSP4

It has a green screen of medium


r tin.
persistence and is priced at 45s. It is fitted
with the standard 9 -pin base, the connections being as follows:
of

Pin
1

Electrode

Deflector Plate El
Deflector Plate X1
Anode 1
Heater and Cathode
Heater
Grid
Anode 2
Deflector Plate X2
Deflector Plate Y2

...

2 ...
3 ...

4 ...
5 ...

8 ...
g ...

8 ...

The circuit arrangement adopted for the


tube depends largely upon the purpose to
which it will be put. A suitable circuit
for many requirements, however, is shown
in the accompanying drawing. The tube
voltages are simply obtained from a voltage
As the
divider across the HT supply.
second anode is earthed in most oscillo graph applications, however, it is usually
advisable to place the smoothing choke in
the negative HT lead as shown.
The lower part of the diagram shows a
simple time -base, which will give a sweep
frequency of about 4-4,000 c/s, thus enabling phenomena up to at least ro,000 c /s to
be clearly distinguished. A gas -triode saw tooth oscillator is used with a pentode
charging valve to obtain linearity. The
frequency of the saw -tooth oscillations is
governed largely by the screen voltage of
the pentode and the amplitude by the grid
bias of the gas triode. As is usual with time bases, however, each control governs frequency and amplitude to some degree.
The input work voltage needed naturally
depends upon the anode voltage. If this
is 35o volts, the sensitivity is 82/350=
0.2345 mm. per volt. For a deflection of
r ein., therefore, about 42.5 volts peak -to peak input is required. For a sine-wave
this is equivalent to 21.25 volts peak=
15.75 volts RMS. For inputs much smaller
than this it is necessary to use an amplifier, which must be carefully designed
to give the requisite output without frequency, phase, or amplitude distortion.
As the tube is of the hard type it can be
used at radio frequency, but the time-base
shown is only suitable for AF work. For
many RF applications, however, such as
the measurement of modulation depth, a
time -base is unnecessary.

THE

May

issue

of

the

General Radio

1 Experimenter contains an article

Suggested circuit arrangement for use with the G.E.C. miniature CR tube

on the

psychology of hearing and a description of a


new high -frequency thermo-couple element.
Copies are obtainable free from Claude Lyons,
Ltd., 40, Buckingham Gate, London, S.W.r.

582

The Wireless World, June 3oth, 1933

NE

OF THE

WEEK

SIR JOHN REITH

BROADCASTING IN
GROSSE DEUTSCHLAND

He Tries Not to Think About


Leaving

THE Director-General is still


at Broadcasting House, and
is likely to remain there for two

or three weeks to come. The


formal leave-taking is to be deferred until the autumn owing
to so many of the staff being
on leave. Meanwhile, amusement has been created at Broadcasting House by rumours that
the staff of Imperial Airways
are " trembling in their shoes "
over the imminent arrival of this
stern disciplinarian.
Sir John Reith will take
with him the good wishes of
a staff which has always realised that the D.G. has a very
human side to his make-up,
never more aptly expressed
than in a message last week to
the Editor of Ariel, the B.B.C.
staff journal. " The work to
which I have been asked to go,"
says Sir John Reith, ' is of great
importance, but you can, maybe, imagine how I feel about
leaving the B.B.C. and B.B.C.
staff. I try not to think about
`

it."

ANOTHER CHIEF DEPARTS


Director of Religion at Retiring Age
THE REV. F. A. IRE MONGER, B.1 -3.C. Director
of Religion, will, it is under-

stood, retire from the Corporation in July on attaining the age


limit of 6o. It has been suggested in some quarters that Mr.
Iremonger's departure is attributable to disagreement on the
lightening of the Sunday programmes, but this is not the
case.

It can now be disclosed that


one of the duties of the Director
of Religion has been to " vet''
plays intended for Sunday
broadcasting. Of' these, only r
per cent. have been rejected by
Mr. Iremonger as unsuitable for
inclusion in the Sunday programmes

VOICE OF THE MINORITY


German Station in Czechoslovakia

ELNIK, the Czechoslovakian


Broadcasting Company's
German-speaking station,, is the
only station which provides for
a foreign language minority.
The transmitter, erected by a
British fis-ii, operates with a
power of ioo k\V, and can
transmit on 269.5 or 470 metres.
Studios are located in Prague,
and the entire programme staff
belong to the German-speaking
minority.

Reichsender Wien

the name of

the
ALTHOUGH
Vienna broadcasting station

changed to Reichsender Wien in


March on the annexation of
Austria by Germany, the former
Austrian broadcasting company,
Ravag, still exists, but under the
direction of Dr. Glasmeier,
Director - General of German
broadcasting iII Berlin. He has
been appointed acting D.G. of
Ravag until the company has
been liquidated and the shareholders (the Government and
Municipality of Vienna) have
been paid out.
We understand that the
rumours regarding the treatment
of Herr Czeija, the former D.G.
and founder of Ravag, are unfounded.
He was sent on
leave " until the end of his
contract, and is now in his home
in Vienna.
The Austrian transmitters
S. P. B. MAIS has compiled a programme designed to give B.B.C.
were not Government-owned,
listeners a panorama of holiday -making. Records typifying the
but on the completion of the
holiday spirit have been made at well-known seaside resorts and
winding -up of Ravag they will
Mr. Mais is seen here interviewing a charabanc conductor on the
become the property of the
front at Brighton. A recording of this interview will be included
German Post Office, as are all
in the programme " Britain on the Bust," to be broadcast at 9, on
the transmitters in Germany,
Monday (Nat.). On the following day Brighton will again be on the
where the broadcasting authoriair, when it is to be the subject of the first of the series of visits to
ties only provide the profavourite coastal towns.
grammes.
Another change with the
In
America
during
the
weekCOPYRIGHT IN
anschluss was the cessation of
end
of
June rrth-12th ama- the publication of, the official
TELEVISION BROADCASTS
teurs took part in the annual radio paper, Radio
Preventing Unauthorised
-Wien. This
field day, conducted by the. was amalgamated
Reproduction
with another
Amateur
Radio
Relay
League.
VIEWERS who watched the This served as a proving ground paper, Radio -Woche, under the
title Rundfunkwoche. Another
Foord-Phillips fight by television will have noticed that- a for the portable emergency Austrian paper, however, Das
copyright warning notice was statins which are so frequently Kleine Kino and Radioblatt,
displayed at odd intervals needed in flooded areas for which is most popular among
contact with the Austrian home -constructors,
throughout the transmission. It maintaining
conoutside
world
when all other tinues under its
is understood that this new
original name.
means
of
communication
have
practice has been adopted in
order to guard against big broken down.
ENGLISH IS PREFERRED
screen displays in places of
B.B.C. ENTHUSIASM
Foreign Titles in Programmes
public entertainment.. Hitherto
to be Translated
it has been possible for the organBusmen's Holidays for Television
Producers
isers of such demonstrations to
IT is a wise new move on the
defer screen projection until
part of the B.B.C. to issue
AT least three producers at
after the copyright warning
Alexandra Palace will use instructions to its programme
notice had been transmitted at their holidays as opportunities staff that henceforth programme
the beginning of the programme. for developing their television items with foreign titles must
The B.B.C.'s latest little dodge programmes in the autumn and be announced in English,
may have interesting results.
winter. Reginald Smith, one of wherever
possible.
Thus,
the variety producers, is touring ' Marche Hongroise " becomes
the s',-.aside shows of the Isle of in the B.B.C. vocabulary
FIVE -METRE TESTS
Wight, and will probably dis- " Hungarian March," and "Die
An Opportunity for Short-wave
cover some new photogenic Meistersinger " will be called
Enthusiasts
His colleague, Harry " The Mastersingers." Where
THE National five-metre field faces.
Pringle, is off to Mentone, an English composer saw fit to
day, organised by the Radio ' where, he will meet some of his give his work a foreign title, as,
Society of Great Britain for leading artistes..
for instance, Elgar's " Salut
Sunday next, July 3rd, will proBut the most romantic holi- d'Amour," this will be retained,
vide an excellent opportunity for day plans are Jan Bussell's. A as also will titles which do not
readers' to test, their five -metre great believer in the use of pup- appear to necessitate translareceivers. All over the country pets for -television, he is touring tion, such as " La Bohme,"
amateurs with five -metre trans-. Greece, Italy and France in which would not look or sound
mitters will, from vantage points, search of marionettes and .pup- so well as " The Bohemian
conduct tests through the days.
pet shows.
World."
-

WheIlgeo
Would

JUNE 3oth, 1938.


NEW MAURETANIA
Elaborate Wireless Equipment
THE most lavishly wireless-

equipped liner in the world


will undoubtedly be the Mauretania, new Cunard -White Star
liner to be launched at Birkenhead on July 28th. Provision
is made for the distribution of
three different broadcast programmes throughout the ship
by means of carefully concealed
loud speakers, and in the big
public rooms the volume will be
increased according to the number of people present. Acoustic
characteristics in the restaurant
have been improved by placing
the speakers in the -hollow pillars.
All interference arising from
the vessel's electrical mechanism
is suppressed, and filters are
fitted in the communication circuits. The telegraph and telephone receiving room is completely lined with copper, and
the room housing the directionfinding apparatus is similarly
lined.

comes New Zealand,


with
z8o,000. Other licence figures
are as follow
South Africa
100,000
India
50,000
Palestine
29,000
Newfoundland
11,500
Southern Rhodesia
e,5oo
Ceylon
5,000
Trinidad
2,500
Burina
1,500
A relatively small proportion
of these, of course, pick up the

:-

Daventry programmes.

ANTLPIRATE MEASURES
IN ITALY

WIRELESS pirates

FROM ALL
QUARTERS
Tele -News Theatre

has been acquired at


British Industries House, Marble
Arch, London, for the erection of
a Monseigneur News Theatre
which will incorporate facilities
for public televiewing.
A

ALL -WELSH BROADCAST-

ING
Regional Development Scheme
Taking Shape
Y

WORK will soon begin on the


construction of the new

B.B.C. station at Clevedon,


Somerset, now that the differences between the Air Ministry
and the B.B.C. have been amicably adjusted. When Clevedon

working-approximately a
year after the opening of Start
Point this summer-Washford
Cross will go " all -Welsh."
When the Welsh Regional
Director recently received a
party of Welsh journalists, he
was pessimistic regarding a site
for new offices in Cardiff, though
undoubtedly these would be
needed at a later date. The
trouble was lack of money, and
he did not want to encourage his
Welsh friends into thinking that
such an important development
was immediately in the offing.
Nevertheless, we are able to
state that a site on the Bute
estate has already been found
which will ultimately be the
home of Welsh broadcasting.
is

in Italy

must be brave and resourceful, for the new regulations give them as much scope
as a cat in- a kennel of hounds.

SITE

Inventor of U -Boat Detector


Retires

Art ER completing forty years'


service at Queen Mary College,
Mile End Road, London, Prof.
J. T. MacGregor -Morris retires today (Thursday). 11e will be remembered by many for his work
in the invention of apparatus for
detecting enemy submarines during the Great \Var. His department (Electrical Engineering) was
a pioneer in the work on the development of cathode-ray tubes
and oscillographs.
New Radio Title
the first time, the Minister
of Posts in the Belgian Cabinet
holds the added title of Minister of
I.N.R. (Institut National de
Radiodiffusion),
the
Belgian
broadcasting organisation.
FOR

583.

Each radio dealer keeps a register in which all transactions are


registered, with the name and
addresses of set purchasers.
Every owner of a broadcast receiver is given a " broadcast
listener's book," in which
licence payments are recorded,
and this must be produced on
demand. If a licence is to be
cancelled, notice must' be given
not later than November in the
current year, otherwise the
licence must be renewed. If the
listener canot continue to use
his set, but does not wish to dispose of it, the Post Office places
it in a sealed case.
Certain authorised r a d i o
dealers may install receiving sets
on trial for a period not exceeding ten days. For this a special
licence is obtainable.
-

Exhibitions
STREET will be a
feature- of the Vienna Fair -to- be.
held from September 4th to the
itth. It will provide Austrians
with their first public television
demonstration.
The.slogan of the Berlin Radio
Exhibition,
which opens_ on
August 5th,. has been 'changed
from " Voice of the People " to
" Broadcasting: Voice of the

TELEVISION

Nation."

Seeking the Golden Fleece


B.B.C. is badly in need of a

THE

television commentator and last


week tests were taken by nine
young men at Wimbledon. Each
took the microphone for ten
minutes, and described the tennis
going- on before him, while the recording unit relentlessly registered
every word. The results are to
be judged at leisure.
Institute of Wireless Technology
ON Friday, July 15th, at a
special meeting of the Institute,
the President, Mr. Sydney A.
Hurren, 111'C., M.I.W.T., will deliver a lecture entitled, " A New
System of Pianoforte ElectrdAcoustics," which will be followed
by a demonstration.

1(

c\

':Mf,, ,:4 ,' .' ",'

"

'

V'"

4,(,,,

;Ji,Iri ,1IM4cJ/k,/,,

.=

_,_

.,. !

.,,,,'

n.r.

,.

Wu.iKr:.

+rWd;,y
414;14:

B.B.C.'S EMPIRE
AUDIENCE
Licensed Listeners in the Dominions
and Colonies

1MPIRE listeners are more


far-flung than numerous,
according to the data recently
collected by the B.B.C. concerning the number of licensed
listeners in the Dominions and
Colonies. Actually they number
fewer than a third of the licenceholders at home, the approximate figure being a little over
two and a half million.
Canada leads the way with approximately 1,050,000 licences,
and Australia is the runner-up
Next
with about 1,030,000.

SPEAKERS
bedded
in
the
ground are the latest
Telefunken
PA
development
in
Germany.
Inconspicuously located in
their
foot - level
water-tight housings,
these 10- and 20 watt units will be
used in large openair arenas for mass
sports meetings.
LOUD

Celestion and Magnavox


to -morrow, July Ist, the
technical and production resources
of the Celestion and Magnavox
concerns will be combined' in a
single company. Celestion, Ltd.,
have acquired the technical designs, patents, etc., of the Magnavox concern and will continue
under the name of Celestion, Ltd.,
with Mr. R. B. Page as managing
director. Mr. Guy Campbell and
Mr. Aytoun Kay, of the Benjamin
Electric, Ltd., have joined the
Board of Celestion, Ltd.
FROM

British Standards for Prague


Post Office are conducting, on 6.1 metres, tests on
their recently completed experimental television transmitter. 405 line pictures are being radiated so
that viewers have the advantage
of being able to use British receivers. Two public viewing halls
will be opened in Prague in the
autumn, and decisions regarding
the introduction of a regular television service are largely dependent on the reaction of the man in -the-street.
THE Czech

Development on the Short Waves


FOLLOWING the Cairo Resolution
which states that only short-wave
broadcasting stations with a power
of more than 5 kW are entitled to
the channels they claim, it has
been decided to increase the output of the i -kW Finnish transmitter near Helsinki to io kW.
This expansion is now being
carried out, and in addition to this
the Government will shortly
grant 10,500,000 marks (approx.
4o,000) for the erection of a 50kW short - wave
broadcasting
station on a site which has been
selected near Bjorneborg.

American Listeners
IT is estimated by the

Joint

Committee o Radio Research in


America that 26,64t,000 homes
are equipped with radio in the
United States.
This represents
32 per cent. of the families in the
country as calculated in July,
1937. It was also estimated that
there are 3.96 persons per family.
(In England there are 3.6 persons
per family.)
Last Year's Sets are Not Luxuries ?
AN interesting clause in the
regulations for poor relief formulated b the Canadian Board of
Control concerns the possession by
relief families of such luxuries as
cars and radio. Radio sets, it has
been decided, must be forfeited,
and their value deducted from the
relief if bought since 1937. In
the case of cheap and second-hand
sets, adjustments may be made to
suit individual circumstances. It
is realised that obsolete sets in
relief homes may be the only form
of entertainment available for the

destitute.

Laughter and Cheers


regarding the appointment of a new Director General for the R.B.C. were raised
in the House of Commons last week.
Mr. De La Bere said hopefully to
QUESTIONS

the Assistant Postmaster -General:


" Will the hon. gentleman press
on the Governors (of the B.B.C,)
the importance of not appointing
a successor who will provoke
Members of Parliament? "

The TT'freless World, June

The

Key tO Circuits

- 198

OHMS

---11- --

E
53C/S

WORKING OUT
REACTANCE VALUES
the circumstances but we cannot write
all that down whenever we address a letter
to him. The practical method is to give
him a name and leave his various purposes in life to be taken account of when
the occasion arises.
In the same way, the reactances of components in a circi:it are never marked on
diagrams, because they depend on circumstances
(i.e.,
the frequencies of
currehts flowing),
but for reference
they a r e given
50C/s
labels that ordin200 VOLTS
arily do not vary
l
to any important
0.083 AMP.
extent with fre(d)
quency.
These
;

5H

3142 OHMS

2348 OHMS

(a)

(b)

(o)

x.-(a)

olh, 1938

AST time I tried to bring a certain


amount of light to readers who
can deal with simple DC circuits
by the application of Ohm's Law
but who are thrown into confusion by the
different sorts of ohms that are talked
about in connection with AC circuits. I
showed that, in addition to the ordinary
ohms, in which resistance is measured,
there are other ohms that cannot be added
or subtracted straightforwardly, but require square roots and things in the calculation, or if one fights shy of that one
can do it very simply by measuring out
lengths on paper in the form of a right-

T'

is a simple circuit diagram as it usually appears. Before


the way it works can be seen, the reactance values must be worked
out (b). Then it can be simplified by combining the two reactances (c).
Lastly by combining resistance and reactance it is in fit state for

Fig.

labels are the

By

"CATHODE RAY"

ohms, but generally you don't know the


inductance within a henry either way, and
if you do it hardly matters.
When it comes to HF tuning coils, the
inductances are in millihenrys (mH) or
microhenrys (H), and the frequencies in
kilocycles per second (kc/s) or mega:
cycles per second (Mc / s). This is still
quite easy if, when L is in mH we write
down the frequency in kc / s and when it
is H take f in Mc/s.
For example, a
rho -H tuning coil at a frequency of 750
kc / s (0.75 Mc / s) has a reactance of
roughly 6 x 0.75 x 160, or 720 ohms. A
long -wave coil of 2,000 H at 150 kc/s is
more conveniently written as 2 mH. And
so on.

A Convenient Unit

Xc is a little less simple. Farads are


never used in practice. The commonest
unit is the microfarad (F, or sometimes
mfd.), but if it involves a lot of decimal
places it is more sensible to use the millionth part of it, the micro-microfarad
(1zF or mmfd.). To calculate Xc most

familiar ones of
r,Ooo,000,
inductance
a n -d
easily, take it as
in which if C
2 -IC
capacity. The
applying simple Ohm's Law.
values of induct- is i'.i F, f must be in c/s, and if C is in
ance and capacity F, f must be in Mc/s. By doing this
angled triangle, representing to scale the marked on circuit diagrams do not in there is least likelihood of tripping up
different lots of ohms in the circuit. Any- themselves tell us very much, any more among rows of decimal places. Example :
body can calculate an AC circuit in this than a person's name in a directory tells us an 8-mfd. smoothing condenser at ioo c / s
way without any mathematical knowledge whether he is grey-haired or works hard or (which is the chief ripple frequency resultat all. We had got this far, that in an AC beats his wife or has a golf handicap of 20. ing from a full -wave rectifier). Xc is
circuit there may be resistance (R) and If inductance and capacity were the sig1'000'000' or almost exactly 200 ohms.
two sorts of reactance (inductive, XL, and nificant quantities, then it would be impos0223x8
sible
method
exto
do
most
and
by
the
of
the
things that are re- To avoid these calculations, a chart has
capacitive, Xc) ;
plained they can all be combined to give quired of radio. circuits. It is the ability been published several times in The Wireto be several things at once that comes in less World; one of the sort in which you
a single number of ohms, impedance (Z),
armed with which one is in a position to so useful.
just lay a ruler or a piece of thread across
Fortunately, it is. very easy to calculate the page and read' the result.
use the good old Ohm's Law, putting Z
reactance, given the inductance (or capawhere one is accustomed to put R.
The most important general feature
city) and frequency. Here are
Unspecified Reactances
the formuke:- 1592 OHMS
- 21
XL=2-/L
supplied
very
if
one
is
well
This is all
f
with all the necessary figures, the numbers
Ls
Xc='
25 C/S

2-fC
p 200 VOLTS
of ohms corresponding to R, XL, and Xc.
As most people
But while circuit diagrams usually oblige
00 AMP
with R, they never say anything about the know, - is the num5H
1571 OHMS
reactances, for the disconcerting reason ber of times greater
(a)
(c)
(b)
(d)
that reactances do not exist apart from cur- t h e circumference
of a circle is than
rent of a definite frequency. DC, as Mr.
Fig. 2. --If the frequency is changed, everything otherwise being the
the diameter, and
Scroggie likes to have us realise, is current
same as in Fig. 1, filling in reactance values shows how the working
of zero frequency, so reactance doesn't needs an infinite
is completely changed.
come into the picture at all, and that is number of decimal
why DC circuits are so simple. But in places to write down in full ; but that need about all this is that increasing the frequency makes XL increase, but Xc
AC circuits the frequency of the currents not worry us. For very rough estimates
present may be constantly changing, and 2- can be regarded as 6 ; a better approxi- decrease. And vice versa.
Now we are ready to calculate an AC
often there are currents of several different mation 61 ; and for greater accuracy still
circuit from the information given on any
frequencies in the same place at the same it can be taken as 6.283. If XI. and Xc
ordinary diagram such as you find in
time. So each component in the circuit are to be in ohms, L and c must be in
Fig. i (a) is a
may have any number of different react- henrys and farads. For working out the every Wireless World.
ances. An individual person may be a reactance of a LF choke; this is usually simple example including all three elebank manager and a justice of the Peace very easy. Suppose a choke is 20 henrys, ments in series with a 5o -cycle supply.
and a husband and a father and a church- then the reactance at a frequency of 5o c/s Working out the reactances as just exwarden and president of the bowls club, is roughly 6 x 5o x 20, or 6,000 ohms. If plained we get Fig. r (b). Remembering
or several of them at once, according to you want to be very precise, it is 6,283 that Xc is negative and therefore can be

-i1-

Wpd.,sog

JUNE 3o1h, 1938.

585

Would

The Key to Circuits-

subtracted from XL, we get a total X of


2,346 ohms, which being positive is inductive, and so Fig. i (b) is equivalent
to (c). Boiling this down still further as
described in the previous article, Z is

FROM

RECTIFIER

(a)

lar frequency-the resonant frequencyand, as everybody knows, is the object of


tuning. If at the same time the resistance
is made very small-say 5o ohms-the
current at resonance is large
amps.
and the voltages across coil and condenser
exceed 6,000. That
is how " sharp "
tuned circuits step
up the applied voltage, often several
hundredfold.
Mark that the
same voltage applied to the same
circuit gives con-

-4

(b)

3.-Two fragments of circuits-a smoothing filter, and a grid leak type of detector-in which the working depends on different
treatment given to different frequencies, which can only be seen by
working out the reactances.
Fig.

4/R2 f X2, in this case 2,400 ohms, and


as impedance as a single item has no
recognised symbol in a circuit diagram I
have put it in Fig. i (d) as a labelled box
'concealing the " works." Having reduced
the original diagram to this single element,
it is in a form where Ohm's Law can be
'applied to find the current in the circuit.
Suppose the supply is 200 volts, then the

spicuously- different
results, simply by a
change in fre-

quency. This is
how circuit values
can be selected so
as to pass currents
of one frequency and impede those of another, and is' the basis of circuit design.
Why are 20 H. and 8 mfd. suitable values

for smoothing circuits? Because at the


hswest ripple frequency usually present in
the output from the rectifier they are reactances of 12,600 ohms and 200 ohms respectively, so only a small proportion of
the ripple appears across the condenser.
But at zero frequency (DC) the reactance
of the choke is nil and of the condenser
infinity ; so except for the drop in the resistance of the choke the whole_ of the
desired DC is obtained. Why is the grid
condenser across a 4-megohm leak in a
detector circuit for good quality reproduction chosen to be about roc) mmfds.?
Because if it were larger its reactance at
the higher audio frequencies would act as
a shunt to the leak and cause a loss of
high notes ; and if it were smaller its reactance at the Lower radio frequencies
would impede them and cause inefficient
detection (Fig. 3). And so on, and so on.
I think I was quite justified in describing
the calculation of impedance as the key to
understanding and designing circuits, and
therefore worth some effort in coping with
the apparent ohms muddle.

SUMMING UP
For DC circuits, and ACl
with resistance only ...f

For all circuits

current is 200

...

Ohm's Law

:-I =

I=

Amps =
Amps

Volts
Ohms (resistance)
Volts
Ohms (impedance)

, 0.083 or 83 mA.
for Z see below.
2,40o
Or can be got by drawing right-angled triangle
Impedance
Z
= VR2 + X2
to scale with Z, R, and X as the sides Z the
Going back now to Fig. i (b), by multifor X see below.
longest.
plying each number of ohms in turn by
X = XL Xe
Easy
0.083 we get the voltage across each ele- Reactance...
...
for XL and Xe see below.
ment. The voltage across the condenser is
Ohms = 6.283 X c/ s x henrys.
XL = 2 L
or 6.283 X kc/s X mil
66.4, across the resistance 41.7, and Inductive reactance
or 6.283 X Mc/s X Ft.
across the coil 262. At first sight this may
1,000,000
1
seem to be a contradiction of Euclid's Capacitive reactance
Ohms =
Xe = 27rft
6.283 X cis X F
axiom about the part never being greater
1,000,000
or
than the whole.
But then the voltage
6.283 X Mc/s X F
is
negative,
which
the
condenser
across
Or XL and Xe can be found without calculation by using The Wireless World alignment chart.
means that it is in opposition to that
Even when that is deacross the coil.
ducted, giving 195.6, this added to 41.7
(the voltage across the resistance) is much
more than Zoo. But I explained last time
why you can't just add resistances and
reactances, and the same applies to the
voltages across them. Now we seem to A.R.P. and Amateurs
The Editor does not necessarily endorse
have done quite a lot of work in getting THANK
the opinions of his correspondents
HANK you for publishing Mr. N. P.
the low-down on this simple circuit, and
1 Spooner's timely letter on the subject
might hope that it has been done once of " Amateurs and A.R.P. Work." While sional or ex -professional men who would be
for all. But not so ; directly a different agreeing in general with his remarks, I do fully capable of rendering invaluable service
frequency is applied the whole thing has not think the authorities are wise in so defi- in an emergency.
Let there be no misunderstanding. The
to be gone through again. Suppose the nitely closing the door against amateur cofrequency is changed to 25 cycles. You operation. I do agree, however, that any F.O.C. does not seek to organise communimay like to check my working in Fig. 2. idea of a general amateur communication cation networks or engage on A.R.P. work
In this, the voltages across condenser network would be foredoomed to failure unless called upon to do so by the appropriate authority. F.O.C. members, being
So al- from the outset. Any professional operator
and coil both rise to over 600.
British amateurs,
who listened to the recent National Field
primarily concerned
though the supply voltage is only zoo Day operations would be immediately con- with experimental are
work, but they are able
it is not safe to use a condenser rated vinced that the average amateur is quite in- to supplement their work with first-class
to work at 25o or even 500 volts. The capable of handling traffic in sufficient operating technique,
= 21 ohms in (c) is the reactance at 25 volume to be of the slightest value to the
Referring again to Mr. Spooner's letter,
one cannot help deploring the short-sighted
cycles of a capacity of 30o mfd. So al- authorities.
But these remarks do not apply to the viewpoint of Sir Samuel Hoare's technical
though only 4 mfd. is actually in circuit,
the addition of the coil is equivalent to re- considerable number of amateurs who are advisers, who state that " the use of wireless
highly skilled operators. It may interest for A.R.P. communications is not considered
placing it by a 300-mfd. condenser.
The Z in Fig. 2 (d) is, of course, actu- your readers to know that a First-class practicable," and that the telephone " must
Club has recently been formed
be regarded as the normal means of commually 'more than 5oo ohms, but only by a Operators'
among British amateurs with the object of nication." If anyone can think of a means
fraction of one ohm, so the difference is encouraging and maintaining a high stan- of communication more vulnerable t air atnegligible. The two reactances almost dard of operating on the amateur bands. All tack than the telephone I should like to hear
exactly cancel out, leaving practically re- the members of this club are expert opera- of it.
sistance only. This occurs at one particu- tors, and the majority of them are profesShould any of your readers desire further
:

_Fetters to the
1

Editor

Wpego2

.586

JUNE 3oth, 1938.

WopIlcal
Letters to the Editordetails of the First-class Operators' Club I
shall be pleased to give full information if
they will write to " Radio G5BW, Willing R. B. WEBSTER.
don, Eastbourne."
Eastbourne, Sussex.

Debunking Intermodulation
Ithe article by " Cathode Ray " in your
May 19th issue, the evidence in favour of
the superiority of intermodulation to harmonics as a criterion of distortion appears
to
(a) on a test comparing two receivers with
different types of output stage, it is considered that a pentode stage exhibits audible
intermodulation at a lower output than a
push-pull triode stage. The only data
supplied is the output rating of the system,
presumably valve maker's ratings, which
takes no account of loss in the output transformer. It would be interesting to know
the relative outputs of the two receivers at
5o c /s and at a lower harmonic level.
(b) Mr. Harries' experiments are quoted
to suggest that the only connection between
intermodulation distortion and old-fashioned
harmonics is that the first appears at the
point where the amplitudes of two particular harmonics happen to go in opposite
directions.
The views expounded by " Cathode Ray "
are supported by Mr. Benham in his letter
of June 2nd, and as, after intermittent
research during the past three years we find
it possible to take up a rather different view
by the consideration of additional, and very
important, factors, we offer the following
comments.
Everyone is agreed that the present
system of specifying distortion by the total
RMS harmonic content bears little relationship to the audibility or the unpleasantness
of the distortion. This is to a great extent
due, not to the unsuspected presence of

be:-

intermodulation products, but to the fact


that at all frequencies and intensities except
those > 2,000 c/s at very low levels, the

sensitivity. of the ear, as modified by the


masking effect of the fundamental, increases
rapidly with the order of the harmonic.
This increase is so rapid that the suggestion
quoted by "Cathode Ray" of weighting the
harmonic amplitudes by multiplying each
by the order of harmonic involved, is quite
insufficient to represent the relative audibility of the different harmonics.
When "Cathode Ray " invokes the aid of
musical theory to establish the relative
unpleasantness of different harmonics he is
on thin ice, for the appreciation of musical
intervals is a complicated function of the
height of the subject's brow: A devotee of
modern compositions enjoys nothing better
than a good hearty discord and considers
octaves, fifths and thirds as painful afflictions. Even if we do adopt an arbitrary
sequence for the relative discord of musical
intervals we find that the relative discord
of the intermodulation products from the
two tones of a simple musical interval is only
slightly greater than that for a harmonic of
a single tone : on the other hand, if the
original tones are discordant, the discord of
the intermodulation tones is not so annoying. All things considered, it may be better
not to attempt to estimate a quality such
as " annoyance value " which we cannot
even define. Let us then concentrate on
audibility.
The fact that, as Mr. Benham points out,
the intermodulation tones produced by the
combination of two tones of widely different
amplitudes may have amplitudes large

compared with the smaller primary tone,


does not mean that in the general case this
tone will be more audible than the harmonics of the larger primary tone ; it is
surely more logical to compare the power
in the alien tones with the total power in
the primary tones.
The masking effects mentioned above,
which affect the normal audibility threshold
level and cause the higher harmonics to be
so much more audible, operate also in the
presence of two or more primary tones, and
it is found that, except for a few special
cases, the masking of the individual intermodulation tones is greater than the masking of the corresponding harmonics from a
single tone of frequency equal to the higher
of the two parent frequencies.
Of the special cases just mentioned one is
that of two high-frequency tones producing
different tones of lower frequency which
are therefore subject to only a small degree
of masking. This type of distortion is rarely
bad owing to the small amplitude of highfrequency tones in music. Another special
case is that of a high -amplitude low frequency tone combined with a low-amplitude high-frequency tone. This is the flute
and drum combination which is so attractive
to the intermodulation protagonists Duets
for the flute and drum are not common and
it would appear that musical composers
have realised that this combination produces
a nasty noise. This it does without the
intervention of any non-linearity additional
to that already present in the ear, which
leads us to another consideration, i.e.,
subjective harmonics and intermodulation
tones.

Alien Tones
The strongest argument in favour of intermodulation tones as producers of distortion
has been that they are in general alien
tones which were not present in the original
sound, whereas harmonics are always
present in some degree. The production of
new tones might be expected to be much
more noticeable than the variation of
amplitude of existing tones. If, as we surely
must, we include the ear in our transmission
system, then we must recognise the fact that
among the frequencies the sensation of
which is experienced in the brain, the
intermodulation tones will always be present
(see " Speech and Hearing," Figs 90, .91,
92 and 93). Harmonics and intermodulation
tones are produced in the ear at quite low
sensation levels, particularly at low frequencies, and at normal listening levels correspond to comparatively large distortions.
From this, intermodulation products are
seen to lose their unique value and cannot
really be considered as a phenomenon
separate from harmonics. For harmonics are
really only that special case of intermodulation tones when the two or more parent
frequencies coincide. It can also be shown
that for ordinary types of non -linearity the
RMS total of harmonics is not widely
different from the RMS total of intermodulation tones (produced by a number of
tones of total power equal to that of the
single tone). The amplitudes of both intermodulation tones and harmonics are directly
related to the coefficients of the power series
representing the characteristic of the system
so that any particular intermodulation tone
could .be predicted from measurements of
the harmonics obtained with a single input.
It has frequently been suggested that
distortion should be measured using a twotone input, but even if all the high order
intermodulation tones were measured, there

is still the necessity for a weighting system

to give emphasis to those components which


are most audible. The test is more difficult
and no more informative than a harmonic
test. Harries' criterion of a falling second
merely marks the onset of fourth harmonic
while the sharp rise in third harmonic indicates the appearance of fifth harmonic.
There is no reason why these phenomena
should occur simultaneously, while it is conceivable that in .some systems the onset of
fourth harmonic might cause the second
harmonic to rise, while the fifth might cause
the third to fall.
A complete specification of harmonic
distortion in any system would require tests
of all measurable harmonics to be made at
all frequencies and at all output levels.
Additional tests made with multiple tone
inputs would provide additional information
quite incommensurate with the labour
involved. It is fortunate that in most radio
receivers the greater part of the distortion
occurs in the output stage and there is little
frequency discrimination subsequent to the
distortion, so that a test at a single frequency
(40o c/s) is fairly satisfactory, although it
may with advantage be supplemented with
a test at 5o c/s.
A harmonic test at 5o c/s on the two
receivers compared by " Cathode Ray "
would show the difference in performance at
this frequency just as well as the two-tone
test. The difference need not be due to the
different types of output systems but may
be attributable to the great reduction of load
value at 5o c/s due to the shunting effect
of the primary inductance in the pentode
output transformer.
Fortunately again it is found that the
relative audibility of the harmonics does not
vary very greatly either with frequency or
with intensity level over the ranges 200r,000 c/s and -4o to -so db intensity levels
(relative to r dyne/cm') so that a single
weighting circuit designed to give an RMS
weighted harmonic in the 400 c/s test gives
a good indication of the average performance over the most important range of
audible frequencies.
A distortion meter using such a weighting
circuit has been in use (in the Pye works)
for more than twelve months and its indications have many times been compared with
aural estimates on pure tones and on musical
programmes with reasonably satisfactory
results. Even so, we .cannot agree with
" Cathode Ray's " assertion that the subject
is on " a satisfactory footing " ; as a matter
of fact it was his remark to this effect that
caused us to adopt the counter provocative
heading to our notes.
L. V. CALLENDAR, M.A.,
G. F. CLARKE, B.Sc.,
Research Department,
Cambridge.
Pye, Ltd.
.

The above letter has been shown to


"Cathode Ray," who makes the following

reply.

IAM glad to see that my remarks on the


subject of intermodulation have at last

drawn fire, even though one shot (fired by


Messrs. Callendar and Clarke) says they are
not true and another (by Mr. Benham) says
they are too obviously true to be worth
printing. Perhaps it would be wiser for me
to withdraw and let these opposing forces
fight it out. But as I have already replied
to Mr. Benham, I had better say something
to Messrs. Callendar and Clarke too.
Their contribution is a valuable corrective
to too great an enthusiasm for intermodulation as against harmonics, and is so con-

VApehoo
Would

JUNE 3oth, x938.


vincing as almost to. persuade me that there
is something in it, were it not that it entirely
fails to explain the results of my little
experiment in which tones that separately
sound practically undistorted are found to
give rise to gross distortion when played
'together.
The effect of masking is quoted. That is
a very important factor, too often neglected.
T have looked up Wegel and Lane's Bell
Telephone Laboratories data, and here are
some deductions therefrom
.

:-

db. below

harmonic.

fundamental to be
just audible.

Corresponding
percentage.

2
3

18
17

18
32
45

No. of

4
5
8

ea

83
58

Now I want to make clear that I am not


necessarily backing these figures ; in fact,
it is one of my contentions that an exact
harmonic is less obtrusive than something
.slightly different in frequency-an effect
that is not exhibited by the data referred
to. But the figures do not help Callendar
and Clarke either.
Then they seem to be on even thinner ice
than I am, in relation to musical theory.
To mix the metaphor, they are barking up
the wrong tree. The reason a devotee of
modern composition considers octaves,
fifths, etc., as " painful afflictions " is that
they are so insipid and unobtrusive. Which
proves my point admirably.
" The relative discord of the intermodulation products from the two tones of a simple
musical interval is only slightly greater than
that for a harmonic of a single tone." No!
Suppose the two tones are too and 800 c/s.
They harmonise simply, for one is three
octaves above the other. Harmonics also
are simple harmonics. But intermodulation
tones are boo and goo. Try striking three
adjacent keys of the piano simultaneously
(black keys Included) instead of the middle
one only, in a piece of Mozart, and compare
the " distortion " with that produced by
throwing in an octave or two. The former
represents the effect of the intermodulation
tones mentioned.
The flute and drum argument is hardly
worthy of your correspondents' qualification. The combination is admittedly rare,
but I would remind them that the fife and
drum is a recognised combination. Not that
I think any the more of it for that ; but if
composers have realised that loud low tones
simultaneously with high ones " produce
a nasty noise," they have been most unkind,
for every organ recital and symphony concert I have ever heard lias included this,
more or less frequently. -Loud pedal notes
on the organ, or bass drum work in the
orchestra, on their own are indeed rare.
But in combination with high notes from
-violins, wood -wind, etc., they hardly
deserve to be considered ad a " special case."
It is just this frequent combination that
sounds so unpleasant when intermodulation
exists.
The subjective argument is a more valid
one. But without denying that the ear itself
produces intermodulation, if the, engineer
were to be allowed to use that as an excuse
for tolerating it in his apparatus, where
:would we end? The fundamental rule for
all concerned in the various links in sound
reproduction is to give the ear what it would
'get if it were present at the original performance. What the ear does with it then
is no business of theirs. Moreover (I only

587

the muffled effect were noticed on a good


loud speaker fed from these, I should believe
that the transmission was at fault. Even
with a speaker whose high note response is
not as good as it might be I do not notice
any muffling.

throw this out as a suggestion) may not the


type of intermodulation produced by a
pentode be more foreign to the ear than that
by a triode? It seems highly probabre that
it should be so.
I am sorry that I cannot gather from
Callendar and Clarke's description of their
distortion meter what precautions, if any,
they take to cover the masking effect they
refer to earlier in their letter. A fuller
description would be appreciated.
Finally, if your correspondents will reread my article they will see that I did not
say that the subject was on a satisfactory
footing, but that Harries' experiments were
not altogether on a satisfactory footing
because no explanation for the alleged relationship between harmonics and modulation
products was given.
" CATHODE RAY."

H. S. SAXTON.

Nottingham.

T READ with interest the letter in your


issue of June gth from Mr. T. J. E. Warburton entitled " Muffled Broadcasting."
Mr. Warburton suggests that the main
cause of the above effect is insufficient modulation of the carrier wave. But I suspect
that the trouble is in Mr. Warburton's receiver, and is probably caused by poor HF
rectification, in addition to which the signal
diodes may be getting hot owing to their
close proximity to the cathode, and, therefore, be emitting electrons.
I have had a number of cases of this
nature, and would strongly advise your
correspondent to remove the chassis from
the cabinet so that the heat which is generated in the receiver may dissipate more
quickly.
It is an unfortunate fact that most commercial receivers have poor provision for
heat dissipation, as, after they have been
switched on a little while, you can virtually
fry eggs in 'em
Surely the B.B.C. are not to blame for
this!
M. MISTVSKI.

Relays
ON the excuse of doing a little debunking,
" Praxis," in his letter in The Wireless
World of. June 23rd, has succeeded in
making out a better case against the relay
system than its opponents have done. If,
as he states, the relay companies are involved in heavy losses, in some cases reaching 90 per cent., whatever this may mean,
can there be any excuse for their continuing
to operate?
The matter need not be
further argued, however, for it will obviously settle itself in a very short time.
When he deals with television relay systems, " Praxis " deals equally hardly with
the system he advocates. He does not make
it at all clear what method of connection to
the subscribers he favours, but it would
appear to be an open wire line with earth
return. On the face of it, this system is

London, S.E.rr.

THE WIRELESS INDUSTRY


C.S. RADIO, formerly of Bromley,
1-1 moved to more central premises at has
16,
Gray's Inn Road, London, W.C.r. The firm
specialises in short-wave apparatus, corninunication receivers, etc.
-

unsuitable an account of the susceptibility


of such lines to interference, especially in
urban and suburban districts.
The alternative interpretation of his
letter is that he is referring to wave -guides.
As far as I- am aware, these are at present
in the experimental state, are suitable only
for centimetre wavelengths, and are, by
their bulk, unsuitable for a relay system.
C. G. J.

Ferranti announces the introduction of a


range of American -type valves with Octal
bases.
The range comprises a heptode,
variable -mu RF pentode, double -diode -triode,
output pentode, and a full -wave rectifier.
r

The 1938-9 catalogue of Kabi products, dealing with potentrometeis and rheostats (standard and heavy-duty), rotary stud switches
and similar components, is obtainable from
F. W. Lechner and Company,
5, Fairfax
Road, London, N.W.6.

Muffled Broadcasting
SURELY Mr. T. J. E. Warburton (June
9th) is wrong. The percentage modulation at any instant is independent of the
carrier volts in the aerial.
In any case I should advise him to make,
as I have done, the Wireless World Quality
Amplifier fed by a high fidelity receiver
such as the Pretuned Quality Receiver. If

Transparent Metal

THE

advantage of metal films for wireless and instrument fuses lies essentially in their quick action, the time taken
to heat up the small amount of metal to
fusing point being negligible.
A special technique is required for the production and
}Zeteh'sro.t .,
the
t
Prig
ne
handling of these films, and
oue ,it thia nxoi
{v
Microfuses, Ltd., 4, Charter niX)nK{ tee,:
i

1..:.-..

.c,.tarty he
}iN,'T had beenCthti.i
.ysonai ovcan& wtithAdt"
linee

.v.tcnt
er+is

r<}

en/weevily.

would hsve h'


+tn nS trutp
,t week that
have been p
ti.rl entere
n the tetett

a, ,... 7heref
tee

tonten
..

Y,tly{l.wtn

Je 'Y nhih t
$'ti s,
ha

int0.h

tnal

s etio oC'k

Werkei
t2r ere' -..al 14x

Nt.itK.
C'
li,tttJ men 1te
uu,att
to send terge of
hutnffeJs of ihouNands ett ht

house Buildings, G o s well


Road, London, E.C.r, who
have been responsible for the
development of fuses of this
type, have recently produced
a gold film so thin that it is
easily possible to read print
through it in ordinary light.
Although of molecular thickness the film is perfectly continuous, and is stable from
the chemical point of view.

Gold film thin enough to read


through has been produced for
use in " Microfuses " of low

current rating

The Wireless World, June 30th, 1938

RANLIM RADIATIONS
It Really is Coming

By

AND so at long (very long !) last we arc


going to have a Bill before Parliament
which will include clauses dealing with radiation of interference with wireless reception.
Some of the lay papers have written as
though the new Wireless Telegraphy Act
were coming almost at once. I am afraid
that it isn't ; it may just possibly be introduced during the autumn session, but the
odds are that it won't make its appearance
until next year. Still, it's something to
know that it is coming. We've waited sixteen years for it -broadcasting in this
country began in the autumn of 1922-so I
suppose that we can wait a little longer.
The trouble is that the Wireless Telegraphy
Act, under which the transmission and reception of both broadcasting and television
are controlled, is an ancient hotch-potch
which became law long before the full possibilities and the implications of wireless were
realised. Rather than add further bits and
pieces to this quaint miscellany, it is proposed to draft an entirely new Bill, dealing
with radio communications as a whole. This
is necessarily a mighty task. The drafting
of the Bill will take time; and its passage
through the two Houses of Parliament is
likely to be a somewhat lengthy process.

Looking Ahead

One only hopes that on its way through


Parliament the Bill won't become so -watered
down that its anti -interference clauses lose
half their effect. There is sure to be strenuous opposition to some of the proposed regulations by vested interests, such as thoss
who control electric railways or tramways,
cinema theatres, or factories equipped with
electrical machinery. Owners of flashing
signs and such things will lift up their
voices, and motorists may object to the ex -

"DIALLIST"

pense of having their ignition systems rendered innocuous. Then there are householders and shopkeepers who have installed
domestic and tradb appliances which radiate
badly. And something will no doubt be said
by hospitals, doctors, masseurs, and others
possessing electrical equipment which, however beneficial it may be to "the human
body, is quite the reverse to the human
listener's and viewer's reception.

A Strong Line Needed


All these people may do their utmost to
cut the claws of anti -interference regulations; but really, when one comes to think
of it, they don't deserve any kind of kid glove treatment. It has been known for
ages that anti -interference legislation was
in the offing, and those who have possessed
themselves of any kind of apparatus which
creates interference with radio reception
have done so more or less at their own risk.
It is a pity, of course, that official warnings to those affected were not issued long
ago ; but that is no very important point.
Certainly it is no excuse for the movie
theatre people or the railways or the tramway concerns, or those who possess flashing
signs that radiate. They have known for
years that they were causing interference
because the Post Office engineers have
brought. it home to them when investigating
the thousands of complaints that come in
annually from listeners. And in these days
of " all -wave " sets there must be few
motorists' who couldn't have found out,.
when trying their cars before purchase,
whether or not they caused short-wave
interference. What I' am afraid of is that
we shall see a delay .of at least a year after
the passing of the Act before it comes into
.

operation, and that, even then, those who


own radiating devices may be given a long
period of grace. My rather gloomy forecast
is that it won't be in less than five years
from now that anti-interference legislation
becomes genuinely effective.
-a

Fixing the Portable


better -half possesses a first-rate
portable set from which she will not
be parted, mainly because it can be used in
any room, at any time, or taken out of doors
if need be. Great though its virtues are this
set is, like many of its kind, rather hard on
its batteries. If a portable is to be
portable, both HTB and LTB must be
light and therefore small. The result is
that filament accumulators must frequently be recharged and dry HTB's often
renewed if reasonable quality is to be
maintained. Now this set probably does
.at least 8o per cent, of its work in one
room. It occurred to me that it wouldn't
be at all a bad idea to make the set workable from big batteries of both kinds when
it was there, though still retaining its own
batteries for use in other rooms.
mY

Working It Cut
This set has automatic grid bias and only
two HT battery leads, as all sets should
have nowadays. The problem wasn't,
therefore, a very formidable one. I made
a small block upon which are mounted two
terminals and two sockets to take standard
wander plugs. This stands beside the set,
whose own leads, slightly lengthened if
need be, are disconnected from the batteries inside its cabinet and connected
respectively to the LT terminals and the
HT sockets when it is in use in the room
where it does most of its work. To the
block are permanently connected HT and
LT cables, the former terminating in a large
two -point plug and the latter in a smaller
one, so that Mistakes can't be made. A
neighbouring cupboard conceals a 50 -

Broadcast Programmes
THURSDAY, JUNE 30th.
Nat., 7.45, Eddie Carroll and his
Orchestra. 8.30, " The Future of
Discussion.
Roads "-Transport
9.20, Variety from Northampton.
10.20, Commentary on London and
Home Counties Individual Darts
Championship.
Reg., 6, Adaptation of the film success.
" Sunny Side Up." 8.30. Irish
Dance Music. 9, " The Tower,"
a pageant in sound.
Abroad.
Breslau, 8, " The Magic Flute,"
opera (Mozart) from the Municipal Theatre.
Poste Parisien, 9.5, International
Stars, presented by Adolphe
Borchard.
FRIDAY, JULY Ist.
Nat., 7.30, A Recital of Modern
Part Songs. 8, "Conversation in
the Train." 8.15, The Western
Brothers present " Cads' College."
9.20, A.R.P. and Scotland-talk
by Lt.-Col. D. J. Colville. 9.35,
Chopin Studies, played by Irene
Scharrer, pianoforte.
Reg., 7.30, Oscar Rabin and his Band.
9, "General Release"-Songs from
Current Films.

FEATURES OF
THE WEEK
Abroad.
Leipzig, 8, Dresden Philharmonic,
conducted by Hilmar Weber.

Bucharest, 8, " Der


opera (Weber).

Freischutz,"

SATURDAY, JULY 2nd.


Nat., 7.30, I66th and final edition of
present series, " In Town Tonight." 8, Music Hall, including
Vic Oliver and Lily Morris. 9.20,
9.35,
American Commentary.
Act 4 of the opera " Macbeth "
from Glyndebourne.
Reg., 8.15, Harry Welchman in
" The Shooting of Kara -Wenzel,"
play. 9.10, Act 3 of the opera
Macbeth " from Glyndebourne.
9.30. Quintette du Hot Club de
France.
Abroad.
Radio Eireann, 10.45, The Dublin
Motor Car Race in Phoenix Park.
Prague, 8.30, Concert of Czech
Music.

SUNDAY, JULY 3rd.


Nat., 9.25, Service from Lichfield
Cathedral. 11.30. Students' Songs.
12, Morton and Kaye, pianofortes.
7, Alfredo Campoli and his Orchestra. 9.5, Sermons in Stone.Canterbury Cathedral.
Reg., 5.30 and 6.15, " Don Pasquale,"
Act I, from Glyndeboume. 6.50.
" Liebelei," the play by Arthur
Schnitzler. 9.50, Recital by Jelly
D'Aranyi, violin, and Myra Hess,
pianoforte.
Abroad.
Radio Paris, 8.30, " La Jolie Pat fumeuse," operetta (Offenbach).

MONDAY, JULY 4th.


Nat., 7, Th Bungalow Club. 8.10,
Frank Mannheimer. pianoforte.
9, " Britain on the Bust," a
panorama of summer holidaymaking, compiled by S. P. B. Mais.
9.45, " The Past Week," talk by
the Rt. Hon. Harold Nicolson.
Reg., 8, Sulgrave Manor and Mount
Vernon, a programme arranged for
Independence Day by the B.B.C.
and the C.B.S. 8.20, " Mr. and
Mrs. Neemo," with Billy Caryll and

Hilda Mundy.

Abroad.
Radio Paris, 8.30. Symphony Concert
from the Casino, Vichy.

TUESDAY, JULY 5th.


Nat., 7, " Horner's Corner." 8.30,
Brighton : the first of a series of
visits to seaside resorts.
Reg., 6, Sokol Festival, music from
Prague. 8, Victor Sylvester and his
Orchestra. 8.30, " Granton Street,"
a play by P. H. Burton.
9.30.
" Daylight Robbery," a burlesque
by the Melluish Brothers.
Abroad.
Kalundborg, 8.15, " The Merry

Widow,' opera (Lehr).


Paris PTT, 8.30, ' Lilac Time "
(Schubert-Bert).
WEDNESDAY, JULY 6th.
Nat., 8, Musical Comedy, " Bianca."
9.40, The Story of the Bombing of
Barcelona. A.R.P. talk by John
Langdon -Davies. 9.20, Al Bollington at the B.B.C. Theatre Organ.
Reg., 6, Jack Wilson and his Five.
8, Arthur Benjamin, pianoforte.
8.30, " China Clay," an account
of the " white " industry. 9, The
Coventry Festival-from the precincts of Coventry Cathedral.
Abroad.
Warsaw, 6.10, Concert of American
Music for American Independence
Day.
Brussels I, 8.30, Falla and Ravel,
Concert.

WIlpellm

JUNE 3olh, 1938..

WopIld
ampere -hour filament accumulator and a
high-tension accumulator battery which
was surplus to my own requirements. Each
battery is connected to an` inconspicuous
socket on the outside of the cupboard. It
doesn't take more than a minute or so to
change over from portable to fixed batteries,
and I find that the change is very willingly
made owing to the much better quality
obtainable with the latter "in use. The
quality is better not only because the accumulator HTB keeps always up to the mark,
but also because, the set having automatic
grid bias, I found that a higher HT voltage
could be used than that which the set's
own HTB supplies even when brand new.
%

..

Now We Know . . .
Or Do We

...

?
FOR a long time now there has been agitation in the United States for an authoritative definition of what constitutes a radio
tube, or, as we should say, a wireless valve.
The trouble was that Uncle Sam's citizens
had got into their heads the idea that the
more tubes it contained the more " powerful " must a receiving set be. Hence, Uncle
Sam's manufacturers, ever on the alert for
what are termed " selling points," did their
best to ensure that their products contained
the maximum possible number. I have
mentioned previously some of the tricks of
the trade in that country, such as the use
of four small half -wave rectifiers to do the
work which could perfectly well have been
undertaken by a single full -wave rectifier of
reasonable size, and even the mounting of
dummy valves, of which only the heaters
were connected to anything. It has become
the practice in the U.S.A. to include in the
number of tubes rectifiers, neon, or cathode-

ray tuning indicators, barretters, thermal


delay switches, and even, so I am told, dial
lights. It was hoped that the long-awaited
definition would clear up the position.

Something Better Wanted


Here is what the American R.M.A., in its
wisdom, has' laid down :
" A radio tube is a device used in
radio equipment in which an electric
or magnetic field causes or controls the
electronic or ionic conduction through
a vacuum or a gas. This definition
shall not be construed to include dial
lamps used for illumination only,
ballast or other resistance devices.".
And where does that leave our American
cousins, or us if we buy American wireless
sets? Pretty well where we were before,
I think, except that the dial lamps, the barretters, and the ballast resistances come out
of the tale of valves. Either a neon or a
cathode-ray tuning indicator clearly conforms with the definition, for each is a
device used in radio in which an electric or
magnetic field causes or controls the electronic conduction through a vacuum or a
gas. The rectifier (or a group of small halfwave rectifiers, for that matter) also passes

the test with' flying colours. I am afraid_


that the American .R.M.A.'s definition,
though it looks well enough at fi'f t blush,
leaves the position very much as it was.
%

A Big Query
SOMETIMES I've wondered what

is going
to be the fate this coming season of a
wireless dealer who sells a number of the
less reliable sets with automatic tuning, and
undertakes, as so many do, to keep them in
order for a period. I can quite see him
having a busy time running round with a
signal generator to adjust levers or banks
of pre-set condensers, some of which are so
placed that their screws are not too easily
accessible. But that such sets will go off
tune is more than likely. Even those with
automatic frequency control can do so. I
had one under test which I left alone for a
month to see what would happen, and by
the end of that time the motor-driven automatic arrangement' was quite a long way
out on the London Regional station.

ASSASSI NATION
ATTEMPT AT
ROYAL WEDDING
Bomb Thrown at King
of Spain and Bride

Many Injured

Ingenious
THE newest Ekco receiver, I observe, has,
besides motor -operated press -button
tuning, a device which automatically operates the wave -change switch. It is claimed
for this set that it will tune in any station
on any wavelength automatically-there is,
perhaps, just a leetle of set makers' natural
enthusiasm for their products in that statement. Somehow I don't quite see this (or
any other set) automatically picking out
.

some feeble short-wave station from between


two strongish neighbours on frequencies
close on either side-perhaps that is rather
a carping criticism. The system is certainly
an ingenious one, and I look forward to
trying one of these sets some time. I am
possibly rather sorry to see that this firm
is also going in for cheaper press -button sets
without motor tuning, for I stick to my
point that there are better ways of spending
the money that goes to make low-priced sets
than in providing any kind of automatic
tuning. But with its customary ingenuity,
the firm has arranged the trimmer screws of
the press -button circuits in such a way that
they can be adjusted by the user from the
front of the cabinet.

THE PROJECTOR UNIT of the Baird Television Theatre receiver, in which is incorporated the time base and focusing chassis
and the final stage of the vision amplifier, is
extremely compact. This apparatus is being
used for the demonstration at the Tatler
Theatre, London, and was shown on the
stand of G. B. Equipment Ltd. at the Cinema
Exhibitors' Association Exhibition at Folkestone. The inset
shows the top of the EHT unit, which, using a voltage doubling
circuit, is capable of giving an output of 6o,000 volts at Ito mA.
although in the present apparatus it is giving 30,000 volts at 300
microamps. for the projection CR tube.

.. that wets ixt


1906!
Wires buzzed. Newsboys shrieked themselves hoarse. All Britain was indignant.
A bomb had been thrown at the King of
Spain and his bride-an English Princess.
Yes, big things
sensational things
happened in 1906.
Little things happened too-little things
that were destined to grow big-T.C.C.,
for example. In 1906 T.C.C. started
operations -began to make condensers.
They've been making them ever sincemaking them as they started to make them
32 years ago-efficient and dependable.
Methods have improved, efficiency has
been increased, new ideas have been developed but, to -day, as in 1906, T.C.C.
put dependability first.

T.C.C.
ALL-BRITISH

CONDENSERS
THE TELEGRAPH CONDENSER CO.LTD.
WALES, FARM RD. NORTH ACTON.W.3

5p88

MI

The Wireless World, June 30th, 1938

590

Recent Inventions
Brief descriptions of the more interesting radio
devices and improvements issued as patents
will be included in this section.
"BEAM" VALVES
RELATES to the type of valve
in which electrons from the
cathode are first focused into a
clear-cut beam, .which is then
swung to and fro between two
.anodes by lateral deflecting grids.
Such valved can be used as amplifiers, generators and rectifiers. but
with positive - biased deflection
grids-such as required to keep
the beam focused-it becomes difficult to handle high -frequency currents.
According to the invention negatively biased deflecting -grids are
interposed between a series of
positively biased focusing wires,
the whole being arranged along the
path. of the electron beam, between
the first accelerating anode and the
split -anode output.
N. V. Philips Glaeilampenfabrieken. Convention date (GerNo.
many) April 23rd, 5936.
482226
o

a source not shown) to a coil L


which is shunted across S and G,

and the secondary electrons first


produced by the impact of the
scanning stream on the screen S
are forced, by the AC Voltage, first
on to the grid G, and then back
again with diminished intensity to
bombard the screen S.
Marconi's Wireless Telegraph
Co., Ltd., and L. M. Myers.
Application date, August loth,
1936.

No. 481434.

Goo

TIME -BASE CIRCUITS


THE object -is to prevent unnecessary loss of power when
genehr,.,ng saw-toothed oscillations
for scanning.
Iluring the time the blocking
oscillator valve V is non -conducting. the condenser C charges up

and the current flowing through


the valve V1. As this is much less
than the average current taken by
the diode when it is shunted across
the whole coil, the drain on the
HT source S is reduced accordingly..

L. C. White and A. D. Blum-

Application date. August

Lein.
27112,

No. 482370.

1936.
o

LIGHT=SENSITIVE DIEI.EC.
T R IC

IT has been known

for some time


phosphorus shows a
change in specific inductive
capacity under the action of light,
and will therefore vary the
capacity of any condenser of
which it forms the dielectric.
Hitherto it has been difficult to
turn this " actino-dielectric "

that

TELEVISION BY INCANDESCENCE

incandescent light

scanning stream from the cathode


C of the tube passes through an
open meshwork grid G, and
through a magnetic field from
windings \V, before reaching the
incandescent screen S. An alternating potential is applied (from

This diverts more or


trodes G.
less of the electrons away from the
aperture in an anode A, so that
the stream passing through is
modulated by picture signals.
Telefunken Ges. fair drahtlose
Telegraphie in.b.H.
Convention
date (Germany), September 24th_,
No. 482208.
o

Scanning circuit designed to prevent unnecessary loss of power in the


production of saw-toothed oscillations.
from a source S through a resistance R. The control grid of a
valve Vr follows the saw-toothed

CR tube in which televised pictures are produced by means of

Modulation system for a television transmitter using a phosphorus dielectric condenser.

1935.

TELEVISED pictures are reproduced by incandescent light


-as distinct from the glow of
fluorescence-on a screen composed of particles of tungsten
metal mixed with colloidal grapThe mixture has a low
hite.
thermal conductivity, in order to
prevent the glowing spot, formed
by the bombardment of the scanning stream, from " spreading "
and so losing definition.
On the other band, the screen
mixture shows a certain amount
of thermal inertia, which tends to
introduce an undesirable " lag "
between the impact of the
scanning stream and the resulting
rise in temperature, necessary to
produce incandescence. To overcome this defect. the screen is
subjected, during the intervals
between successive scannings, to a
steady bombardment of secondary
electrons, which maintain it at a
constant temperature just below
the glow point. It will then incandesce more quickly under the
action of the scanning stream.
As shown in the figure, the

denser is inserted in an arm of a


Wheatstone bridge, one diagonal
of which is branched across a high frequency source S, whilst the
other diagonal is connected to the
two deflecting or control electrodes
G of a cathode-ray tube T.
The incidence of the light on
the phosphorus, by upsetting the
balance of the Bridge, applies an
alternating potential to the elec-

voltage produced by the ensuing


discharge, the output from the latter valve_being fed to the deflecting
coils D of a cathode-ray tube (not
shown) through the primary winding of a transformer T. Usually
the whole of this primary winding
is shunted by a diode rectifier in
series with a resistance which dissipates the current taken by the
diode when the current in the primary coil reverses.
According to the invention, the
ohmic losses are reduced by tapping the diode Vz across the upper
half only of the primary coil T,
so that the current to be dissipated
by the resistance Rs amounts only
to the difference between the current flowing through the diode V2

effect to practical advantage owing


to its small magnitude.
The figure shows au arrangement for amplifying the effect in

question, and utilising it to modulate the electron stream passing


through a cathode-ray tube: The
'' sensitive " phosphorus forms
the dielectric of a condenser C, one
plate of which is made as a
transparent wire -mesh, so that the
image of a picture to be transmitted can be projected directly
on to the phosphorus. The con-

THERMIONIC AMPLIFIERS
TIIE electron emission from the
cathode of a valve is known
to depend upon its temperature,
so that an input current or
voltage, applied directly to the
cathode, should produce an increased emission corresponding to
the change of temperature. This
" emission - sensitivity " of the
cathode might therefore be used to
control the output from a valve.
as an alternative to the present
method of grid control.
In practice, however, it is found
that the " thermal inertia " of the
ordinary cathode is too high to
allhw this method to be successfully. used, either for high or low
frequency amplification. That is
to say there is too much " lag "
between the applied current or
voltage, and the resulting rise in
temperature required to produce a
corresponding increase in electron
emission.
To overcome this difficulty it is
proposed to use for a cathode a
ribbon or hand of tungsten reduced by a special method of rolling to a thickness of less than the
one -thousandth part of a millimetre. Such a cathode is sufficiently " heat -sensitive " to respond either to small or -highfrequency inputs, and to produce
corresponding variations in the
electron stream flowing through
the valve.
N. V. Philips GloeilampenFabrieken. Convention date (Germany) May 13th, 193G.
No,
482552.

The British abstracts published here are prepared with the permission
of the Controller of IW.bt. Stationery Office, from Specifications
obtainable at the Patent Office, 25, Southampton Buildings, London,
W.C.2, price 1'- each.

You might also like